* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download - Free Documents
Many-worlds interpretation wikipedia , lookup
Probability amplitude wikipedia , lookup
Gauge fixing wikipedia , lookup
Bell's theorem wikipedia , lookup
Relativistic quantum mechanics wikipedia , lookup
Bra–ket notation wikipedia , lookup
Quantum electrodynamics wikipedia , lookup
Asymptotic safety in quantum gravity wikipedia , lookup
EPR paradox wikipedia , lookup
Quantum field theory wikipedia , lookup
Interpretations of quantum mechanics wikipedia , lookup
Orchestrated objective reduction wikipedia , lookup
Quantum state wikipedia , lookup
BRST quantization wikipedia , lookup
Quantum chromodynamics wikipedia , lookup
Renormalization group wikipedia , lookup
Quantum group wikipedia , lookup
Symmetry in quantum mechanics wikipedia , lookup
Renormalization wikipedia , lookup
Path integral formulation wikipedia , lookup
AdS/CFT correspondence wikipedia , lookup
Introduction to gauge theory wikipedia , lookup
Yang–Mills theory wikipedia , lookup
Hidden variable theory wikipedia , lookup
History of quantum field theory wikipedia , lookup
Canonical quantization wikipedia , lookup
Scalar field theory wikipedia , lookup
Preface A fundamental problem with quantum theories of gravity, as opposed to the other forces of nature, is that in Einsteins theory of gravity, general relativity, there is no background geometry to work with the geometry of spacetime itself becomes a dynamical variable. This is loosely sum marized by saying that the theory is generally covariant. The standard model of the strong, weak, and electromagnetic forces is dominated by the presence of a nitedimensional group, the Poincare group, acting as the symmetries of a spacetime with a xed geometrical structure. In general relativity, on the other hand, there is an innitedimensional group, the group of dieomorphisms of spacetime, which permutes dierent mathe matical descriptions of any given spacetime geometry satisfying Einsteins equations. This causes two dicult problems. On the one hand, one can no longer apply the usual criterion for xing the inner product in the Hilbert space of states, namely that it be invariant under the geometrical symmetry group. This is the socalled inner product problem. On the other hand, dynamics is no longer encoded in the action of the geometrical symmetry group on the space of states. This is the socalled problem of time. The prospects for developing a mathematical framework for quantizing gravity have been considerably changed by a number of developments in the s that at rst seemed unrelated. On the one hand, Jones discov ered a new polynomial invariant of knots and links, prompting an intensive search for generalizations and a unifying framework. It soon became clear that the new knot polynomials were intimately related to the physics of dimensional systems in many ways. Atiyah, however, raised the challenge of nding a manifestly dimensional denition of these polynomials. This challenge was met by Witten, who showed that they occur naturally in ChernSimons theory. ChernSimons theory is a quantum eld theory in dimensions that has the distinction of being generally covariant and also a gauge theory, that is a theory involving connections on a bundle over spacetime. Any knot thus determines a quantity called a Wilson loop, the trace of the holonomy of the connection around the knot. The knot polynomials are simply the expectation values of Wilson loops in the vac uum state of ChernSimons theory, and their dieomorphism invariance is a consequence of the general covariance of the theory. In the explosion of work that followed, it became clear that a useful framework for under standing this situation is Atiyahs axiomatic description of a topological quantum eld theory, or TQFT. On the other hand, at about the same time as Jones initial discov ery, Ashtekar discovered a reformulation of general relativity in terms of v vi Preface what are now called the new variables. This made the theory much more closely resemble a gauge theory. The work of Ashtekar proceeds from the canonical approach to quantization, meaning that solutions to Einsteins equations are identied with their initial data on a given spacelike hyper surface. In this approach the action of the dieomorphism group gives rise to two constraints on initial data the dieomorphism constraint, which generates dieomorphisms preserving the spacelike surface, and the Hamil tonian constraint, which generates dieomorphisms that move the surface in a timelike direction. Following the procedure invented by Dirac, one expects the physical states to be annihilated by certain operators corre sponding to the constraints. In an eort to nd such states, Rovelli and Smolin turned to a descrip tion of quantum general relativity in terms of Wilson loops. In this loop representation, they saw that at least formally a large space of states annihilated by the constraints can be described in terms of invariants of knots and links. The fact that link invariants should be annihilated by the dieomorphism constraint is very natural, since a link invariant is nothing other than a function from links to the complex numbers that is invariant under dieomorphisms of space. In this sense, the relation between knot theory and quantum gravity is a natural one. But the fact that link in variants should also be annihilated by the Hamiltonian constraint is deeper and more intriguing, since it hints at a relationship between knot theory and dimensional mathematics. More evidence for such a relationship was found by Ashtekar and Ko dama, who discovered a strong connection between ChernSimons theory in dimensions and quantum gravity in dimensions. Namely, in terms of the loop representation, the same link invariant that arises from Chern Simons theorya certain normalization of the Jones polynomial called the Kauman bracketalso represents a state of quantum gravity with cosmo logical constant, essentially a quantization of antideSitter space. The full ramications of this fact have yet to be explored. The present volume is the proceedings of a workshop on knots and quantum gravity held on May thth, at the University of Cali fornia at Riverside, under the auspices of the Departments of Mathematics and Physics. The goal of the workshop was to bring together researchers in quantum gravity and knot theory and pursue a dialog between the two subjects. On Friday the th, Dana Fine began with a talk on ChernSimons theory and the WessZuminoWitten model. Wittens original work deriv ing the Jones invariant of links or, more precisely, the Kauman bracket from ChernSimons theory used conformal eld theory in dimensions as a key tool. By now the relationship between conformal eld theory and topological quantum eld theories in dimensions has been explored from a number of viewpoints. The path integral approach, however, has not yet Preface vii been worked out in full mathematical rigor. In this talk Fine described work in progress on reducing the ChernSimons path integral on S to the path integral for the WessZuminoWitten model. Oleg Viro spoke on Simplicial topological quantum eld theories. Re cently there has been increasing interest in formulating TQFTs in a man ner that relies upon triangulating spacetime. In a sense this is an old idea, going back to the ReggePonzano model of Euclidean quantum gravity. However, this idea was given new life by Turaev and Viro, who rigorously constructed the ReggePonzano model of d quantum gravity as a TQFT based on the j symbols for the quantum group SU q . Viro discussed a variety of approaches of presenting manifolds as simplicial complexes, cell complexes, etc., and methods for constructing TQFTs in terms of these data. Saturday began with a talk by Renate Loll on The loop formulation of gauge theory and gravity, introduced the loop representation and var ious mathematical issues associated with it. She also discussed her work on applications of the loop representation to lattice gauge theory. Abhay Ashtekars talk, Loop transforms, largely concerned the paper with Jerzy Lewandowski appearing in this volume. The goal here is to make the loop representation into rigorous mathematics. The notion of measures on the space // of connections modulo gauge transformations has long been a key concept in gauge theory, which, however, has been notoriously di cult to make precise. A key notion developed by Ashtekar and Isham for this purpose is that of the holonomy Calgebra, an algebra of observ ables generated by Wilson loops. Formalizing the notion of a measure on // as a state on this algebra, Ashtekar and Lewandowski have been able to construct such a state with remarkable symmetry properties, in some sense analogous to Haar measure on a compact Lie group. Ashtekar also discussed the implications of this work for the study of quantum gravity. Pullin spoke on The quantum Einstein equations and the Jones poly nomial, describing his work with Bernd Br ugmann and Rodolfo Gambini on this subject. He also sketched the proof of a new result, that the coef cient of the nd term of the AlexanderConway polynomial represents a state of quantum gravity with zero cosmological constant. His paper with Gambini in this volume is a more detailed proof of this fact. On Saturday afternoon, Louis Kauman spoke on Vassiliev invari ants and the loop states in quantum gravity. One aspect of the work of Br uegmann, Gambini, and Pullin that is especially of interest to knot theorists is that it involves extending the bracket invariant to generalized links admitting certain kinds of selfintersections. This concept also plays a major role in the study of Vassiliev invariants of knots. Curiously, however, the extensions occurring in the two cases are dierent. Kauman explained their relationship from the path integral viewpoint. Sunday morning began with a talk by Gerald Johnson, Introduction viii Preface to the Feynman integral and Feynmans operational calculus, on his work with Michel Lapidus on rigorous path integral methods. Viktor Ginzburg then spoke on Vassiliev invariants of knots, and in the afternoon, Paolo CottaRamusino spoke on d quantum gravity and knot theory. This talk dealt with his work in progress with Maurizio Martellini. Just as Chern Simons theory gives a great deal of information on knots in dimensions, there appears to be a relationship between a certain class of dimensional theories and socalled knots, that is, embedded surfaces in dimensions. This class, called BF theories, includes quantum gravity in the Ashtekar formulation, as well as Donaldson theory. CottaRamusino and Martellini have described a way to construct observables associated to knots, and are endeavoring to prove at a perturbative level that they give knot in variants. Louis Crane spoke on Quantum gravity, spin geometry, and categor ical physics. This was a review of his work on the relation between ChernSimons theory and dimensional quantum gravity, his construc tion with David Yetter of a dimensional TQFT based on the j symbols for SU q , and his work with Igor Frenkel on certain braided tensor categories. In the nal talk of the workshop, John Baez spoke on Strings, loops, knots and gauge elds. He attempted to clarify the similarity be tween the loop representation of quantum gravity and string theory. At a xed time both involve loops or knots in space, but the stringtheoretic approach is also related to the study of knots. As some of the speakers did not submit papers for the proceedings, pa pers were also solicited from Steve Carlip and also from J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito. Carlips paper, Geometric structures and loop variables, treats the thorny issue of relating the loop representation of quantum grav ity to the traditional formulation of gravity in terms of a metric. He treats quantum gravity in dimensions, which is an exactly soluble test case. The paper by Carter and Saito, Knotted surfaces, braid movies, and beyond, contains a review of their work on knots as well as a number of new re sults on braids. They also discuss the role in dimensional topology of new algebraic structures such as braided tensor categories. The editor would like to thank many people for making the workshop a success. First and foremost, the speakers and other participants are to be congratulated for making it such a lively and interesting event. The workshop was funded by the Departments of Mathematics and Physics of U. C. Riverside, and the chairs of these departments, Albert Stralka and Benjamin Shen, were crucial in bringing this about. Michel Lapidus deserves warm thanks for his help in planning the workshop. Invaluable help in organizing the workshop and setting things up was provided by the sta of the Department of Mathematics, and particularly Susan Spranger, Linda Terry, and Chris Truett. Arthur Greenspoon kindly volunteered to help edit the proceedings. Lastly, thanks go to all the participants in the Preface ix Knots and Quantum Gravity Seminar at U. C. Riverside, and especially Jim Gilliam, Javier Muniain, and Mou Roy, who helped set things up. x Preface Contents The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Renate Loll Introduction YangMills theory and general relativity as dynamics on connection space Introducing loops Equivalence between the connection and loop formulations Some lattice results on loops Quantization in the loop approach Acknowledgements Bibliography Representation Theory of Analytic Holonomy C algebras Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski Introduction Preliminaries The spectrum . Loop decomposition . Characterization of // . Examples of A Integration on // . Cylindrical functions . A natural measure Discussion Appendix A C loops and U connections Appendix B C loops, UN and SUN connections Acknowledgements Bibliography The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Introduction The WheelerDeWitt equation in terms of loops The Gauss selflinking number as a solution Discussion Acknowledgements xi xii Contents Bibliography Vassiliev Invariants and the Loop States in Quantum Gravity Louis H. Kauman Introduction Quantum mechanics and topology Links and the Wilson loop Graph invariants and Vassiliev invariants Vassiliev invariants from the functional integral Quantum gravityloop states Acknowledgements Bibliography Geometric Structures and Loop Variables in dimensional Gravity Steven Carlip Introduction From geometry to holonomies Geometric structures from holonomies to geometry Quantization and geometrical observables Acknowledgements Bibliography From ChernSimons to WZW via Path Integrals Dana S. Fine Introduction The main result // n as a bundle over G An explicit reduction from ChernSimons to WZW Acknowledgements Bibliography Topological Field Theory as the Key to Quantum Gravity Louis Crane Introduction Quantum mechanics of the universe. Categorical physics Ideas from TQFT Hilbert space is deadlong live Hilbert space or the observer gas approximation The problem of time Contents xiii Matter and symmetry Acknowledgements Bibliography Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields John C. Baez Introduction String eld/gauge eld duality YangMills theory in dimensions Quantum gravity in dimensions Quantum gravity in dimensions Acknowledgements Bibliography BF Theories and knots Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini Introduction BF theories and their geometrical signicance knots and their quantum observables Gauss constraints Path integrals and the Alexander invariant of a knot Firstorder perturbative calculations and higherdimensional linking numbers Wilson channels Integration by parts Acknowledgements Bibliography Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Introduction Movies, surface braids, charts, and isotopies . Movie moves . Surface braids . Chart descriptions . Braid movie moves . Denition locality equivalence The permutohedral and tetrahedral equations . The tetrahedral equation . The permutohedral equation . Planar versions categories and the movie moves . Overview of categories . The category of braid movies xiv Contents Algebraic interpretations of braid movie moves . Identities among relations and Peier elements . Moves on surface braids and identities among re lations . Symmetric equivalence and moves on surface braids . Concluding remarks Acknowledgements Bibliography The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Renate Loll Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry, Pennsylvania State University, University Park, Pennsylvania , USA email lollphys.psu.edu Abstract This chapter contains an overview of the loop formulation of Yang Mills theory and dimensional gravity in the Ashtekar form. Since the conguration spaces of these theories are spaces of gauge potentials, their classical and quantum descriptions may be given in terms of gaugeinvariant Wilson loops. I discuss some mathematical problems that arise in the loop formulation and illustrate parallels and dierences between the gauge theoretic and gravitational appli cations. Some remarks are made on the discretized lattice approach. Introduction This chapter summarizes the main ideas and basic mathematical structures that are necessary to understand the loop formulation of both gravity and gauge theory. It is also meant as a guide to the literature, where all the relevant details may be found. Many of the mathematical problems aris ing in the loop approach are described in a related review article . I have tried to treat YangMills theory and gravity in parallel, but also to highlight important dierences. Section summarizes the classical and quantum features of gauge theory and gravity, formulated as theories of connections. In Section , the Wilson loops and their properties are intro duced, and Section discusses the classical equivalence between the loop and the connection formulation. Section contains a summary of progress in a corresponding lattice loop approach, and in Section some of the main ingredients of quantum loop representations are discussed. YangMills theory and general relativity as dynamics on connection space In this section I will briey recall the Lagrangian and Hamiltonian for mulation of both pure YangMills gauge theory and gravity, dened on a dimensional manifold M R of Lorentzian signature. The gravi tational theory will be described in the Ashtekar form, in which it most Renate Loll closely resembles a gauge theory. The classical actions dening these theories are up to overall constants S YM A M d x Tr F F M TrF F . and S GR A, e M d xee I e J F IJ M IJKL e I e J F KL . for YangMills theory and general relativity respectively. In ., the basic variable A is a LieGvalued connection form on M, where G denotes the compact and semisimple Liestructure group of the YangMills theory typically G SUN. In ., which is a rstorder form of the gravi tational action, A is a selfdual, so, C valued connection form, and e a vierbein, dening an isomorphism of vector spaces between the tangent space of M and the xed internal space with the Minkowski metric IJ . The connection A is selfdual in the internal space, A MN i MN IJ A IJ , with the totally antisymmetric tensor. A mathematical characterization of the action . is contained in Baez chapter . As usual, F denotes in both cases the curvature associated with the dimensional connection A. Note that the action . has the unusual feature of being complex. I will not explain here why this still leads to a welldened theory equivalent to the standard formulation of general relativity. Details may be found in ,. Our main interest will be the Hamiltonian formulations associated with . and .. Assuming the underlying principal bre bundles P, G to be trivial, we can identify the relevant phase spaces with cotangent bundles over ane spaces / of LieGvalued connections on the dimensional manifold assumed compact and orientable. The cotangent bundle T / is coordinatized by canonically conjugate pairs A, E, where A is a LieG valued, pseudotensorial form gauge potential and E a LieGvalued vector density generalized electric eld on . We have G SUN, say, for gauge theory, and G SO C for gravity. The standard symplectic structure on T / is expressed by the fundamental Poisson bracket relations A i a x, E b j y i j b a xy. for gauge theory, and A i a x, E b j yi i j b a xy. for gravity, where the factor of i arises because the connection A is complex valued. In . and ., a and b are dimensional spatial indices and i The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity and j internal gauge algebra indices. However, points in T / do not yet correspond to physical congura tions, because both theories possess gauge symmetries, which are related to invariances of the original Lagrangians under certain transformations on the fundamental variables. At the Hamiltonian level, this manifests it self in the existence of socalled rstclass constraints. These are sets of functions C on phase space, which are required to vanish, C , for phys ical congurations and at the same time generate transformations between physically indistinguishable congurations. In our case, the rstclass con straints for the two theories are YM D a E ai . and GR D a E ai ,C a F ab i E b i ,C ijk F ab i E a j E b k .. The physical interpretation of these constraints is as follows the so called Gauss law constraints D a E ai , which are common to both theo ries, restrict the allowed congurations to those whose covariant divergence vanishes, and at the same time generate local gauge transformations in the internal space. The wellknown YangMills transformation law correspond ing to a group element g , the set of Gvalued functions on , is A, Eg Ag g dg, g Eg. . The second set, C a , of constraints in . generates dimensional dieomorphisms of and the last expression, the socalled scalar or Hamil tonian constraint C, generates phase space transformations that are inter preted as corresponding to the time evolution of the spatial slice in M in a spacetime picture. Comparing . and ., we see that in the Hamil tonian formulation, pure gravity may be interpreted as a YangMills theory with gauge group G SO C , subject to four additional constraints in each point of . However, the dynamics of the two theories is dierent we have H YM A, E d xg ab g E ai E b i gB ai B b i . as the Hamiltonian for YangMills theory where for convenience we have introduced the generalized magnetic eld B a i abc F bc i . Note the explicit appearance of a Riemannian background metric g on , to contract indices and ensure the integrand in . is a density. On the other hand, no such additional background structure is necessary to make the gravitational Hamiltonian well dened. The Hamiltonian H GR for gravity is a sum of a Renate Loll subset of the constraints ., H GR A, Ei d x N a F ab i E b i i N ijk F ab k E a i E b j ,. and therefore vanishes on physical congurations. N and N a in . are Lagrange multipliers, the socalled lapse and shift functions. This latter feature is peculiar to generally covariant theories, whose gauge group contains the dieomorphism group of the underlying manifold. A further dierence from the gaugetheoretic application is the need for a set of reality conditions for the gravitational theory, because the connection A is a priori a complex coordinate on phase space. The space of physical congurations of YangMills theory is the quotient space // of gauge potentials modulo local gauge transformations. It is nonlinear and has nontrivial topology. After excluding the reducible connections from /, this quotient can be given the structure of an innite dimensional manifold for compact and semisimple G . The corresponding physical phase space is then its cotangent bundle T //. Elements of T // are called classical observables of the YangMills theory. The nonlinearities of both the equations of motion and the physical conguration/phase spaces, and the presence of gauge symmetries for these theories, lead to numerous diculties in their classical and quantum de scription. For example, in the path integral quantization of YangMills theory, a gaugexing term has to be introduced in the sum over all con gurations Z , dA e iSY M ,. to ensure that the integration is only taken over one member A of each gauge equivalence class. However, because the principal bundle / // is nontrivial, we know that a unique and attainable gauge choice does not exist this is the assertion of the socalled Gribov ambiguity. In any case, since the expression . can be made meaningful only in a weakeld approximation where one splits S YM S free S I , with S free being just quadratic in A, this approach has not yielded enough information about other sectors of the theory, where the elds cannot be assumed weak. Similarly, in the canonical quantization, since no good explicit descrip tion of T // is available, one quantizes the theory a la Dirac. This means that one rst quantizes on the unphysical phase space T /, as if there were no constraints. That is, one uses a formal operator repre sentation of the canonical variable pairs A, E, satisfying the canonical commutation relations A i a x, E b j y ih i j b a x y, . The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity the quantum analogues of the Poisson brackets .. Then a subset of physical wave functions T YM phy phy A is projected out from the space of all wave functions, T A, according to T YM phy AT TEA , . i.e. T YM phy consists of all functions that lie in the kernel of the quantized Gauss constraint, TE. For a critical appraisal of the use of such Dirac conditions, see . The notations T and T YM phy indicate that these are just spaces of complexvalued functions on / and do not yet carry any Hilbert space structure. Whereas this is not required on the unphysical space T, one does need such a structure on T YM phy in order to make physical statements, for instance about the spectrum of the quantum Hamiltonian H. Unfortunately, we lack an appropriate scalar product, i.e. an appropri ate gaugeinvariant measure dA in phy , t phy ,/ dA phy A t phy A. . More precisely, we expect the integral to range over an extension of the space // which includes also distributional elements . Given such a measure, the space of physical wave functions would be the Hilbert space H YM T YM phy of functions squareintegrable with respect to the inner product .. Unfortunately, the situation for gravity is not much better. Here the space of physical wave functions is the subspace of T projected out accord ing to T GR phy AT TEA , C a A, CA . . Again, one now needs an inner product on the space of such states. As suming that the states phy of quantum gravity can be described as the set of complexvalued functions on some still innitedimensional space /, the analogue of . reads phy , t phy , dA phy A t phy A, . where the measure dA is now both gauge and dieomorphism invariant and projects in an appropriate way to /. If we had such a measure again, we do not, the Hilbert space H GR of states for quantum gravity would con sist of all those elements of T GR phy which are squareintegrable with respect to that measure. In theup to nowabsence of explicit measures to make ., . well dened, our condence in the procedure outlined here stems from the fact that it can be made meaningful for lowerdimensional model systems such as YangMills theory in and gravity in di Renate Loll mensions, where the analogues of the space / are nite dimensional cf. also . Note that there is a very important dierence in the role played by the quantum Hamiltonians in gauge theory and gravity. In YangMills theory, one searches for solutions in H YM of the eigenvector equation H YM phy AE phy A, whereas in gravity the quantum Hamiltonian C is one of the constraints and therefore a physical state of quantum gravity must lie in its kernel, C phy A. After all that has been said about the diculties of nding a canon ical quantization for gauge theory and general relativity, the reader may wonder whether one can make any statements at all about their quantum theories. For the case of YangMills theory, the answer is of course in the armative. Many qualitative and quantitative statements about quantum gauge theory can be derived in a regularized version of the theory, where the at background spacetime is approximated by a hypercubic lattice. Using rened computational methods, one then tries to extract for either weak or strong coupling properties of the continuum theory, for exam ple an approximate spectrum of the Hamiltonian H YM , in the limit as the lattice spacing tends to zero. Still there are nonperturbative features, the most important being the connement property of YangMills theory, which also in this framework are not well understood. Similar attempts to discretize the Hamiltonian theory have so far been not very fruitful in the treatment of gravity, because, unlike in YangMills theory, there is no xed background metric with respect to which one could build a hypercubic lattice, without violating the dieomorphism invariance of the theory. However, there are more subtle ways in which discrete struc tures arise in canonical quantum gravity. An example of this is given by the latticelike structures used in the construction of dieomorphisminvariant measures on the space // , . One important ingredient we will be focusing on are the nonlocal loop variables on the space / of connections, which will be the subject of the next section. Introducing loops A loop in is a continuous map from the unit interval into , , s a s, . s. t. . The set of all such maps will be denoted by , the loop space of . Given such a loop element , and a space / of connections, we can dene The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity a complex function on /, the socalled Wilson loop, T A N Tr R P exp A. . The pathordered exponential of the connection A along the loop , U P exp A, is also known as the holonomy of A along . The holonomy measures the change undergone by an internal vector when parallel trans ported along . The trace is taken in the representation R of G, and N is the dimensionality of this linear representation. The quantity T A was rst introduced by K. Wilson as an indicator of conning behaviour in the lattice gauge theory . It measures the curvature or eld strength in a gaugeinvariant way the components of the tensor F ab itself are not mea surable, as can easily be seen by expanding T A for an innitesimal loop . The Wilson loop has a number of interesting properties. . It is invariant under the local gauge transformations ., and there fore an observable for YangMills theory. . It is invariant under orientationpreserving reparametrizations of the loop . . It is independent of the basepoint chosen on . It follows from and that the Wilson loop is a function on a crossproduct of the quotient spaces, T A T// /Di S . In gravity, the Wilson loops are not observables, since they are not in variant under the full set of gauge transformations of the theory. However, there is now one more reason to consider variables that depend on closed curves in , since observables in gravity also have to be invariant under dif feomorphisms of . This means going one step further in the construction of such observables, by considering Wilson loops that are constant along the orbits of the Diaction, T T, Di. . Such a loop variable will just depend on what is called the generalized knot class K of generalized since may possess selfintersections and selfoverlaps, which is not usually considered in knot theory. Note that a similar construction for taking care of the dieomorphism invariance is not very contentful if we start from a local scalar function, x, say. The analogue of . would then tell us that had to be constant on any connected component of . The set of such variables is not big enough to account for all the degrees of freedom of gravity. In contrast, loops can carry dieomorphisminvariant information such as their number of selfintersections, number of points of nondierentiability, etc. The use of nonlocal holonomy variables in gauge eld theory was pi oneered by Mandelstam in his paper on Quantum electrodynamics Renate Loll without potentials , and later generalized to the nonAbelian theory by BialynickiBirula and again Mandelstam . Another upsurge in interest in pathdependent formulations of YangMills theory took place at the end of the s, following the observation of the close formal re semblance of a particular form of the YangMills equations in terms of holonomy variables with the equations of motion of the dimensional non linear sigma model , . Another set of equations for the Wilson loop was derived by Makeenko and Migdal see, for example, the review . The hope underlying such approaches has always been that one may be able to nd a set of basic variables for YangMills theory which are better suited to its quantization than the local gauge potentials Ax. Owing to their simple behaviour under local gauge transformations, the holonomy or the Wilson loop seem like ideal candidates. The aim has therefore been to derive suitable dierential equations in loop space for the holonomy U , its trace, T, or for their vacuum expectation values, which are to be thought of as the analogues of the usual local YangMills equations of motion. The fact that none of these attempts have been very successful can be attributed to a number of reasons. To make sense of dierential equations on loop space, one rst has to introduce a suitable topology, and then set up a dierential calculus on . Even if we give locally the structure of a topological vector space, and are able to dene dierentiation, this in general will ensure the existence of neither inverse and implicit function theorems nor theorems on the existence and uniqueness of solutions of dierential equations. Such issues have only received scant attention in the past. Since the space of all loops in is so much larger than the set of all points in , one expects that not all loop variables will be in dependent. This expectation is indeed correct, as will be explained in the next section. Still, the ensuing redundancy is hard to control in the continuum theory, and has therefore obscured many attempts of establishing an equivalence between the connection and the loop formulation of gauge theory. For example, there is no action princi ple in terms of loop variables, which leaves considerable freedom for deriving loop equations of motion. As another consequence, pertur bation theory in the loop approach always had to fall back on the perturbative expansion in terms of the connection variable A. Equivalence between the connection and loop formulations In this section I will discuss the motivation for adopting a pure loop for mulation for any theory whose conguration space comes from a space // of connection forms modulo local gauge transformations. For the YangMills theory itself, there is a strong physical motivation to choose The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity the variables T as a set of basic variables on physical grounds, one requires only physical observables O i.e. in our case the Wilson loops, and not the local elds A to be represented by selfadjoint operators O in the quantum theory, with the classical Poisson relations O, O t going over to the quantum commutators ih O, O t . There is also a mathematical justication for reexpressing the classical theory in terms of loop variables. It is a wellknown result that one can reconstruct the gauge potential A up to gauge transformations from the knowledge of all holonomies U , for any structure group G GLN, C. Therefore all that remains to be shown is that one can reconstruct the holonomies U from the set of Wilson loops T. It turns out that, at least for compact G, there is indeed an equivalence between the two quotient spaces / T, /Di S Mandelstam constraints .. By Mandelstam constraints I mean a set of necessary and sucient con ditions on generic complex functions f on /Di S that ensure they are the traces of holonomies of a group G in a given representation R. They are typically algebraic, nonlinear constraints among the T. To obtain a complete set of such conditions without making reference to the connection space / is a nontrivial problem that for general G to my knowledge has not been solved. For example, for G SL, C in the fundamental representation by matrices, the Mandelstam constraints are a Tpoint loop bTT cT T . dTT t , t eT T T T . The loop t in eqn d is the loop with an appendix attached, where is any path not necessarily closed starting at a point of see Fig. . In e, is a path starting at a point of and ending at see Fig. . The circle denotes the usual path composition. It is believed that the set . and all conditions that can be derived from . exhaust the Mandelstam constraints for this particular gauge group and represen tation, although I am not aware of a formal proof. Still, owing to the noncompactness of G, it can be shown that not every element of // can be reconstructed from the Wilson loops. This is the case for holonomies that take their values in the socalled subgroup of null rotations . How ever, this leads only to an incompleteness of measure zero of the Wilson Renate Loll Fig. . Adding an appendix to the loop does not change the Wilson loop Fig. . The loop congurations related by the Mandelstam constraint T T T T loops on //. If one wants to restrict the group G to a subgroup of SL, C, there are further conditions on the loop variables, which now take the form of inequalities . For SU SL, C, one nds the two conditions T, T T T T ,. whereas for SU, SL, C one derives T T T T T T ,. and no restrictions for other values of T and T . Unfortunately, The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity . and . do not exhaust all inequalities there are for SU and SU, respectively. There are more inequalities corresponding to more complicated congurations of more than two intersecting loops, which are critically dependent on the geometry of the loop conguration. Let me nish this section with some further remarks on the Mandelstam constraints In cases where the Wilson loops form a complete set of variables, they are actually overcomplete, due to the existence of the Mandel stam constraints i.e. implicitly the nontrivial topological structure of //. This is the overcompleteness I referred to in the previous section. Note that one may interpret some of the constraints . as con straints on the underlying loop space, i.e. the Wilson loops are eec tively not functions on /Di S , but on some appropriate quo tient with respect to equivalence relations such as . The existence of such relations makes it dicult to apply directly math ematical results on the loop space or the space /Di S of oriented, unparametrized loops such as , , , to the present case. One has to decide how the Mandelstam constraints are to be carried over to the quantum theory. One may try to eliminate as many of them as possible already in the classical theory, but real progress in this direction has only been made in the discretized lattice gauge theory see Section below. Another possibility will be mentioned in Section . Finally, let me emphasize that the equivalence of the connection and the loop description at the classical level does not necessarily mean that quantization with the Wilson loops as a set of basic variables will be equivalent to a quantization in which the connections A are turned into fundamental quantum operators. One may indeed hope that at some level, those two possibilities lead to dierent results, with the loop representation being better suited for the description of the nonperturbative structure of the theory. Some lattice results on loops This section describes the idea of taking the Wilson loops as the set of basic variables, as applied to gauge theory, although some of the techniques and conclusions may be relevant for gravitational theories too. The lattice discretization is particularly suited to the loop formulation, because in it the gauge elds are taken to be concentrated on the dimensional links l i of the lattice. The Wilson loops are easily formed by multiplying together the holonomies U l ...U ln of a set of contiguous, oriented links that form Renate Loll Fig. . is a loop on the hypercubic lattice N d ,N,d. a closed chain on the lattice see Fig. , T Tr R U l U l ...U ln .. We take the lattice to be the hypercubic lattice N d , with periodic boundary conditions N is the number of links in each direction, and the gauge group G to be SU, again in the fundamental representation. Although the lattice is nite, there are an innite number of closed con tours one can form on it, and hence an innite number of Wilson loops. At the same time, the number of Mandelstam constraints . is innite. The only constraints that cause problems are those of type e, because of their nonlinear and highly coupled character. Nevertheless, as I showed in , it is possible to solve this coupled set of equations and obtain an explicit local description of the nitedimensional physical conguration space phy / lattice T, a lattice loop Mandelstam constraints . in terms of an independent set of Wilson loops. The nal solution for the independent degrees of freedom is surprisingly simple it suces to use the Wilson loops of small lattice loops, consisting of no more than six lattice links. At this point it may be noted that a similar problem arises in gravity in the connection formulation on a manifold g R, with a compact, dimensional Riemann surface g of genus g. One also has a discrete set of loops, namely, the elements of the homotopy group of g , and can introduce the corresponding Wilson loops. Again, one is interested in nding a maximally reduced set of such Wilson loops, in terms of which all the others can be expressed, using the Mandelstam constraints see, for example, , . The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Of course it does not suce to establish a set of independent loop variables on the lattice one also has to show that the dynamics can be expressed in a manageable form in terms of these variables. Some important problems are the following. . Since the space phy // is topologically nontrivial, the set of independent lattice Wilson loops cannot provide a good global chart for phy . It would therefore be desirable to nd a minimal embedding into a space of loop variables that is topologically trivial together with a nite number of nonlinear constraints that dene the space phy . . What is the explicit form of the Jacobian of the transformation from the holonomy link variables to the Wilson loops From this one could derive an eective action/Hamiltonian for gauge theory, and maybe derive a prescription of how to translate local quantities into their loop space analogues. . Is it possible to dene a perturbation theory in loop space, once one understands which Wilson loop congurations contribute most in the path integral, say This would be an interesting alternative to the usual perturbation theory in A or the N expansion, and may lead to new and more ecient ways of performing calculations in lattice gauge theory. . Lastly, in nding a solution to the Mandelstam constraints it was crucial to have the concept of a smallest loop size on the lattice the loops of link length going around a single plaquette. What are the consequences of this result for the continuum theory, where there is no obstruction to shrinking loops down to points Some progress on points and has been made for small lattices , and it is clear that all of the aboveposed problems are rather nontrivial, even in the discretized lattice theory where the number of degrees of freedom is eectively nite. One may be able to apply some of the techniques used here to dimensional gravity, where discrete structures appear too the generalized knot classes after factoring out by the spatial dieomorphisms. Quantization in the loop approach I will now return to the discussion of the continuum theory of both gravity and gauge theory, and review a few concepts that have been used in their quantization in a loop formulation. The contributions by Ashtekar and Lewandowski and Pullin in this volume contain more details about some of the points raised here. The main idea is to base the canonical quantization of a theory with conguration space / on the nonlocal, gaugeinvariant phase space vari ables T and not on some gaugecovariant local eld variables. This Renate Loll is a somewhat unusual procedure in the quantization of a eld theory, but takes directly into account the nonlinearities of the theory. You may have noted that so far we have only talked about congura tion space variables, the Wilson loops. For a canonical quantization we obviously need some momentum variables that depend on the generalized electric eld E. One choice of a generalized Wilson loop that also depends on E is T a A, E , s Tr U s E a s. . This variable depends now on both a loop and a marked point, and it is still gauge invariant under the transformations .. Also it is strictly speaking not a function on phase space, but a vector density. This latter fact may be remedied by integrating T a over a dimensional ribbon or strip, i.e. a nondegenerate parameter congruence of curves t s Rs, t, t , . In any case, the momentum Wilson loop depends not just on a loop, but needs an additional geometric ingredient. I will use here the unsmeared version since it does not aect what I am going to say. The crucial ingredient in the canonical quantization is the fact that the loop variables T, T a , s form a closing algebra with respect to the canonical symplectic structure on T /. This fact was rst established by Gambini and Trias for the gauge group SUN and later rediscovered by Rovelli and Smolin in the context of gravity . For the special case of G SL, C or any of its subgroups in the fundamental representation, the Poisson algebra of the loop variable s is T ,T , T a , s, T a , s T s T s , T a , s, T b ,t. a , s T b s , ut T b s , ut b , t T a t , vs T a t , vs . In the derivation of this semidirect product algebra, the Mandelstam con straints .e have been used to bring the righthand sides into a form linear in T. The structure constants are distributional and depend just on the geometry of loops and intersection points, a ,x dt t, x a t. . The Poisson bracket of two loop variables is nonvanishing only when an insertion of an electric eld E in a T a variable coincides in with the holonomy of another loop. For gauge group SUN, the righthand sides of the Poisson brackets can no longer be written as linear expressions in T. The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity By a quantization of the theory in the loop representation we will mean a representation of the loop algebra . as the commutator algebra of a set of selfadjoint operators T, T a , s or an appropriately smeared version of the momentum operator T a , s. Secondly, the Mandelstam constraints must be incorporated in the quantum theory, for example by demanding that relations like . hold also for the corresponding quan tum operators T. For the momentum Wilson loops there are analogous Mandelstam constraints. The completion of this quantization program is dierent for gauge the ory and gravity, in line with the remarks made in Section above. For YangMills theory, one has to nd a Hilbert space of wave functionals that depend on either the Wilson loops T or directly on the elements of some appropriate quotient of a loop space. The quantized Wilson loops must be selfadjoint with respect to the inner product on this Hilbert space, since they correspond to genuine observables in the classical theory. Then the YangMills Hamiltonian . has to be reexpressed as a function of Wilson loops, and nally, one has to solve the eigenvector equation H YM T, T a E, . to obtain the spectrum of the theory. Because of the lack of an appropriate scalar product in the continuum theory, the only progress that has been made along these lines is in the latticeregularized version of the gauge theory see, for example, , . For the case of general relativity one does not require the loop vari ables T, T a , s to be represented selfadjointly, because they do not constitute observables on the classical phase space. At least one such repre sentation where the generalized Wilson loops are represented as dierential operators on a space of loop functionals is known, and has been ex tensively used in quantum gravity. The completion of the loop quantization program for gravity requires an appropriate inclusion of the dimensional dieomorphism constraints C a and the Hamiltonian constraint C, cf. ., which again means that they have to be reexpressed in terms of loop vari ables. Then, solutions to these quantum constraints have to be found, i.e. loop functionals that lie in their kernel, C a T, T a CT, T a .. Finally, the space of these solutions or an appropriate subspace has to be given a Hilbert space structure to make a physical interpretation possible. No suitable scalar product is known at the moment, but there exist a large number of solutions to the quantum constraint equations .. These solutions and their relation to knot invariants are the subject of Pullins chapter . There is one more interesting mathematical structure in the loop ap Renate Loll proach to which I would like to draw attention, and which tries to establish a relation between the quantum connection and the quantum loop rep resentations. This is the socalled loop transform, rst introduced by Rovelli and Smolin , which is supposed to intertwine the two types of representations according to ,/ dA T A phy A. and T ,/ dA T A T phy A ,. and similarly for the action of the T a . Indeed, it was by the heuristic use of . and . that Rovelli and Smolin arrived at the quantum representation of the loop algebra . mentioned above. The relation . is to be thought of as a nonlinear analogue of the Fourier transform p dx e ixp x. on L R, dx, but does in general not possess an inverse. Again, for Yang Mills theory we do not know how to construct a concrete measure dA that would allow us to proceed with a loop quantization program, although in this case the loop transform can be given a rigorous mathematical meaning. For the application to gravity, the domain space of the integration will be a smaller space /, as explained in Section above, but for this case we know even less about the welldenedness of expressions like . and .. There is, however, a variety of simpler examples such as dimensional gravity, electrodynamics, etc. where the loop transform is a very useful and mathematically welldened tool. The following diagram Fig. summarizes the relations between con nection and loop dynamics, both classically and quantummechanically, as outlined in Sections and . The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Fig. . Renate Loll Acknowledgements Warm thanks to John Baez for organizing an inspiring workshop. Bibliography . Arefeva, I. Ya. The gauge eld as chiral eld on the path and its integrability, Lett. Math. Phys. . Arms, J. M., Marsden, J. E., and Moncrief, V. Symmetry and bi furcations of momentum mappings, Commun. Math. Phys. . Ashtekar, A. Lectures on nonperturbative gravity, World Scientic, Singapore, . Ashtekar, A. Mathematical problems of nonperturbative quantum general relativity, Les Houches lecture notes, preprint Syracuse SU GP/ . Ashtekar, A. and Isham, C. J. Representations of the holonomy alge bras of gravity and nonAbelian gauge theories, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Ashtekar, A. and Lewandowski, J. Representation theory of analytic Calgebras, this volume . Ashtekar, A. and Loll, R. New loop representations for gravity, Penn. State University preprint, in preparation . Baez, J. Dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations, to appear in the Pro ceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology, eds L. Crane and D. Yetter, hepth . Baez, J. Strings, loops, knots, and gauge elds, this volume . BialynickiBirula, I. Gaugeinvariant variables in the YangMills the ory, Bull. Acad. Polon. Sci. . Br ugmann, B. The method of loops applied to lattice gauge theory, Phys. Rev. D . Brylinski, J. M. The Kaehler geometry of the space of knots in a smooth threefold, Penn. State pure mathematics report No. PM . Fulp, R. O. The nonintegrable phase factor and gauge theory, in Proceedings of the Summer Institute on Dierential Geometry, Symposia in Pure Mathematics Series . Fulp, R. O. Connections on the path bundle of a principal bre bun dle, Math. preprint North Carolina State University . Gambini, R. and Setaro, L. SU QCD in the path representation, preprint Montevideo, April . Gambini, R. and Trias, A. Gauge dynamics in the Crepresentation, The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Nucl. Phys. B . Giles, R. Reconstruction of gauge potentials from Wilson loops, Phys. Rev. D . Goldberg, J. N., Lewandowski, J., and Stornaiolo, C. Degeneracy in loop variables, Commun. Math. Phys. . Loll, R. Independent SUloop variables and the reduced congu ration space of SUlattice gauge theory, Nucl. Phys. B . Loll, R. Canonical and BRSTquantization of constrained systems, in Mathematical aspects of classical eld theory, eds M. Gotay, J. Marsden, V. Moncrief, Contemporary Mathematics Series, vol. , . Loll, R. Chromodynamics and gravity as theories on loop space, Penn. State University preprint CGPG/, hepth , September . Loll, R. YangMills theory without Mandelstam constraints, Nucl. Phys. B . Loll, R. Loop variable inequalities in gravity and gauge theory, Clas sical amp Quantum Gravity . Mandelstam, S. Quantum electrodynamics without potentials, Ann. Phys. NY . Mandelstam, S. Feynman rules for electromagnetic and YangMills elds from the gaugeindependent eldtheoretic formalism, Phys. Rev. . Migdal, A. A. Loop equations and /N expansion, Phys. Rep. . Nelson, J. E. and Regge, T. gravity for genus gt , Commun. Math. Phys. . Polyakov, A. M. String representations and hidden symmetries for gauge elds, Phys. Lett. B . Pullin, J. The Gauss linking number in quantum gravity, this volume . Rovelli, C. and Smolin, L. Loop space representation of quantum general relativity, Nucl. Phys. B . Schaper, U. Geometry of loop spaces, I. A KaluzaKlein type point of view, preprint Freiburg THEP /, March , pp. . Wilson, K. Connement of quarks, Phys. Rev. D Renate Loll Representation Theory of Analytic Holonomy Calgebras Abhay Ashtekar Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry, Pennsylvania State University, University Park, Pennsylvania , USA email ashtekarphys.psu.edu Jerzy Lewandowski Department of Physics, University of Florida, Gainesville, Florida , USA email lewandfuw.edu.pl Abstract Integral calculus on the space A/G of gaugeequivalent connections is developed. Loops, knots, links, and graphs feature prominently in this description. The framework is well suited for quantization of dieomorphisminvariant theories of connections. The general setting is provided by the Abelian Calgebra of functions on A/G generated by Wilson loops i.e. by the traces of holonomies of connections around closed loops. The representation theory of this algebra leads to an interesting and powerful dual ity between gauge equivalence classes of connections and certain equivalence classes of closed loops. In particular, regular measures on a suitable completion of A/G are in correspondence with certain functions of loops and dieomorphism invariant measures correspond to generalized knot and link invariants. By carrying out a nonlinear extension of the theory of cylindrical measures on topological vector spaces, a faithful, dieomorphisminvariant mea sure is introduced. This measure can be used to dene the Hilbert space of quantum states in theories of connections. The Wilson loop functionals then serve as the conguration operators in the quantum theory. Introduction The space // of connections modulo gauge transformations plays an im portant role in gauge theories, including certain topological theories and general relativity . In a typical setup, // is the classical congu ration space. In the quantum theory, then, the Hilbert space of states On leave from Instytut Fizyki Teoretycznej, Warsaw University ul. Hoza , Warszawa, Poland Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski would consist of all squareintegrable functions on // with respect to some measure. Thus, the theory of integration over // would lie at the heart of the quantization procedure. Unfortunately, since // is an innitedimensional nonlinear space, the wellknown techniques to dene integrals do not go through and, at the outset, the problem appears to be rather dicult. Even if this problem could be overcome, one would still face the issue of constructing selfadjoint operators corresponding to phys ically interesting observables. In a Hamiltonian approach, the Wilson loop functions provide a natural set of manifestly gaugeinvariant congura tion observables. The problem of constructing the analogous, manifestly gaugeinvariant momentum observables is dicult already in the classical theory these observables would correspond to vector elds on // and dierential calculus on this space is not well developed. Recently, Ashtekar and Isham hereafter referred to as AI devel oped an algebraic approach to tackle these problems. The AI approach is in the setting of canonical quantization and is based on the ideas in troduced by Gambini and Trias in the context of YangMills theories and by Rovelli and Smolin in the context of quantum general relativity . Fix an nmanifold on which the connections are to be dened and a compact Lie group G which will be the gauge group of the theory un der consideration . The rst step is the construction of a Calgebra of conguration observablesa suciently large set of gaugeinvariant func tions of connections on . A natural strategy is to use the Wilson loop functionsthe traces of holonomies of connections around closed loops on to generate this Calgebra. Since these are conguration observables, they commute even in the quantum theory. The Calgebra is therefore Abelian. The next step is to construct representations of this algebra. For this, the Gelfand spectral theory provides a natural setting since any given Abelian Calgebra with identity is naturally isomorphic with the Calgebra of continuous functions on a compact, Hausdor space, the Gelfand spectrum spC of that algebra. As the notation suggests, spC can be constructed directly from the given Calgebra its ele ments are homomorphisms from the given Calgebra to the algebra of complex numbers. Consequently, every continuous cyclic representation of the AI Calgebra is of the following type the carrier Hilbert space is L spC , d for some regular measure d and the Wilson loop operators act on squareintegrable functions on spC simply by multiplication. AI pointed out that, since the elements of the Calgebra are labelled by loops, there is a correspondence between regular measures on spC In typical applications, will be a Cauchy surface in an n dimensional space time in the Lorentzian regime or an ndimensional spacetime in the Euclidean regime. In the main body of this paper, n will be taken to be and G will be taken to be SU both for concreteness and simplicity. These choices correspond to the simplest nontrivial applications of the framework to physics. Holonomy Calgebras and certain functions on the space of loops. Dieomorphisminvariant mea sures correspond to knot and link invariants. Thus, there is a natural inter play between connections and loops, a point which will play an important role in the present paper. Note that, while the classical conguration space is //, the domain space of quantum states is spC . AI showed that // is naturally embedded in spC and Rendall showed that the embedding is in fact dense. Elements of spC can be therefore thought of as generalized gauge equivalent connections. To emphasize this point and to simplify the nota tion, let us denote the spectrum of the AI Calgebra by //. The fact that the domain space of quantum states is a completion ofand hence larger thanthe classical conguration space may seem surprising at rst since in ordinary i.e. nonrelativistic quantum mechanics both spaces are the same. The enlargement is, however, characteristic of quantum eld theory, i.e. of systems with an innite number of degrees of freedom. AI further explored the structure of // but did not arrive at a complete characterization of its elements. They also indicated how one could make certain heuristic considerations of Rovelli and Smolin precise and associate momentum operators with closed strips i.e. ndimensional ribbons on . However, without further information on the measure d on //, one cannot decide if these operators can be made selfadjoint, or indeed if they are even densely dened. AI did introduce certain measures with which the strip operators interact properly. However, as they pointed out, these measures have support only on nitedimensional subspaces of // and are therefore too simple to be interesting in cases where the theory has an innite number of degrees of freedom. In broad terms, the purpose of this paper is to complete the AI program in several directions. More specically, we will present the following results . We will obtain a complete characterization of elements of the Gelfand spectrum. This will provide a degree of control on the domain space of quantum states which is highly desirable since // is a nontrivial, innitedimensional space which is not even locally compact, while // is a compact Hausdor space, the completion procedure is quite nontrivial. Indeed, it is the lack of control on the precise content of the Gelfand spectrum of physically interesting Calgebras that has prevented the Gelfand theory from playing a prominent role in quantum eld theory so far. . We will present a faithful, dieomorphisminvariant measure on //. The theory underlying this construction suggests how one might in troduce other dieomorphisminvariant measures. Recently, Baez has exploited this general strategy to introduce new measures. These developments are interesting from a strictly mathematical standpoint because the issue of existence of such measures was a subject of Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski controversy until recently . They are also of interest from a physical viewpoint since one can, for example, use these measures to regulate physically interesting operators such as the constraints of general relativity and investigate their properties in a systematic fashion. . Together, these results enable us to dene a RovelliSmolin loop transform rigorously. This is a map from the Hilbert space L //, d to the space of suitably regular functions of loops on . Thus, quantum states can be represented by suitable functions of loops. This loop representation is particularly well suited to dieomorphisminvariant theories of connections, including general relativity. We have also developed dierential calculus on // and shown that the strip i.e. momentum operators are in fact densely dened, symmetric op erators on L //, d i.e. that they interact with our measure correctly. However, since the treatment of the strip operators requires a number of new ideas from physics as well as certain techniques from graph theory, these results will be presented in a separate work. The methods we use can be summarized as follows. First, we make the nonlinear duality between connections and loops explicit. On the connection side, the appropriate space to consider is the Gelfand spectrum // of the AI Calgebra. On the loop side, the ap propriate object is the space of hoopsi.e. holonomically equivalent loops. More precisely, let us consider based, piecewise analytic loops and regard two as being equivalent if they give rise to the same holonomy evaluated at the basepoint for any Gconnection. Call each holonomic equivalence class a Ghoop. It is straightforward to verify that the set of hoops has the structure of a group. It also carries a natural topology , which, however, will not play a role in this paper. We will denote it by H and call it the hoop group. It turns out that H and the spectrum // can be regarded as being dual to each other in the following sense . Every element of H denes a continuous, complexvalued function on // and these functions generate the algebra of all continuous functions on //. . Every element of // denes a homomorphism fromH to the gauge group G which is unique modulo an automorphism of G and every homomorphism denes an element of //. In the case of topological vector spaces, the duality mapping respects the topology and the linear structure. In the present case, however, H has the structure only of a group and // of a topological space. The duality mappings can therefore respect only these structures. Property above We should add, however, that in most of these debates, it was A/Grather than its completion A/Gthat was the center of attention. Holonomy Calgebras provides us with a complete algebraic characterization of the elements of Gelfand spectrum // while property species the topology of the spectrum. The second set of techniques involves a family of projections from the topological space // to certain nitedimensional manifolds. For each subgroup of the hoop group H, generated by n independent hoops, we dene a projection from // to the quotient, G n /Ad, of the nth power of the gauge group by the adjoint action. An element of G n /Ad is thus an equivalence class of ntuples, g ,...,g n , with g i G, where g ,...,g n g g g ,...,g g n g for any g G. The lifts of func tions on G n /Ad are then the nonlinear analogs of the cylindrical functions on topological vector spaces. Finally, since each G n /Ad is a compact topo logical space, we can equip it with measures to integrate functions in the standard fashion. This in turn enables us to dene cylinder measures on // and integrate cylindrical functions thereon. Using the Haar measure on G, we then construct a natural, dieomorphisminvariant, faithful mea sure on //. Finally, for completeness, we will summarize the strategy we have adop ted to introduce and analyze the momentum operators, although, as men tioned above, these results will be presented elsewhere. The rst observa tion is that we can dene vector elds on // as derivations on the ring of cylinder functions. Then, to dene the specic vector elds corresponding to the momentum or strip operators we introduce certain notions from graph theory. These specic vector elds are divergencefree with respect to our cylindrical measure on //, i.e. they leave the cylindrical measure invariant. Consequently, the momentum operators are densely dened and symmetric on the Hilbert space of squareintegrable functions on //. The paper is organized as follows. Section is devoted to preliminaries. In Section , we obtain the characterization of elements of // and also present some examples of those elements which do not belong to //, i.e. which represent genuine, generalized gauge equivalence classes of connec tions. Using the machinery introduced in this characterization, in Section we introduce the notion of cylindrical measures on // and then dene a natural, faithful, dieomorphisminvariant, cylindrical measure. Section contains concluding remarks. In all these considerations, the piecewise analyticity of loops on plays an important role. That is, the specic constructions and proofs presented here would not go through if the loops were allowed to be just piecewise smooth. However, it is far from being obvious that the nal results would not go through in the smooth category. To illustrate this point, in Appendix A we restrict ourselves to U connections and, by exploiting the Abelian character of this group, show how one can obtain the main results of this paper using piecewise C loops. Whether similar constructions are possible in the nonAbelian case is, however, an open question. Finally, in Appendix Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski B we consider another extension. In the main body of the paper, is a manifold and the gauge group G is taken to be SU. In Appendix B, we indicate the modications required to incorporate SUN and UN connections on an nmanifold keeping, however, piecewise analytic loops. Preliminaries In this section, we will introduce the basic notions, x the notation, and recall those results from the AI framework which we will need in the subsequent discussion. Fix a dimensional, real, analytic, connected, orientable manifold . Denote by P, SU a principal bre bundle P over the base space and the structure group SU. Since any SU bundle over a manifold is trivial we take P to be the product bundle. Therefore, SU connections on P can be identied with suvalued form elds on . Denote by / the space of smooth say C SU connections, equipped with one of the standard Sobolev topologies see, e.g., . Every SUvalued function g on denes a gauge transformation in /, Agg Ag g dg. . Let us denote the quotient of / under the action of this group of local gauge transformations by //. Note that the ane space structure of / is lost in this projection // is a genuinely nonlinear space with a rather complicated topological structure. The next notion we need is that of closed loops in . Let us begin by considering continuous, piecewise analytic C parametrized paths, i.e. maps p,s ...s n ,. which are continuous on the whole domain and C on the closed intervals s k ,s k . Given two paths p , and p , such that p p , we denote by p p the natural composition p p s p s, for s , p s , for s ,. . The inverse of a path p , is a path p s p s. . A path which starts and ends at the same point is called a loop. We will be interested in based loops. Let us therefore x, once and for all, a point x . Denote by L x the set of piecewise C loops which are based at x , i.e. which start and end at x . Given a connection A on P, SU, a loop L x , and a xed point x in the ber over the point x , we denote the corresponding element of the Holonomy Calgebras holonomy group by H, A. Since P is a product bundle, we will make the obvious choice x x , e, where e is the identity in SU. Using the space of connections /, we now introduce a key equivalence relation on L x Two loops , L x will be said to be holonomically equivalent, , i H, A H, A, for every SU connection A in /. Each holonomic equivalence class will be called a hoop. Thus, for example, two loops which have the same orientation and which dier only in their parametrization dene the same hoop. Similarly, if two loops dier just by a retraced segment, they belong to the same hoop. More precisely, if paths p and p are such that p p and p p x , so that p p is a loop in L x , and if is a path starting at the point p p , then p p and p p dene the same hoop. Note that in general the equivalence relation depends on the choice of the gauge group, whence the hoop should in fact be called an SUhoop. However, since the group is xed to be SU in the main body of this paper, we drop this sux. The hoop to which a loop belongs will be denoted by . The collection of all hoops will be denoted by H thus H L x /. Note that, because of the properties of the holonomy map, the space of hoops, H, has a natural group structure . We will call it the hoop group . With this machinery at hand, we can now introduce the AI Calgebra. We begin by assigning to every H a realvalued function T on //, bounded between and T A Tr H, A, . where A // A is any connection in the gauge equivalence class A any loop in the hoop and where the trace is taken in the fundamental representation of SU. T is called the Wilson loop function in the physics literature. Owing to SU trace identities, products of these functions can be expressed as sums T T T T ,. where, on the right, we have used the composition of hoops in H. There fore, the complex vector space spanned by the T functions is closed under the product it has the structure of a algebra. Denote it by H/ and call it the holonomy algebra. Since each T is a bounded continuous func The hoop equivalence relation seems to have been introduced independently by a number of authors in dierent contexts e.g. by Gambini and collaborators in their investigation of YangMills theory and by Ashtekar in the context of gravity. Recently, the group structure of HG has been systematically exploited and extended by Di Bartolo, Gambini, and Griego to develop a new and potentially powerful framework for gauge theories. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski tion on //, H/ is a subalgebra of the Calgebra of all complexvalued, bounded, continuous functions thereon. The completion H/ of H/ under the sup norm has therefore the structure of a Calgebra. This is the AI Calgebra. As in , one can make the structure of H/ explicit by constructing it, step by step, from the space of loops L x . Denote by TL x the free vector space over complexes generated by L x . Let K be the subspace of TL x dened as follows i a i i Ki i a i T i A, A //. . It is then easy to verify that H/ TL x /K. Note that the Kequivalence relation subsumes the hoop equivalence. Thus, elements of H/can be rep resented either as a i T i or as a i i K . The operation, the product, and the norm on H/ can be specied directly on TL x /K as follows i a i i K i a i i K , i a i i K j b j j K ij a i b j i j K i j K , i a i i K sup A,/ i a i T i A, . where a i is the complex conjugate of a i . The Calgebra H/ is obtained by completing H/ in the norm topology. By construction, H/ is an Abelian Calgebra. Furthermore, it is equipped with the identity element T o o K , where o is the trivial i.e. zero loop. Therefore, we can directly apply the Gelfand representation theory. Let us summarize the main results that follow . First, we know that H/ is naturally isomorphic to the Calgebra of complexvalued, con tinuous functions on a compact Hausdor space, the spectrum spH/. Furthermore, one can show that the space // of connections mod ulo gauge transformations is densely embedded in spH/. Therefore, we can denote the spectrum as //. Second, every continuous, cyclic rep resentation of H/ by bounded operators on a Hilbert space has the fol lowing form the representation space is the Hilbert space L //, d for some regular measure d on // and elements of H/, regarded as func tions on //, act simply by pointwise multiplication. Finally, each of these representations is uniquely determined via the GelfandNaimark Segal construction by a positive linear functional on the Calgebra H/ a i T i a i T i a i T i . The functionals naturally dene functions on the space L x of loopswhich in turn serve as the generating functionals for the representa Holonomy Calgebras tionvia T . Thus, there is a canonical correspondence between regular measures on // and generating functionals . The question naturally arises can we write down necessary and sucient conditions for a function on the loop space L x to qualify as a generating functional Using the structure of the algebra H/ outlined above, one can answer this question armatively A function on L x serves as a generating functional for the GNS construction if and only if it satises the following two conditions i a i T i i a i i and i,j a i a j i j i j .. The rst condition ensures that the functional on H/, obtained by extending by linearity, is well dened while the second condition by . ensures that it satises the positivity property, B B,B H/. Thus, together, they provide a positive linear functional on the algebra H/. Finally, since H/ is dense in H/ and contains the identity, it follows that the positive linear functional extends to the full Calgebra H/. Thus, a loop function satisfying . determines a cyclic represen tation of H/ and therefore a regular measure on //. Conversely, every regular measure on // provides through vacuum expectation values a loop functional T satisfying .. Note, nally, that the rst equation in . ensures that the generating function factors through the hoop equivalence relation . We thus have an interesting interplay between connections and loops, or, more precisely, generalized gaugeequivalent connections elements of // and hoops elements of H. The generators T of the holonomy algebra i.e. conguration operators are labelled by elements of H. The elements of the representation space i.e. quantum states are L functions on //. Regular measures d on // are, in turn, determined by functions on H satisfying .. The group of dieomorphisms on has a natural action on the algebra H/, its spectrum //, and the space of hoops, H. The measure d is invariant under this induced action on // i is invariant under the induced action on H. Now, a dieomorphism invariant function of hoops is a function of generalized knotsgeneralized, because our loops are allowed to have kinks, intersections, and segments that may be traced more than once. Hence, there is a correspondence If the gauge group were more general, we could not have expressed products of the generators T as sums eqn .. For SU, for example, one cannot get rid of double products triple and higher products can, however, be reduced to linear combinations Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski between generalized knot invariants which in addition satisfy . and regular dieomorphisminvariant measures on generalized gaugeequivalent connections. The spectrum The constructions discussed in Section have several appealing features. In particular, they open up an algebraic approach to the integration theory on the space of gaugeequivalent connections and bring to the forefront the duality between loops and connections. However, in practice, a good control on the precise content and structure of the Gelfand spectrum // of H/ is needed to make further progress. Even for simple algebras which arise in nonrelativistic quantum mechanicssuch as the algebra of almost periodic functions on R n the spectrum is rather complicated while R n is densely embedded in the spectrum, one does not have as much control as one would like on the points that lie in its closure see, e.g., . In the case of a Calgebra of all continuous, bounded functions on a completely regular topological space, the spectrum is the StoneCech compactication of that space, whence the situation is again rather unruly. In the case of the AI algebra H/, the situation seems to be even more complicated since the algebra H/ is generated only by certain functions on //, at least at rst sight, H/ appears to be a proper subalgebra of the Calgebra of all continuous functions on //, and therefore outside the range of applicability of standard theorems. However, the holonomy Calgebra is also rather special it is con structed from natural geometrical objectsconnections and loopson the manifold . Therefore, one might hope that its spectrum can be charac terized through appropriate geometric constructions. We shall see in this section that this is indeed the case. The specic techniques we use rest heavily on the fact that the loops involved are all piecewise analytic. This section is divided into three parts. In the rst, we introduce the key tools that are needed also in subsequent sections, in the second, we present the main result, and in the third we give examples of generalized gaugeequivalent connections, i.e. of elements of // //. To keep the discussion simple, generally we will not explicitly distinguish between paths and loops and their images in . . Loop decomposition A key technique that we will use in various constructions is the decom position of a nite number of hoops, ,..., k , into a nite number of independent hoops, ,..., n . The main point here is that a given set of double products of T and the T themselves. In this case, the generating functional is dened on single and double loops, whence, in addition to knot invariants, link invariants can also feature in the denition of the generating function. Holonomy Calgebras of loops need not be holonomically independent every open segment in a given loop may be shared by other loops in the given set, whence, for any connection A in /, the holonomies around these loops could be inter related. However, using the fact that the loops are piecewise analytic, we will be able to show that any nite set of loops can be decomposed into a nite number of independent segments and this in turn leads us to the desired independent hoops. The availability of this decomposition will be used in the next subsection to obtain a characterization of elements of // and in Section to dene cylindrical functions on //. Our aim then is to show that, given a nite number of hoops, ,..., k , with i , identity in H for any i, there exists a nite set of loops, ,..., n L x , which satises the following properties . If we denote by H ,..., m the subgroup of the hoop group H generated by the hoops ,..., m , then we have H ,..., k H ,..., n ,. where, as before, i denotes the hoop to which i belongs. . Each of the new loops i contains an open segment i.e. an embedding of an interval which is traced exactly once and which intersects any of the remaining loops j with i , j at most at a nite number of points. The rst condition makes the sense in which each hoop i can be decom posed in terms of j precise while the second condition species the sense in which the new hoops ,..., n are independent. Let us begin by choosing a loop i L x in each hoop i , for all i , . . . , k, such that none of the i has a piece which is immediately retraced i.e. none of the loops contains a path of the type . Now, since the loops are piecewise analytic, any two which overlap do so either on a nite number of nite intervals and/or intersect in a nite number of points. Ignore the isolated intersection points and mark the end points of all the overlapping intervals including the end points of selfoverlaps of a loop. Let us call these marked points vertices. Next, divide each loop i into paths which join consecutive vertices. Thus, each of these paths is piecewise analytic, is part of at least one of the loops ,..., k , and has a nonzero parameter measure along any loop to which it belongs. Two distinct paths intersect at a nite set of points. Let us call these oriented paths edges. Denote by n the number of edges that result. The edges and vertices form a piecewise analytically embedded graph. By construction, each loop in the list is contained in the graph and, ignoring parametrization, can be expressed as a composition of a nite number of its n edges. Finally, this decomposition is minimal in the sense that, if the initial set ,..., k of loops is extended to include p additional loops, k ,..., kp , each edge in the original decomposition of k loops Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski is expressible as a product of the edges which feature in the decomposition of the k p loops. The next step is to convert this edge decomposition of loops into a decomposition in terms of elementary loops. This is easy to achieve. Con nect each vertex v to the basepoint x by an oriented, piecewise analytic curve qv such that these curves overlap with any edge e i at most at a nite number of isolated points. Consider the closed curves i , starting and ending at the basepoint x , i qv i e i qv i ,. where v i are the end points of the edge e i , and denote by o the set of these n loops. Loops i are not unique because of the freedom in choosing the curves qv. However, we will show that they provide us with the required set of independent loops associated with the given set ,..., k . Let us rst note that the decomposition satises certain conditions which follow immediately from the properties of the segments noted above . o is a nite set and every i o is a nontrivial loop in the sense that the hoop i it denes is not the identity element of H . every loop i contains an open interval which is traversed exactly once and no nite segment of which is shared by any other loop in o . every hoop ,..., k in our initial set can be expressed as a nite composition of hoops dened by elements of o and their inverses where a loop i and its inverse i may occur more than once and, . if the initial set ,..., k of loops is extended to include p additional loops, k ,..., kp , and if o t is the set of n t loops t ,..., t n corresponding to ,..., kp , such that the paths q t v t agree with the paths qv whenever v v t , then each hoop i is a nite product of the hoops t j . These properties will play an important role throughout the paper. For the moment we only note that we have achieved our goal the property above ensures that the set ,..., n of loops is independent in the sense we specied in the point just below eqn . and that above implies that the hoop group generated by ,..., k is contained in the hoop group generated by ,..., n , i.e. that our decomposition satises .. We will conclude this subsection by showing that the independence of hoops ,..., n has an interesting consequence which will be used repeatedly Lemma . For every g ,...,g n SU n , there exists a connection A / such that H i ,A g i i , . . . , n. . Holonomy Calgebras Proof Fix a sequence of elements g ,...,g n of SU, i.e. a point in SU n . Next, for each loop i , pick an Abelian connection A t i a t i w t where a t i is a realvalued form on and w t a xed element of the Lie algebra of SU. Let furthermore the support of a t i intersect the ith segment s i in a nite interval, and, if j , i, intersect the jth segment s j only on a set of measure zero as measured along any loop m containing that segment. Finally, let us suppose that the connection is generic in the sense that the holonomy that the holonomy H i ,A t i is not the identity element of SU. Then, it is of the form H i ,A t i exp w, w su, w , with w a multiple of w t . Now, consider a connection A i tg A t i g, g SU, t R Then, we have H i ,A i exp tg wg. Hence, by choosing g and t appropriately, we can make H i ,A i coincide with any element of SU, in particular g i . Because of the independence of the loops i noted above, we can choose connections A i independently for every i . Then, the connection A A A n . satises .. We conclude this subsection with two remarks. . The result . we just proved can be taken as a statement of the independence of the SUhoops ,..., n it captures the idea that the loops ,..., n we constructed above are holonomically in dependent as far as SU connections are concerned. This notion of independence is, however, weaker than the one contained in the statement above. Indeed, that notion does not refer to connections at all and is therefore not tied to any specic gauge group. More precisely, we have the following. We just showed that if loops are independent in the sense of , they are necessarily independent in the sense of .. The converse is not true. Let and be two loops in L x which do not share any point other than x and which have no selfintersections or selfoverlaps. Set and . Then, it is easy to check that i , i , are independent in the sense of . although they are obviously not independent in the sense of . Simi larly, given , we can set . Then, is independent in the sense of . since the square root is well dened in SU but not in the sense of . From now on, we will say that loops satisfying Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski are independent and those satisfying . are weakly independent. This denition extends naturally to hoops. Although we will not need them explicitly, it is instructive to spell out some algebraic con sequences of these two notions. Algebraically, weak independence of hoops i ensures that i freely generate a subgroup of H. On the other hand, if i are independent, then every homomorphism from H ,..., n to any group G can be extended to every nitely generated subgroup of H which contains H ,..., n . Weak in dependence will suce for all considerations in this section. However, to ensure that the measure introduced in Section is well dened, we will need hoops which are independent. . The availability of the loop decomposition sheds considerable light on the hoop equivalence one can show that two loops in L x dene the same SUhoop if and only if they dier by a combination of reparametrization and immediate retracings. This second charac terization is useful because it involves only the loops no mention is made of connections and holonomies. This characterization continues to hold if the gauge group is replaced by SUN or indeed any group which has the property that, for every nonnegative integer n, the group contains a subgroup which is freely generated by n elements. . Characterization of // We will now use the availability of this hoop decomposition to obtain a complete characterization of all elements of the spectrum //. The characterization is based on results due to Giles . Recall rst that elements of the Gelfand spectrum// are in correspondence with multiplicative, preserving homomorphisms from H/ to the algebra of complex numbers. Thus, in particular, every A // acts on T H/ and hence on any hoop to produce a complex number A . Now, using certain constructions due to Giles, AI were able to show that Lemma . Every element A of // denes a homomorphism H A from the hoop group H to SU such that, H, A Tr H A . .a They also exhibited the homomorphism explicitly. Here, we have para phrased the AI result somewhat because they did not use the notion of hoops. However, the step involved is completely straightforward. Our aim now is to establish the converse of this result. Let us make a small digression to illustrate why the converse cannot be entirely straight forward. Given a homomorphism H from H to SU we can simply dene A via A Tr H . The question is whether this A can qualify Holonomy Calgebras as an element of the spectrum. From the denition, it is clear that AT sup A,/ T A .a for all hoops . On the other hand, to qualify as an element of the spectrum //, the homomorphism A must be continuous, i.e. should satisfy Af f .b for every f a i i K H/. Since, a priori, .b appears to be a stronger requirement than .a, one would expect that there are more homomorphisms H from the hoop group H to SU than the H A , which arise from elements of //. That is, one might expect that the converse of the AI result would not be true. It turns out, however, that if the holon omy algebra is constructed from piecewise analytic loops, the apparently weaker condition .a is in fact equivalent to .b, and the converse does hold. Whether it would continue to hold if one used piecewise smooth loopsas was the case in the AI analysisis not clear see Appendix A. We begin our detailed analysis with an immediate application of Lemma . Lemma . For every homomorphism H from H to SU, and every nite set of hoops ,..., k , there exists an SU connection A such that for every i in the set, H i H i ,A ,. where, as before, H i ,A is the holonomy of the connection A around any loop in the hoop class . Proof Let ,..., n be, as in Section ., a set of independent loops corresponding to the given set of hoops. Denote by g ,...,g n the image of ,..., n under H. Use the construction of Section . to obtain a connection A such that g i H i ,A for all i. It then follows from the denition of the hoop group that for any hoop in the subgroup H ,..., n generated by ,..., n , we have HH,A . Since each of the given i belongs to H ,..., n , we have, in particular, .. We now use this lemma to prove the main result. Recall that each A // is a homomorphism from H/ to complex numbers and as before denote by A the number assigned to T H/ by A. Then, we have Lemma . Given a homomorphism H from the hoop group H to SU there exists an element A H of the spectrum // such that A H Tr H . .b Two homomorphisms H and H t dene the same element of the spectrum Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski if and only if H t g H g, H, for some independent g in SU. Proof The idea is to dene the required A H using .b, i.e. to show that the right side of .b provides a homomorphism from H/ to the algebra of complex numbers. Let us begin with the free complex vector space TH over the hoop group H and dene on it a complexvalued function h as follows h a i i a i Tr H i . We will rst show that h passes through the Kequivalence relation of AI noted in Section and is therefore a welldened complexvalued function on the holonomy algebra H/ TH/K. Note rst that Lemma . immediately implies that, given a nite set of hoops, ,..., k , there exists a connection A such that h k i a i i k i a i T i A sup A,/ k i a i T i A .. Therefore, we have k i a i T i A A // h k i a i i . Since the left side of this implication denes the Kequivalence, it follows that the function h on TH has a welldened projection to the holonomy algebra H/. That h is linear is obvious from its denition. That it respects the operation and is a multiplicative homomorphism follows from the denitions . of these operations on H/ and the denition of the hoop group H. Finally, the continuity of this funtion on H/ is obvious from .. Hence h extends uniquely to a homomorphism from the C algebra H/ to the algebra of complex numbers, i.e. denes a unique element A H via A H B hB, B H/. Next, suppose H and H give rise to the same element of the spectrum. In particular, then, Tr H Tr H for all hoops. Now, there is a general result given two homomorphisms H and H from a group G to SU such that Tr H g Tr H g, g G, there exists g SU such that H gg H gg , where g is independent of g. Using the hoop group H for G, we obtain the desired uniqueness result. To summarize, by combining the results of the three lemmas, we obtain the following characterization of the points of the Gelfand spectrum of the holonomy Calgebra Theorem . Every point A of // gives rise to a homomorphism H from the hoop group H to SU and every homomorphism H denes a point of //, such that A Tr H . This is a correspondence modulo the trivial ambiguity that homomorphisms H and g H g dene Holonomy Calgebras the same point of //. We conclude this subsection with some remarks . It is striking that Theorem . does not require the homomorphism H to be continuous indeed, no reference is made to the topology of the hoop group anywhere. This purely algebraic characterization of the elements of // makes it convenient to use it in practice. . Note that the homomorphism H determines an element of // and not of // A H is not, in general, a smooth gaugeequivalent con nection. Nonetheless, as Lemma . tells us, it can be approximated by smooth connections in the sense that, given any nite number of hoops, one can construct a smooth connection which is indistinguish able from A H as far as these hoops are concerned. This is stronger than the statement that // is dense in //. Necessary and su cient conditions for H to arise from a smooth connection were given by Barrett see also . . There are several folk theorems in the literature to the eect that given a function on the loop space L x satisfying certain conditions, one can reconstruct a connection modulo gauge such that the given function is the trace of the holonomy of that connection. For a summary and references, see, e.g., . Results obtained in this sub section have a similar avor. However, there is a key dierence our main result shows the existence of a generalized connection mod ulo gauge, i.e. an element of // rather than a regular connection in //. A generalized connection can also be given a geometrical meaning in terms of parallel transport, but in a generalized bundle . . Examples of A Fix a connection A /. Then, the holonomy H, A denes a ho momorphism H A H SU. A gaugeequivalent connection, A t g Ag g dg, gives rise to the homomorphism H A g x H A gx . Therefore, by Theorem ., A and A t dene the same element of the Gelfand spectrum // is naturally embedded in //. Furthermore, Lemma . now implies that the embedding is in fact dense. This provides an alternative proof of the AI and Rendall results quoted in Section . Had the gauge group been dierent and/or had a dimension greater than , there would exist nontrivial Gprincipal bundles over . In this case, even if we begin with a specic bundle in our construction of the holon omy Calgebra, connections on all possible bundles belong to the Gelfand spectrum see Appendix B. This is one illustration of the nontriviality of Note, however, that while this proof is tailored to the holonomy Calgebra HA, Rendalls proof is applicable in more general contexts. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski the completion procedure leading from // to //. In this subsection, we will illustrate another facet of this nontriviality we will give examples of elements of // which do not arise from //. These are the generalized gaugeequivalent connections A which have a distributional character in the sense that their support is restricted to sets of measure zero in . Recall rst that the holonomy of the zero connection around any hoop is identity. Hence, the homomorphism H from H to SU it denes sends every hoop to the identity element e of SU and the multiplicative homomorphism it denes from the Calgebra H/ to complex numbers sends each T to /Tr e. We now use this information to introduce the notion of the support of a generalized connection. We will say that A // has support on a subset S of if for every hoop which has at least one representative loop which fails to pass through S, we have i H A e , the identity element of SU or, equivalently, ii A K . In ii, A is regarded as a homomorphism of algebras. While H A has an ambiguity, noted in Theorem ., conditions i and ii are insensitive to it. We are now ready to give the simplest example of a generalized connec tion A which has support at a single point x . Note rst that, owing to piecewise analyticity, if L x passes through x, it does so only a nite number of times, say N. Let us denote the incoming and outgoing tan gent directions to the curve at its jth passage through x by v j ,v j . The generalized connections we want to dene now will depend only on these tangent directions at x. Let be a not necessarily continuous mapping from the sphere S of directions in the tangent space at x to SU. Set j v j v j , so that, if at the jth passage, arrives at x and then simply returns by retracing its path in a neighborhood of x, we have j e, the identity element of SU. Now, dene H H SU via H e, if / H x , N ... , otherwise, . where H x is the space of hoops every loop in which passes through x. For each choice of , the mapping H is well dened, i.e. is independent of the choice of the loop in the hoop class used in its construction. In particular, we used tangent directions rather than vectors to ensure this. It denes a homomorphism from H to SU which is nontrivial only on H x , and hence a generalized connection with support at x. Furthermore, one can verify that . is the most general element of // which has support at x and depends only on the tangent vectors at that point. Using analyticity of the loops, we can similarly construct elements which depend Holonomy Calgebras on the higherorder behavior of loops at x. There is no generalized con nection with support at x which depends only on the zerothorder behavior of the curve, i.e. only on whether the curve passes through x or not. One can proceed in an analogous manner to produce generalized con nections which have support on or dimensional submanifolds of . We conclude with an example. Fix a dimensional, oriented, analytic sub manifold M of and an element g of SU, g , e. Denote by H M the subset of H consisting of hoops, each loop of which intersects M nontangentially, i.e. such that at least one of the incoming or the outgo ing tangent direction to the curve is transverse to M. As before, owing to analyticity, any L x can intersect M only a nite number of times. De note as before the incoming and the outgoing tangent directions at the jth intersection by v j and v j respectively. Let j equal if the orientation of v j , M coincides with the orientation of if the two orientations are opposite and if v j is tangential to M. Dene H g,M H SU via H g,M e, if / H M , g N g N ...g g , otherwise, . where g e, the identity element of SU. Again, one can check that . is a welldened homomorphism from H to SU, which is non trivial only on H M and therefore denes a generalized connection with support on M. One can construct more sophisticated examples in which the homomorphism is sensitive to the higherorder behavior of the loop at the points of intersection and/or the xed SU element g is replaced by gx M SU. Integration on // In this section we shall develop a general strategy to perform integrals on // and introduce a natural, faithful, dieomorphisminvariant measure on this space. The existence of this measure provides considerable con dence in the ideas involving the loop transform and the loop representation introduced in , . The basic strategy is to carry out an appropriate generalization of the theory of cylindrical measures , on topological vector spaces . The key idea in our approach is to replace the standard linear duality on vector spaces by the duality between connections and loops. In the rst part of This idea was developed also by Baez using, however, an approach which is somewhat dierent from the one presented here. Chronologically, the authors of this paper rst found the faithful measure introduced in this section and reported this result in the rst draft of this paper. Subsequently, Baez and the authors independently realized that the theory of cylindrical measures provides the appropriate conceptual setting for this discussion. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski this section, we will dene cylindrical functions, and in the second part, we will present a natural cylindrical measure. . Cylindrical functions Let us begin by recalling the situation in the linear case. Let V denote a topological vector space and V its dual. Given a nitedimensional subspace S of V , we can dene an equivalence relation on V v v if and only if v ,s v ,s for all v ,v V and s S , where v, s is the action of s S on v V . Denote the quotient V/ by S. Clearly, S is a nitedimensional vector space and we have a natural projection map S V S. A function f on V is said to be cylindrical if it is a pullback via S to V of a function f on S, for some choice of S . These are the functions we will be able to integrate. Equip each nitedimensional vector space S with a measure d and set V df S d f. . For this denition to be meaningful, however, the set of measures d that we chose on vector spaces S must satisfy certain compatibility conditions. Thus, if a function f on V is expressible as a pullback via S j of functions f j on S j , for j , , say, we must have S d f S d f .. Such compatible measures do exist. Perhaps the most familiar example is the normalized Gaussian measure. We want to extend these ideas, using // in place of V . An immediate problem is that // is a genuinely nonlinear space whence there is no obvious analog of V and S which are central to the above construction of cylindrical measures. The idea is to use the results of Section to nd suitable substitutes for these spaces. The appropriate choices turn out to be the following we will let the hoop group H play the role of V and its subgroups, generated by a nite number of independent hoops, the role of S . Recall that S is generated by a nite number of linearly independent basis vectors. More precisely, we proceed as follows. From Theorem ., we know that each A in // is completely characterized by the homomorphism H A from the hoop group H to SU, which is unique up to the freedom H A g H A g for some g SU. Now suppose we are given n independent loops, ,..., n . Denote by o the subgroup of the hoop group H they generate. Using this o , let us introduce the following equivalence relation on // A A i H A g H A g for all o and some hoopindependent g SU. Denote by o the Holonomy Calgebras projection from // onto the quotient space /// . The idea is to consider functions f on // which are pullbacks under o of functions f on /// and dene the integral of f on // to be equal to the integral of f on /// . However, for this strategy to work, /// should have a simple structure that one can control. Fortunately, this is the case Lemma . Let o be a subgroup of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops. Then, a There is a natural bijection /// Homo , SU/Ad b For each choice of independent generators ,..., n of o , there is a bijection /// SU n /Ad c Given o as in a, the topology induced on /// from SU n /Ad according to b is independent of the choice of free generators of o . Proof By denition of the equivalence relation , every A in /// is in correspondence with the restriction to o of an equivalence class H A of homomorphisms from the full hoop group H to SU. Now, it follows from Lemma . that every homomorphism from o to SU extends to a homomorphism from the full hoop group to SU. There fore, there is a correspondence between equivalence classes A and equivalence classes of homomorphisms from o to SU where, as usual, two are equivalent if they dier by the adjoint action of SU. The statement b follows automatically from a the map in b is given by the values taken by an element of Homo , SU on the chosen generators. The proof of c is a simple exercise. Some remarks about this result are in order . Although we began with independent loops ,..., n , the equiv alence relation we introduced makes direct reference only to the sub group o of the hoop group they generate. This is similar to the situation in the linear case where one may begin with a set of linearly independent elements s ,...,s n of V , let them generate a subspace S and then introduce the equivalence relation on S using S directly. . However, a specic basis is often used in subsequent constructions. In particular, cylindrical measures are generally introduced as follows. One xes a basis in S , uses it to dene an isomorphism between S V/ and R n , introduces a measure on R n for each n and uses the isomorphism to dene measures d on spaces S. These, in turn, dene a cylindrical measure d on V through .. However, since S admits other bases, at the end one must make sure that Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski the nal measure d on V is welldened, i.e., is insensitive to the specic choice of basis made in its denition. In the case now under consideration, we will follow a similar strategy. As we just showed in Lemma ., given a set of independent loops which generate o , we can identify /// with SU n /Ad. Therefore, we can dene a cylindrical measure on // by rst choosing suitable measures on SU n /Ad for each n, using the isomorphism to dene measures on /// and showing nally that the nal integrals are insensitive to the initial choices of generators of o . . The equivalence relation of Lemma . says that two generalized connections are equivalent if their actions on the group o , generated by a nite number of independent loops, are indistinguishable. It follows from Lemma . that each equivalence class A contains a regular connection A. Finally, if A and A t are two regular connections whose pullbacks to all i are the same for i , . . . , n, then they are equivalent where i is any loop in the hoop class i . Thus, in eect, the projection o maps the domain space // of the continuum quantum theory to the domain space of a lattice gauge theory where the lattice is formed by the n loops ,..., n . The initial choice of the independent hoops is, however, arbitrary and it is this arbitrariness that is responsible for the richness of the continuum theory. We can now dene cylindrical functions on //. Let o be a subgroup of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent loops. Let us set B S Homo , SU/Ad Using Lemma . we shall regard o as a projection map from // onto B S and parametrize B S by SU n /Ad. For the topology on B S we will use the one dened by its identication with SU n /Ad. By a cylindrical function f on //, we shall mean the pullback to // under o of a continuous function f on B S , for some subgroup o of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent loops. These are the functions we want to integrate. Let us note an elementary property of cylindrical functions which will be used repeatedly. Let o and o t be two nitely generated subgroups of the hoop group and such that o t o . Then, it is easy to check that if a function f on // is cylindrical with respect to o t , it is also cylindrical with respect to o . Furthermore, there is now a natural projection from B S onto B S given by the projection Homo , SU Homo t , SU and f is the pullback of f t via this projection. In the remainder of this subsection, we will analyse the structure of the space of cylindrical functions. First we have Holonomy Calgebras Lemma . has the structure of a normed algebra with respect to the operations of taking linear combinations, multiplication, complex conjuga tion and sup norm of cylindrical functions. Proof It is clear by denition of that if f , then any complex multiple f as well as the complex conjugate f also belongs to . Next, given two elements, f i with i , , of , we will show that their sum and their product also belong to . Let o i be nitely generated subgroups of the hoop group H such that f i are the pullbacks to // of continuous functions f i on B S i . Consider the sets of n and n independent hoops generating respectively o and o . While the rst n and the last n hoops are independent, there may be relations between hoops belonging to the rst set and those belonging to the second. Using the technique of Section ., nd the set of independent hoops, say, ,..., n which generate the given n n hoops and denote by o the subgroup of the hoop group generated by ,..., n . Then, since o i o , it follows that f i are cylindrical also with respect to o . Therefore, f f and f f are also cylindrical with respect to o . Thus has the structure of a algebra. Finally, since B S being homeomorphic to SU n /Ad is compact for any o , and since elements of are pullbacks to // of continuous functions on B S , it follows that the cylindrical functions are bounded. We can therefore use the sup norm to endow with the structure of a normed algebra. We will use the sup norm to complete and obtain a Calgebra . A natural class of functions one would like to integrate on // is given by the Gelfand transforms of the traces of holonomies. The question then is if these functions are contained in . Not only is the answer armative, but in fact the traces of holonomies generate all of . More precisely, we have Theorem . The Calgebra is isomorphic to the Calgebra H/. Proof Let us begin by showing that H/ is embedded in . Given an element F with FA a i T i A of H/, its Gelfand transform is a function f on the spectrum //, given by f A a i A i . Consider the set of hoops ,..., k that feature in the sum, decompose them into independent hoops ,..., n as in Section ., and denote by o the sub group of the hoop group they generate. Then, it is clear that the function f is the pullback via o of a continuous function f on B S . Hence we have f . Since the norms of F in H/ and f in are given by F sup A, FA and f sup A,/ f A, since the restriction of f to // coincides with F, and since // is em bedded densely in //, it is clear that the map from F to f is isometric. Finally, since H/ is obtained by a C completion of the space of functions Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski of the form F, we have the result that H/ is embedded in the Calgebra . Next, we will show that there is also an inclusion in the opposite di rection. We rst note a fact about SU. Fix n elements g ,...,g n of SU. Then, from the knowledge of traces in the fundamental rep resentation of all elements which belong to the group generated by these g i , i , . . . , n, we can reconstruct g ,...,g n modulo an adjoint map. It therefore follows that the space of functions f on B S considered as a copy of SU n /Ad which come from the functions F on H/ using all the hoops i o suce to separate points of B S . Since this space is compact, it follows from the Weierstrass theorem that the Calgebra generated by these projected functions is the entire Calgebra of contin uous functions on B S . Now, suppose we are given a cylindrical function f t on //. Its projection under the appropriate o is, by the preceed ing result, contained in the projection of some element of H/. Thus, is contained in H/. Combining the two results, we have the desired result the Calgebras H/ and are isomorphic. Remark Theorem . suggests that from the very beginning we could have introduced the Calgebra in place of H/. This is indeed the case. More precisely, we could have proceeded as follows. Begin with the space //, and introduce the notion of hoops and hoop decomposition in terms of independent hoops. Then given a subgroup o of H generated by a nite number of independent hoops, we could have introduced an equivalence relation on // not // which we do not yet have as follows A A iH,A g H,A g for all o and some hoop independent g SU. It is then again true due to Lemma . that the quotient /// is isomorphic to B S . This is true inspite of the fact that we are using // rather than // because, as remarked immediately after Lemma ., each A /// contains a regular connection. We can therefore dene cylindrical functions, but now on // rather than // as the pullbacks of continuous functions on B S . These functions have a natural Calgebra structure. We can use it as the starting point in place of the AI holonomy algebra. While this strategy seems natural at rst from an analysis viewpoint, it has two drawbacks, both stemming from the fact that the Wilson loops are now assigned a secondary role. For physical applications, this is unsatisfactory since Wilson loops are the basic observables of gauge theories. From a mathematical viewpoint, the relation between knot/link invariants and measures on the spectrum of the algebra would now be obscure. Nonetheless, it is good to keep in mind that this alternate strategy is available as it may make other issues more transparent. Holonomy Calgebras . A natural measure In this subsection, we will discuss the issue of integration of cylindrical functions on //. Our main objective is to introduce a natural, faithful, dieomorphism invariant measure on //. As mentioned in the remarks following Lemma ., the idea is similar to the one used in the case of topological vector spaces. Thus, for each subgroup o of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops, we will equip the space B S with a measure d S and, as in ., set ,/ df B S d S f. where f is any cylindrical function compatible with o . It is clear that for the integral to be welldened, the set of measures we choose on dif ferent B S should be compatible so that the analog of . holds. We will now exhibit a natural choice for which the compatibility is automatically satised. Denote by d the normalized Haar measure on SU. It naturally in duces a measure on SU n which is invariant under the adjoint action of SU and therefore projects down unambiguously to a measure dn on SU n /Ad. Next, consider an arbitrary group o which is generated by n independent loops. Choose a set of independent generators ,..., n and use the corresponding map SU n /Ad B S to transport the mea sure dn to a measure d S on B S . We will show that the measure d S is insensitive to the specic choice of the generators of o used in its construction and that the resulting family of measures on the various B S satises the appropriate compatibility conditions. We will then explore the properties of the resulting cylindrical measure on //. Our construction is natural since SU comes equipped with the Haar measure. In partic ular, we have not introduced any additional structure on the underlying manifold on which the initial connections A are dened hence the re sulting cylindrical measure will be automatically invariant under the action of Di. Theorem . a Let f be a cylindrical function on // with respect to two subgroups o i , i , , of the hoop group, each of which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops. Fix a set of generators in each subgroup and denote by d S i the corresponding measures on B S i . Then, if f i denote the projections of f to B S i , we have B S d S f B S d S f .. In particular, if o o , the integral is independent of the choice of gen erators used in its denition. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski b The functional v H/ C dened below extends to a linear, strictly positive and Diinvariant functional on H/ vF ,/ df. where d is dened by . and where the cylindrical function f on // is the Gelfand transform of the element F of H/ and, c The cylindrical measure d dened by . is a genuine, regular and strictly positive measure on //. Furthermore, d is Di invariant. Proof Fix n i independent hoops that generate o i and, as in the proof of Theorem ., use the construction of Section . to carry out the decompo sition of these n n hoops in terms of independent hoops, say ,..., n . Thus, the original n n hoops are contained in the group o generated by the i . Clearly, o i o . Hence, the given f is cylindrical also with respect to o , i.e. is the pullback of a function f on B S . We will now establish . by showing that each of the two integrals in that equation equals the analogous integral of f over B S . Note rst that, since the generators have been xed, we can ignore the distinction between B S i and SU ni /Ad and between B S and SU n / Ad. It will also be convenient to regard functions on SU n /Ad as functions on SU n which are invariant under the adjoint SU ac tion. Thus, instead of carrying out integrals over B S i and B S of functions on these spaces, we can integrate the lifts of these functions to SU ni and SU n respectively. To deal with quantities with suxes and simultaneously, for no tational simplicity we will let a prime stand for either the sux or . Then, in particular, we have nitely generated subgroups o and o t of the hoop group, with o t o , and a function f which is cylindrical with respect to both of them. The generators of o are ,..., n while those of o t are t ,..., t n with n t lt n. From the construction of o Sec tion . it follows that every hoop in the second set can be expressed as a composition of the hoops in the rst set and their inverses. Furthermore, since the hoops in each set are independent, the construction implies that for each i t ,...,n t , there exists Ki t , . . . , n with the following properties i if i t ,j t , Ki t , Kj t and, ii in the decomposition of t i in terms of unprimed hoops, the hoop Ki or its inverse appears exactly once and if i t ,j t , the hoop Kj does not appear at all. For simplicity, let us assume that the orientation of the primed hoops is such that it is Ki rather than its inverse that features in the decomposition of t i . Next, let us denote by g ,...,g n a point of the quotient SU n which is projected to g t ,...,g t n in SU n . Then g t i is expressed in terms of g i as g t i ..g Ki .., where .. denotes a product of elements of the Holonomy Calgebras type g m where m , Kj for any j. Since the given function f on // is a pullback of a function f on SU n as well as of a function f t on SU n , it follows that fg ,...,g n f t g t ,...,g t n f t ..g K .., . . . , ..g Kn ... Hence, d d n fg ,...,g n m,K...Kn d m d K d Kn f t ..g K .., . . . , ..g Kn .. n mn d m d d n f t g ,...,g n d d n f t g ,...,g n , where, in the rst step, we simply rearranged the order of integration, in the second step we used the invariance property of the Haar measure and simplied notation for dummy variables being integrated, and, in the third step, we used the fact that, since the measure is normalized, the integral of a constant produces just that constant . This establishes the required result .. Next, consider the vacuum expectation value functional v on H/ de ned by .. The continuity and linearity of v follow directly from its denition. That it is positive, i.e. satises vF F , is equally obvi ous. In fact, a stronger result holds if F , , then vF F gt since the value vF F of v on F F is obtained by integrating a nonnegative function f f on SU n /Ad with respect to a regular measure. Thus, v is strictly positive. Since H/ is dense in H/ it follows that the functional extends to H/ by continuity. To see that we have a regular measure on //, recall rst that the C algebra of cylindrical functions is naturally isomorphic with the Gelfand transform of the Calgebra H/, which, in turn is the Calgebra of all continuous functions on the compact Hausdor space //. The vacuum expectation value function v is therefore a continuous linear functional on the algebra of all continuous functions on // equipped with the L i.e. sup norm. Hence, by the RieszMarkov theorem, it follows that In the simplest case, with n and n , we would for example have fg ,g f g g f g . Then dg dg fg ,g dg dg f g g dg fg , where in the second step we have used the invariance and normalization properties of the Haar measure. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski vf df is in fact the integral of the continuous function f on // with respect to a regular measure. This is just our cylindrical measure. Finally, since our construction did not require the introduction of any extra structure on such as a metric or a volume element, it follows that the functional v and the measure d are Di invariant. We will refer to d as the induced Haar measure on //. We now explore some properties of this measure and of the resulting representation of the holonomy Calgebra H/. First, the representation of H/ can be constructed as follows. The Hilbert space is L //, d and the elements F of H/ act by multiplica tion so that we have F f for all L //, d, where f is the Gelfand transform of F. This representation is cyclic and the function dened by A on // is the vacuum state. Every generator T of the holonomy Calgebra is represented by a bounded, selfadjoint operator on L //, d. Second, it follows from the strictness of the positivity of the measure that the resulting representation of the Calgebra H/ is faithful. To our knowledge, this is the rst faithful representation of the holonomy C algebra that has been constructed explicitly. Finally, the dieomorphism group Di of has an induced action on the Calgebra H/ and hence also on its spectrum //. Since the measure d on // is invariant under this action, the Hilbert space L //, d carries a unitary representation of Di. Under this action, the vacuum state is left invariant. Third, restricting the values of v to the generators T K of H/, we obtain the generating functional of this representation d A . This functional on the loop space L x is dieomorphism invari ant since the measure d is. It thus dened a generalized knot invariant. We will see below that, unlike the standard invariants, vanishes on all smoothly embedded loops. Its action is nontrivial only when the loop is retraced, i.e. only on generalized loops. Let us conclude this section by indicating how one computes the integral in practice. Fix a loop L x and let i iN N . be the minimal decomposition of into independent loops ,..., n as in Section ., where k , keeps track of the orientation and i k , . . . , n. We have used the double sux i k because any one independent loop ,..., n can arise more than once in the decomposition. Thus, N n. The loop denes an element T of the holonomy Calgebra H/ whose Gelfand transform t is a function on //. This is the cylindrical function we wish to integrate. Now, the projection map of Lemma . assigns to t the function t on SU n /Ad given by t g ,...,g n Tr g i ...g N iN . Holonomy Calgebras Thus, to integrate t on //, we need to integrate this t on SU n /Ad. Now, there exist in the literature useful formulae for integrating polyno mials of the matrix element functions over SU see, e.g., . These can be now used to evaluate the required integrals on SU n /Ad. In particular, one can readily show the following result ,/ dt , unless every loop i is repeated an even number of times in the decompo sition . of . Discussion In this paper, we completed the AI program in several directions. First, by exploiting the fact that the loops are piecewise analytic, we were able to obtain a complete characterization of the Gelfand spectrum // of the holonomy Calgebra H/. AI had shown that every element of // denes a homomorphism from the hoop group H to SU. We found that every homomorphism from H to SU denes an element of the spectrum and two homomorphisms H and H dene the same element of // only if they dier by an SU automorphism, i.e. if and only if H g H g for some g SU. Since this characterization is rather simple and purely algebraic, it is useful in practice. The second main result also intertwines the structure of the hoop group with that of the Gelfand spectrum. Given a subgroup o of H generated by a nite number, say n, of independent hoops, we were able to dene a projection o from // to the compact space SU n /Ad. This family of projections en ables us to dene cylindrical functions on // these are the pullbacks to // of the continuous functions on SU n /Ad. We analysed the space of these functions and found that its completion has the structure of a Calgebra which, moreover, is naturally isomorphic with the Calgebra of all continuous functions on the compact Hausdor space // and hence, via the inverse Gelfand transform, also to the holonomy Calgebra H/ with which we began. We then carried out a nonlinear extension of the theory of cylindrical measures to integrate these cylindrical functions on //. Since is the Calgebra of all continuous functions on //, the cylindrical measures in fact turn out to be regular measures on //. Fi nally, we were able to introduce explicitly such a measure on // which is natural in the sense that it arises from the Haar measure on SU. The resulting representation of the holonomy Calgebra has several interesting properties. In particular, the representation is faithful and dieomorphism invariant. Hence, its generating function which sends loops based at x to real numbers denes a generalized knot invariant generalized because we have allowed loops to have kinks, selfintersections, and self Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski overlaps. These constructions show that the AI program can be realized in detail. Having the induced Haar measure d on // at ones disposal, we can now make the ideas on the loop transform T of , rigorous. The transform T sends states in the connection representation to states in the socalled loop representation. In terms of machinery introduced in this paper, a state in the connection representation is a squareintegrable function on // thus L //, d. The transform T sends it to a function on the space H of hoops. Sometimes, it is convenient to lift canonically to the space L x and regard it as a function on the loop space. This is the origin of the term loop representation. We have T with ,/ dt A At ,,. where t with t A A is the Gelfand transform of the trace of the holonomy function, T , on //, associated with the hoop , and , denotes the inner product on L //, d. Thus, in the transform the traces of holonomies play the role of the integral kernel. Elements of the holonomy algebra have a natural action on the connection states . Using T , one can transform this action to the hoop states . It turns out that the action is surprisingly simple and can be represented directly in terms of elementary operations on the hoop space. Consider a generator T of H/. In the connection representation, we have T AT A A. On the hoop states, this action translates to T . where is the composition of hoops and in the hoop group. Thus, one can forgo the connection representation and work directly in terms of hoop states. We will show elsewhere that the transform also interacts well with the momentum operators which are associated with closed strips, i.e. that these operators also have simple action on the hoop states. The hoop states are especially well suited to deal with dieomorphism i.e. Di invariant theories. In such theories, physical states are re quired to be invariant under Di. This condition is awkward to impose in the connection representation, and it is dicult to control the structure of the space of resulting states. In the loop representation, by contrast, the task is rather simple physical states depend only on generalized knot and link classes of loops. Because of this simplication and because the action of the basic operators can be represented by simple operations on hoops, the loop representation has proved to be a powerful tool in quantum general relativity in and dimensions. The use of this representation, however, raises several issues which are Holonomy Calgebras still open. Perhaps the most basic of these is that, without referring back to the connection representation, we do not yet have a useful characterization of the hoop states which are images of connection states, i.e. of elements of L //, d. Neither do we have an expression of the inner product be tween hoop states. It would be extremely interesting to develop integration theory also over the hoop group H and express the inner product between hoop states directly in terms of such integrals, without any reference to the connection representation. This may indeed be possible using again the idea of cylindrical functions, but now on H, rather than on //, and exploiting, as before, the duality between these spaces. If this is achieved and if the integrals over // and H can be related, we would have a non linear generalization of the Plancherel theorem which establishes that the Fourier transform is an isomorphism between two spaces of L functions. The loop transform would then become an extremely powerful tool. Appendix A C loops and U connections In the main body of the paper, we restricted ourselves to piecewise analytic loops. This restriction was essential in Section . for our decomposition of a given set of a nite number of loops into independent loops which in turn is used in every major result contained in this paper. The restriction is not as severe as it might rst seem since every smooth manifold admits a unique analytic structure. Nonetheless, it is important to nd out if our arguments can be replaced by more sophisticated ones so that the main results would continue to hold even if the holonomy Calgebra were constructed from piecewise smooth loops. In this appendix, we consider U connections rather than SU and show that, in this theory, our main results do continue to hold for piecewise C loops. However, the new arguments make a crucial use of the Abelian character of U and do not by themselves go over to nonAbelian theories. Nonetheless, this Abelian example is an indication that analyticity may not be indispensible even in the nonAbelian case. The appendix is divided into three parts. The rst is devoted to cer tain topological considerations which arise because manifolds admit non trivial Ubundles. The second proves the analog of the spectrum theo rem of Section . The third introduces a dieomorphisminvariant measure on the spectrum and discusses some of its properties. Throughout this ap pendix, by loops we shall mean continuous, piecewise C loops. We will use the same notation as in the main text but now those symbols will refer to the U theory. Thus, for example, H will denote the Uhoop group and H/, the U holonomy algebra. A. Topological considerations Fix a smooth manifold . Denote by / the space of all smooth U con nections which belong to an appropriate Sobolev space. Now, unlike SU Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski bundles, U bundles over manifolds need not be trivial. The question therefore arises as to whether we should allow arbitrary U connections or restrict ourselves only to the trivial bundle in the construction of the holonomy Calgebra. Fortunately, it turns out that both choices lead to the same Calgebra. This is the main result of this subsection. Denote by / the subspace of / consisting of connections on the trivial U bundle over . As is common in the physics literature, we will identify elements A of / with realvalued forms. Thus, the holonomies dened by any A / will be denoted by H, A expi A expi, where takes values in , and depends on both the connection A and the loop . We begin with the following result Lemma A. Given a nite number of loops, ,..., n , for every A / there exists A / such that H i ,AH i ,A , i , . . . , n. Proof Suppose the connection A is dened on the bundle P. We will show rst that there exists a local section s of P which contains the given loops i . To construct the section we use a map S which generates the bundle P, U see Trautman . The map carries each i into a loop i in S . Since the loops i cannot form a dense set in S , we may remove from the sphere an open ball B which does not intersect any of i . Now, since S B is contractible, there exists a smooth section of the Hopf bundle U SU S , S B SU. Hence, there exists a section s of P, U dened on a subset V S B which contains all the loops i . Having obtained this section s, we can now look for the connection A . Let be a globally dened, real form on such that V s A. Hence, the connection A denes on the given loops i the same holonomy elements as A i.e. H i ,A H i , A A. for all i. This lemma has several useful implications. We mention two that will be used immediately in what follows. . Denition of hoops A priori, there are two equivalence relations on the space L x of based loops that one can introduce. One may say that two loops are equivalent if the holonomies of all connections in / around them are the same, or, one could ask that the holonomies Holonomy Calgebras be the same only for connections in / . Lemma A. implies that the two notions are in fact equivalent there is only one hoop group H. As in the main text, we will denote by the hoop to which a loop L x belongs. . Sup norm Consider functions f on / dened by nite linear combi nations of holonomies on / around hoops in H. Since the holono mies themselves are complex numbers, the trace operation is now re dundant. We can restrict these functions to / . Lemma A. implies that sup A, fA sup A , fA . A. As a consequence of these implications, we can use either / or / to construct the holonomy Calgebra in spite of topological nontrivialities, there is only one H/. To construct this algebra we proceed as follows. Let H/ denote the complex vector space of functions f on / of the form fA n j a j H, A n j a j exp i A , A. where a j are complex numbers. Clearly, H/ has the structure of a algebra with the product law H, A H, A H,A and the relation given by H, A H ,A . Equip it with the sup norm and take the completion. The result is the required Calgebra H/. We conclude by noting another consequence of Lemma A. the Abelian hoop group H has no torsion. More precisely, we have the following result Lemma A. Let H. Then if n e, the identity in H, for n Z, then e. Proof Since n e, we have, for every A / , H, A H n , n A , where is any loop in the hoop . Hence, by Lemma A., it follows that e. Although the proof is more complicated, the analogous result holds also in the SU case treated in the main text. However, in that case, the hoop group is nonAbelian. As we will see below, it is the Abelian character of the Uhoop group that makes the result of this lemma useful. A. The Gelfand spectrum of H/ We now want to obtain a complete characterization of the spectrum of the U holonomy Calgebra H/ along the lines of Section . The analog of Lemma . is easy to establish every element A of the spectrum denes Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski a homomorphism H A from the hoop group H to U now given simply by H A A . This is not surprising. Indeed, it is clear from the discussion in Section that this lemma continues to hold for piecewise smooth loops even in the full SU theory. However, the situation is quite dierent for Lemma . because there we made a crucial use of the fact that the loops were continuous and piecewise analytic. Therefore, we must now modify that argument suitably. An appropriate replacement is contained in the following lemma. Lemma A. For every homomorphism H from the hoop group H to U, every nite set of hoops ,..., k , and every gt , there exists a connection A / such that H i H i ,A lt , i , . . . , k. A. Proof Consider the subgroup H ,..., n H that is generated by ,..., k . Since H is Abelian and since it has no torsion, H ,..., k is nitely and freely generated by some elements, say ,..., n . Hence, if A. is satised by i for a suciently small t then it will also be satised by the given j for the given . Consequently, without loss of generality, we can assume that the hoops i are weakly Uindependent, i.e. that they satisfy the following condition if k n kn e, then k i i. Now, given such hoops i , the homomorphism H H U denes a point H ,..., H k U k . On the other hand, there also exists a map from / to U k , which can be expressed as a composition / A A ,..., k A e i A ,...,e i k A U k . A. The rst map in A. is linear and its image, V R k , is a vector space. Let ,mm ,...,m k Z k . Denote by V m the subspace of V orthogonal to m. Now if V m were to equal V then we would have m k m k , which would contradict the assumption that the given set of hoops is in dependent. Hence we necessarily have V m lt V . Furthermore, since a countable union of subsets of measure zero has measure zero, it follows that mZ k V m lt V. This strict inequality implies that there exists a connection B / such Holonomy Calgebras that v B ,..., n B V mZ k V m . In other words, B is such that every ratio v i /v j of two dierent components of v is irrational. Thus, the line in / dened by B via A t tB is carried by the map A. into a line which is dense in U k . This ensures that there exists an A on this line which has the required property A.. Armed with this substitute of Lemma ., it is straightforward to show the analog of Lemma .. Combining these results, we have the U spectrum theorem Theorem A. Every A in the spectrum of H/ denes a homomorphism H from the hoop group H to U, and, conversely, every homomorphism H denes an element A of the spectrum such that H A . This is a correspondence. A. A natural measure Results presented in the previous subsection imply that one can again intro duce the notion of cylindrical functions and measures. In this subsection, we will exhibit a natural measure. Rather than going through the same constructions as in the main text, for the sake of diversity, we will adopt here a complementary approach. We will present a strictly positive linear functional on the holonomy Calgebra H/ whose properties suce to en sure the existence of a dieomorphisminvariant, faithful, regular measure on the spectrum of H/. We know from the general theory outlined in Section that, to specify a positive linear functional on H/, it suces to provide an appropriate generating functional on L x . Let us simply set , if o , otherwise, A. where o is the identity hoop in H. It is clear that this functional on L x is dieomorphism invariant. Indeed, it is the simplest of such functionals on L x . We will now show that it does have all the properties to be a generating function . Theorem A. extends to a continuous positive linear function on the holonomy Calgebra H/. Furthermore, this function is strictly positive. Since this functional is so simple and natural, one might imagine using it to dene a positive linear functional also for the SU holonomy algebra of the main text. However, this strategy fails because of the SU identities. For example, in the SU holonomy algebra we have T T T . Evaluation of the generating functional A. on this identity would lead to the contradiction . We can dene a Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski Proof By its denition, the loop functional admits a welldened projection on the hoop space H which we will denote again by . Let TH be the free vector space generated by the hoop group. Extend to TH by linearity. We will rst establish that this extension satises the following property given a nite set of hoops j , j , . . . , n, such that, if i , j if i , j, we have n j a j j n j a j j lt sup A , n j a j H j ,A n j a j H j ,A . A. To see this, note rst that, by denition of , the left side equals a j . The right side equals a j expi j a j exp i j where j depend on A and the hoop j . Now, by Lemma A., given the n hoops j , one can nd an A such that the angles j can be made as close as one wishes to a prespecied ntuple j . Finally, given the n complex numbers a i , one can always nd j such that a j lt a j expi j a j expi j . Hence we have A.. The inequality A. implies that the functional has a welldened projection on the holonomy algebra H/ which is obtained by taking the quotient of TH by the subspace K consisting of b i i such that b i H i ,A for all A / . Furthermore, the projection is positive denite f f for all f H/, equality holding only if f . Next, since the norm on this algebra is the sup norm on / , it follows from A. that the functional is continuous on H/. Hence it admits a unique continuous extension to the Calgebra H/. Finally, A. implies that the functional continues to be strictly positive on H/. Theorem A. implies that the generating functional provides a contin uous, faithful representation of H/ and hence a regular, strictly positive measure on the Gelfand spectrum of this algebra. It is not dicult to verify by direct calculations that this is precisely the U analog of the induced Haar measure discussed in Section . Appendix B C loops, UN and SUN connections In this appendix, we will consider another extension of the results presented in the main text. We will now work with analytic manifolds and piecewise analytic loops as in the main text. However, we will let the manifold have positive linear function on the SU holonomy Calgebra via , if T AAA , otherwise, where we have regarded A as a subspace of the space of SU connections. However, on the SU holonomy algebra, this positive linear functional is not strictly positive the measure on A/G it denes is concentrated just on A . Consequently, the resulting representation of the SU holonomy Calgebra fails to be faithful. Holonomy Calgebras any dimension and let the gauge group G be either UN or SUN. Con sequently, there are two types of complications algebraic and topological. The rst arise because, for example, the products of traces of holonomies can no longer be expressed as sums while the second arise because the connections in question may be dened on nontrivial principal bundles. Nonetheless, we will see that the main results of the paper continue to hold in these cases as well. Several of the results also hold when the gauge group is allowed to be any compact Lie group. However, for brevity of presen tation, we will refrain from making digressions to the general case. Also, since most of the arguments are rather similar to those given in the main text, details will be omitted. Let us begin by xing a principal bre bundle P, G, obtain the main results, and then show, at the end, that they are independent of the initial choice of P, G. Denitions of the space L x of based loops, and holonomy maps H, A, are the same as in Section . To keep the notation simple, we will continue to use the same symbols as in the main text to denote various spaces which, however, now refer to connections on P, G. Thus, / will denote the space of suitably regular connections on P, G, H will denote the P, Ghoop group, and H/ will be the holonomy Calgebra generated by nite sums of nite products of traces of holonomies of connections in / around hoops in H. B. Holonomy Calgebra We will set T A N TrH, A, where the trace is taken in the fun damental representation of UN or SUN, and regard T as a function on //, the space of gaugeequivalent connections. The holonomy alge bra H/ is, by denition, generated by all nite linear combinations with complex coecients of nite products of the T , with the relation given by f f, where the bar stands for complex conjugation. Being traces of UN and SUN matrices, T are bounded functions on //. We can therefore introduce on H/ the sup norm f sup A, fA, and take the completion of H/ to obtain a Calgebra. We will denote it by H/. This is the holonomy Calgebra. The key dierence between the structure of this H/ and the one we constructed in Section is the following. In Section , the algebra H/ was obtained simply by imposing an equivalence relation K, see eqn . on the free vector space generated by the loop space L x . This was possible because, owing to SU Mandelstam identities, products of any two T could be expressed as a linear combination of T eqn .. For the groups under consideration, the situation is more involved. Let us summarize the situation in the slightly more general context of the group GLN. In Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski this case, the Mandelstam identities follow from the contraction of N matricesH , A, . . . , H N , A in our casewith the identity j i ,..., jN iN where j i is the Kronecker delta and the bracket stands for the antisym metrization. They enable one to express products of N T functions as a linear combination of traces of products of , , . . . , N T functions. Hence, we have to begin by considering the free algebra generated by the hoop group and then impose on it all the suitable identities by extend ing the denition of the kernel .. Consequently, if the gauge group is GLN, an element of the holonomy algebra H/ is expressible as an equiv alence class a, b ,...,c N , where a, b, c are complex numbers products involving N and higher loops are redundant. For subgroups of GLNsuch as SUNfurther reductions arise. Finally, let us note identities that will be useful in what follows. These result from the fact that the determinant of N N matrix M can be expressed in terms of traces of powers of that matrix, namely det M FTrM, TrM , . . . , TrM N for a certain polynomial F. Hence, if the gauge group G is UN, we have, for any hoop , FT ,...,T NFT ,...,T N . B.a In the SUN case a stronger identity holds FT ,...,T N . B.b B. Loop decomposition and the spectrum theorem The construction of Section . for decomposition of a nite number of loops into independent loops makes no direct reference to the gauge group and therefore carries over as is. Also, it is still true that the map /AH , A, . . . , H n ,AG n is onto if the loops i are independent. The proof requires some minor modications which consist of using local sections and a suciently large number of generators of the gauge group. A direct consequence is that the analog of Lemma . continues to hold. As for the Gelfand spectrum, the AI result that there is a natural embedding of // into the spectrum // of H/ goes through as before and so does the general argument due to Rendall that the image of // is dense in //. This is true for any group and representation for which the traces of holonomies separate the points of //. Finally, using the analog of Lemma ., it is straightforward to establish the analog of the Holonomy Calgebras main conclusion of Lemma .. The conversethe analog of Lemma .on the other hand requires further analysis based on Giles results along the lines used by AI in the SU case. For the gauge group under consideration, given an ele ment of the spectrum Ai.e. a continuous homomorphism from H/ to the algebra of complex numbersGiles theorem provides us with a homomorphism H A from the hoop group H to GLN. What we need to show is that H A can be so chosen that it takes values in the given gauge group G. We can establish this by considering the eigenvalues ,..., N of H A . After all, the characteristic polynomial of the matrix H A is expressible directly by the values of A taken on the hoops , ,..., n . First, we note from eqn B.a that in particular i , , for every i. Thus far, we have used only the algebraic properties of A. From continuity it follows that for every hoop , TrH A N. Substituting for its powers we conclude that k k N N for every integer k. This suces to conclude that i . With this result in hand, we can now use Giles analysis to conclude that given A we can nd H A which takes values in UN. If G is SUN then, by the identity B.b, we have det H A , so that the analog of Lemma . holds. Combining these results, we have the spectrum theorem every element A of the spectrum // denes a homomorphism H from the hoop group H to the gauge group G, and, conversely, every homomorphism H from the hoop group H to G denes an element A of the spectrum // such that A N Tr H for all H. Two homomorphisms H and H dene the same element of the spectrum if and only if Tr H Tr H . B. Cylindrical functions and the induced Haar measure Using the spectrum theorem, we can again associate with any subgroup o H ,..., n generated by n independent hoops ,..., n , an equivalence relation on // A A i A A for all o . This relation provides us with a family of projections from // onto the compact manifolds G n /Ad since, for groups under consideration, the traces of all elements of a nitely generated subgroup in the fundamental representation suce to characterize the subgroup modulo an overall ad joint map. Therefore, as before, we can dene cylindrical functions on // as the pullbacks to // of continuous functions on G n /Ad. They again Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski form a Calgebra. Using the fact that traces of products of group elements suce to separate points of G n /Ad when G UN or G SUN , it again follows that the Calgebra of cylindrical functions is isomorphic with H/. Finally, the construction of Section . which led us to the deni tion of the induced Haar measure goes through step by step. The resulting representation of the Calgebra H/ is again faithful and dieomorphism invariant. B. Bundle dependence In all the constructions above, we xed a principal bundle P, G. To conclude, we will show that the Calgebra H/ and hence its spectrum are independent of this choice. First, as noted at the end of Section ., using the hoop decomposition one can show that two loops in L x dene the same hoop if and only if they dier by a combination of reparametrization and an immediate retracing of segments for gauge groups under consideration. Therefore, the hoop groups obtained from any two bundles are the same. Fix a gauge group G from UN, SUN and let P , G and P , G be two principal bundles. Let the corresponding holonomy Calgebras be H/ and H/ . Using the spectrum theorem, we know that their spectra are naturally isomorphic // HomH, G // . We wish to show that the algebras are themselves naturally isomorphic, i.e. that the map dened by n i a i T i n i a i T i B. is an isomorphism from H/ to H/ . Let us decompose the given hoops ,..., k into independent hoops ,..., n . Let o be the subgroup of the hoop group they generate and, as in Section ., let i o ,i,, be the corresponding projection maps from // to G n /Ad. From the denition of the maps it follows that the projections of the two functions in B. to G N /Ad are in fact equal. Hence, we have n i a i T i n i a i T i , whence it follows that is an isomorphism of Calgebras. Thus, it does not matter which bundle we begin with we obtain the same holonomy Calgebra H/. Now, x a bundle, P say, and consider a connection A dened on P . Note that the holonomy map of A denes a homomorphism from the bundleindependent hoop group to G. Hence, A denes also a point in the spectrum of H/ . Therefore, given a manifold M and a gauge group G the spectrum // automatically contains all the connections Holonomy Calgebras on all the principal Gbundles over M. Acknowledgements The authors are grateful to John Baez for several illuminating comments and to Roger Penrose for suggesting that the piecewise analytic loops may be better suited for their purpose than the piecewise smooth ones. JL also thanks Cliord Taubes for stimulating discussions. This work was sup ported in part by the National Science Foundation grants PHY and PHY by the Polish Committee for Scientic Research KBN through grant no. and by the Eberly research fund of Penn sylvania State University. Bibliography . A. Ashtekar, Nonperturbative canonical quantum gravity Notes pre pared in collaboration with R.S. Tate, World Scientic, Singapore . A. Ashtekar and C. Isham, Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . R. Gambini and A. Trias, Nucl. Phys. B, . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Nucl. Phys. B, . A. Rendall, Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . J. Baez, In Proceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology, eds L. Crane and D. Yetter to appear, hepth/ . J. Lewandowski, Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . P.K. Mitter and C. Viallet, Commun. Math. Phys. , . C. Di Bartolo, R. Gambini, and J. Griego, preprint IFFI/ gr qc/ . R. Giles, Phys. Rev. D, . J.W. Barrett, Int. J. Theor. Phys. , . A.N. Kolmogorov, Foundations of the Theory of Probability, Chelsea, New York . Y. ChoquetBruhat, C. DeWittMorette and M. DillardBleick, Anal ysis, Manifolds and Physics, NorthHolland, Amsterdam , pp. . M. Creutz, Quarks, Gluons and Lattices, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge Chapter . A. Trautman, Czech. J. Phys. B, . C. Procesi, Adv. Math. , Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity Rodolfo Gambini Intituto de Fsica, Facultad de Ciencias, Tristan Narvaja , Montevideo, Uruguay email rgambinising.edu.uy Jorge Pullin Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry, Pennsylvania State University, University Park, Pennsylvania , USA email pullinphys.psu.edu Abstract We show that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number of a knot is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space with a cosmological constant. Using this fact, it is straightforward to prove that the second coecient of the Jones polynomial is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space with no cosmological constant. We perform calculations from scratch, starting from the connection representation and give details of the proof. Implications for the possibility of generation of other solutions are also discussed. Introduction The introduction of the loop representation for quantum gravity has made it possible for the rst time to nd solutions to the WheelerDeWitt equa tion the quantum Hamiltonian constraint and therefore to have possible candidates to become physical wave functions of the gravitational eld. In the loop representation the Hamiltonian constraint has nonvanishing ac tion only on functions of intersecting loops. It was rst argued that by considering wave functions with support on smooth loops one could solve the constraint straightforwardly , . However, it was later realized that such solutions are associated with degenerate metrics metrics with zero determinant and this posed inconsistencies if one wanted to couple the theory . For instance, if one considered general relativity with a cosmo logical constant it turns out that nonintersecting loop states also solve the WheelerDeWitt equation for arbitrary values of the cosmological constant. This does not appear as reasonable since dierent values of the cosmological constant lead to widely dierent behaviors in general relativity. Therefore the problem of solving the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. . At least a triple intersection is needed to have a state associated with a nondegenerate dimensional metric in the loop representation. And even in this case the metric is nondegenerate only at the point of intersection. space is far from solved and has to be tackled by considering the action of the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop representation on states based on at least triply intersecting loops, as depicted in Fig. . Although performing this kind of direct calculations is now possible, since welldened expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint exist in terms of the loop derivative see also and actually some solutions have been found with this approach , another line of reasoning has also proved to be useful. This other approach is based on the fact that the exponential of the ChernSimons term based on Ashtekars connection CS A exp d xA i a b A i c A i a A j b A k c ijk abc . is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in the connection represen tation with a cosmological term H ijk A i a A j b F k ab ijk abc A i a A j b A k c . the rst term is just the usual Hamiltonian constraint with and the second term is just det g where det g is the determinant of the spatial part of the metric written in terms of triads. To prove this fact one simply needs to notice that for the ChernSimons state introduced above, A i a CS A abc F i bc CS A, . and therefore the rightmost functional derivative in the cosmological con stant term of the Hamiltonian . produces a term in F i ab that exactly cancels the contribution from the vacuum Hamiltonian constraint. The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity This result for the ChernSimons state in the connection representa tion has an immediate counterpart in the loop representation, since the transform of the ChernSimons state into the loop representation CS dA CS AW A. can be interpreted as the expectation value of the Wilson loop in a Chern Simons theory, CS dA e SCS W AW . with coupling constant , and we know due to the insight of Witten that this coincides with the Kauman bracket of the loop. Therefore the state CS Kauman bracket . should be a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space. This last fact can actually be checked in a direct fashion using the expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint in loop space of . In order to do this we make use of the identity Kauman bracket e Gauss Jones polynomial . which relates the Kauman bracket, the Gauss selflinking number, and the Jones polynomial. The Gauss selflinking number is framing dependent, and so is the Kauman bracket. The Jones polynomial, however, is framing independent. This raises the issue of up to what extent statements about the Kauman bracket being a state of gravity are valid, since one expects states of quantum gravity to be truly dieomorphisminvariant objects and framing is always dependent on an external device which should conict with the dieomorphism invariance of the theory. Unfortunately it is not clear at present how to settle this issue since it is tied to the regularization procedures used to dene the constraints. We will return to these issues in the nal discussion. We now expand both the Jones polynomial and the exponential of the Gauss linking number in terms of and get the expression Kauman bracket Gauss Gauss a Gauss Gauss a a .... where a ,a are the second and third coecient of the innite expansion of the Jones polynomial in terms of . a is known to coincide with the second coecient of the Conway polynomial . Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin One could now apply the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop represen tation with a cosmological constant to the expansion . and one would nd that certain conditions have to be satised if the Kauman bracket is to be a solution. Among them it was noticed that H a . where H is the Hamiltonian constraint without cosmological constant more recently it has also been shown that H a but we will not discuss it here. Summarizing, the fact that the Kauman bracket is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological constant seems to have as a di rect consequence that the coecients of the Jones polynomial are solutions of the vacuum WheelerDeWitt equation This partially answers the problem of framing we pointed out above. Even if one is reluctant to accept the Kauman bracket as a state because of its framing dependence, it can be viewed as an intermediate step of a framingdependent proof that the Jones polynomial which is a framingindependent invariant solves the WheelerDeWitt equation it should be stressed that we only have evidence that the rst two nontrivial coecients are solutions. The purpose of this paper is to present a rederivation of these facts from a dierent, and to our understanding simpler, perspective. We will show that the framingdependent knot invariant G e Gauss . is also a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological con stant. It can be viewed as an Abelian limit of the Kauman bracket more on this in the conclusions. Given this fact, one can therefore consider their dierence divided by , D Kauman bracket G ,. which is also a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with a cosmolog ical constant. This dierence is of the form D a a Gauss a ..... Now, this dierence is a state for all values of , in particular for . This means that a should be a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation. This conrms the proof given in , . Therefore we see that by noticing that the Gauss linking number is a state with cosmological constant, it is easy to prove that the second coecient of the innite expansion of the Jones polynomial which coincides with the second coecient of the Conway polynomial is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with . The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity The rest of this paper will be devoted to a detailed proof that the expo nential of the Gauss linking number solves the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological constant. To this aim we will derive expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint with cosmological constant in the loop represen tation. We will perform the calculation explicitly for the case of a triply selfintersecting loop, the more interesting case for gravity purposes it should be noticed that all the arguments presented above were indepen dent of the number and order of intersections of the loops we just present the explicit proof for a triple intersection since in three spatial dimensions it represents the most important type of intersection. Apart from presenting this new state, we think the calculations exhib ited in this paper should help the reader get into the details of how these calculations are performed and make an intuitive contact between the ex pressions in the connection and the loop representation. In Section we derive the expression of the Hamiltonian constraint with a cosmological constant in the loop representation for a triply in tersecting loop in terms of the loop derivative. In Section we write an explicit analytic expression for the Gauss linking number and prove that it is a state of the theory. We end in Section with a discussion of the results. The WheelerDeWitt equation in terms of loops Here we derive the explicit form in the loop representation of the Hamil tonian constraint with a cosmological constant. The derivation proceeds along the following lines. Suppose one wants to dene the action of an operator O L on a wave function in the loop representation . Applying the transform O L dA O L W AA . the operator O in the right member acts on the loop dependence of the Wilson loop. On the other hand, this denition should agree with O L dAW A O C A. where O C is the connection representation version of the operator in ques tion. Therefore, it is clear that O L W A O C W A, . where means the adjoint operator with respect to the measure of inte gration dA. If one assumes that the measure is trivial, the only eect of taking the adjoint is to reverse the factor ordering of the operators. Concretely, in the case of the Hamiltonian constraint without Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin cosmological constant H C ijk A i a A j b F k ab . and therefore H L W A ijk F k ab A i a A j b W A. . We now need to compute this quantity explicitly. For that we need the expression of the functional derivative of the Wilson loop with respect to the connection A i a x W A dy a y xTr Pexp y o dz b A b i Pexp o y dz b A b . where o is the basepoint of the loop. The Wilson loop is therefore broken at the point of action of the functional derivative and a Pauli matrix i is inserted. It is evident that with this action of the functional derivative the Hamiltonian operator is not well dened. We need to regularize it as H L W A lim f xz ijk F k ab x A i a x A j b z W A. where f xz xz when . Caution should be exercised, since such point splitting breaks the gauge invariance of the Hamiltonian. There are a number of ways of xing this situation in the language of loops. One of them is to dene the Hamiltonian inserting pieces of holonomies connecting the points x and z between the functional derivatives to produce a gauge invariant quantity . Here we will only study the operator in the limit in which the regulator is removed therefore we will not be concerned with these issues. A proper calculation would require their careful study. It is immediate from the above denitions that the Hamiltonian con straint vanishes in any regular point of the loop, since it yields a term dy a dy b F i ab which vanishes due to the antisymmetry of F i ab and the symme try of dy a dy b at points where the loop is smooth. However, at intersections there can be nontrivial contributions. Here we compute the contribution at a point of triple selfintersection, ijk F k ab x A i a x A j b z W A ijk F k ab x. a b W j k A a b W j kA a b W j kA, where we have denoted where i are the petals of the loop as indicated in Fig. . By W j k A we really mean take the holon omy from the basepoint along up to just before the intersection point, insert a Pauli matrix, continue along to the intersection, continue along The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity , and just before the intersection insert another Pauli matrix, continue to the intersection, and complete the loop along . One could pick after the intersection instead of before to include the Pauli matrices and it would make no dierence since we are concentrating on the limit in which the regulator is removed, in which the insertions are done at the intersection. By a we mean the tangent to the petal number just before the inter section where the Pauli matrix was inserted. This is just shorthand for expressions like dy a xy when the point x is close to the intersection, so strictly speaking a really is a distribution that is nonvanishing only at the point of intersection. One now uses the following identity for traces of SU matrices, ijk W j kA W i AW AW AW i A, . which is a natural generalization to the case of loops with insertions of the SU Mandelstam identities, W AW AW AW A, . where means the loop opposite to . The result of the application of these identities to the expression of the Hamiltonian is HW A. F i ab a b W iA a b W iA a b W iA . This expression can be further rearranged making use of the loop deriva tive. The loop derivative ab x o , is the dierentiation operator that appears in loop space when one considers two loops to be close if they dier by an innitesimal loop appended through a path x o going from the basepoint to a point of the manifold x as shown in Fig. . Its denition is x o o x ab ab x o . where ab is the element area of the innitesimal loop and by x o o x we mean the loop obtained by traversing the path from the basepoint to x, the innitesimal loop , the path from x to the basepoint, and then the loop . We will not discuss all its properties here. The only one we need is that the loop derivative of a Wilson loop taken with a path along the loop is given by ab x o W A Tr F ab xPexp dy c A c ,. which reects the intuitive notion that a holonomy of an innitesimal loop is related to the eld tensor. Therefore we can write expressions like F i ab W iA. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. . The loop dening the loop derivative as ab W A, . and the nal expression for the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop repre sentation can therefore be read o as follows H a b ab a b ab a b ab .. This expression could be obtained by particularizing that of to the case of a triply selfintersecting loop and rearranging terms slightly using the Mandelstam identities. However, we thought that a direct derivation for this particular case would be useful for pedagogical purposes. We now have to nd the loop representation form of the operator corre sponding to the determinant of the metric in order to represent the second term in .. We proceed in a similar fashion, rst computing the action of the operator in the connection representation det q ijk abc A i a A j b A k c . on a Wilson loop ijk abc A i a A j b A k c W A abc ijk a b c W i j kA .. This latter expression can be rearranged with the following identity between holonomies with insertions of Pauli matrices ijk W i j kA W AW AW A. . It is therefore immediate to nd the expression of the determinant of the metric in the loop representation detq abc a b c .. The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity With these elements we are in a position to perform the main calculation of this paper, to show that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number of a loop is a solution of the Hamiltonian constraint with a cosmological constant. The Gauss selflinking number as a solution In order to be able to apply the expressions we derived in the previous section for the constraints to the Gauss selflinking number we need an ex pression for it in terms of which it is possible to compute the loop derivative. This is furnished by the wellknown integral expression Gauss dx a dy b abc xy c xy . where x y is the distance between x and y with a ducial metric. This formula is most well known when the two loop integrals are computed along dierent loops. In that case the formula gives an integer measuring the extent to which the loops are linked. In the present case we are considering the expression of the linking of a curve with itself. This is in general not well dened without the introduction of a framing . We will rewrite the above expression in a more convenient fashion Gauss d x d yX a x, X b y, g ab x, y . where the vector densities X are dened as X a x, dz a zx. and the quantity g ab x, y is the propagator of a ChernSimons theory , g ab x, y abc xy c xy .. For calculational convenience it is useful to introduce the notation Gauss X ax X by g ax by . where we have promoted the point dependence in x, y to a continuous index and assumed a generalized Einstein convention which means sum over repeated indices a, b and integrate over the manifold for repeated continuous indices. This notation is also faithful to the fact that the index a behaves as a vector density index at the point x that is, it is natural to pair a and x together. The only dependence on the loop of the Gauss selflinking number is through the X, so we just need to compute the action of the loop derivative on one of them to be in a position to perform the calculation straightfor Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. . The loop derivative that appears in the denition of the Hamilto nian is evaluated along a path that follows the loop wardly. In order to do this we apply the denition of loop derivative, that is we consider the change in the X when one appends an innitesimal loop to the loop as illustrated in Fig. . We partition the integral in a portion going from the basepoint to the point z where we append the innitesimal loop, which we characterize as four segments along the integral curves of two vector elds u a and v b of associated lengths and , and then we continue from there back to the basepoint along the loop. Therefore, ab ab z o X ax z o dy a xy u a xz v b u c c xz u a u c v c c xz. v a v c c xz o z dy a y z. The last and rst term combine to give back X ax and therefore one can read o the action of the loop derivative from the other terms. Rearranging one gets ab z o X cx a c b xz. where the notation c b x z stands for c b x z, the product of the Kronecker and Dirac deltas. This is really all we need to compute the action of the Hamiltonian. We therefore now consider the action of the vacuum part of the Hamiltonian on the exponential of the Gauss linking number. The action of the loop derivative is ab x o exp X cy X dz g cy dz . a c b x yX dz g cy dz exp X ew X fw g ew fw . Now we must integrate by parts. Using the fact that a X ax and The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity the denition of g cy dz ., we get ab x o exp X cy X dz g cy dz . abc X cx X cx X cx exp X cy X dz g cy dz . Therefore the action of the Hamiltonian constraint on the Gauss linking number is He Gauss abc a b c e Gauss . where we again have replaced the distributional tangents at the point of intersection by an expression only involving the tangents. The expression is only formal since in order to do this a divergent factor should be kept in front. We assume such factors coming from all terms to be similar and therefore ignore them. It is straightforward now to check that applying the determinant of the metric one the Gauss linking number one gets a contribution exactly equal and opposite by inspection from expression .. This concludes the main proof of this paper. Discussion We showed that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number is a solution of the Hamiltonian constraint of quantum gravity with a cosmo logical constant. This naturally can be viewed as the Abelian limit of the solution given by the Kauman bracket. What about the issue of regularization The proof we presented is only valid in the limit where , that is, when the regulator is removed. If one does not take the limit the various terms do not cancel. However, the expression for the Hamiltonian constraint we introduced is also only valid when the regulator is removed. A regularized form of the Hamiltonian con straint in the loop representation is more complicated than the expression we presented. If one is to pointsplit, innitesimal segments of loop should be used to connect the split points to preserve gauge invariance and a more careful calculation would be in order. What does all this tell us about the physical relevance of the solutions The situation is remarkably similar to the one present in the loop repre sentation of the free Maxwell eld . In that case, as here, there are two terms in the Hamiltonian that need to be regularized in a dierent way in the case of gravity, the determinant of the metric requires splitting three points whereas the Hamiltonian only needs two. As a consequence of this, it is not surprising that the wave functions that solve the constraint have some regularization dependence. In the case of the Maxwell eld the vac uum in the loop representation needs to be regularized. In fact, its form is exactly the same as that of the exponential of the Gauss linking number if one replaces the propagator of the ChernSimons theory present in the Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin latter by the propagator of the Maxwell eld. This similarity is remarkable. The problem is therefore the same the wave functions inherit regulariza tion dependence since the regulator does not appear as an overall factor of the wave equation. How could these regularization ambiguities be cured In the Maxwell case they are solved by considering an extended loop representation in which one allows the quantities X ax to become smooth vector densities on the manifold without reference to any particular loop . In the grav itational case such construction is being actively pursued , although it is more complicated. It is in this context that the present solutions really make sense. If one allows the X to become smooth functions the framing problem disappears and one is left with a solution that is a func tion of vector elds and only reduces to the Gauss linking number in a very special singular limit. It has been proved that the extensions of the Kauman bracket and Jones polynomials to the case of smooth den sity elds are solutions of the extended constraints. A similar proof goes through for the extended Gauss linking number. In the extended repre sentation, there are additional multivector densities needed in the repre sentation. The Abelian limit of the Kauman bracket the Gauss linking number appears as the restriction of the extended Kauman bracket to the case in which higherorder multivector densities vanish. It would be interesting to study if such a limit could be pursued in a systematic way or der by order. It would certainly provide new insights into how to construct nonperturbative quantum states of the gravitational eld. Acknowledgements This paper is based on a talk given by J P at the Riverside conference. J P wishes to thank John Baez for inviting him to participate in the conference and hospitality in Riverside. This work was supported by grants NSF PHY, NSFPHY, and by research funds of the University of Utah and Pennsylvania State University. Support from PEDECIBA Uruguay is also acknowledged. R G wishes to thank Karel Kuchar and Richard Price for hospitality at the University of Utah where part of this work was accomplished. Bibliography . T. Jacobson, L. Smolin, Nucl. Phys. B, . . C. Rovelli, L. Smolin, Phys. Rev. Lett. , Nucl. Phys. B, . . B. Br ugmann, J. Pullin, Nucl. Phys. B, . . R. Gambini, Phys. Lett. B, . . B. Br ugmann, R. Gambini, J. Pullin, Phys. Rev. Lett. , . The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity . E. Witten, Commun. Math. Phys. , . . E. Guadagnini, M. Martellini, M. Mintchev, Nucl. Phys. B, . . B. Br ugmann, R. Gambini, J. Pullin, General Relativity Gravitation ,. . J. Griego, The extended loop representation a rst approach, preprint . . R. Gambini, A. Trias, Phys. Rev. D, . . C. Di Bartolo, F. Nori, R. Gambini, L. Leal, A. Trias, Lett. Nuovo. Cim. , . . D. ArmandUgon, R. Gambini, J. Griego, L. Setaro, Classical loop actions of gauge theories, preprint hepth . . C. Di Bartolo, R. Gambini, J. Griego, J. Pullin, in preparation. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Vassiliev Invariants and the Loop States in Quantum Gravity Louis H. Kauman Department of Mathematics, Statistics, and Computer Science, University of Illinois at Chicago, Chicago, Illinois , USA email Uuicvm.uic.edu Abstract This paper derives at the physical level of rigor a general switch ing formula for the link invariants dened via the Witten functional integral. The formula is then used to evaluate the top row of the cor responding Vassiliev invariants and it is shown to match the results of BarNatan obtained via perturbation expansion of the integral. It is explained how this formalism for Vassiliev invariants can be used in the context of the loop transform for quantum gravity. Introduction The purpose of this paper is to expose properties of Vassiliev invariants by using the simplest of the approaches to the functional integral denition of link invariants. These methods are strong enough to give the top row eval uations of Vassiliev invariants for the classical Lie algebras. They give an insight into the structure of these invariants without using the full pertur bation expansion of the integral. One reason for examining the invariants in this light is the possible applications to the loop variables approach to quantum gravity. The same level of handling the functional integral is commonly used in the loop transform for quantum gravity. The paper is organized as follows. Section is a brief discussion of the nature of the functional integral. Section details the formalism of the functional integral that we shall use, and works out a dierence formula for changing crossings in the link invariant and a formula for the change of framing. These are applied to the case of an SUN gauge group. Section denes the Vassiliev invariants and shows how to formulate them in terms of the functional integral. In particular we derive the specic expressions for the top rows of Vassiliev invariants corresponding to the fundamental representation of SUN. This gives a neat point of view on the results of BarNatan, and also gives a picture of the structure of the graphical vertex associated with the Vassiliev invariant. We see that this vertex is not just a transversal intersection of Wilson loops, but rather has the structure Louis H. Kauman of Casimir insertion up to rst order of approximation coming from the dierence formula in the functional integral. This claries an issue raised by John Baez in . Section is a quick remark about the loop formalism for quantum gravity and its relationships with the invariants studied in the previous sections. This marks the beginning of a study that will be carried out in detail elsewhere. Quantum mechanics and topology In Edward Witten proposed a formulation of a class of manifold invariants as generalized Feynman integrals taking the form ZM where ZM dAexp ik/SM, A . Here M denotes a manifold without boundary and A is a gauge eld also called a gauge potential or gauge connection dened on M. The gauge eld is a form on M with values in a representation of a Lie algebra. The group corresponding to this Lie algebra is said to be the gauge group for this particular eld. In this integral the action SM, A is taken to be the integral over M of the trace of the ChernSimons threeform CS AdA/AAA. The product is the wedge product of dierential forms. Instead of integrating over paths, the integral ZM integrates over all gauge elds modulo gauge equivalence see for a discussion of the denition and meaning of gauge equivalence. This generalization from paths to elds is characteristic of quantum eld theory. Quantum eld theory was designed in order to accomplish the quan tization of electromagnetism. In quantum electrodynamics the classical entity is the electromagnetic eld. The question posed in this domain is to nd the value of an amplitude for starting with one eld conguration and ending with another. The analogue of all paths from point a to point b is all elds from eld A to eld B. Wittens integral ZM is, in its form, a typical integral in quantum eld theory. In its content ZM is highly unusual. The formalism of the integral, and its internal logic, support the existence of a large class of topological invariants of manifolds and associated invariants of knots and links in these manifolds. The invariants associated with this integral have been given rigorous combinatorial descriptions see , , , , , but questions and con jectures arising from the integral formulation are still outstanding see . Links and the Wilson loop We now look at the formalism of the Witten integral and see how it im plicates invariants of knots and links corresponding to each classical Lie algebra. We need the Wilson loop. The Wilson loop is an exponentiated Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity version of integrating the gauge eld along a loop K in space that we take to be an embedding knot or a curve with transversal selfintersections. For the purpose of this discussion, the Wilson loop will be denoted by the notation KA to denote the dependence on the loop K and the eld A. It is usually indicated by the symbolism Tr P exp KA . Thus KA Tr P exp KA . Here the P denotes pathordered integration. The symbol Tr denotes the trace of the resulting matrix. With the help of the Wilson loop functional on knots and links, Witten writes down a functional integral for link invariants in a manifold M ZM, K dAexp ik/SM, A Tr P exp KA dAexp ik/S KA . Here SM, A is the ChernSimons action, as in the previous discussion. We abbreviate SM, A as S. Unless otherwise mentioned, the manifold M will be the dimensional sphere S . An analysis of the formalism of this functional integral reveals quite a bit about its role in knot theory. This analysis depends upon key facts relating the curvature of the gauge eld to both the Wilson loop and the ChernSimons Lagrangian. To this end, let us recall the local coordinate structure of the gauge eld Ax, where x is a point in space. We can write Ax A a k xT a dx k where the index a ranges from to m with the Lie algebra basis T ,T ,T ,...,T m . The index k goes from to . For each choice of a and k, A k a x is a smooth function dened on space. In Ax we sum over the values of repeated indices. The Lie algebra generators T a are actually matrices corresponding to a given representation of an abstract Lie algebra. We assume some properties of these matrices as follows .T a ,T b if abc T c where x, y xy yx, and f abc the matrix of structure constants is totally antisymmetric. There is summation over repeated indices. . TrT a T b ab / where ab is the Kronecker delta ab if a b and zero otherwise. We also assume some facts about curvature. The reader may compare with the exposition in . But note the dierence in conventions on the use of i in the Wilson loops and curvature denitions. The rst fact is the relation of Wilson loops and curvature for small loops Fact The result of evaluating a Wilson loop about a very small planar circle around a point x is proportional to the area enclosed by this circle times the corresponding value of the curvature tensor of the gauge eld evaluated at x. The curvature tensor is written F a rs xT a dx r dy s . It is the Louis H. Kauman local coordinate expression of dA AA. Application of Fact Consider a given Wilson loop KA . Ask how its value will change if it is deformed innitesimally in the neighborhood of a point x on the loop. Approximate the change according to Fact , and regard the point x as the place of curvature evaluation. Let KA denote the change in the value of the loop. KA is given by the formula KA dx r dx s F a rs xT a KA . This is the rstorder approximation to the change in the Wilson loop. In this formula it is understood that the Lie algebra matrices T a are to be inserted into the Wilson loop at the point x, and that we are summing over repeated indices. This means that each T a KA is a new Wilson loop obtained from the original loop KA by leaving the form of the loop unchanged, but inserting the matrix T a into the loop at the point x. See the gure below. KA T a KA Remark on insertion The Wilson loop is the limit, over partitions of the loop K, of products of the matrices Ax where x runs over the partition. Thus one can write symbolically, KA xK Ax xK A a k xT a dx k . It is understood that a product of matrices around a closed loop connotes the trace of the product. The ordering is forced by the dimensional nature of the loop. Insertion of a given matrix into this product at a point on the loop is then a welldened concept. If T is a given matrix then it is understood that T KA denotes the insertion of T into some point of the loop. In the case above, it is understood from the context of the formula ds r dx s F a rs xT a KA that the insertion is to be performed at the point x indicated in the argument of the curvature. Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity Remark The previous remark implies the following formula for the varia tion of the Wilson loop with respect to the gauge eld KA A a k x dx k T a KA . Varying the Wilson loop with respect to the gauge eld results in the insertion of an innitesimal Lie algebra element into the loop. Proof KA A a k x A a k x yK A a k yT a dy k yltx A a k yT a dy k T a dx k ygtx A a k yT a dy k dx k T a KA . . Fact The variation of the ChernSimons action S with respect to the gauge potential at a given point in space is related to the values of the curvature tensor at that point by the following formula where abc is the epsilon symbol for three indices F a rs x rst S A a t x . With these facts at hand we are prepared to determine how the Witten integral behaves under a small deformation of the loop K. Proposition Compare . All statements of equality in this proposi tion are up to order /k . . Let ZK ZK, S and let ZK denote the change of ZK under an innitesimal change in the loop K. Then ZK i/k dAexp ik/S rst dx r dy s dz t T a T a KA . The sum is taken over repeated indices, and the insertion is taken of the matrix products T a T a at the chosen point x on the loop K that is regarded as the center of the deformation. The volume element rst dx r dy s dz t is taken with regard to the innitesimal directions of the loop deformation from this point on the original loop. . The same formula applies, with a dierent interpretation, to the case where x is a double point of transversal selfintersection of a loop Louis H. Kauman K, and the deformation consists in shifting one of the crossing seg ments perpendicularly to the plane of intersection so that the self intersection point disappears. In this case, one T a is inserted into each of the transversal crossing segments so that T a T a KA denotes a Wilson loop with a selfintersection at x and insertions of T a at x and x , where and denote small displacements along the two arcs of K that intersect at x. In this case, the volume form is nonzero, with two directions coming from the plane of movement of one arc, and the perpendicular direction is the direction of the other arc. Proof ZK dAexp ik/S KA dAexp ik/S dx r dy s F a rs xT a KA Fact dAexp ik/S dx r dy s rst S A a t x T a KA Fact dAexp ik/S S A a t x rst dx r dy s T a KA i/k dA exp ik/S A a t x rst dx r dy s T a KA i/k dAexp ik/S rst dx r dy s T a KA A a t x integration by parts i/k dAexp ik/S rst dx r dy s dz t T a T a KA dierentiating the Wilson loop. This completes the formalism of the proof. In the case of part , the change of interpretation occurs at the point in the argument when the Wilson loop is dierentiated. Dierentiating a selfintersecting Wilson loop at a point of selfintersection is equivalent to dierentiating the corresponding product of matrices at a variable that occurs at two points in the product corresponding to the two places where the loop passes through the point. One of these derivatives gives rise to a term with volume form equal to zero, the other term is the one that is described in part . This completes the proof of the proposition. . Applying Proposition As the formula of Proposition shows, the in Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity tegral ZK is unchanged if the movement of the loop does not involve three independent space directions since rst dx r dy s dz t computes a vol ume. This means that ZK ZS , K is invariant under moves that slide the knot along a plane. In particular, this means that if the knot K is given in the nearly planar representation of a knot diagram, then ZK is invariant under regular isotopy of this diagram. That is, it is invari ant under the Reidemeister moves II and III. We expect more complicated behavior under move I since this deformation does involve three spatial directions. This will be discussed momentarily. We rst determine the dierence between ZK and ZK where K and K denote the knots that dier only by switching a single crossing. We take the given crossing in K to be the positive type, and the crossing in K to be of negative type. The strategy for computing this dierence is to use K as an intermediate, where K is the link with a transversal selfcrossing replacing the given crossing in K or K . Thus we must consider ZK ZK and ZK ZK . The second part of Proposition applies to each of these dierences and gives i/k dAexp ik/S rst dx r dy s dz t T a T a K A where, by the description in Proposition , this evaluation is taken along the loop K with the singularity and the T a T a insertion occurs along the two transversal arcs at the singular point. The sign of the volume element will be opposite for and consequently we have that . The volume element rst dx r dy s dz t must be given a conventional value in our calculations. There is no reason to assign it dierent absolute values for the cases of and since they are symmetric except for the sign. Therefore ZK ZK ZK ZK . Hence ZK / ZK ZK . Louis H. Kauman This result is central to our further calculations. It tells us that the eval uation of a singular Wilson loop can be replaced with the average of the results of resolving the singularity in the two possible ways. Now we are interested in the dierence ZK ZK ZK ZK i/k dAexp ik/S rst dx r dy s dz t T a T a K A . Volume convention It is useful to make a specic convention about the volume form. We take rst dx r dy s dz t for and for . Thus ZK ZK i/k dAexp ik/S T a T a K A . Integral notation Let ZT a T a K denote the integral ZT a T a K dAexp ik/S T a T a K A . Dierence formula Write the dierence formula in the abbreviated form ZK ZK i/kZT a T a K . This formula is the key to unwrapping many properties of the knot in variants. For diagrammatic work it is convenient to rewrite the dierence equation in the form shown below. The crossings denote small parts of otherwise identical larger diagrams, and the Casimir insertion T a T a K is indicated with crossed lines entering a disk labelled C. Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity The Casimir The element a T a T a of the universal enveloping algebra is called the Casimir. Its key property is that it is in the center of the algebra. Note that by our conventions Tr a T a T a a aa / d/ where d is the dimension of the Lie algebra. This implies that an unknotted loop with one singularity and a Casimir insertion will have Zvalue d/. In fact, for the classical semisimple Lie algebras one can choose a basis so that the Casimir is a diagonal matrix with identical values d/D on its diagonal. D is the dimension of the representation. We then have the general formula ZT a T a K loc d/DZK for any knot K. Here K loc denotes the singular knot obtained by placing a local selfcrossing loop in K as shown below Note that ZK loc ZK. Let the at loop shrink to nothing. The Wilson loop is still dened on a loop with an isolated cusp and it is equal to the Wilson loop obtained by smoothing that cusp. Louis H. Kauman Let K loc denote the result of adding a positive local curl to the knot K, and K loc the result of adding a negative local curl to K. Then by the above discussion and the dierence formula, we have ZK loc ZK loc i/kZT a T a K loc ZK i/kd/DZK. Thus, ZK loc i/kd/D ZK. Similarly, ZK loc i/kd/D ZK. These calculations show how the dierence equation, the Casimir, and properties of Wilson loops determine the framing factors for the knot in variants. In some cases we can use special properties of the Casimir to obtain skein relations for the knot invariant. For example, in the fundamental representation of the Lie algebra for SUN the Casimir obeys the following equation see , a T a ij T a kl il jk N ij kl . Hence ZT a T a K ZK N ZK where K denotes the result of smoothing a crossing as shown below Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity Using ZK ZK ZK and the dierence identity, we obtain ZK ZK i/k ZK / N ZK ZK . Hence i/NkZK i/NkZK i/kZK or e N ZK e N ZK ee ZK where ex expi/kx taken up to O/k . Here d N and D N, so the framing factor is i/k N N e N /N . Therefore, if PK wK ZK denotes the normalized invariant of ambient isotopy associated with ZK with wK the sum of the crossing signs of K, then e/NPK e/NPK ee PK . Hence eNPK eNPK ee PK . This last equation shows that PK is a specialization of the Homy poly nomial for arbitrary N, and that for N SU it is a specialization of the Jones polynomial. Graph invariants and Vassiliev invariants We now apply this integral formalism to the structure of rigid vertex graph invariants that arise naturally in the context of knot polynomials. If V K is a Laurentpolynomialvalued, or, more generally, commutativering valued invariant of knots, then it can be naturally extended to an invariant of rigid vertex graphs by dening the invariant of graphs in terms of the Louis H. Kauman knot invariant via an unfolding of the vertex as indicated below VK aV K bV K cV K . Here K indicates an embedding with a transversal valent vertex . We use the symbol to distinguish this choice of vertex designation from the previous one involving a selfcrossing Wilson loop. Formally, this means that we dene V G for an embedded valent graph G by taking the sum over a iS b iS c iS V S for all knots S obtained from G by replacing a node of G either with a crossing of positive or negative type, or with a smoothing denoted . It is not hard to see that if V K is an ambient isotopy invariant of knots, then this extension is a rigid vertex isotopy invariant of graphs. In rigid vertex isotopy the cyclic order at the vertex is preserved, so that the vertex behaves like a rigid disk with exible strings attached to it at specic points. There is a rich class of graph invariants that can be studied in this manner. The Vassiliev invariants , , constitute the important special case of these graph invariants where a , b , and c . Thus V G is a Vassiliev invariant if VK VK VK . V G is said to be the nite type k if V G whenever G gt k where G denotes the number of valent nodes in the graph G. If V is the nite type k, then V G is independent of the embedding type of the graph G when G has exactly k nodes. This follows at once from the denition of nite type. The values of V G on all the graphs of k nodes is called the top row of the invariant V . For purposes of enumeration it is convenient to use chord diagrams to enumerate and indicate the abstract graphs. A chord diagram consists of an oriented circle with an even number of points marked along it. These points are paired with the pairing indicated by arcs or chords connecting the paired points. See the gure below. Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity This gure illustrates the process of associating a chord diagram to a given embedded valent graph. Each transversal selfintersection in the embed ding is matched to a pair of points in the chord diagram. Vassiliev invariants from the functional integral In order to examine the Vassiliev invariants associated with the functional integral, we must rst normalize these invariants to invariants of ambient isotopy, and then consider the structure of the dierence between posi tive and negative crossings. The framed dierence formula provides the necessary information for obtaining the top row. We have shown that ZK loc ZK with ed/D. Hence PK wK ZK is an ambient isotopy invariant. The equation ZK ZK i/kZT a T a K implies that if wK w, then we have the ambient isotopy dierence formula PK PK w i/k ZT a T a K d/DZK . We leave the proof of this formula as an exercise for the reader. This formula tells us that for the Vassiliev invariant associated with P we have PK w i/k ZT a T a K d/DZK . Furthermore, if V j K denotes the coecient of i/k j in the expansion of PK in powers of /k, then the ambient dierence formula implies that /k j divides PG when G has j or more nodes. Hence V j G if G has more than j nodes. Therefore V j K is a Vassiliev invariant of nite type. This result was proved by Birman and Lin by dierent methods and by BarNatan by methods equivalent to ours. The fascinating thing is that the ambient dierence formula, appropri ately interpreted, actually tells us how to compute V k G when G has k Louis H. Kauman nodes. Under these circumstances each node undergoes a Casimir insertion, and because the Wilson loop is being evaluated abstractly, independent of the embedding, we insert nothing else into the loop. Thus we take the pair ing structure associated with the graph the socalled chord diagram and use it as a prescription for obtaining a trace of a sum of products of Lie al gebra elements with T a and T a inserted for each pair or a simple crossover for the pair multiplied by d/D. This yields the graphical evaluation implied by the recursion VG VT a T a G d/DV G . At each stage in the process one node of G disappears or it is replaced by these insertions. After k steps we have a fully inserted sum of abstract Wilson loops, each of which can be evaluated by taking the indicated trace. This result is equivalent to BarNatans result, but it is very interesting to see how it follows from a minimal approach to the Witten integral. In particular, it follows from BarNatan and Kontsevich that the condition of topological invariance is translated into the fact that the Lie bracket is represented as a commutator and that it is closed with respect to the Lie algebra. Diagrammatically we have Since T a T b T b T a c if abc T c we obtain Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity This relationship on chord diagrams is the seed of all the topology. In particular, it implies the basic term relation Proof . The presence of this relation on chord diagrams for V i G with G i is the basis for the existence of a corresponding Vassiliev invariant. There is not room here to go into more detail about this matter, and so we bring this discussion to a close. Nevertheless, it must be mentioned that this brings us to the core of the main question about Vassiliev invariants are there nontrivial Vassiliev invariants of knots and links that cannot be constructed through combinations of Lie algebraic invariants There are many other open questions in this arena, all circling this basic problem. Louis H. Kauman Quantum gravityloop states We now discuss the relationship of Wilson loops and quantum gravity that is forged in the theory of Ashtekar, Rovelli, and Smolin . In this theory the metric is expressed in terms of a spin connection A, and quantization involves considering wave functions A. Smolin and Rovelli analyze the loop transform K dAA KA where KA denotes the Wilson loop for the knot or singular embedding K. Dierential operators on the wave function can be referred, via integration by parts, to corresponding statements about the Wilson loop. It turns out that the condition that K be a knot invariant without framing dependence is equivalent to the socalled dieomorphism constraint for these wave functions. In this way, knots and weaves and their topological invariants become a language for representing a state of quantum gravity. The main point that we wish to make in the relationship of the Vassiliev invariants to these loop states is that the Vassiliev vertex satisfying is not simply a transverse intersection of Wilson loops. We have seen that it follows from the dierence formula that the Vassiliev vertex is much more complex than thisthat it involves the Casimir insertion at the transverse intersection up to the rst order of approximation, and that this structure can be used to compute the top row of the corresponding Vassiliev invariant. This situation suggests that one should amalgamate the formalism of the Vassiliev invariants with the structure of the Poisson algebras of loops and insertions used in the quantum gravity theory , . It also suggests Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity taking the formalism of these invariants in the functional integral form quite seriously even in the absence of an appropriate measure theory. One can begin to work backwards, taking the position that invari ants that do not ostensibly satisfy the dieomorphism constraint owing to change of value under framing change nevertheless still dene states of a quantum gravity theory that is a modication of the Ashtekar formula tion. This theory can be investigated by working the transform methods backwardsfrom knots and links to dierential operators and dierential geometry. All these remarks are the seeds for another paper. We close here, and ask the reader to stay tuned for further developments. Acknowledgements It gives the author pleasure to acknowledge the support of NSF Grant Number DMS and the Program for Mathematics and Molecular Biology of the University of California at Berkeley, Berkeley, CA. Bibliography . A. Ashtekar, C. Rovelli, and L. Smolin, Weaving a classical geometry with quantum threads. Preprint . . M. F. Atiyah, Geometry of YangMills Fields, Accademia Nazionale dei Lincei Scuola Superiore Lezioni Fermiare, Pisa . . M. F. Atiyah, The Geometry and Physics of Knots, Cambridge Uni versity Press . . J. Baez, Link invariants of nite type and perturbation theory, Lett. Math. Phys. . . D. BarNatan, On the Vassiliev knot invariants. Preprint . . J. Birman and X. S. Lin, Knot polynomials and Vassilievs invariants, Invent. Math. to appear. . B. Br ugmann, R. Gambini, and J. Pullin, Knot invariants as nonde generate quantum geometries, Phys. Rev. Lett. . . L. Crane, Conformal eld theory, spin geometry and quantum gravity, Phys. Lett. B . . L. Crane and D. Yetter, A categorical construction of D topological quantum eld theories. Preprint . . P. A. M. Dirac, Principles of Quantum Mechanics, Oxford University Press . . R. Feynman and A. R. Hibbs, Quantum Mechanics and Path Integrals, McGrawHill . . D. Freed and R. Gompf, Computer calculations of Wittens manifold invariants, Commun. Math. Phys. . Louis H. Kauman . S. Garoufalidis, Applications of TQFT to invariants in low dimensional topology. Preprint . . B. Hasslacher and M. J. Perry, Spin networks are simplicial quantum gravity, Phys. Lett. B . . L. C. Jerey, On Some Aspects of ChernSimons Gauge Theory. The sis, Oxford . . V. F. R. Jones, Index for subfactors, Invent. Math. . . V. F. R. Jones, A polynomial invariant for links via von Neumann algebras, Bull. Am. Math. Soc. . . V. F. R. Jones, A new knot polynomial and von Neumann algebras, Not. Am. Math. Soc. . . V. F. R. Jones, Hecke algebra representations of braid groups and link polynomials, Ann. Math. . . V. F. R. Jones, On knot invariants related to some statistical mechan ics models, Pacic J. Math. . . L. H. Kauman, State models and the Jones polynomial, Topology . . L. H. Kauman, On Knots, Annals of Mathematics Studies Number , Princeton University Press . . L. H. Kauman, Statistical mechanics and the Jones polynomial, AMS Contemp. Math. Ser. . . L. H. Kauman, Knots and Physics, World Scientic Pub. . . L. H. Kauman and S. Lins, Temperley Lieb Recoupling Theory and Invariants of Manifolds to appear as Annals monograph, Princeton University Press. . L. H. Kauman and P. Vogel, Link polynomials and a graphical cal culus, J. Knot Theor. Ramications, . . R. Kirby and P. Melvin, On the manifold invariants of Reshetikhin Turaev for sl, C, Invent. Math. . . M. Kontsevich, Graphs, homotopical algebra and low dimensional topology. Preprint . . W. B. R. Lickorish, manifolds and the Temperley Lieb algebra, Math. Ann. . . C. W. Misner, K. S. Thorne, and J. A. Wheeler, Gravitation, W. H. Freeman . . H. Ooguri, Discrete and continuum approaches to threedimensional quantum gravity. Preprint . . H. Ooguri, Topological lattice models in four dimensions, Mod. Phys. Lett. A . . J. Pullin, Knot theory and quantum gravity a primer. Preprint Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity . . N. Y. Reshetikhin and V. Turaev, Ribbon graphs and their invariants derived from quantum groups, Commun. Math. Phys. . . N. Y. Reshetikhin and V. Turaev, Invariants of three manifolds via link polynomials and quantum groups, Invent. Math. . . L. Rozansky, Large k asymptotics of Wittens invariant of Seifert man ifolds. Preprint . . L. Smolin, Quantum gravity in the selfdual representation, Contemp. Math. . . T. Stanford, Finitetype invariants of knots, links and graphs. Preprint . . V. G. Turaev, Quantum invariants of links and valent graphs in manifolds. Preprint . . V. G. Turaev, Quantum invariants of manifolds and a glimpse of shadow topology. Preprint . . V. G. Turaev, Topology of shadows. Preprint . . V. G. Turaev and O. Viro, State sum invariants of manifolds and quantum j symbols, Topology . . V. G. Turaev and H. Wenzl, Quantum invariants of manifolds asso ciated with classical simple Lie algebras. Preprint. . V. Vassiliev, Cohomology of knot spaces. In Theory of Singularities and its Applications V. I. Arnold, ed., Am. Math. Soc. , pp. . . K. Walker, On Wittens manifold invariants. Preprint . . R. Williams and F. Archer, The TuraevViro state sum model and dimensional quantum gravity. Preprint . . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Commun. Math. Phys. . . E. Witten, dimensional gravity as an exactly soluble system, Nucl. Phys. B , . Louis H. Kauman Geometric Structures and Loop Variables in dimensional Gravity Steven Carlip Department of Physics, University of California, Davis, California , USA email carlipdirac.ucdavis.edu Abstract In this chapter, I review the relationship between the metric formula tion of dimensional gravity and the loop observables of Rovelli and Smolin. I emphasize the possibility of reconstructing the classi cal geometry, via the theory of geometric structures, from the values of the loop variables. I close with a brief discussion of implications for quantization, particularly for covariant canonical approaches to quantum gravity. Introduction Ashtekars connection representation for general relativity , and the closely related loop variable approach have generated a good deal of excitement over the past few years. While it is too early to make rm predictions, there seems to be some real hope that these new variables will allow the construction of a consistent nonperturbative quantum theory of gravity. Some important progress has been made a number of observables have been found, large classes of quantum states have been identied, and the rst steps have been taken towards establishing a reasonable weakeld perturbation theory . Progress has been hampered, however, by the absence of a clear physi cal interpretation for the observables built out of Ashtekars new variables. In part, the problem is simply one of unfamiliarityphysicists accustomed to metrics and their associated connections can nd it dicult to make the transition to densitized triads and selfdual connections. But there is a deeper problem as well, inherent in almost any canonical formulation of general relativity. To dene Ashtekars variables, one must choose a time slicing, an arbitrary splitting of spacetime into spacelike hypersurfaces. But real geometry and physics cannot depend on such a choice the true physical observables must somehow forget any details of the time slicing, and refer only to the invariant underlying geometry. To a certain extent, this is already a source of trouble in classical general relativity, where one must take care to separate physical phenomena from artifacts of coordinate Steven Carlip choices. In canonical quantization, however, the problem becomes much sharperall observables must be dieomorphism invariants, and the need to reconstruct geometry and physics from such quantities becomes unavoid able. In a sense, the Ashtekar program is a victim of its own success. For the rst time, we can actually write down a large set of dieomorphism invariant operators, built out of the loop variables of Rovelli and Smolin in the loop representation of quantum gravity , . But although some progress has been made in dening area and volume operators in terms of these variables , the goal of reconstructing spacetime geometry from such invariant quantities remains out of reach. The purpose of this chapter is to demonstrate that such a reconstruc tion is possible in the simple model of dimensional gravity, general relativity in two spatial dimensions plus time. A reduction in the number of dimensions greatly simplies general relativity, allowing the use of powerful techniques not readily available in the realistic dimensional theory. As a consequence, many of the specic results presented here will not read ily generalize to higher dimensions. But the success of dimensional gravity can be viewed as an existence proof for canonical quantum grav ity, and one may hope that at least some of the technical results have extensions to our physical spacetime. From geometry to holonomies Let us begin with a brief review of dimensional general relativity in rstorder formalism. As our spacetime we take a manifold M, which we shall often assume to have a topology R, where is a closed orientable surface. The fundamental variables are a triad e a a section of the bundle of orthonormal framesand a connection on the same bundle, which can be specied by a connection form a b . The EinsteinHilbert action can be written as I grav M e a d a abc b c ,. where e a e a dx and a abc bc dx . The action is invariant under local SO, transformations, e a abc e b c . a d a abc b c , Indices , , , . . . are spacetime coordinate indices i, j, k, . . . are spatial coordinate indices and a, b, c, . . . are Lorentz indices, labelling vectors in an orthonormal basis. Lorentz indices are raised and lowered with the Minkowski metric ab . This notation is standard in papers in dimensional gravity, but diers from the usual conventions for Ashtekar variables, so readers should be careful in translation. Geometric Structures and Loop Variables as well as local translations, e a d a abc b c . a . I grav is also invariant under dieomorphisms of M, of course, but this is not an independent symmetry Witten has shown that when the triad e a is invertible, dieomorphisms in the connected component of the identity are equivalent to transformations of the form ... We therefore need only worry about equivalence classes of dieomorphisms that are not isotopic to the identity, that is elements of the mapping class group of M. The equations of motion coming from the action . are easily derived de a abc b e c . and d a abc b c .. These equations have four useful interpretations, which will form the basis for our analysis . We can solve . for as a function of e, and rewrite . as an equation for e. The result is equivalent to the ordinary vacuum Einstein eld equations, R g,. for the Lorentzian i.e. pseudoRiemannian metric g e a e b ab . In dimensions, these eld equations are much more powerful than they are in dimensions the full Riemann curvature tensor is linearly dependent on the Ricci tensor, R g R g R g R g R g g g g R, . so . actually implies that the metric g is at. The space of solutions of the eld equations can thus be identied with the set of at Lorentzian metrics on M. . As a second alternative, note that eqn . depends only on and not on e. In fact, . is simply the requirement that the curvature of vanish that is, that be a at SO, connection. Moreover, eqn . can be interpreted as the statement that e is a cotangent vector to the space of at SO, connections indeed, if s is a curve in the space of at connections, the derivative of . gives d d a ds abc b d c ds ,. Steven Carlip which can be identied with . with e a d a ds .. To determine the physically inequivalent solutions of the eld equa tions, we must still factor out the gauge transformations ... The local Lorentz transformations . act on as ordinary SO, gauge transformations, and tell us that only gauge equivalence classes of at SO, connections are relevant. Let us denote the space of such equivalence classes as . The transformations of e can once again be interpreted as statements about the cotangent space if we consider a curve s of SO, transformations, it is easy to check that the rst equations of . and . follow from dierentiating the second equation of ., with a d a ds . and e a as in .. A solution of the eld equations is thus determined by a point in the cotangent bundle T . Now, a at connection on the frame bundle of M is determined by its holonomies, that is by a homomorphism M SO, , . and gauge transformations act on by conjugation. We can therefore write Hom M, SO, / , if h h , h SO, . . It remains for us to factor out the dieomorphisms that are not in the component of the identity, the mapping class group. These transfor mations act on through their action as a group of automorphisms of M, and in many interesting casesfor example, when M has the topology Rthis action comprises the entire set of outer au tomorphisms of M . If we denote equivalence under this action by t , and let / t , we can express the space of solutions of the eld equations .. as T . When M has the topology R, this description can be further rened. In that case, the space or at least the physically relevant connected component of is homeomorphic to the Teichm uller Strictly speaking, one more subtlety remains. The space of homomorphisms . is not always connected, and it is often the case that only one connected component cor responds to physically admissible spacetimes. See , for the mathematical structure and , , , for physical implications. Geometric Structures and Loop Variables space of , and is the corresponding moduli space , . The set of vacuum spacetimes can thus be identied with the cotangent bundle of the moduli space of , and many powerful results from Riemann surface theory become applicable. . A third approach is available if M has the topology R. For such a topology, it is useful to split the eld equations into spatial and temporal components. Let us write d d dt , e a e a e a dt, . a a a dt. This decomposition can be made in a less explicitly coordinate dependent mannersee, for example, but the nal results are unchanged. The spatial projections of .. take the same form as the original equations, with all quantities replaced by their tilded spatial equivalents. As above, solutions may therefore be labelled by classes of homomorphisms, now from to SO, , and the cor responding cotangent vectors. The temporal components of the eld equations, on the other hand, now become e a de a abc b e c abc e b c . a d a abc b c . Comparing with .., we see that the time development of e, is entirely described by a gauge transformation, with a a and a e a . This is consistent with our previous results, of course. For a topol ogy of the form R, the fundamental group is simply that of , and an invariant description in terms of holonomies should not be able to detect a particular choice of spacelike slice. Equation . shows in detail how this occurs motion in coordinate time is merely a gauge transformation, and is therefore invisible to the holonomies. But the central dilemma described in the introduction now stands out sharply. For despite eqn ., solutions of the dimensional eld equations are certainly not static as geometriesthey do not, in general, admit timelike Killing vectors. The real physical dynamics has somehow been hidden by this analysis, and must be uncovered if we are to nd a sensible physical interpretation of our solutions. This puzzle is an example of the notorious problem of time in gravity , and exemplies one of the basic issues that must be resolved in order to construct a sensible quantum theory. . A nal approach to the eld equations .. was suggested by Witten , who observed that the triad e and the connection could Steven Carlip be combined to form a single connection on an ISO, bundle. ISO, , the dimensional Poincare group, has a Lie algebra with generators a and T b and commutation relations a , b abc c , a ,T b abc T c , T a ,T b . . If we write a single connection form Ae a T a a a . and dene a trace, an invariant inner product on the Lie algebra, by Tr a T b ab , Tr a b Tr T a T b ,. then it is easy to verify that the action . is simply the Chern Simons action for A, I CS M Tr A dA AAA .. The eld equations now reduce to the requirement that A be a at ISO, connection, and the gauge transformations .. can be identied with standard ISO, gauge transformations. Imitat ing the arguments of our second interpretation, we should therefore expect solutions of the eld equations to be characterized by gauge equivalence classes of at ISO, connections, that is by homo morphisms in the space / Hom M, ISO, / , if h h , h ISO, . . To relate this description to our previous results, observe that ISO, is itself a cotangent bundle with base space SO, . In deed, a cotangent vector at the point SO, can be written in the form d , and the multiplication law ,d ,d ,d ,d d . may be recognized as the standard semidirect product composition law for Poincare transformations. The space of homomorphisms from M to ISO, inherits this cotangent bundle structure in an obvious way, leading to the identication /T , where is the space of homomorphisms .. It remains for us to factor out the mapping class group. But this group acts in . and . as the same group of automorphisms of M writing the quotient as // t /, we thus see that / T . Geometric Structures and Loop Variables Of these four approaches to the dimensional eld equations, only the rst corresponds directly to our usual picture of spacetime physics. Trajectories of physical particles, for instance, are geodesics in the at manifolds of this description. The second approach, on the other hand, is the one that is closest to the loop variable picture in dimensional gravity. The loop variables of Rovelli and Smolin , , , may be expressed as follows. Let U, x P exp a a . be the holonomy of the connection form a around a closed path t based at x. Here, P denotes path ordering, and the basepoint x species the point at which the path ordering begins. We then dene T Tr U, x . and T dt Tr U, xt e a t dx dt t a .. T is thus the trace of the SO, holonomy around , while T is essentially a cotangent vector to T indeed, given a curve s in the space of at SO, connections, we can dierentiate . to obtain d ds T Tr U, xt d a ds t a ,. and we have already seen that the derivative d a /ds can be identied with the triad e a . In dimensions, the variables T and T depend on particular loops , and considerable work is still needed to construct dieomorphism invariant observables that depend only on knot classes. In dimensions, on the other hand, the loop variables are already invariant, at least under dieomorphisms isotopic to the identity. The key dierence is that in dimensions the connection is at, so the holonomy U, x depends only on the homotopy class of . Some care must be taken in handling the mapping class group, which acts nontrivially on T and T this issue has been investigated in a slightly dierent context by Nelson and Regge . Of course, T and T are not quite the equivalence classes of holonomies of our interpretation number above T is not a holonomy, but only the trace of a holonomy. But knowledge of T for a large enough set of homotopically inequivalent curves may be used to reconstruct a point in the space of eqn ., and indeed, the loop variables can serve as local coordinates on ,,. Steven Carlip Geometric structures from holonomies to geometry The central problem described in the introduction can now be made ex plicit. Spacetimes in dimensions can be characterized a la Ashtekar et al. as points in the cotangent bundle T , our description number of the last section. Such a description is fully dieomorphism invariant, and provides a natural starting point for quantization. But our intuitive geometric picture of a dimensional spacetime is that of a manifold M with a at metricdescription number and only in this representation do we know how to connect the mathematics with ordinary physics. Our goal is therefore to provide a translation between these two descriptions. To proceed, let us investigate the space of at spacetimes in a bit more detail. If M is topologically trivial, the vanishing of the curvature tensor implies that M, g is simply ordinary Minkowski space V , , , or at least some subset of V , , that can be extended to the whole of Minkowski space. If the spacetime topology is nontrivial, M can still be covered by contractible coordinate patches U i that are each isometric to V , , with the standard Minkowski metric on each patch. The geometry is then encoded in the transition functions ij on the intersections U i U j , which determine how these patches are glued together. Moreover, since the met rics in U i and U j are identical, these transition functions must be isometries of , that is elements of the Poincare group ISO, . Such a construction is an example of what Thurston calls a geomet ric structure , , , , in this case a Lorentzian or ISO, ,V , structure. In general, a G, X manifold is one that is locally modelled on X, just as an ordinary ndimensional manifold is modelled on R n . More precisely, let G be a Lie group that acts analytically on some nmanifold X, the model space, and let M be another nmanifold. A G, X structure on M is then a set of coordinate patches U i covering M with coordinates i U i X taking their values in the model space and with transition functions ij i j U i U j in G. While this general formulation may not be widely known, specic examples are familiar for example, the uni formization theorem for Riemann surfaces implies that any surface of genus g gt admits an PSL,R, H structure. A fundamental ingredient in the description of a G, X structure is its holonomy group, which can be viewed as a measure of the failure of a single coordinate patch to extend around a closed curve. Let M be a G, X manifold containing a closed path . We can cover with coordinate charts i U i X, i , . . . , n . with constant transition functions g i G between U i and U i , i.e. i U i U i g i i U i U i . Geometric Structures and Loop Variables n U n U g n U n U . Let us now try analytic continuation of the coordinate from the patch U to the whole of . We can begin with a coordinate transformation in U that replaces by t g , thus extending to U U . Continuing this process along the curve, with t j g ...g j j , we will eventually reach the nal patch U n , which again overlaps U . If the new coordinate function t n g ...g n n happens to agree with on U n U , we will have succeeded in covering with a single patch. Otherwise, the holonomy H, dened as H g ...g n , measures the obstruction to such a covering. It may be shown that the holonomy of a curve depends only on its homotopy class . In fact, the holonomy denes a homomorphism H M G. . Note that if we pass from M to its universal covering space M, we will no longer have noncontractible closed paths, and will be extendable to all of M. The resulting map D M X is called the developing map of the G, X structure. At least in simple examples, D embodies the classical geometric picture of development as unrollingfor instance, the unwrapping of a cylinder into an innite strip. The homomorphism H is not quite uniquely determined by the geo metric structure, since we are free to act on the model space X by a xed element h G, thus changing the transition functions g i without altering the G, X structure of M. It is easy to see that such a transformation has the eect of conjugating H by h, and it is not hard to prove that H is in fact unique up to such conjugation . For the case of a Lorentzian structure, where G ISO, , we are thus led to a space of holonomies of precisely the form .. This identication is not a coincidence. Given a G, X structure on a manifold M, it is straightforward to dene a corresponding at G bundle . To do so, we simply form the product G U i in each patchgiving the local structure of a G bundleand use the transition functions ij of the geometric structure to glue together the bers on the overlaps. It is then easy to verify that the at connection on the resulting bundle has a holonomy group isomorphic to the holonomy group of the geometric struc ture. We can now try to reverse this process, and use one of the holonomy groups of eqn .approach number to the eld equationsto dene a Lorentzian structure on M, reproducing approach number . In gen eral, this step may fail the holonomy group of a G, X structure is not necessarily sucient to determine the full geometry. For spacetimes, it is easy to see what can go wrong. If we start with a at manifold M and simply cut out a ball, we can obtain a new at manifold without aecting Steven Carlip the holonomy of the geometric structure. This is a rather trivial change, however, and we would like to show that nothing worse can go wrong. Mess has investigated this question for the case of spacetimes with topologies of the form R. He shows that the holonomy group determines a unique maximal spacetime Mspecically, a spacetime constructed as a domain of dependence of a spacelike surface . Mess also demonstrates that the holonomy group H acts properly discontinuously on a region WV , of Minkowski space, and that M can be obtained as the quotient space W/H. This quotient construction can be a powerful tool for obtaining a description of M in reasonably standard coordinates, for instance in a time slicing by surfaces of constant mean curvature. For topologies more complicated than R, I know of very few gen eral results. But again, a theorem of Mess is relevant if M is a compact manifold with a at, nondegenerate, timeorientable Lorentzian metric and a strictly spacelike boundary, then M necessarily has the topology R, where is a closed surface homeomorphic to one of the bound ary components of M. This means that for spatially closed dimensional universes, topology change is classically forbidden, and the full topology is uniquely xed by that of an initial spacelike slice. Hence, although more exotic topologies may occur in some approaches to quantum gravity, it is not physically unreasonable to restrict our attention to spacetimes R. To summarize, we now have a procedurevalid at least for spacetimes of the form Rfor obtaining a at geometry from the invariant data given by AshtekarRovelliSmolin loop variables. First, we use the loop variables to determine a point in the cotangent bundle T , establishing a connection to our second approach to the eld equations. Next, we associate that point with an ISO, holonomy group H/, as in our approach number . Finally, we identify the group H with the holonomy group of a Lorentzian structure on M, thus determining a at spacetime of approach number . In particular, if we can solve the dicult technical problem of nding an appropriate fundamental region W V , for the action of H, we can write M as a quotient space W/H. This procedure has been investigated in detail for the case of a torus universe, RT , in and . For a universe containing point particles, it is implicit in the early descriptions of Deser et al. , and is explored in some detail in . For the dimensional black hole, the geometric structure can be read o from and . And although it is never stated explicitly, the recent work of t Hooft and Waelbroeck is really a description of at spacetimes in terms of Lorentzian structures. For the black hole, a cosmological constant must be added to the eld equations. Instead of being at, the resulting spacetime has constant negative curvature, and the geometric structure becomes an SO, , H , structure. A related result for the torus will appear in . Geometric Structures and Loop Variables Quantization and geometrical observables Our discussion so far has been strictly classical. I would like to conclude by briey describing some of the issues that arise if we attempt to quantize dimensional gravity. The canonical quantization of a classical system is by no means uniquely dened, but most approaches have some basic features in common. A classi cal system is characterized by its phase space, a Ndimensional symplectic manifold , with local coordinates consisting of N position variables and N conjugate momenta. Classical observables are functions of the positions and momenta, that is maps f, g, . . . from to R. The symplectic form on determines a set of Poisson brackets f, g among observables, and hence induces a Lie algebra structure on the space of observables. To quantize such a system, we are instructed to replace the classical observables with operators and the Poisson brackets with commutators that is, we are to look for an irreducible representation of this Lie algebra as an algebra of operators acting on some Hilbert space. As stated, this program cannot be carried out Van Hove showed in that in general, no such irreducible representation of the full Poisson algebra of classical observables exists . In practice, we must therefore choose a subalgebra of preferred observables to quantize, one that must be small enough to permit a consistent representation and yet big enough to generate a large class of classical observables . Ordinarily, the resulting quantum theory will depend on this choice of preferred observables, and we will have to look hard for physical and mathematical justications for our selection. In simple classical systems, there is often an obvious set of preferred observablesthe positions and momenta of point particles, for instance, or the elds and their canonical momenta in a free eld theory. For gravity, on the other hand, such a natural choice seems dicult to nd. In dimensions, where a number of approaches to quantization can be carried out explicitly, it is known that dierent choices of variables lead to genuinely dierent quantum theories , , . In particular, each of the four interpretations of the eld equations discussed above suggests its own set of fundamental observables. In the rst interpretationsolutions as at spacetimesthe natural candidates are the metric and its canonical momentum on some spacelike surface. But these quantities are not dieomorphism invariant, and it seems that the best we can do is to dene a quantum theory in some particular, xed time slicing , , . This is a rather undesirable situation, however, since the choice of such a slicing is arbitrary, and there is no reason to expect the quantum theories coming from dierent slicings to be equivalent. In our second interpretationsolutions as classes of at connections and their cotangentsthe natural observables are points in the bundle T . Steven Carlip These are dieomorphism invariant, and quantization is relatively straight forward in particular, the appropriate symplectic structure for quantiza tion is just the natural symplectic structure of T as a cotangent bundle. The procedure for quantizing such a cotangent bundle is well established , and there seem to be no fundamental diculties in constructing the quantum theory. But now, just as in the classical theory, the physical interpretation of the quantum observables is obscure. It is therefore natural to ask whether we can extend the classical rela tionships between these approaches to the quantum theories. At least for simple topologies, the answer is positive. The basic strategy is as follows. We begin by choosing a set of physically interesting classical observables of at spacetimes. For example, it is often possible to foliate uniquely a spacetime by spacelike hypersurfaces of constant mean extrinsic curvature TrK the intrinsic and extrinsic geometries of such slices are useful ob servables with clear physical interpretations. Let us denote these variables generically as QT, where the parameter T labels the time slice on which the Q are dened for instance, T TrK. Classically, such observables can be determinedat least in principle as functions of the geometric structure, and thus of the ISO, holonomies , Q Q, T. . We now adopt these holonomies as our preferred observables for quantiza tion, obtaining a Hilbert space L and a set of operators . Finally, we translate . into an operator equation, Q Q , T, . thus obtaining a set of dieomorphisminvariant but timedependent quan tum observables to represent the variables Q. Some ambiguity will remain, since the operator ordering in . is rarely unique, but in the examples studied so far, the requirement of mapping class group invariance seems to place major restrictions on the possible orderings . This program has been investigated in some detail for the simplest non trivial topology, M RT , . There, a natural set of geometric variables are the modulus of a toroidal slice of constant mean curvature TrK T and its conjugate momentum p . These can be expressed ex plicitly in terms of a set of loop variables that characterize the ISO, holonomies of the spacetime. Following the program outlined above, one obtains a parameter family of dieomorphisminvariant operators T and p T that describe the physical evolution of a spacelike slice. The Tdependence of these operators can be described by a set of Heisenberg Geometric Structures and Loop Variables equations of motion, d dT i H, , dp dT i H, p ,. with a Hamiltonian H,p , T that can again be calculated explicitly. Let me stress that despite the familiar appearance of ., the pa rameter T is not a time coordinate in the ordinary sense the operators T and p T are fully dieomorphism invariant. We thus have a kind of time dependence without time dependence, an expression of dynamics in terms of operators that are individually constants of motion. For more complicated topologies, such an explicit construction seems quite dicult, although Unruh and Newbury have taken some interesting steps in that direction . Ideally, one would like to nd some kind of perturbation theory for geometrical variables like Q, but little progress has yet been made in this direction. The specic constructions I have described here are unique to di mensions, of course. But I believe that some of the basic features are likely to extend to realistic dimensional gravity. The quantization of holonomies is a form of covariant canonical quantization , , or quantization of the space of classical solutions. We do not yet understand the classical solutions of the dimensional eld equations well enough to duplicate such a strategy, but a similar approach may be useful in mini superspace models. The invariant but Tdependent operators T and p T are examples of Rovellis evolving constants of motion , whose use has also been suggested in dimensional gravity. Finally, our sim ple model has strikingly conrmed the power of the RovelliSmolin loop variables. A full extension to dimensions undoubtedly remains a dis tant goal, but for the rst time in years, there seems to be some real cause for optimism. Acknowledgements This work was supported in part by US Department of Energy grant DE FGER. Bibliography . A. Ashtekar, Phys. Rev. D . . A. Ashtekar, Lectures on Nonperturbative Quantum Gravity World Scientic, Singapore, . . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Nucl. Phys. B . . For a recent review, see L. Smolin, in General Relativity and Gravi tation , ed. R. J. Gleiser, C. N. Kozameh, and O. M. Moreschi IOP Publishing, Bristol, . . A. Ashtekar, C. Rovelli, and L. Smolin, Phys. Rev. Lett. Steven Carlip . . E. Witten, Nucl. Phys. B . . W. J. Harvey, in Discrete Groups and Automorphic Functions, ed. W. J. Harvey Academic Press, New York, . . W. M. Goldman, Invent. Math. . . G. Mess, Lorentz Spacetimes of Constant Curvature, Institut des Hautes Etudes Scientiques preprint IHES/M// . . S. Carlip, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . . J. Luoko and D. M. Marolf, Solution Space to Gravity on RT in Wittens Connection Formulation, Syracuse preprint SUGP/ . . W. M. Goldman, Adv. Math. . . L. Smolin, in Knots, Topology, and Quantum Field Theory, ed. L. Lu sanna World Scientic, Singapore, . . For an extensive review, see K. Kuchar, in Proc. of the th Canadian Conf. on General Relativity and Relativistic Astrophysics, ed. G. Kun statter et al. World Scientic, Singapore, . . E. Witten, Commun. Math. Phys. . . A. Ashtekar, V. Husein, C. Rovelli, J. Samuel, and L. Smolin, Classical amp Quantum Gravity L. . See also T. Jacobson and L. Smolin, Nucl. Phys. B . . J. E. Nelson and T. Regge, Commun. Math. Phys. Phys. Lett. B . . M. Seppala and T. Sorvali, Ann. Acad. Sci. Fenn. Ser. A. I. Math. . . T. Okai, Hiroshima Math. J. . . J. E. Nelson and T. Regge, Commun. Math. Phys. . . W.P. Thurston, The Geometry and Topology of ThreeManifolds, Princeton lecture notes . . R. D. Canary, D. B. A. Epstein, and P. Green, in Analytical and Geometric Aspects of Hyperbolic Space, London Math. Soc. Lecture Notes Series , ed. D. B. Epstein Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, . . W. M. Goldman, in Geometry of Group Representations, ed. W. M. Goldman and A. R. Magid American Mathematical Society, Provi dence, . . For examples of geometric structures, see D. Sullivan and W. Thurston, Enseign. Math. . . S. Carlip, Phys. Rev. D . . S. Deser, R. Jackiw, and G. t Hooft, Ann. Phys. . Geometric Structures and Loop Variables . M. Ba nados et al., Phys. Rev. D . . D. Cangemi, M. Leblanc, and R. B. Mann, Gauge Formulation of the Spinning Black Hole in Dimensional Antide Sitter Space, MIT preprint MITCTP . . S. Carlip and J. E. Nelson, Equivalent Quantisations of Dimensional Gravity, Turin preprint DFTT / and Davis preprint UCD. . G. t Hooft, Classical amp Quantum Gravity Classical amp Quantum Gravity . . H. Waelbroeck, Classical amp Quantum Gravity Phys. Rev. Lett. Nucl. Phys. B . . L. Van Hove, Mem. de lAcad. Roy. de Belgique Classe de Sci. . . For a useful summary, see C. J. Isham, in Relativity, Groups, and Topology II, ed. B. S. DeWitt and R. Stora NorthHolland, Amster dam, . . S. Carlip, Phys. Rev. D Phys. Rev. D . . S. Carlip, Six Ways to Quantize Dimensional Gravity, Davis preprint UCD, to appear in Proc. of the Fifth Canadian Con ference on General Relativity and Relativistic Astrophysics. . D. M. Marolf, Loop Representations for Gravity on a Torus, Syracuse preprint SUGP/ . . V. Moncrief, J. Math. Phys. . . A. Hosoya and K. Nakao, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . . W. G. Unruh and P. Newbury, Solution to Gravity in the Dreibein Formalism, University of British Columbia preprint . . A. Ashtekar and A. Magnon, Proc. R. Soc. London A . . C. Crnkovic and E. Witten, in Three Hundred Years of Gravity, ed. S. W. Hawking and W. Israel Cambridge University Press, Cam bridge, . . C. Rovelli, Phys. Rev. D Phys. Rev. D . Steven Carlip From ChernSimons to WZW via Path Integrals Dana S. Fine Department of Mathematics, University of Massachusetts, Dartmouth, Massachusetts , USA email dnecis.umassd.edu Abstract Direct analysis of the ChernSimons path integral reduces quantum expectations of unknotted Wilson lines in ChernSimons theory on S with group G to npoint functions in the WZW model of maps fromS to G. The reduction hinges on the characterization of A/G n , the space of connections modulo those gauge transformations which are the identity at a point n, as itself a principal ber bundle with anelinear ber. Introduction In this chapter, I will describe how to reduce the path integral for Chern Simons theory on S to the path integral for the WessZuminoWitten WZW model for maps from S to G, where G is the symmetry group of the ChernSimons theory. The points I would like to emphasize are, rst, that the ChernSimons path integral on S is tractable, and, second, that it provides an unusually direct link between the ChernSimons theory and the WZW model. The details I omit appear in . That the two theories are related has been known at least since Witten rst described the geometric quantization of the ChernSimons theory in the axial gauge on manifolds of the form R , where is a Riemann surface . Although this is frequently described as a path integral ap proach, it does not use a direct evaluation of the path integral rather, the formal properties of the path integral provide axioms crucial to extending the theory from R to compact manifolds. In this approach, the WZW model appears in a highly rened form, as the source of a certain modular functor. That is, one must already know how to solve the WZW model or at least know that its solution denes this modular functor to recognize its appearance in the ChernSimons theory. Treatments of the path integral for ChernSimons in the axial gauge on R tend to make contact with the WZW model at earlier stages. Moore and Seiberg proceed with the evaluation of the path integral far enough Dana S. Fine to obtain a path integral over the phase space LG/G. This links the two theories as theories of the representations of LG/G. Fr ohlich and King obtain the KnizhnikZamolodchikov equation of the WZW model from the same gaugexed ChernSimons path integral. The approach I will describe is novel in that it treats the path integral on S directly, it does not require a choice of gauge, and one need only know the action of the WZW model, not its solution nor even its current algebra, to recognize its appearance in the ChernSimons theory. The key ingredient is a technique for integrating directly on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations which I developed to evaluate path integrals for YangMills on Riemann surfaces . The main result The ChernSimons path integral to evaluate is f CS Z ,/ n fAe iSA TA, where A is a connection on the principal bundle P S G, and SA is the ChernSimons action k S Tr A dA AAA . Here / is the space of smooth connections on P, n is the space of gauge transformations which are the identity at the north pole n of S ,/ // n is the standard map to the quotient, TA means the standard measure on /, and TA is the pushforward to // n . Note that even the formal denition of TA requires a metric. Take this to be the standard metric on S . The WZW path integral for G based maps from S to G is f WZW Z G fXe iSX TX, where the WZW action is SX k S TrX X M Tr X d X X d X X d X . Here M is any manifold with M S , and X is any extension of X from S to M. The main result is f CS Z fXe i k S TrX Xi k M Tr X dX TX, where X G, and f explicitly determines f. In particular, if f is a Wilson line, then f is the trace of a product of evaluationatapoint From ChernSimons to WZW Fig. . The path e maps. That is, the ChernSimons path integral directly reduces to the path integral for a WZW model of based maps from S to G. The technique is as follows . Characterize // n as a bundle over G with anelinear bers. . Integrate along the ber over each point X G. . Recognize the resulting measure on G as a WZW path integral. // n as a bundle over G For each connection A, and each point e S , dene A e by holonomy about paths e of the form pictured in Fig. . That is, e follows a longitude from the north pole n to the south pole s through a xed point e of the equator and then returns along the longitude through the variable point e. Relative to a basepoint in the ber over n, A e lies in G. As e varies throughout the equator identied with S , A e denes, for each A, a map from S to G. Since A e , it is a based map, so A G. Moreover, since a gauge transformation aects holonomy about e by conjugation by the value of the gauge transformation at n, A A for n . Thus the assignment A A denes a mapping // n G which will serve as our projection. Turn now to the ber of . Clearly, A A if vanishes along the longitudes of Fig. . If P S ,g S , g denotes projection to the longitudinal part, the space of such is ker P . In fact, the ber over Dana S. Fine A is the set of orbits A ker P .. Thus the ber is the ane version of the linear space ker P , and the connection A in the above presentation represents a choice of origin in the ber. The image of is all of G. To see this, use a homotopy from X to the identity to determine lifts to P of the family of paths e in S which dened . Such a homotopy exists, because G for any Lie group G. This determines P A such that A X. This is a slight renement of and , which describe a homotopy equivalence between // n for bundles over S and G. The reason to redo this is to describe the topologically trivial ber in an explicit manner. According to eqn ., the integral over the ber looks like I ber X det / D A P D A fA e iSA T. The determinant factor relates TA on the ber to the metriccompatible measure T. The action along the ber is, after an integration by parts, SA SA k M Tr D A F A M TrA , where, for reasons which will soon be clear, the boundary contribution is retained. To integrate over the ber, choose a specic origin A to remove the linear term. One such choice is determined by A X d X, where XS G is parallel transport by A along the longitudinal paths e used in dening . Note that X is not well dened at n. In fact X X, where is the restriction to a small sphere approaching n. Thus A is not continuous at n nor is any other such choice, so to keep A smooth requires A X dX. With this choice, the boundary term vanishes, and S AS A k S Tr D A . The integral over the ber becomes I ber X det / D A P D A e iS A ker P f Ae i k TrDA T, From ChernSimons to WZW where ker P denotes elements of ker P with the prescribed discontinuity at n. Now assume f is independent of and consider e i k TrDA T. But for the discontinuity at n, this would be standard. The result would be a determinant times the exponential of the etainvariant as in and . Repeating these arguments, which refer to a nitedimensional analog, with a minor variation to account for the discontinuity, will evaluate I ber . The metric on S , g restricts to ker P to dene a decomposition of its complexication ker P C , in terms of which Tr D A S Tr D A S Tr S Tr D A S TrX X. Model this by a vector space V V V with a linear mapping T V V . Add a small quadratic term, and integrate to nd e iTv,v Tv Tv det / T T . The determinant analogous to the righthand side is that of P D A D A P acting on elements of ker P which vanish at n. Now, regularize and account for negative eigenvalues using the etainvariant that is, take det P D A D A P e i , where is the etainvariant, as the analogue for det / T T . Then I ber X det D A P D A det P D A D A P e i e iS A e i k TrX X . Performing the integration over the bers in the path integral for f, assuming f constant along the bers, thus gives f Z f Ae iS A e i k TrX X det D A P D A det P D A D A P e i base , where base is the measure on G induced by the metric on // n . To interpret this in terms of G requires four observations .S A k S Tr X d X . . base constant TX. . Each determinant is constant along the base in // n . . f can be expressed as a function f of X. Dana S. Fine Fig. . The path whose holonomy is Xe Xe Absorbing everything independent of X into Z , then, f CS Z fXe i k S TrX Xi k S Tr X dX TX, as claimed. An explicit reduction from ChernSimons to WZW Let R be a representation of G, and let J denote the Wilson line corre sponding to the longitudinal path indicated in Fig. . Then J R CS Z Tr R Xe Xe e i k TrX Xi k S Tr X dX TX Tr R Xe Xe WZW . As a description of the relation between ChernSimons theory on S and the WZW for G, this work is nearly complete. However, as an eval uation of the ChernSimons path integral it lacks an essential component namely, an evaluation of the WZW path integral appearing on the right hand side of the above equation. For expectations of evaluationatapoint maps, the WZW path integral is tractable, at least formally, but this is work in progress. The basic idea is to reinterpret X G as an element of PathG with some constraints on its endpoint values. Then, the WZW From ChernSimons to WZW path integral becomes a path integral for quantum mechanics on G. At a formal level, expectations of evaluationatapoint maps are given by the FeynmanKac formula. Formal calculations lead to some promising pre liminary observations such as complicated unknot unknot. However, to come up with an explicit evaluation of even unknot requires going be yond formal properties to a more detailed understanding of the heat kernel on G. Acknowledgements This material is based upon work supported in part by the National Science Foundation under Grant DMS. Bibliography . M. F. Atiyah and J. D. S. Jones, Topological aspects of YangMills theory, Commun. Math. Phys. . D. Fine, YangMills on the twosphere, Commun. Math. Phys. . D. Fine, YangMills on a Riemann surface, Commun. Math. Phys. , . D. Fine, ChernSimons on S via path integrals, preprint . J. Fr ohlich and C. King, The ChernSimons theory and knot poly nomials, Commun. Math. Phys. . G. Moore and N. Seiberg, Taming the conformal zoo, Phys. Lett. B . I. M. Singer, Some remarks on the Gribov ambiguity, Commun. Math. Phys. . I. M. Singer, Families of Dirac operators with applications to physics, Societe Mathematique de France Asterisque, hor serie, . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Com mun. Math. Phys. Dana S. Fine Topological Field Theory as the Key to Quantum Gravity Louis Crane Mathematics Department, Kansas State University, Manhattan, Kansas , USA email cranemath.ksu.edu Abstract Motivated by the similarity between CSW theory and the Chern Simons state for general relativity in the Ashtekar variables, we ex plore what a universe would look like if it were in a state correspond ing to a d TQFT. We end up with a construction of propagating states for parts of the universe and a Hilbert space corresponding to a certain approximation. The construction avoids path integrals, using instead recombination diagrams in a very special tensor category. Introduction What I wish to propose is that the quantum theory of gravity can be constructed from a topological eld theory. Notice, I do not say that it is a topological eld theory. Physicists will be quick to point out that there are local excitations in gravity, so it cannot be topological. Nevertheless, the connections between general relativity in the loop formulation and the CSW TQFT are very suggestive. Formally, at least, the CSW action term e ik TrAdA AAA . gives a state for the Ashtekar variable version of quantized general relativ ity, as mentioned previously in this volume. That is, we can think of this measure on the space of connections on a manifold either as dening a theory in dimensions, or as a state in a d theory, which is GR with a cosmological constant. Furthermore, states for the Ashtekar or loop variable form of GR are very scarce, unless one is prepared to consider states of zero volume. Fi nally, one should note that a number of very talented workers in the eld have searched in vain for a Hilbert space of states in either representation. If one attempts to use the loop variables to quantize subsystems of the universe, one ends up looking at functionals on the set of links in a manifold with boundary with ends on the boundary. It turns out in regularizing that the links need to be framed, and one can trace them in Louis Crane any representation of SU, so they need to be labelled. The coincidence of all this with the picture of d TQFT was the initial motivation for this work. Another point, which seems important, is that although path integrals in general do not exist, the CSW path integral can be thought of as a symbolic shorthand for a d TQFT which can be rigorously dened by combining combinatorial topology with some very new algebraic structures, called modular tensor categories. Thus, if we want to explore . as a state for GR, we have the possibility of switching from the language of path integrals to a nite, discrete picture, where physics is described by variables on the edges of a triangulation. Physics on a lattice is nothing new. What is new here is that the choice of lattice is unimportant, because the coecients attached to simplices are algebraically special. Thus we do not have to worry about a continuum limit, since a nite result is exact. Motivated by these considerations, I propose to consider the hypothesis Conjecture The universe is in the CSW state. This idea is similar to the suggestion of Witten that the CSW theory is the topological phase of quantum gravity . My suggestion diers from his in assuming that the universe is still in the topological phase, and that the concrete geometry we see is not the result of a uctuation of the state of the universe as a whole, but rather due to the collapse of the wave packet in the presence of classical observers. As I shall explain below, the machinery of CSW theory provides spaces of states for parts of the universe, which I interpret as the relative states an observer might see. This suggestion is closely related to the manyworlds interpretation of quantum mechanics the states on surfaces are data in one particular world. The state of the universe is the sum of all possible worlds, which takes the elegant form of the CSW invariant of links, or more concretely, of the Jones polynomial or one of its generalizations. During the talk I gave at the conference one questioner pointed out, quite correctly, that it is not necessary to make this conjecture, since other states exist. Let me emphasize that it is only a hypothesis. I think it is fair to say that it leads to more beautiful mathematics than any other I know of. Whether that is a good guide for physics, only time will tell. Topological quantum eld theory in dimensions , , and is leading into an extraordinarily rich mathematical eld. In the spirit of the drunk ard who looks for his keys near a street light, I have been thinking for several years about an attempt to unite the structures of TQFT with a suitable reinterpretation of quantum mechanics for the entire universe. I believe that the two subjects resemble one another strongly enough that the program I am outlining becomes natural. Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Quantum mechanics of the universe. Categorical physics I want to propose that a quantum eld theory is the wrong structure to describe the entire universe. Quantum eld theory, like quantum mechanics generally, presupposes an external classical observer. There can be no probability interpretation for the whole universe. In fact, the state of the universe cannot change, because there is no time, except in the presence of an external clock. Since the universe as a whole is in a xed state, the quantum theory of the gravitational eld as a whole is not a physical theory. It describes all possible universes, while the task of a physical theory is to explain measurements made in this universe in this state. Thus, what is needed is a theory which describes a universe in a particular state. This is similar to what some researchers, such as Penrose, have suggested that the initial conditions of the universe are determined by the laws. What I am proposing is that the initial conditions become part of the laws. Naturally, this requires that the universe be in a very special state. Philosophically, this is similar to the idea of a wave function of the universe. One can phrase this proposal as the suggestion that the wave function of the universe is the CSW functional. There is also a good deal here philosophically in common with the recent paper of Rovelli and Smolin . Although they do not assume the universe is in the CSW state, they couple the gravitational eld to a particular matter eld, which acts as a clock, so that the gravitational eld is treated as only part of a universe. What replaces a quantum eld theory is a family of quantum theories corresponding to parts of the universe. When we divide the universe into two parts, we obtain a Hilbert space which is associated to the boundary between them. This is another departure from quantum eld theory it amounts to abandonment of observation at a distance. The quantum theories of dierent parts of the universe are not, of course, independent. In a situation where one observer watches another there must be maps from the space of states which one observer sees to the other. Furthermore, these maps must be consistent. If A watches B watch C watch the rest of the universe, A must see B see C see what A sees C see. Since, in the Ashtekar/loop variables the states of quantum gravity are invariants of embedded graphs, we allow labelled punctures on the boundaries between parts of the universe, and include embedded graphs in the parts of the universe we study, i.e. in manifolds with boundary. The structure we arrive at has a natural categorical avor. Objects are places where observations take place, i.e. boundaries and morphisms are d cobordisms, which we think of as A observing B. Let us formalize this as follows Denition . An observer is an oriented manifold with boundary Louis Crane containing an embedded labelled framed graph which intersects the boundary in isolated labelled points. The labelling sets for the edges and vertices of the graph are nite, and need to be chosen for all of what ensues. Denition . A skin of observation is a closed oriented surface with labelled punctures. Denition . If A and B are skins of observation an inspection, , of B by A is an observer whose boundary is identied with A B i.e. reverse the orientation on A such that the labellings of the components of the graph which reach the boundary of match the labellings in A B. This denition requires that the set of labellings possess an involution corresponding to reversal of orientation on a surface. To every inspection of B by A there corresponds a dual inspection of A by B, given by reversing orientation and dualizing on . Denition . The category of observation is the category whose objects are skins of observation and whose morphisms are inspections. Denition . If M is a closed oriented manifold the category of observation in M is the relative i.e. embedded version of the above. Of course, we can speak of observers, etc., in M . Denition . A state for quantum gravity in M is a functor from the category of observation in M to the category of vector spaces. Nowhere in any of this do we assume that these boundaries are con nected. In fact, the most important situation to study may be one in which the universe is crammed full of a gas of classical observers. We shall discuss this situation below as a key to a physical interpretation of our theory. If we examine the mathematical structure necessary to produce a state for the universe in this sense, we nd that it is identical to a d TQFT. Thus, the CSW state produces a state in this new sense as well. Another way to look at this proposal is as follows the CSW state for the Ashtekar variables is a very special state, in that it factorizes when we cut the manifold along a surface with punctures, so that a nitedimensional Hilbert space is attached to each such surface, and the invariant of any link cut by the surface can be expressed as the inner product of two vectors corresponding to the two half links. John Baez has pointed out that these nitedimensional spaces really do possess natural inner products. Thus, it produces a state also in the sense we have dened above. I interpret this as saying that the state of the universe is unchanging, but that because the universe is in a very special state, it can contain a classical world, i.e. a family of classical observers with consistent mutual Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity observations. The states on pieces of the universe i.e. links with ends in manifolds with boundary can be interpreted as changing, once we learn to interpret vectors in the Hilbert spaces as clocks. So far, we have a net of nitedimensional Hilbert spaces, rather than one big one, and no idea how to reintroduce time in the presence of ob servers. There are natural things to try for both of these problems in the mathematical context of TQFT. Before going into a program for solving these problems and thereby opening the possibility of computing the results of real experiments let us make a survey of the mathematical toolkit we inherit from TQFT. Ideas from TQFT As we have indicated, the notion of a state of quantum gravity we dened above is equivalent to the notion of a d TQFT which is currently prevalent in the literature. The simplest denition of a d TQFT is that it is a machine which assigns a vector space to a surface, and a linear map to a cobordism between two surfaces. The empty surface receives a dimensional vector space, so a closed manifold gets a numerical invariant. Composition of cobordisms corresponds to composition of the linear maps. A more abstract way to phrase this is that a TQFT is a functor from the cobordism category to the category of vector spaces. The TQFTs which have appeared lately are richer than this. They as sign vector spaces to surfaces with labelled punctures, and linear maps to cobordisms containing links or knotted graphs with labelled edges. The labels correspond to representations. Since it is easy to extend the loop variables to allow traces in arbitrary representations characters, there is a great deal of coincidence in the pictures of CSW TQFT and the loop variables. That constituted much of the initial motivation for this pro gram. We can describe this as a functor from a richer cobordism category to V ect. The objects in the richer cobordism category are surfaces with labelled punctures, and the morphisms are cobordisms containing labelled links with ends on the punctures. There are several ways to construct TQFTs in various dimensions. Let us here discuss the construction of a TQFT from a triangulation. We assign labels to edges in the triangulation, and some sort of factors combining the edge labels to dierent dimensional simplices in the triangulation, multiply the factors together, and sum over labellings. In order to obtain a topologically invariant theory, we need the combi nation factors to satisfy some equations. The equations they need to satisfy are very algebraic in nature as we go through dierent classes of theories in dierent low dimensions we rst rediscover most of the interesting classes of associative algebras, then of tensor categories . Louis Crane d d d d d d d d d d d d E Fig. . Move for d TQFT A simple example in two dimensions may explain why the equations for a topological theory have a fundamental algebraic avor. For a d TQFT dened from a triangulation, we need invariance under the move in Fig. . Now, if we think of the coecients which we use to combine the labels around a triangle as the structure coecients of an algebra, this is exactly the associative law. Much of the rest of classical abstract algebra makes an appearance here too. As has been described elsewhere , a d TQFT can be constructed from a modular tensor category. The interesting examples of MTCs can be realized as quotients of the categories of representations of quantum groups. If we try to use the modular tensor categories to construct a TQFT on a triangulation, we obtain, not the CSW theory, but the weaker TQFT of Turaev and Viro . Here we label edges, not from a basis for an algebra, but with irreducible objects from a tensor category. The combinations we attach to tetrahedra simplices are the quantum j symbols, which come from the associativity isomorphisms of the category. We refer to this sort of formula as a state summation. The full CSW theory can also be reproduced from a modular tensor category by a slightly subtler construction which uses a Heegaard splitting which can be easily produced from a triangulation . The quantum j symbols satisfy some identities, which imply that the summation formula for a manifold is independent under a change of the triangulation. The most interesting of these is the ElliotBiedenharn iden tity. This identity is the consistency relation for the associativity isomor phism of the MTC. This is another example of the marriage between algebra and topology which underlies TQFT. The suggestion that this sort of summation could be related to the quantum theory of gravity is older than one might think. If we use the representations of an ordinary Lie group instead of a quantum group, then the TuraevViro formula becomes the PonzanoRegge formula for the eval uation of a spin network. Ponzano and Regge , were able to interpret the evaluation as a sort of discrete path integral for d Euclidean quantum gravity. The formula which Regge and Ponzano found for the evaluation of a graph is the analog for a Lie group of the state sum of Turaev and Viro for a quantum group. Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Thus, the evaluation of a tetrahedron for a spin network is a j symbol for the group SU labellings internal edges dim q j tetrahedra j. . The topological invariance of this formula follows from some elementary properties of representation theory. In ., we have placed our trivalent labelled graph on the boundary of a manifold with boundary, and then cut the interior up into tetrahedra, labelling the edges of all the internal lines with arbitrary spins. The ClebschGordan relations imply that only nitely many terms in . are nonzero. Ponzano and Regge then proceeded to interpret . as a discretized path integral for d quantum GR. The geometric interpretation consisted in thinking of the Casimirs of the representations as lengths of edges. Rep resentation theory implied that the summation was dominated by at ge ometries . Another way to think of the program in this chapter is as an attempt to nd the appropriate algebraic structure for extending the spin network approach to quantum gravity from d to d. Another idea from TQFT, which seems to have relevance for this phys ical program, is the ladder of dimensions . TQFTs in adjacent dimen sions seem to be related algebraically. The spirit of the relationship is like the relationship of a tensor category to an algebra. Tensor categories look just like algebras with the operation symbols in circles. The identities of an algebra correspond to isomorphisms in a tensor category. These isomor phisms then satisfy higherorder consistency or coherence relations, which relate to topology up dimension. The program of construction in TQFT, which I hope will yield the tools for the quantization of general relativity, is not yet completed, but is progressing rapidly. There are two outstanding problems, which are mathematically natural, and which I believe are crucial to the physical problem as well. They are Topological problem Find a triangulation version of CSW theory not merely its absolute square as in . Topological problem Construct a d TQFT related via the dimensional ladder to CSW theory. The solution of these two problems will be in reach, if the program in succeeds. The program of also suggests that the solutions of these two topological problems are closely related, both being constructed from state sums involving the same new algebraic tools. In this context we should also note that a d TQFT has been con structed in , out of a modular tensor category. This construction begins with a triangulation of a manifold, and picks a Heegaard splitting for the Louis Crane boundary of each simplex of the triangulation. Thus the theory in can be thought of as producing a d theory by lling the space with a network of d subspaces containing observers. This connection between TQFTs in dimensions and dimensions is the sort of thing I believe we will need to solve the problem of reintroducing time in a universe in a TQFT state. What I expect is that the program of will provide richer examples of such a connection, which will prove to be relevant to quantizing general relativity. What we conjecture in is that a new algebraic structure will give us a new state summation, similar to the one we discussed above, which will give us CSW in dimensions. If we use the new summation in dimensions, we should obtain a discrete version of F F theory. This combination seems very suggestive, since we are supposed to be obtaining our relative states from CSW theory on a boundary, while F F theory is a Lagrangian for the topological sector for the quantum theory of GR . Also, the algebraic structure we need to construct seems to be an expanded quantum version of the Lorentz group. It is this new, not yet understood summation, which comes from the representation theory of the new structure which we call an F algebra in , which I believe should give us a discretized version of a path integral for quantum gravity. Hilbert space is deadlong live Hilbert space or the observer gas approximation Let us assume that we have found a suitable state summation formula to solve our two topological problems so that what we suggest will be predicated on the success of the program in , although one could also try to use the state sum in together with TuraevViro theory. There is a natural proposal to make a physical interpretation within it in a dimensional setting. In the scheme I am suggesting, we can recover a Hilbert space in a certain sort of classical limit, in which the universe is full of a gas, of classical observers. The idea is that if we choose a triangulation for the manifold and a Heegaard splitting for the boundary of each simplex, then we obtain a family of surfaces which can be thought of as lling up the manifold. These surfaces should be thought of as skins of observation for a family of observers who are crowding the spacetime. Now let us think of a manifold with boundary. In a dimensional boundary component, we can then combine the vector spaces which we assign to the surfaces which cut the boundaries of those simplices lying on the boundary into a larger Hilbert space, which is a quotient of their tensor product. It is a quotient because the surfaces overlap. Now, if we pass to a ner triangulation, we will obtain a larger space, with a linear map to the smaller one. The linear map comes from the fact that we are using a d TQFT, and the existence of d cobordisms connecting pieces of the Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity surfaces of the two sets of Heegaard splittings. We end up with a large vector space for each triangulation of the bound ary manifold, and a linear map when one triangulation is a renement of another. This produces a directed graph of vector spaces and linear maps associated to a manifold. The d state sum can be extended to act on the vectors in these vector spaces by extending a triangulation for the boundary manifold to one for the manifold. Whenever we have a directed set of vector spaces and consistent linear maps, there is a construction called the inverse limit which can combine them into a single vector space. The vectors are vectors in any of the spaces, with images under the maps identied. Since the d state sum is assumed to be topologically invariant, we can extend the linear map it assigns to a d cobordism to a map on the inverse limit spaces. I propose that it is these inverse limit spaces which play the role of the physical Hilbert spaces of the theory. The thought here is that physical Hilbert space is the union of the nitedimensional spaces which a gas of observers can see, in the limit of an innitely dense gas. The eect of this suggestion is to reverse the relationship between the nitedimensional spaces of states which each observer can actually see and the global Hilbert space. We are regarding the states which can be observed at one skin of observation as primary. This relational approach bears some resemblance to the physical ideas of Leibniz, although that is not an argument for it. The problem of time The test of this proposal is whether it can reproduce Einsteins equations in some classical limit. What I am proposing is that the d state sum which I hope to construct from the representation theory of the F algebra can be interpreted as a discretized version of the path integral for general relativity. The key question is whether the state sum is dominated in the limit of large spins on edges by assignments of spins whose geometric interpretation would give a discrete approximation to an Einstein manifold. This would mean that the theory was a quantum theory whose classical limit was general relativity. The analogy with the work of Ponzano and Regge is the rst suggestion that this program might work. In , they interpreted the summation we wrote down above as a discretized path integral for d quantum gravity. The geometric interpretation consisted in thinking of the Casimirs of rep resentations as lengths. It was somewhat easier to get Einsteins equations in d , since the solutions are just at metrics. Should this program work One objection, which was raised in the discussion, is that the F F model may only be a sector of quantum Louis Crane gravity in some weak sense. I am restating this objection somewhat, in the absence of the questioner. It can be replied that since the theory we are writing has the right symmetries, the action of the renormalization group should x the Lagrangian. I do not think that either the objection or the reply is decisive in the abstract. If the state sum suggested in can be dened, then we can investigate whether we recover Einsteins equation or not. If this does work, one could do the state sum on a manifold with corners, i.e. x states on surfaces in the dimensional boundaries of a d cobordism. One could interpret these states as initial conditions for an experiment, and investigate the results by studying the propagation via the d state sum. One could conjecture that this would give a spacetime picture for the evolution of relative states within the framework of the CSW state of the universe. Matter and symmetry It is natural to ask whether this picture could be expanded to include matter elds. The obvious thing to try is to pass from SU to a larger group. It may be noted that Peldan has observed that the CSW state also satises the YangMills equation. If we really get a picture of gravity from the state sum associated to SU, it would not be a great leap to try a larger gauge group. As I was writing this I became aware of , in which Gambini and Pullin point out that the CSW state is also a state for GR coupled to electromagnetism. They also say that the sources for such a theory, thought of as places where links have ends, are necessarily fermionic. These results seem to strengthen further the program set forth here. In general, the constructions which lead up to the F algebras in can be thought of as expressions of quantum symmetry, i.e. as relatives of Lie groups in a quantum context. For example, the modular tensor categories can be described as deformed ClebschGordan coecients. The F algebras arise as a result of pushing this process further, recategori fying the categories into categories. These constructions can also be done from extremely simple starting points, looking at representations of Dynkin diagrams as quivers. The idea that theories in physics should be reconstructed from symmetries actually originated with Einstein, who was thinking of general relativity. It would be tting somehow to reconstruct truly fundamental theories of physics from fundamental mathematical ex pressions of symmetries. Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Acknowledgements The author wishes to thank Lee Smolin and Carlo Rovelli for many years of conversation on this extremely elusive topic. The mathematical ideas here are largely the result of collaborations with David Yetter and Igor Frenkel. Louis Kauman has provided many crucial insights. The author is supported by NSF grant DMS. Bibliography . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Loop representation for quantum general relativity, Nucl. Phys. B , . . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Com mun. Math. Phys. , . . L. Crane, d physics and d topology, Commun. Math. Phys. ,. . G. Moore and N. Seiberg, Classical and quantum conformal eld theory, Commun. Math. Phys. , . . B. Br ugmann, R. Gambini, and J. Pullin, Jones polynomials for in tersecting knots as physical states for quantum gravity, Nucl. Phys. B,. . L. Crane, Quantum symmetry, link invariants and quantum geome try, in Proceedings of the XXth International Conference on Dier ential Geometric Methods in Theoretical Physics, eds S. Catto and A. Rocha, Singapore, World Scientic, . . L. Crane, Conformal eld theory, spin geometry, and quantum grav ity, Phys. Lett. B , . . R. Penrose, Angular momentum an approach to combinatorial space time, in Quantum Theory and Beyond, ed. T. Bastin, Cam bridge University Press, . . G. Ponzano and T. Regge, Semiclassical limits of Racah coecients, in Spectroscopic and Group Theoretical Methods in Physics, ed. F. Bloch, New York, Wiley, . . C. Rovelli, What is an observable in classical and quantum gravity Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . . J. Moussouris, Quantum Models of Space Time Based on Recoupling Theory, Thesis, Oxford University . . P. Peldan, Ashtekars variables for arbitrary gauge group, Phys. Rev. D , RR. . L. Smolin, personal communication. . V. Moncrief, personal communication. . K. Walker, On Wittens manifold invariants, unpublished. . L. Crane and I. Frenkel, Hopf categories and their representations, Louis Crane to appear. . M. Kapranov and V. Voevodsky, Braided monoidal categories, vector spaces and Zamolodchikovs tetrahedra equation, preprint. . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Knot theory and quantum gravity, Phys. Rev. Lett. , . . L. Crane and I. Frenkel, A representation theoretic approach to dimensional topological quantum eld theory, to appear in Pro ceedings of AMS conference, Mt Holyoke, Massachusetts, June . . V. Turaev and O. Viro, State sum invariants of manifolds and quantum j symbols, Topology , . . L. Crane and D. Yetter, A categorical construction of d TQFTs, to appear in Proceedings of AMS conference, Dayton, Ohio, October . . L. N. Chang and C. Soo, BRST cohomology and invariants of D gravity in Ashtekar variables, preprint. . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, The physical hamiltonian in non perturbative quantum gravity, preprint. . R. Gambini and J. Pullin, Quantum EinsteinMaxwell elds a uni ed viewpoint from the loop representation, preprint. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields John C. Baez Department of Mathematics, University of California, Riverside, California , USA email jbaezucrmath.ucr.edu Abstract The loop representation of quantum gravity has many formal resem blances to a backgroundfree string theory. In fact, its origins lie in attempts to treat the string theory of hadrons as an approxima tion to QCD, in which the strings represent ux tubes of the gauge eld. A heuristic pathintegral approach indicates a duality between backgroundfree string theories and generally covariant gauge theo ries, with the loop transform relating the two. We review progress towards making this duality rigorous in three examples d Yang Mills theory which, while not generally covariant, has symmetry under all areapreserving transformations, d quantum gravity, and d quantum gravity. SUN YangMills theory in dimensions has been given a stringtheoretic interpretation in the largeN limit, but here we provide an exact stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory on RS for nite N. The stringtheoretic interpretation of quan tum gravity in dimensions gives rise to conjectures about integrals on the moduli space of at connections, while in dimensions there may be relationships to the theory of tangles. Introduction The notion of a deep relationship between string theories and gauge theo ries is far from new. String theory rst arose as a model of hadron interac tions. Unfortunately this theory had a number of undesirable features in particular, it predicted massless spin particles. It was soon supplanted by quantum chromodynamics QCD, which models the strong force by an SU YangMills eld. However, string models continued to be popular as an approximation of the conning phase of QCD. Two quarks in a meson, for example, can be thought of as connected by a stringlike ux tube in which the gauge eld is concentrated, while an excitation of the gauge eld alone can be thought of as a looped ux tube. This is essentially a modern reincarnation of Faradays notion of eld lines, but it can be formalized using the notion of Wilson loops. If A denotes the vector potential, or connection, in a classical gauge theory, a Wilson loop is simply the trace of the holonomy of A around a loop in space, typically written in terms John C. Baez of a pathordered exponential Tr Pe A . If instead A denotes the vector potential in a quantized gauge theory, the Wilson loop may be reinterpreted as an operator on the Hilbert space of states, and, at least heuristically, applying this operator to the vacuum state one obtains a state in which the YangMills analog of the electric eld ows around the loop . In the late s, Makeenko and Migdal, Nambu, Polyakov, and others , attempted to derive equations of string dynamics as an approxi mation to the YangMills equation, using Wilson loops. More recently, D. Gross and others , , , , have been able to reformulate Yang Mills theory in dimensional spacetime as a string theory by writing an asymptotic series for the vacuum expectation values of Wilson loops as a sum over maps from surfaces the string worldsheet to spacetime. This development raises the hope that other gauge theories might also be iso morphic to string theories. For example, recent work by Witten and Periwal suggests that ChernSimons theory in dimensions is also equivalent to a string theory. String theory eventually became popular as a theory of everything be cause the massless spin particles it predicted could be interpreted as the gravitons one obtains by quantizing the spacetime metric perturbatively about a xed background metric. Since string theory appears to avoid the renormalization problems in perturbative quantum gravity, it is a strong candidate for a theory unifying gravity with the other forces. However, while classical general relativity is an elegant geometrical theory relying on no background structure for its formulation, it has proved dicult to describe string theory along these lines. Typically one begins with a xed background structure and writes down a string eld theory in terms of this only afterwards can one investigate its background independence . The clarity of a manifestly backgroundfree approach to string theory would be highly desirable. On the other hand, attempts to formulate YangMills theory in terms of Wilson loops eventually led to a fulledged loop representation of gauge theories, thanks to the work of Gambini and Trias , and others. After Ashtekar formulated quantum gravity as a sort of gauge theory using the new variables, Rovelli and Smolin were able to use the loop rep resentation to study quantum gravity nonperturbatively in a manifestly backgroundfree formalism. While supercially quite dierent from mod ern string theory, this approach to quantum gravity has many points of similarity, thanks to its common origin. In particular, it uses the device of Wilson loops to construct a space of states consisting of multiloop in variants, which assign an amplitude to any collection of loops in space. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields The resemblance of these states to wavefunctions of a string eld theory is striking. It is natural, therefore, to ask whether the loop representation of quantum gravity might be a string theory in disguiseor vice versa. The present paper does not attempt a denitive answer to this question. Rather, we begin by describing a general framework relating gauge theories and string theories, and then consider a variety of examples. Our treatment of examples is also meant to serve as a review of YangMills theory in dimensions and quantum gravity in and dimensions. In Section we describe how the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory is related to a backgroundfree closed string eld theory. We take a very naive approach to strings, thinking of them simply as maps from a surface into spacetime, and disregarding any conformal structure or elds propagating on the surface. We base our treatment on the path integral formalism, and in order to simplify the presentation we make a number of overoptimistic assumptions concerning measures on innitedimensional spaces such as the space // of connections modulo gauge transformations. In Section we consider YangMills theory in dimensions as an ex ample. In fact, this theory is not generally covariant, but it has an innite dimensional subgroup of the dieomorphism group as symmetries, the group of all areapreserving transformations. Rather than the path in tegral approach we use canonical quantization, which is easier to make rigorous. Gross, Taylor, and others , , , , have already given dimensional SUN YangMills theory a stringtheoretic interpretation in the largeN limit. Our treatment is mostly a review of their work, but we nd it to be little extra eort, and rather enlightening, to give the theory a precise stringtheoretic interpretation for nite N. In Section we consider quantum gravity in dimensions. We review the loop representation of this theory and raise some questions about inte grals over the moduli space of at connections on a Riemann surface whose resolution would be desirable for developing a stringtheoretic picture of the theory. We also briey discuss ChernSimons theory in dimensions. These examples have nitedimensional reduced conguration spaces, so there are no analytical diculties with measures on innitedimensional spaces, at least in canonical quantization. In Section , however, we con sider quantum gravity in dimensions. Here the classical conguration space is innite dimensional and issues of analysis become more impor tant. We review recent work by Ashtekar, Isham, Lewandowski, and the author , , on dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on // and their relation to multiloop invariants and knot theory. We also note how a stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory leads naturally to the study of tangles. John C. Baez String eld/gauge eld duality In this section we sketch a relationship between string eld theories and gauge theories. We begin with a nonperturbative Lagrangian description of backgroundfree closed string eld theories. From this we derive a Hamil tonian description, which turns out to be mathematically isomorphic to the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory. We emphasize that while our discussion here is rigorous, it is schematic, in the sense that some of our assumptions are not likely to hold precisely as stated in the most interesting examples. In particular, by measure in this section we will always mean a positive regular Borel measure, but in fact one should work with a more general version of this concept. We discuss these analyt ical issues more carefully in Section . Consider a theory of strings propagating on a spacetime M that is dieomorphic to R X, with X a manifold we call space. We do not assume a canonical identication of M with RX, or any other background structure metric, etc. on spacetime. We take the classical conguration space of the string theory to be the space / of multiloops in X / n / n with / n MapsnS , X. Here nS denotes the disjoint union of n copies of S , and we write Maps to denote the set of maps satisfying some regularity conditions continuity, smoothness, etc. to be specied. Let T denote a measure on / and let Fun/ denote some space of squareintegrable functions on /. We assume that Fun/ and the measure T are invariant both under dieo morphisms of space and reparametrizations of the strings. That is, both the identity component of the dieomorphism group of X and the orientation preserving dieomorphisms of nS act on /, and we wish Fun/ and T to be preserved by these actions. Introduce on FunM the kinematical inner product, which is just the L inner product , kin , T. We assume for convenience that this really is an inner product, i.e. it is nondegenerate. Dene the kinematical state space H kin to be the Hilbert space completion of Fun/ in the norm associated to this inner product. Following ideas from canonical quantum gravity, we do not expect H kin to be the true space of physical states. In the space of physical states, any two states diering by a dieomorphism of spacetime are identied. The physical state space thus depends on the dynamics of the theory. Taking a Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields Lagrangian approach, dynamics may be described in terms of path integrals as follows. Fix a time t gt . Let T denote the set of histories, that is maps f , t X, where is a compact oriented manifold with boundary, such that f , t X f. Given , t /, we say that f T is a history from to t if f , t X and the boundary of is a disjoint union of circles nS mS , with fnS , fmS t . We x a measure, or path integral, on T, t . Following tradition, we write this as e iSf Tf, with Sf denoting the action of f, but e iSf and Tf only appear in the combination e iSf Tf. Since we are interested in generally covariant theories, this path integral is assumed to have some invariance properties, which we note below as they are needed. Using the standard recipe in topological quantum eld theory, we dene the physical inner product on H kin by , phys , , , t e iSf TfTT t assuming optimistically that this integral is well dened. We do not ac tually assume this is an inner product in the standard sense, for while we assume , for all H kin , we do not assume positive deniteness. The general covariance of the theory should imply that this inner product is independent of the choice of time t gt , so we assume this as well. Dene the space of normzero states I H kin by I, phys , phys for all H kin and dene the physical state space H phys to be the Hilbert space com pletion of H kin /I in the norm associated to the physical inner product. In general I is nonempty, because if g Di X is a dieomorphism in the connected component of the identity, we can nd a path of dieomor phisms g t Di M with g g and g t equal to the identity, and dening g Di, t X by gt, x t, g t x, we have , phys , , , t e iSf TfTT t , , , gg t e iSf TfTT t John C. Baez , , , gg t e iS gf T gfTgT t , , , g t e iSf TfTT t g, phys for any , . Here we are assuming e iS gf T gf e iSf Tf, which is one of the expected invariance properties of the path integral. It follows that I includes the space J, the closure of the span of all vectors of the form g. We can therefore dene the spatially dieomorphism invariant state space H diff by H diff H kin /J and obtain H phys as a Hilbert space completion of H diff /K, where K is the image of I in H diff . To summarize, we obtain the physical state space from the kinematical state space by taking two quotients H kin H kin /J H diff H diff H diff /K H phys . As usual in canonical quantum gravity and topological quantum eld the ory, there is no Hamiltonian instead, all the information about dynamics is contained in the physical inner product. The reason, of course, is that the path integral, which in traditional quantum eld theory described time evolution, now describes the physical inner product. The quotient map H diff H phys , or equivalently its kernel K, plays the role of a Hamil tonian constraint. The quotient map H kin H diff , or equivalently its kernel J, plays the role of the dieomorphism constraint, which is indepen dent of the dynamics. Strictly speaking, we should call K the dynamical constraint, as we shall see that it expresses constraints on the initial data other than those usually called the Hamiltonian constraint, such as the Mandelstam constraints arising in gauge theory. It is common in canonical quantum gravity to proceed in a slightly dierent manner than we have done here, using subspaces at certain points where we use quotient spaces , . For example, H diff may be dened as the subspace of H kin consisting of states invariant under the action of Di X, and H phys then dened as the kernel of certain operators, the Hamiltonian constraints. The method of working solely with quotient spaces has, however, been studied by Ashtekar . The choice between these dierent approaches will in the end be dic tated by the desire for convenience and/or rigor. As a heuristic guiding principle, however, it is worth noting that the subspace and quotient space approaches are essentially equivalent if we assume that the subspace I is closed in the norm topology on H kin . Relative to the kinematical inner Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields H d d d a d d d b dd dd c E E Fig. . Twostring interaction in dimensional space product, we can identify H diff with the orthogonal complement J , and similarly identify H phys with I . From this point of view we have H phys H diff H kin . Moreover, H diff if and only if is invariant under the action of Di X on H kin . To see this, rst note that if g for all g Di X, then for all H kin we have ,gg , so J . Conversely, if J , ,g so , , g, and since g acts unitarily on H kin the CauchySchwarz inequality implies g . The approach using subspaces is the one with the clearest connection to knot theory. An element H kin is a function on the space of multiloops. If is invariant under the action of Di X, we call a multiloop in variant. In particular, denes an ambient isotopy invariant of links in X when we restrict it to links which are nothing but multiloops that happen to be embeddings. We see therefore that in this situation the physical states dene link invariants. As a suggestive example, take X S , and take as the Hamiltonian constraint an operator H on H diff that has the property described in Fig. . Here a, b, c C are arbitrary. This Hamil tonian constraint represents the simplest sort of dieomorphisminvariant twostring interaction in dimensional space. Dening the physical space H phys to be the kernel of H, it follows that any H phys gives a link invariant that is just a multiple of the HOMFLY invariant . For appro priate values of the parameters a, b, c, we expect this sort of Hamiltonian constraint to occur in a generally covariant gauge theory on dimensional spacetime known as BF theory, with gauge group SUN . A simi lar construction working with unoriented framed multiloops gives rise to the Kauman polynomial, which is associated with BF theory with gauge group SON . We see here in its barest form the path from string theoretic considerations to link invariants and then to gauge theory. In what follows, we start from the other end, and consider a generally covariant gauge theory on M. Thus we x a Lie group G and a principal Gbundle P M. Fixing an identication M R X, the classical conguration space is the space /of connections on P X . The physical John C. Baez Hilbert space of the quantum theory, it should be emphasized, is supposed to be independent of this identication M RX. Given a loop S X and a connection A /, let T, A be the corresponding Wilson loop, that is the trace of the holonomy of A around in a xed nitedimensional representation of G T, A Tr Pe A . The group of gauge transformations acts on /. Fix a invariant measure TA on / and let Fun// denote a space of gaugeinvariant functions on / containing the algebra of functions generated by Wilson loops. We may alternatively think of Fun// as a space of functions on // and TA as a measure on //. Assume that TA is invariant under the action of Di M on //, and dene the kinematical state space H kin to be the Hilbert space completion of Fun// in the norm associated to the kinematical inner product , kin ,/ AA TA. The relation of this kinematical state space and that described above for a string eld theory is given by the loop transform. Given any multiloop ,..., n / n , dene the loop transform of Fun// by ,..., n ,/ AT ,AT n , A TA. Take Fun/ to be the space of functions in the range of the loop trans form. Let us assume, purely for simplicity of exposition, that the loop transform is onetoone. Then we may identify H kin with Fun/ just as in the string eld theory case. The process of passing from the kinematical state space to the dieo morphisminvariant state space and then the physical state space has al ready been treated for a number of generally covariant gauge theories, most notably quantum gravity , , . In order to emphasize the resemblance to the string eld case, we will use a path integral approach. Fix a time t gt . Given A, A t /, let TA, A t denote the space of connections on P ,tX which restrict to A on X and to A t on t X. We assume the existence of a measure on TA, A t which we write as e iSa Ta, using a to denote a connection on P ,tX . Again, this generalized measure has some invariance properties corresponding to the general covariance of the gauge theory. Dene the physical inner product on H kin by , phys , , A,A AA t e iSa TaTATA t Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields again assuming that this integral is well dened and that , for all . This inner product should be independent of the choice of time t gt . Letting I H kin denote the space of normzero states, the physical state space H phys of the gauge theory is H kin /I. As before, we can use the general covariance of the theory to show that I contains the closed span J of all vectors of the form g. Letting H diff H kin /J, and letting K be the image of I in H diff , we again see that the physical state space is obtained by applying rst the dieomorphism constraint H kin H kin /J H diff and then the Hamiltonian constraint H diff H diff /K H phys . In summary, we see that the Hilbert spaces for generally covariant string theories and generally covariant gauge theories have a similar form, with the loop transform relating the gauge theory picture to the string the ory picture. The key point, again, is that a state in H kin can be re garded either as a wave function on the classical conguration space / for gauge elds, with A being the amplitude of a specied connection A, or as a wave function on the classical conguration space / for strings, with ,..., n being the amplitude of a specied ntuple of strings ,..., n S X to be present. The loop transform depends on the nonlinear duality between connections and loops, // / C A, ,..., n TA, TA, n which is why we speak of string eld/gauge eld duality rather than an isomorphism between string elds and gauge elds. At this point it is natural to ask what the dierence is, apart from words, between the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory and the sort of purely topological string eld theory we have been considering. From the Hamiltonian viewpoint that is, in terms of the spaces H kin , H diff , and H phys the dierence is not so great. The Lagrangian for a gauge theory, on the other hand, is quite a dierent object than that of a string eld theory. Note that nothing we have done allows the direct construction of a string eld Lagrangian from a gauge eld Lagrangian or vice versa. In the following sections we will consider some examples YangMills theory in dimensions, quantum gravity in dimensions, and quantum gravity in dimensions. In no case is a string eld action Sf known that corresponds to the gauge theory in question However, in d YangMills theory a working substitute for the string eld path integral is known a discrete sum over certain equivalence classes of maps f M. This is, in fact, a promising alternative to dealing with measures on the John C. Baez space T of string histories. In dimensional quantum gravity, such an approach might involve a sum over tangles, that is ambient isotopy classes of embeddings f , t X. YangMills theory in dimensions We begin with an example in which most of the details have been worked out. YangMills theory is not a generally covariant theory since it relies for its formulation on a xed Riemannian or Lorentzian metric on the spacetime manifold M. We x a connected compact Lie group G and a principal Gbundle P M. Classically the gauge elds in question are connections A on P, and the YangMills action is given by SA M TrF F where F is the curvature of A and Tr is the trace in a xed faithful unitary representation of G and hence its Lie algebra g. Extremizing this action we obtain the classical equations of motion, the YangMills equation d A F, where d A is the exterior covariant derivative. The action SA is gauge invariant, so it can be regarded as a function on the space of connections on M modulo gauge transformations. The group DiM acts on this space, but the action is not dieomorphism invariant. However, if M is dimensional one may write F f where is the volume form on M and f is a section of P Ad g, and then SA M Trf . It follows that the action SA is invariant under the subgroup of dieomor phisms preserving the volume form . So upon quantization one expects toand doesobtain something analogous to a topological quantum eld theory, but in which dieomorphism invariance is replaced by invariance under this subgroup. Strictly speaking, then, many of the results of the previous section do not apply. In particular, this theory has an honest Hamiltonian, rather than a Hamiltonian constraint. Still, it illustrates some interesting aspects of gauge eld/string eld duality. The Riemannian case of d YangMills theory has been extensively investigated. An equation for the vacuum expectation values of Wilson loops for the theory on Euclidean R was found by Migdal , and these expectation values were explicitly calculated by Kazakov . These calcu lations were made rigorous using stochastic dierential equation techniques by L. Gross, King and Sengupta , as well as Driver . The classical YangMills equations on Riemann surfaces were extensively investigated Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields by Atiyah and Bott , and the quantum theory on Riemann surfaces has been studied by Rusakov , Fine , and Witten . In particular, Witten has shown that the quantization of d YangMills theory gives a mathematical structure very close to that of a topological quantum eld theory, with a Hilbert space ZS S associated to each compact manifold S S , and a vector ZM, ZM for each compact oriented manifold M with boundary having total area M . Similar results were also obtained by Blau and Thompson . Here, however, it will be a bit simpler to discuss YangMills theory on RS with the Lorentzian metric dt dx , where t R, x S , as done by Rajeev . This will simultaneously serve as a brief introduction to the idea of quantizing gauge theories after symplectic reduction, which will also be important in d quantum gravity. This approach is an alternative to the path integral approach of the previous section, and in some cases is easier to make rigorous. Any Gbundle P R S is trivial, so we x a trivialization and identify a connection on P with a gvalued form on RS . The classical conguration space of the theory is the space / of connections on P S . This may be identied with the space of gvalued forms on S . The classical phase space of the theory is the cotangent bundle T /. Note that a tangent vector v T A / may be identied with a gvalued form on S . We may also think of a gvalued form E on S as a cotangent vector, using the nondegenerate inner product E, v S TrE v, We thus regard the phase space T /as the space of pairs A, E of gvalued forms on S . Given a connection on P solving the YangMills equation we obtain a point A, E of the phase space T / as follows let A be the pullback of the connection to S , and let E be its covariant time derivative pulled back to S . The pair A, E is called the initial data for the solution, and in physics A is called the vector potential and E the electric eld. The YangMills equation implies a constraint on A, E, the Gauss law d A E, and any pair A, E satisfying this constraint are the initial data for some solution of the YangMills equation. However, this solution is not unique, owing to the gauge invariance of the equation. Moreover, the loop group C S , G acts as gauge transformations on /, and this action lifts John C. Baez naturally to an action on T /, given by g A, E gAg gdg , gEg . Two points in the phase space T / are to be regarded as physically equiv alent if they dier by a gauge transformation. In this sort of situation it is natural to try to construct a smaller, more physically relevant reduced phase space using the process of symplectic re duction. The phase space T / is a symplectic manifold, but the constraint subspace A, E d A ET / is not. However, the constraint d A E, integrated against any f C S ,g as follows, S Trfd A E, gives a function on phase space that generates a Hamiltonian ow coin ciding with a parameter group of gauge transformations. In fact, all parameter subgroups of are generated by the constraint in this fash ion. Consequently, the quotient of the constraint subspace by is again a symplectic manifold, the reduced phase space. In the case at hand there is a very concrete description of the reduced phase space. First, by basic results on moduli spaces of at connections, the reduced conguration space // may be naturally identied with Hom S , G/AdG, which is just G/AdG. Alternatively, one can see this quite concretely. We may rst take the quotient of / by only those gauge transformations that equal the identity at a given point of S gC S ,Gg. This almost reduced conguration space // is dieomorphic to G itself, with an explicit dieomorphism taking each equivalence class A to its holonomy around the circle A Pe S A . The remaining gauge transformations form the group / G, which acts on the almost reduced conguration space G by conjugation, so // G/AdG. Next, writing E edx, the Gauss law says that e C S , g is a at section, and hence determined by its value at the basepoint of S . It follows that any point A, E in the constraint subspace is determined by A / together with e g. The quotient of the constraint subspace by , the almost reduced phase space, is thus identied with T G. It follows that the quotient of the constraint subspace by all of , the reduced phase space, is identied with T G/AdG. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields The advantage of the almost reduced conguration space and phase space is that they are manifolds. Observables of the classical theory can be identied either with functions on the reduced phase space, or functions on the almost reduced phase space T G that are constant on the orbits of the lift of the adjoint action of G. For example, the YangMills Hamiltonian is initially a function on T / HA, E E, E but by the process of symplectic reduction one obtains a corresponding Hamiltonian on the reduced phase space. One can, however, carry out only part of the process of symplectic reduction, and obtain a Hamiltonian function on the almost reduced phase space. This is just the Hamiltonian for a free particle on G, i.e. for any p T g G it is given by Hg, p p with the obvious inner product on T g G. Now let us consider quantizing dimensional YangMills theory. What should be the Hilbert space for the quantized theory on R S As de scribed in the previous section, it is natural to take L of the reduced conguration space //. Since the theory is not generally covariant, the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints do not enter the kine matical Hilbert space is the physical Hilbert space. However, to dene L // requires choosing a measure on // G/AdG. We will choose the pushforward of normalized Haar measure on G by the quotient map G G/AdG. This measure has the advantage of mathematical elegance. While one could also argue for it on physical grounds, we prefer simply to show ex post facto that it gives an interesting quantum theory consistent with other approaches to d YangMills theory. To begin with, note that this measure gives a Hilbert space isomorphism L // L G inv where the right side denotes the subspace of L G consisting of functions constant on each conjugacy class of G. Let denote the character of an equivalence class of irreducible representations of G. Then by the Schur orthogonality relations, the set forms an orthonormal basis of L G inv . In fact, the Hamiltonian of the quantum theory is diagonalized by this basis. Since the YangMills Hamiltonian on the almost reduced phase space T G is that of a classical free particle on G, we take the quantum Hamiltonian to be that for a quantum free particle on G H/ where is the nonnegative Laplacian on G. When we decompose the John C. Baez regular representation of G into irreducibles, the function lies in the sum of copies of the representation , so H c ,. where c is the quadratic Casimir of G in the representation . Note that the vacuum the eigenvector of H with lowest eigenvalue is the function , which is for the trivial representation. In a sense this diagonalization of the Hamiltonian completes the solution of YangMills theory on R S . However, extracting the physics from this solution requires computing expectation values of physically interesting observables. To take a step in this direction, and to make the connection to string theory, let us consider the Wilson loop observables. Recall that given a based loop S S , the classical Wilson loop T, A is dened by T, A TrPe A . We may think of T T, as a function on the reduced conguration space //, but it lifts to a function on the almost reduced conguration space G, and we prefer to think of it as such. In the case at hand these Wilson loop observables depend only on the homotopy class of the loop, because all connections on S are at. In the string eld picture of Section , we obtain a theory in which all physical states have ,..., n ,..., n when i is homotopic to i for all i. We will see this again in d quantum gravity. Letting n S S be an arbitrary loop of winding number n, we have T n , g Trg n . Since the classical Wilson loop observables are functions on congura tion space, we may quantize them by interpreting them as multiplication operators acting on L G inv T n g Trg n g. We can also form elements of L G inv by applying products of these op erators to the vacuum. Let n ,...,n k T n T n k . The states n ,...,n k may also be regarded as states of a string theory in which k strings are present, with winding numbers n ,...,n k , respectively. For convenience, we dene to be the vacuum state. The idea of describing the YangMills Hamiltonian in terms of these string states goes back at least to Jevickis work on lattice gauge the Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields ory. More recently, string states appear prominently in the work of Gross, Taylor, Douglas, Minahan, Polychronakos, and others , , , , on d YangMills theory as a string theory. All these authors, however, work primarily with the largeN limit of the theory, for since the work of t Hooft it has been clear that SUN YangMills theory simplies as N . In what follows we will use many ideas from these authors, but give a stringtheoretic formula for the SUN YangMills Hamiltonian that is exact for arbitrary N, instead of working in the largeN limit. The resemblance of the string states n ,...,n k to states in a bosonic Fock space should be clear. In particular, the T n are analogous to cre ation operators. However, we do not generally have a representation of the canonical commutation relations. In fact, the string states do not neces sarily span L G inv , although they do in some interesting cases. They are never linearly independent, because the Wilson loops satisfy relations. One always has T Tr, for example, and for any particular group G the Wilson loops will satisfy identities called Mandelstam identities. For exam ple, for G SU and taking traces in the fundamental representation, the Mandelstam identity is T n T m T nm T nm . Note that this implies that n, m n m n m, so the total number of strings present in a given state is ambiguous. In other words, there is no analog of the Fock space number operator on L G inv . For the rest of this section we set G SUN and take traces in the fundamental representation. In this case the string states do span L G inv , and all the linear dependencies between string states are consequences of the following Mandelstam identities . Given loops ,..., k in S , let M k ,..., k k S k sgnTg j g jn Tg j k g j kn k where has the cycle structure j j n j k j kn k . Then M N ,..., for all loops , and M N ,..., N for all loops i . There are also explicit formulae expressing the string states in terms of the basis of characters. These formulae are based on the classical theory of Young diagrams, which we shall briey review. The importance of this theory for dimensional physics was stressed by John C. Baez Nomura , and plays a primary role in Gross and Taylors work on d YangMills theory . As we shall see, Young diagrams describe a duality between the representation theory of SUN and of the symmetric groups S n which can be viewed as a mathematical reection of string eld/gauge eld duality. First, note using the Mandelstam identities that the string states n ,...,n k with all the n i positive but k possibly equal to zero span L SUN inv . Thus we will restrict our attention for now to states of this kind, which we call righthanded. There is a correspondence between righthanded string states and conjugacy classes of permutations in symmetric groups, in which the string state n ,...,n k corresponds to the conjugacy class of all permutations with cycles of length n ,...,n k . Note that consists of permutations in S n , where n n n k . To take advantage of this correspondence, we simply dene n ,...,n k . when is the conjugacy class of permutations with cycle lengths n ,...,n k . We will assume without loss of generality that n n k gt . The rationale for this description of string states as conjugacy classes of permutations is in fact quite simple. Suppose we have lengthminimizing strings in S with winding numbers n ,...,n k . Labelling each strand of string each time it crosses the point x , for a total of n n n k labels, and following the strands around counterclockwise to x , we obtain a permutation of the labels, and hence an element of S n . How ever, since the labelling was arbitrary, the string state really only denes a conjugacy class of elements of S n . In a Young diagram one draws a conjugacy class with cycles of length n n k gt as a diagram with k rows of boxes, having n i boxes in the ith row. See Fig. . Let Y denote the set of Young diagrams. On the one hand, there is a map from Young diagrams to equivalence classes of irreducible representations of SUN. Given Y , we form an irreducible representation of SUN, which we also call , by taking a tensor product of n copies of the fundamental representation, one copy for each box, and then antisymmetrizing over all copies in each column and symmetrizing over all copies in each row. This gives a correspondence between Young diagrams with lt N rows and irreducible representations of SUN. If has N rows it is equivalent to a representation coming from a Young diagram having lt N rows, and if has gt N rows it is zero dimensional. We will write for the character of the representation if has gt N rows . On the other hand, Young diagrams with n boxes are in correspon Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields Fig. . Young diagram dence with irreducible representations of S n . This allows us to write the Frobenius relations expressing the string states in terms of characters and vice versa. Given Y , we write for the corresponding repre sentation of S n . We dene the function on S n to be zero for n , n, where n is the number of boxes in . Then the Frobenius relations are Y ,. and conversely n S n .. The YangMills Hamiltonian has a fairly simple description in terms of the basis of characters . First, recall that eqn . expresses the Hamiltonian in terms of the Casimir. There is an explicit formula for the value of the SUN Casimir in the representation c Nn N n nn dim where denotes the conjugacy class of permutations in S n with one cycle of length and the rest of length . It follows that H NH N H H . John C. Baez where H n . and H nn dim .. To express the operators H and H in stringtheoretic terms, it is convenient to dene string annihilation and creation operators satisfying the canonical commutation relations. As noted above, there is no natural way to do this in L SUN inv since the string states are not linearly independent. The advantage of taking the N limit is that any nite set of distinct string states becomes linearly independent, in fact orthogonal, for suciently large N. We will proceed slightly dierently, simply dening a space in which all the string states are independent. Let H be a Hilbert space having an orthonormal basis A Y indexed by all Young diagrams. For each Y , dene a vector in H by the Frobenius relation .. Then a calculation using the Schur orthogonality equations twice shows that these string states are not only linearly independent, but orthogonal t , Y t A ,A Y t n where is the number of elements in regarded as a conjugacy class in S n . One can also derive the Frobenius relation . from these denitions and express the basis A in terms of the string states A n S n . It follows that the string states form a basis for H. The YangMills Hilbert space L SUN inv is essentially a quotient space of the string eld Hilbert space H, with the only densely dened quotient map jHL SUN inv being given by A . This quotient map sends the string state in H to the corresponding Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields string state L SUN inv . It follows that this quotient map is precisely that which identies any two string states that are related by the Mandelstam identities. It was noted some time ago by Gliozzi and Virasoro that Mandelstam identities on string states are strong evidence for a gauge eld interpretation of a string eld theory. Here in fact we will show that the Hamiltonian on the YangMills Hilbert space L SUN inv lifts to a Hamiltonian on H with a simple interpretation in terms of string interactions, so that dimensional SUN YangMills theory is isomorphic to a quotient of a string theory by the Mandelstam identities. In the framework of the previous section, the Mandelstam identities would appear as part of the dynamical constraint K of the string theory. Following eqns .., we dene a Hamiltonian H on the string eld Hilbert space H by H NH N H H where H A nA ,H A nn dim A . This clearly has the property that Hj jH, so the YangMills dynamics is the quotient of the string eld dynamics. On H we can introduce creation operators a j j gt by a j n ,...,n k j, n ,...,n k , and dene the annihilation operator a j to be the adjoint of a j . These satisfy the following commutation relations a j ,a k a j ,a k ,a j ,a k j jk . We could eliminate the factor of j and obtain the usual canonical commu tation relations by a simple rescaling, but it is more convenient not to. We then claim that H jgt a j a j and H j,kgt a jk a j a k a j a k a jk . These follow from calculations which we briey sketch here. The Frobenius relations and the denition of H give H n, . John C. Baez d d E E H Fig. . Twostring interaction in dimensional space and this implies the formula for H as a sum of harmonic oscillator Hamiltonians a j a j . Similarly, the Frobenius relations and the denition of H give H Y nn dim . Since there are nn / permutations S n lying in the conjugacy class , we may rewrite this as H Y, dim . Since dim the Frobenius relations give H .. An analysis of the eect of composing with all possible shows that either one cycle of will be broken into two cycles, or two will be joined to form one, giving the expression above for H in terms of annihilation and creation operators. We may interpret the Hamiltonian in terms of strings as follows. By eqn ., H can be regarded as a string tension term, since if we represent a string state n ,...,n k by lengthminimizing loops, it is an eigenvector of H with eigenvalue equal to n n k , proportional to the sum of the lengths of the loops. By eqn ., H corresponds to a twostring interaction as in Fig. . In this gure only the x coordinate is to be taken seriously the other has been introduced only to keep track of the identities of the strings. Also, we have switched to treating states as functions on the space of multiloops. As the gure indicates, this kind of interaction is a dimensional version of that which gave the HOMFLY invariant of links in dimensional space in the previous section. Here, however, we have a true Hamiltonian rather than a Hamiltonian constraint. Figure can also be regarded as two frames of a movie of a string worldsheet in dimensional spacetime. Similar movies have been used by Carter and Saito to describe string worldsheets in dimensional spacetime Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields . If we draw the string worldsheet corresponding to this movie we obtain a surface with a branch point. Indeed, in the path integral approach of Gross and Taylor this kind of term appears in the partition function as part of a sum over string histories, associated to those histories with branch points. They also show that the H term corresponds to string worldsheets with handles. When considering the /N expansion of the theory, it is convenient to divide the Hamiltonian H by N, so that it converges to H as N . Then the H term is proportional to /N . This is in accord with the observation by t Hooft that in an expansion of the free energy logarithm of the partition function as a power series in /N, string worldsheets of genus g give terms proportional to /N g . From the work of Gross and Taylor it is also clear that in addition to the space H spanned by righthanded string states one should also consider a space with a basis of lefthanded string states n ,...,n k with n i lt . The total Hilbert space of the string theory is then the tensor product H H of righthanded and lefthanded state spaces. This does not describe any new states in the YangMills theory per se, but it is more natural from the stringtheoretic point of view. It follows from the work of Minahan and Polychronakos that there is a Hamiltonian H on H H naturally described in terms of string interactions and a densely dened quotient map j H H L SUN inv such that Hj jH. Quantum gravity in dimensions Now let us turn to a more sophisticated model, dimensional quantum gravity. In dimensions, Einsteins equations say simply that the spacetime metric is at, so there are no local degrees of freedom. The theory is therefore only interesting on topologically nontrivial spacetimes. Interest in the mathematics of this theory increased when Witten reformulated it as a ChernSimons theory. Since then, many approaches to the subject have been developed, not all equivalent . We will follow Ashtekar, Husain, Rovelli, Samuel and Smolin , and treat dimensional quantum gravity using the new variables and the loop transform, and indicate some possible relations to string theory. It is important to note that there are some technical problems with the loop transform in Lorentzian quantum gravity, since the gauge group is then noncompact . These are presently being addressed by Ashtekar and Loll in the dimensional case, but for simplicity of presentation we will sidestep them by working with the Riemannian case, where the gauge group is SO. It is easiest to describe the various action principles for gravity using the abstract index notation popular in general relativity, but we will instead translate them into language that may be more familiar to mathematicians, since this seems not to have been done yet. In this section we describe the Witten action, applicable to the dimensional case in the next section John C. Baez we describe the Palatini action, which applies to any dimension, and the Ashtekar action, which applies to dimensions. The relationship between these action principles has been discussed rather thoroughly by Peldan . Let the spacetime M be an orientable manifold. Fix a real vector bundle T over M that is isomorphic tobut not canonically identied withthe tangent bundle TM, and x a Riemannian metric and an orientation on T . These dene a volume form on T , that is a nowhere vanishing section of T . The basic elds of the theory are then taken to be a metricpreserving connection A on T , or SO connection, together with a T valued form e on M. Using the isomorphism T T given by the metric, the curvature F of A may be identied with a T valued form. It follows that the wedge product e F may be dened as a T valued form. Pairing this with to obtain an ordinary form and then integrating over spacetime, we obtain the Witten action SA, e M e F. The classical equations of motion obtained by extremizing this action are F and d A e. Note that we can pull back the metric on E by e TM T to obtain a Riemannian metric on M, which, however, is only nondegenerate when e is an isomorphism. When e is an isomorphism we can also use it to pull back the connection to a metricpreserving connection on TM. In this case, the equations of motion say simply that this connection is the LeviCivita connection of the metric on M, and that the metric on M is at. The formalism involving the elds A and e can thus be regarded as a device for extending the usual Einstein equations in dimensions to the case of degenerate metrics on M. Now suppose that M R X, where X is a compact oriented manifold. The classical conguration and phase spaces and their reduction by gauge transformations are reminiscent of those for d YangMills theory. There are, however, a number of subtleties, and we only present the nal results. The classical conguration space can be taken as the space / of metricpreserving connections on T X, which we call SO connections on X. The classical phase space is then the cotangent bundle T /. Note that a tangent vector v T A / is a T valued form on X. We can thus regard a T valued form E on X as a cotangent vector by means of the pairing Ev X E v. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields Thus given any solution A, e of the classical equations of motion, we can pull back A and e to the surface X and get an SO connection and a T valued form on X, that is a point in the phase space T /. This is usually written A, E, where E plays a role analogous to the electric eld in YangMills theory. The classical equations of motion imply constraints on A, ET / which dene a reduced phase space. These are the Gauss law, which in this context is d A E, and the vanishing of the curvature B of the connection A on T X, which is analogous to the magnetic eld B. The latter constraint subsumes both the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints of the theory. The reduced phase space for the theory turns out to be T / /, where / is the space of at SO connections on X, and is the group of gauge transformations . As in d YangMills theory, it will be attractive to quantize after imposing constraints, taking the physical state space of the quantized theory to be L of the reduced conguration space, if we can nd a tractable description of / /. A quite concrete description of / / was given by Goldman . The moduli space T of at SObundles has two connected components, cor responding to the two isomorphism classes of SO bundles on M. The component corresponding to the bundle T X is precisely the space / /, so we wish to describe this component. There is a natural identication T Hom X, SO/AdSO, given by associating to any at bundle the holonomies around homotopy classes of loops. Suppose that X has genus g. Then the group X has a presentation with g generators x ,y ,...,x g ,y g satisfying the relation Rx i ,y i x y x y x g y g x g y g . An element of Hom X, SO may thus be identied with a collection u ,v ,...,u g ,v g of elements of SO, satisfying Ru i ,v i , and a point in T is an equivalence class u i ,v i of such collections. The two isomorphism classes of SO bundles on M are distinguished by their second StiefelWhitney number w Z . The bundle T X is trivial so w T X We can calculate w for any point u i ,v i T by the following method. For all the elements u i ,v i SO, choose lifts u i ,v i John C. Baez to the universal cover SO SU. Then w Ru i ,v i . It follows that we may think of points of / / as equivalence classes of gtuples u i ,v i of elements of SO admitting lifts u i ,v i with Ru i ,v i , where the equivalence relation is given by the adjoint action of SO. In fact / / is not a manifold, but a singular variety. This has been investigated by Narasimhan and Seshadri , and shown to be dimension d g for g , or d for g the case g is trivial and will be excluded below. As noted, it is natural to take L / / to be the physical state space, but to dene this one must choose a measure on / /. As noted by Goldman , there is a symplectic structure on / / coming from the following form on / B, C X TrB C, in which we identify the tangent vectors B, C with EndT Xvalued forms. The dfold wedge product denes a measure on / /, the Liouville measure. On the grounds of elegance and dieomorphism invariance it is customary to use this measure to dene the physical state space L / /. It would be satisfying if there were a stringtheoretic interpretation of the inner product in L / / along the lines of Section . Note that we may dene string states in this space as follows. Given any loop in X, the Wilson loop observable T is a multiplication operator on L / / that only depends on the homotopy class of . As in the case of d Yang Mills theory, we can form elements of L / / by applying products of these operators to the function , so given ,..., k X, dene ,..., k T T k . The rst step towards a stringtheoretic interpretation of d quantum grav ity would be a formula for an inner product of string states ,..., k t ,..., t k , which is just a particular kind of integral over / /. Note that this sort of integral makes sense when / / is the moduli space of at connections for a trivial SON bundle over X, for any N. Alternatively, one could formulate d quantum gravity as a theory of SU connections and then generalize to SUN. In fact, it appears that this sort of integral can be computed using d YangMills theory on a Riemann surface, by introducing a coupling Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields constant in the action SA M TrF F, computing the appropriate vacuum expectation value of Wilson loops, and then taking the limit . This procedure has been discussed by Blau and Thompson and Witten . One thus expects that this sort of integral simplies in the N limit just as it does in d YangMills theory, giving a formula for ,..., k t ,..., t k as a sum over ambient isotopy classes of surfaces f , t X having the loops i , t i as boundaries. This, together with a method of treating the nite N case by imposing Mandelstam identities, would give a string theoretic interpretation of d quantum gravity. Taylor and the author are currently trying to work out the details of this program. Before concluding this section, it is worth noting another generally co variant gauge theory in dimensions, ChernSimons theory. Here one xes an arbitrary Lie group G and a Gbundle P M over spacetime, and the eld of the theory is a connection A on P. The action is given by SA k Tr A dA AAA . As noted by Witten , d quantum gravity as we have described it is essentially the same ChernSimons theory with gauge group ISO, the Euclidean group in dimension, with the SO connection and triad eld appearing as two parts of an ISO connection. There is a profound con nection between ChernSimons theory and knot theory, rst demonstrated by Witten , and then elaborated by many researchers see, for example, . This theory does not quite t our formalism because in it the space / / of at connections modulo gauge transformations plays the role of a phase space, with the Goldman symplectic structure, rather than a cong uration space. Nonetheless, there are a number of clues that ChernSimons theory admits a reformulation as a generally covariant string eld theory. In fact, Witten has given such an interpretation using open strings and the BatalinVilkovisky formalism . Moreover, for the gauge groups SUN Periwal has expressed the partition function for ChernSimons theory on S , in the N limit, in terms of integrals over moduli spaces of Rie mann surfaces. In the case N there is also, as one would expect, an expression for the vacuum expectation value of Wilson loops, at least for the case of a link where it is just the Kauman bracket invariant, in terms of a sum over surfaces having that link as boundary . It would be very worth while to reformulate ChernSimons theory as a string theory at the level of elegance with which one can do so for d YangMills theory, but John C. Baez this has not yet been done. Quantum gravity in dimensions We begin by describing the Palatini and Ashtekar actions for general rela tivity. As in the previous section, we will sidestep certain problems with the loop transformby working with Riemannian rather than Lorentzian gravity. We shall then discuss some recent work on making the loop representation rigorous in this case, and indicate some mathematical issues that need to be explored to arrive at a stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory. Let the spacetime M be an orientable nmanifold. Fix a bundle T over M that is isomorphic to TM, and x a Riemannian metric and orientation on T . These dene a nowherevanishing section of n T . The basic elds of the theory are then taken to be a metricpreserving connection A on T , or SOn connection, and a T valued form e. We require, however, that e TM T be a bundle isomorphism its inverse is called a frame eld. The metric denes an isomorphism T T and allows us to identify the curvature F of A with a section of the bundle T T M. We may also regard e as a section of T TM and dene e e in the obvious manner as a section of the bundle T TM. The natural pairing between these bundles gives rise to a function Fe e on M. Using the isomorphism e, we can push forward to a volume form on M. The Palatini action for Riemannian gravity is then SA, e M Fe e . We may use the isomorphism e to transfer the metric and connection A to a metric and connection on the tangent bundle. Then the classical equations of motion derived from the Palatini action say precisely that this connection is the LeviCivita connection of the metric, and that the metric satises the vacuum Einstein equations i.e. is Ricci at. In dimensions, the Palatini action reduces to the Witten action, which, however, is expressed in terms of e rather than e . In dimensions the Palatini action can be rewritten in a somewhat similar form. Namely, the wedge product e e F is a T valued form, and pairing it with to obtain an ordinary form we have SA, e M e e F. The Ashtekar action depends upon the fact that in dimensions the Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields metric and orientation on T dene a Hodge star operator T T with not to be confused with the Hodge star operator on dierential forms. This allows us to write F as a sum F F of selfdual and anti selfdual parts F F . The remarkable fact is that the action SA, e M eeF gives the same equations of motion as the Palatini action. Moreover, sup pose T is trivial, as is automatically the case when M RX. Then F is just an sovalued form on M, and its decomposition into selfdual and antiselfdual parts corresponds to the decomposition so soso. Similarly, A is an sovalued form, and may thus be written as a sum A A of selfdual and antiselfdual connections, which are forms having values in the two copies of so. It is easy to see that F is the curvature of A . This allows us to regard general relativity as the theory of a selfdual connection A and a T valued form ethe socalled new variableswith the Ashtekar action SA ,e M eeF . Now suppose that M R X, where X is a compact oriented manifold. We can take the classical conguration space to be space / of righthanded connections on T X, or equivalently xing a trivialization of T , sovalued forms on X. A tangent vector v T A / is thus an so valued form, and an sovalued form E denes a cotangent vector by the pairing Ev X Tr E v. A point in the classical phase space T / is thus a pair A, E consisting of an sovalued form A and an sovalued form E on X. In the physics literature it is more common to use the natural isomorphism T X TX T X given by the interior product to regard the gravitational electric eld E as an sovalued vector density, that is, a section of so TX T X. A solution A , e of the classical equations of motion determines a point A, ET / as follows. The gravitational vector potential A is simply the pullback of A to the surface X. Obtaining E from e is John C. Baez a somewhat subtler aair. First, split the bundle T as the direct sum of a dimensional bundle T and a line bundle. By restricting to TX and then projecting down to T X, the map e TM T gives a map e TX T X, called a cotriad eld on X. Since there is a natural isomorphism of the bers of T with so, we may also regard this as an sovalued form on X. Applying the Hodge star operator we obtain the sovalued form E. The classical equations of motion imply constraints on A, ET /. These are the Gauss law d A E, and the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints. The latter two are most easily expressed if we treat E as an sovalued vector density. Let ting B denote the gravitational magnetic eld, or curvature of the con nection A, the dieomorphism constraint is given by Tr i E B and the Hamiltonian constraint is given by Tr i E i E B. Here the interior product i E B is dened using matrix multiplication and is an M R T Xvalued form similarly, i E i E B is an M R T X T Xvalued function. In d YangMills theory and d quantum gravity one can impose enough constraints before quantizing to obtain a nitedimensional reduced con guration space, namely the space / / of at connections modulo gauge transformations. In d quantum gravity this is no longer the case, so a more sophisticated strategy, rst devised by Rovelli and Smolin , is re quired. Let us rst sketch this without mentioning the formidable technical problems. The Gauss law constraint generates gauge transformations, so one forms the reduced phase space T //. Quantizing, one obtains the kinematical Hilbert space H kin L //. One then applies the loop transform and takes H kin Fun/ to be a space of functions of multi loops in X. The dieomorphism constraint generates the action of Di X on //, so in the quantum theory one takes H diff to be the subspace of Di Xinvariant elements of Fun/. One may then either attempt to represent the Hamiltonian constraint as operators on H kin , and dene the image of their common kernel in H diff to be the physical state space H phys , or attempt to represent the Hamiltonian constraint directly as operators Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields on H diff and dene the kernel to be H phys . The latter approach is still under development by Rovelli and Smolin . Even at this formal level, the full space H phys has not yet been de termined. In their original work, Rovelli and Smolin obtained a large set of physical states corresponding to ambient isotopy classes of links in X. More recently, physical states have been constructed from familiar link invariants such as the Kauman bracket and certain coecients of the Alexander polynomial to all of /. Some recent developments along these lines have been reviewed by Pullin . This approach makes use of the connection between d quantum gravity with cosmological constant and ChernSimons theory in dimensions. It is this work that suggests a profound connection between knot theory and quantum gravity. There are, however, signicant problems with turning all of this work into rigorous mathematics, so at this point we shall return to where we left o in Section and discuss some of the diculties. In Section we were quite naive concerning many details of analysisdeliberately so, to indicate the basic ideas without becoming immersed in technicalities. In particular, one does not really expect to have interesting dieomorphisminvariant measures on the space // of connections modulo gauge transformations in this case. At best, one expects the existence of generalized measures sucient for integrating a limited class of functions. In fact, it is possible to go a certain distance without becoming involved with these considerations. In particular, the loop transform can be rigor ously dened without xing a measure or generalized measure on // if one uses, not the Hilbert space formalism of the previous section, but a Calgebraic formalism. A Calgebra is an algebra A over the complex numbers with a norm and an adjoint or operation satisfying a a, a a ,ab a b , ab b a , ab ab, a aa for all a, b in the algebra and C. In the Calgebraic approach to physics, observables are represented by selfadjoint elements of A, while states are elements of the dual A that are positive, a a , and normalized, . The number a then represents the expectation value of the observable a in the state . The relation to the more tradi tional Hilbert space approach to quantum physics is given by the Gelfand NaimarkSegal GNS construction. Namely, a state on A denes an inner product that may, however, be degenerate a, b a b. Let I A denote the subspace of normzero states. Then A/I has an honest inner product and we let H denote the Hilbert space completion of A/I in the corresponding norm. It is then easy to check that I is a left John C. Baez ideal of A, so that A acts by left multiplication on A/I, and that this action extends uniquely to a representation of A as bounded linear operators on H. In particular, observables in A give rise to selfadjoint operators on H. A Calgebraic approach to the loop transform and generalized mea sures on // was introduced by Ashtekar and Isham in the context of SU gauge theory, and subsequently developed by Ashtekar, Lewandow ski, and the author , . The basic concept is that of the holonomy Calgebra. Let X be a manifold, space, and let P X be a princi pal Gbundle over X. Let / denote the space of smooth connections on P, and the group of smooth gauge transformations. Fix a nitedimensional representation of G and dene Wilson loop functions T T, on // taking traces in this representation. Dene the holonomy algebra to be the algebra of functions on // generated by the functions T T, . If we assume that G is compact and is unitary, the functions T are bounded and continuous in the C topology on //. Moreover, the pointwise complex conjugate T equals T , where is the orientationreversed loop. We may thus complete the holonomy algebra in the sup norm topology f sup A,/ fA and obtain a Calgebra of bounded continuous functions on //, the holonomy Calgebra, which we denote as Fun// in order to make clear the relation to the previous section. While in what follows we will assume that G is compact and is unitary, it is important to emphasize that for Lorentzian quantum gravity G is not compact This presents important problems in the loop representation of both and dimensional quantum gravity. Some progress in solving these problems has recently been made by Ashtekar, Lewandowski, and Loll , , . Recall that in the previous section the loop transform of functions on // was dened using a measure on //. It turns out to be more natural to dene the loop transform not on Fun// but on its dual, as this involves no arbitrary choices. Given Fun// we dene its loop transform to be the function on the space / of multiloops given by ,..., n T T n . Let Fun/ denote the range of the loop transform. In favorable cases, such as G SUN and the fundamental representation, the loop trans form is onetoone, so Fun// Fun/. This is the real justication for the term string eld/gauge eld duality. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields We may take the generalized measures on // to be simply ele ments Fun// , thinking of the pairing f as the integral of f Fun//. If is a state on Fun//, we may construct the kine matical Hilbert space H kin using the GNS construction. Note that the kinematical inner product f, g kin f g then generalizes the L inner product used in the previous section. Note that a choice of generalized measure also allows us to dene the loop transform as a linear map from Fun// to Fun/ f ,..., n T T n f in a manner generalizing that of the previous section. Moreover, there is a unique inner product on Fun/ such that this map extends to a map from H kin to the Hilbert space completion of Fun/. Note also that Di X acts on Fun// and dually on Fun// . The kinematical Hilbert space constructed from a Di Xinvariant state Fun// thus becomes a unitary representation of Di X. It is thus of considerable interest to nd a more concrete description of Di Xinvariant states on the holonomy Calgebra Fun//. In fact, it is not immediately obvious that any exist, in general For technical reasons, the most progress has been made in the realanalytic case. That is, we take X to be real analytic, Di X to consist of the realanalytic dieomor phisms connected to the identity, and Fun// to be the holonomy C algebra generated by realanalytic loops. Here Ashtekar and Lewandowski have constructed a Di Xinvariant state on Fun// that is closely analogous to the Haar measure on a compact group . They have also given a general characterization of such dieomorphisminvariant states. The latter was also given by the author , using a slightly dierent for malism, who also constructed many more examples of Di Xinvariant states on Fun//. There is thus some real hope that the loop represen tation of generally covariant gauge theories can be made rigorous in cases other than the toy models of the previous two sections. We conclude with some speculative remarks concerning d quantum gravity and tangles. The correct inner product on the physical Hilbert space of d quantum gravity has long been quite elusive. A path integral formula for the inner product has been investigated recently by Rovelli , but there is as yet no manifestly welldened expression along these lines. On the other hand, an inner product for relative states of quantum gravity in the Kauman bracket state has been rigorously constructed by the author , but there are still many questions about the physics here. The example of d YangMills theory would suggest an expression for the John C. Baez inner product of string states ,..., n t ,..., t n as a sum over ambient isotopy classes of surfaces f , t X having the loops i , t i as boundaries. In the case of embeddings, such surfaces are known as tangles, and have been intensively investigated by Carter and Saito using the technique of movies. The relationships between tangles, string theory, and the loop rep resentation of d quantum gravity are tantalizing but still rather obscure. For example, just as the Reidemeister moves relate any two pictures of the same tangle in dimensions, there are a set of movie moves relating any two movies of the same tangle in dimensions. These moves give a set of equations whose solutions would give tangle invariants. For example, the analog of the YangBaxter equation is the Zamolodchikov equation, rst derived in the context of string theory . These equations can be understood in terms of category theory, since just as tangles form a braided tensor category, tangles form a braided tensor category . It is thus quite signicant that Crane has initiated an approach to generally co variant eld theory in dimensions using braided tensor categories. This approach also claries some of the signicance of conformal eld theory for dimensional physics, since braided tensor categories can be con structed from certain conformal eld theories. In a related development, CottaRamusino and Martellini have endeavored to construct tangle invariants from generally covariant gauge theories, much as tangle invari ants may be constructed using ChernSimons theory. Clearly it will be some time before we are able to appraise the signicance of all this work, and the depth of the relationship between string theory and the loop rep resentation of quantum gravity. Acknowledgements I would like to thank Abhay Ashtekar, Scott Axelrod, Matthias Blau, Scott Carter, Paolo CottaRamusino, Louis Crane, Jacob Hirbawi, Jerzy Lewandowski, Renate Loll, Maurizio Martellini, Jorge Pullin, Holger Niel sen, and Lee Smolin for useful discussions. Wati Taylor deserves special thanks for explaining his work on YangMills theory to me. Also, I would like to thank the Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry as a whole for inviting me to speak on this subject. Bibliography . A. Ashtekar, New variables for classical and quantum gravity, Phys. Rev. Lett. . New Hamiltonian formulation of general relativity, Phys. Rev. D . Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields Lectures on Nonperturbative Canonical Quantum Gravity, Singa pore, World Scientic, . . A. Ashtekar, unpublished notes, June . . A. Ashtekar and C. J. Isham, Representations of the holonomy alge bra of gravity and nonabelian gauge theories, Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . . A. Ashtekar and J. Lewandowski, Completeness of Wilson loop func tionals on the moduli space of SL, C and SU, connections, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Representation theory of analytic holonomy CAlgebras, this vol ume. . A. Ashtekar and R. Loll, New loop representations for gravity, Syracuse U. preprint. . A. Ashtekar, V. Husain, C. Rovelli, J. Samuel, and L. Smolin, gravity as a toy model for the theory, Classical amp Quantum Gravity LL. . M. Atiyah, The Geometry and Physics of Knots, Cambridge U. Press, Cambridge, . . M. Atiyah and R. Bott, The YangMills equations over Riemann surfaces, Phil. Trans. R. Soc. A . . J. Baez, Quantum gravity and the algebra of tangles, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . . J. Baez, Dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations, to appear in the proceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology, eds L. Crane and D. Yetter, hepth/. Link invariants, functional integration, and holonomy algebras, U. C. Riverside preprint, hepth/. . M. Blau and G. Thompson, Topological gauge theories of antisym metric tensor elds, Ann. Phys. . Quantum YangMills theory on arbitrary surfaces, Int. J. Mod. Phys. A . . S. Carlip, Six ways to quantize dimensional gravity, U. C. Davis preprint, grqc/. . J. S. Carter, How Surfaces Intersect in Space an Introduction to Topology, World Scientic, Singapore, . . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, Reidemeister moves for surface isotopies and their interpretation as moves to movies, U. of South Alabama preprint. Knotted surfaces, braid movies, and beyond, this volume. . P. CottaRamusino and M. Martellini, BF theories and knots, this John C. Baez volume. . L. Crane, Topological eld theory as the key to quantum gravity, this volume. . M. Douglas, Conformal eld theory techniques for large N group theory, Rutgers U. preprint, hepth/. . B. Driver, YM continuum expectations, lattice convergence, and lassos, Commun. Math. Phys. . . D. Fine, Quantum YangMills on a Riemann surface, Commun. Math. Phys. . . J. Fischer, categories and knots, Yale U. preprint, Feb. . . P. Freyd, D. Yetter, J. Hoste, W. Lickorish, K. Millett, and A. Ocneanu, A new polynomial invariant for links, Bull. Am. Math. Soc. . . R. Gambini and A. Trias, Gauge dynamics in the Crepresentation, Nucl. Phys. B . . J. Gervais and A. Neveu, The quantum dual string wave functional in YangMills theories, Phys. Lett. B , . . F. Gliozzi and M. Virasoro, The interaction among dual strings as a manifestation of the gauge group, Nucl. Phys. B . . W. Goldman, The symplectic nature of fundamental groups of sur faces, Adv. Math. . Invariant functions on Lie groups and Hamiltonian ows of surface group representations, Invent. Math. . Topological components of spaces of representations, Invent. Math. . . D. Gross, Two dimensional QCD as a string theory, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Dec. , hepth/. . D. Gross and W. Taylor IV, Two dimensional QCD is a string theory, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Jan. , hepth/. Twists and Wilson loops in the string theory of two dimensional QCD, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Jan. , hepth/. . L. Gross, C. King, and A. Sengupta, Twodimensional YangMills theory via stochastic dierential equations, Ann. Phys. . . G. Horowitz, Exactly soluble dieomorphisminvariant theories, Commun. Math. Phys. . . A. Jevicki, Loopspace representation and the largeN behavior of the oneplaquette KogutSusskind Hamiltonian, Phys. Rev. D . . L. Kauman, Knots and Physics, World Scientic, Singapore, . Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields . V. Kazakov, Wilson loop average for an arbitrary contour in two dimensional UN gauge theory, Nuc. Phys. B . . R. Loll, J. Mour ao, and J. Tavares, Complexication of gauge the ories, Syracuse U. preprint, hepth/. . Y. Makeenko and A. Migdal, Quantum chromodynamics as dynam ics of loops, Nucl. Phys. B . Loop dynamics asymptotic freedom and quark connement, Sov. J. Nucl. Phys. . . D. Marolf, Loop representations for gravity on a torus, Syracuse U. preprint, March , grqc/. An illustration of gravity loop transform troubles, Syracuse U. preprint, May , grqc/. . A. Migdal, Recursion equations in gauge eld theories, Sov. Phys. JETP . . J. Minahan, Summing over inequivalent maps in the string theory interpretation of two dimensional QCD, U. of Virginia preprint, hep th/ . J. Minahan and A. Polychronakos, Equivalence of two dimensional QCD and the c matrix model, U. of Virginia preprint, hep th/. . S. Naculich, H. Riggs, and H. Schnitzer, Twodimensional Yang Mills theories are string theories, Brandeis U. preprint, hep th/. . Y. Nambu, QCD and the string model, Phys. Lett. B . . M. Narasimhan and C. Seshadri, Stable and unitary vector bundles on a compact Riemann surface, Ann. Math. . . M. Nomura, A soluble nonlinear Bose eld as a dynamical manifes tation of symmetric group characters and Young diagrams, Phys. Lett. A . . P. Peldan, Actions for gravity, with generalizations a review, U. of Goteborg preprint, May , grqc/. . V. Periwal, ChernSimons theory as topological closed string, Insti tute for Advanced Studies preprint. . A. Polyakov, Gauge elds as rings of glue, Nucl. Phys. B . Gauge elds and strings, Harwood Academic Publishers, New York, . . J. Pullin, Knot theory and quantum gravity in loop space a primer, to appear in Proc. of the Vth Mexican School of Particles and Fields, ed J. L. Lucio, World Scientic, Singapore preprint available as John C. Baez hepth/. . S. Rajeev, YangMills theory on a cylinder, Phys. Lett. B . . C. Rovelli, The basis of the PonzanoReggeTuraevViroOoguri model is the loop representation basis, Pittsburgh U. preprint, April , hepth/. . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Loop representation for quantum general relativity, Nucl. Phys. B . . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, The physical hamiltonian in non perturbative quantum gravity, Pennsylania State U. preprint, Au gust , grqc/. . B. Rusakov, Loop averages and partition functions in UN gauge theory on twodimensional manifolds, Mod. Phys. Lett. A . . G. t Hooft, A twodimensional model for mesons, Nucl. Phys. B . . E. Witten, dimensional gravity as an exactly soluble system, Nucl. Phys. B . . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Com mun. Math. Phys. , . . E. Witten, On quantum gauge theories in two dimensions, Commun. Math. Phys. . Localization in gauge theories, Lectures at MIT, February . . E. Witten, ChernSimons gauge theory as a string theory, to ap pear in the Floer Memorial Volume, Institute for Advanced Studies preprint, . . A. Zamolodchikov, Tetrahedron equations and the relativistic S Matrix of straightstrings in dimensions, Commun. Math. Phys. . . B. Zwiebach, Closed string eld theory an introduction, MIT preprint, May , hepth/. BF Theories and knots Paolo CottaRamusino Dipartimento di Fisica, Universit a di Trento and INFN, Sezione di Milano, Via Celoria , Milano, Italy email cottamilano.infn.it Maurizio Martellini Dipartimento di Fisica, Universit a di Milano and INFN, Sezione di Pavia, Via Celoria , Milano, Italy email martellinimilano.infn.it Abstract We discuss the relations between topological quantum eld theo ries in dimensions and the theory of knots embedded spheres in a manifold. The socalled BF theories allow the construction of quantum operators whose trace can be considered as the higher dimensional generalization of Wilson lines for knots in dimensions. Firstorder perturbative calculations lead to higherdimensional link ing numbers, and it is possible to establish a heuristic relation be tween BF theories and Alexander invariants. Functional integration byparts techniques allow the recovery of an innitesimal version of the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation, in the form considered by Carter and Saito. Introduction In a seminal work, Witten has shown that there is a very deep connection between invariants of knots and links in a manifold and the quantum ChernSimons eld theory. One of the questions that is possible to ask is whether there exists an analog of Wittens ideas in higher dimensions. After all, knots and links are dened in any dimension as embeddings of kspheres into a k dimensional space, and topological quantum eld theories exist in dimensions , . The question, unfortunately, is not easy to answer. On one hand, the theory of higherdimensional knots and links is much less developed the relevant invariants are, for the time being, more scarce than in the theory of ordinary knots and links. As far as dimensional topological eld theories are concerned, only the general BRST structure has been thor oughly discussed perturbative calculations, at least in the nonAbelian Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini case, do not appear to have been carried out. Even the quantum observ ables have not been clearly dened in the nonAbelian case. Moreover, ChernSimons theory in dimensions beneted greatly from the results of dimensional conformal eld theory. No analogous help is available for dimensional topological eld theories. In this paper we make some preliminary considerations and proposals concerning knots and topological eld theories of the BF type. Speci cally we propose a set of quantum observables associated to surfaces em bedded in space. These observables can be seen as a generalization of ordinary Wilson lines in dimensions. Moreover, the framework in which these observables are dened ts with the picture of knots as movies of ordinary links or link diagrams considered by Carter and Saito see references below. It is also possible to nd heuristic arguments that may relate the expectation values of our observables in the BF theory with the Alexander invariants of knots. As far as perturbative calculations are concerned, they are much more complicated than in the lowerdimensional case. Nevertheless it is pos sible to recover a relation between rstorder calculations and higher dimensional linking numbers, which parallels a similar relation for ordinary links in a dimensional space. Finally, in dimensions it is also possible to apply functional integration byparts techniques. In this case, these techniques produce a solution of an innitesimal Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation, consistent with the proposal made by Carter, Saito, and Lawrence. BF theories and their geometrical signicance We start by considering a dimensional Riemannian manifold M, a com pact Lie group G, and a principal bundle PM, G over M. If A denotes a connection on such a bundle, then its curvature will be denoted by F A or simply by F. The space of all connections will be denoted by the symbol / and the group of gauge transformations by the symbol . The group G, with Lie algebra LieG, will be, in most cases, the group SUn or SOn. Looking for possible topological actions for a dimensional manifold, we may consider , the Gibbs measures of the . Chern action exp M Tr FF ,. . BF action exp M Tr BF .. In the formulae above and are coupling constants, is a given represen BF Theories and knots tation of the group G and of its Lie algebra. The curvature F is a form on M with values in the associated bundle P Ad LieG or, equivalently, a tensorial form on P with values in LieG. The eld B in eqn . is assumed classically to be a form of the same nature as F. We shall see, though, that the quantization procedure may force B to take values in the universal enveloping algebra of LieG. It is then convenient to discuss the geometrical aspects of a more general BF theory, where B is assumed to be a form on M with values in the associated bundle P Ad G where G is the universal enveloping algebra of LieG. In other words B is a section of the bundle T MP Ad G. The space of forms with values in P Ad G will be denoted by the sym bol M, adP this space naturally contains M, adP, the space of forms with values in P Ad LieG. In order to obtain an ordinary form on M from an element of M, adP, one needs to take the trace with respect to a given represen tation of LieG. Notice that the wedge product for forms in M, adP is obtained by combining the product in G with the exterior product for ordinary forms. We now mention some examples of Belds that have a nice geometrical meaning . Let LM M be the frame bundle and let be the soldering form. It is an R n valued form, given by the identity map on the tangent space of M. For any given metric g we consider the reduced SOn bundle of orthonormal frames O g M. A vielbein in physics is dened as the R n valued form on M given by , for a given section MO g M. We now dene the form B M, adO g M as B T OgM , where T denotes transposition. In the corresponding BF action, the curvature F is the curvature of a connection in the orthonormal frame bundle O g M. This action is known to be classically equivalent to the Einstein action, written in the vielbein formalism. . The manifold / is an ane space with underlying vector space M, adP. We denote by the form on / given by the iden tity map on the tangent space of /, i.e. on M, adP. From this we can obtain the form on / B,. with values in M, adP. More explicitly, B can be dened as Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini Ba, bX, Y p,A aXbY aY bX bXaY bY aX, . where a, b T A / X, Y T p P. We now want to show that the BF action considered in the last example is connected with the ABJ AdlerBellJackiw anomaly in dimensions. On the principal Gbundle P/M/. we can consider the tautological connection dened by the following hori zontal distribution Hor p,A Hor A p T A /. where Hor A p denotes the horizontal space at p P with respect to the connection A. The connection form of the tautological connection is given simply by A, seen as a ,form on P /. Its curvature form is given by T p,A F A p A .. Let us now use Q l to denote an irreducible adinvariant polynomial on LieG with l entries. Integrating the ChernWeil forms corresponding to such polynomials over M we obtain for l , , M Q T, T k M Tr F A F A . M Q T, T, T k M Tr BF A . M Q T, T, T, T k M Tr BB. where B is dened as in eqns . and ., and k l are normalization factors. In eqn . the wedge product also includes the exterior product of forms on /. As Atiyah and Singer pointed out, one can consider together with BF Theories and knots . the following principal Gbundle P/ M / .. Any connection on the bundle / // determines a connection on the bundle . and hence on the bundle .. When we consider such a connection on . instead of the tautological one, then the lefthand side of eqn . becomes the term which generates, via the socalled descent equation, the ABJ anomaly in dimensions , . Hence the BF action . is a sort of gaugexed version of the generating term for the ABJ anomaly. In any BF action one has to integrate forms dened on M /. Hence we can consider dierent kinds of symmetries , . connection invariance this refers to forms on M / which are closed when they are integrated over cycles of M, they give closed forms on /. . gauge invariance this refer to forms which are dened over M /, but are pullbacks of forms dened over M / . . dieomorphism invariance this can be considered whenever we have an action of DiM over P and over /. In particular we can consider dieomorphism invariance when P is a trivial bundle, or when P is the bundle of linear frames over M. In the latter case P/ DiM M/ DiM . is a principal bundle . . dieomorphism/gauge invariance this refers to the action of AutP, i.e. the full group of automorphisms of the principal bundle P in cluding the automorphisms which do not induce the identity map on the base manifold. This kind of invariance implies gauge invariance and dieomorphism invariance when the latter is dened. For instance, the Chern action . is both connection and dieomor phism/gauge invariant, while the BF action . is gauge invariant and its connection invariance depends on further specications. In particular the BF action of example is connection invariant, while the action of Strictly speaking, in this case, one should consider either the space of irreducible connections and the gauge group, divided by its center, or the space of all connections and the group of gauge transformations which give the identity when restricted to a xed point of M. We always assume that one of the above choices is made. In fact one should really consider only the group of dieomorphisms of M which strongly x one point of M. Also, instead of LM A it is possible to consider O M A metric , namely the space of all orthonormal frames paired with the corresponding metric connections see e.g. . Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini example is not. More precisely, in example , the integrand of the BF action denes a closed form on O g M /, i.e. we have , M Tr F T OgM only when the covariant derivative d A is zero in other words, the critical connections are the LeviCivita connections. When B is given by ., then for any cycle in M Tr B Q TT is a closed form on / and so we have a map Z MZ /, . where Z Z denotes cycles cocycles. When we replace the curva ture of the tautological connection with the curvature of a connection in the bundle ., then we again obtain a map ., but now this map descends to a map H MH / .. The map . is the basis for the construction of the Donaldson polyno mials . As a nal remark we would like to mention BF theories in arbitrary dimensions. When M is a manifold of dimension d, then we can take the eld B to be a d form, again with values in the bundle P Ad G. The form . then makes perfect sense in any dimension. A special situation occurs when the group G is SOd. In this case there is a linear isomorphism R d LieSOd, . dened by e i e j E i j E j i , where e i is the canonical basis of R d and E i j is the matrix with entries E i j m n m,i n,j . The isomorphism . has the following properties . It is an isomorphism of inner product spaces, when the inner product in LieSOd is given by A, B /TrAB. . The left action of SOd on R n corresponds to the adjoint action on LieSOd. One can then consider a principal SOdbundle and an associated bundle E with ber R d . In this special case we can consider a dierent kind of BF theory, where the eld B is assumed to be a d form with values BF Theories and knots in the d th exterior power of E. In this case the corresponding BF action is given by exp M BF ,. where the wedge product combines the wedge product of forms on M with the wedge product in R d . The action . is invariant under gauge transformations. When the SOdbundle is the orthonormal bundle and the eld B is the d th exterior power of the soldering form, then the corresponding BF action . gives the classical action for gravity in d dimensions, in the socalled Palatini rstorder formalism , . knots and their quantum observables In WittenChernSimons theory we have a topological action on a dimensional manifold M , and the observables correspond to knots or links in M . More precisely to each knot we associate the trace of the holonomy along the knot in a xed representation of the group G, or Wilson line. In dimensions we have at our disposal the Lagrangians considered at the beginning of the previous section. It is natural to con sider as observables, quantities higherdimensional Wilson lines related to knots. Let us recall here that while an ordinary knot is a sphere embedded in S or R , a knot is a sphere embedded in S or in the space R . A generalized knot in a dimensional closed manifold M can be dened as a closed surface embedded in M. Two knots generalized or not will be called equivalent if they can be mapped into each other by a dieomorphism connected to the identity of the ambient manifold M. The theory of knots and links is less developed than the theory of ordinary knots and links. For instance, it is not known whether one can have an analogue of the Jones polynomial for knots. On the other hand, one can dene Alexander invariants for knots see e.g. . The problem we would like to address here is whether there exists a connection between dimensional eld theories and invariants of knots. Namely, we would like to ask whether there exists a generalization to dimensions of the connection established by Witten between topological eld theories and knot invariants in dimensions. Even though we are not able to show rigorously that a consistent set of nontrivial invariants for knots can be constructed out of dimensional eld theories, we can show that there exists a connection between BF theories in dimensions and knots. This connection involves, in dierent places, the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation as well as selflinking and higherdimensional linking numbers. In Wittens theory one has to perform functional integration upon an observable depending on the given ordinary knot in the given manifold Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini with respect to a topological Lagrangian. Here we want to do something similar, namely we want to perform functional integration upon dierent observables depending on a given embedded surface in M with respect to a path integral measure given by the BF action. The rst classical observable we want to consider is Tr exp HolA, y,x ByHolA, z,y ,y.. Here by HolA, y,x we mean the holonomy with respect to the connection A along the path joining two given points y and x belonging to . Expression . has the following properties . It depends on the choice of a map assigning to each y a path joining x and z and passing through y more precisely, it depends on the holonomies along such paths. One expects that the functional integral over the space of all connections will integrate out this de pendency. More precisely, we recall that the functional measure over the space of connections is given, up to a Jacobian determinant, by the measure over the paths over which the holonomy is computed. See in this regard the analysis of the WessZuminoWitten model made by Polyakov and Wiegmann . . It is gauge invariant if we consider only gauge transformations that are the identity at the points x and z. In the special case when z and x coincide, then . is gauge invariant without any restriction. The functional integral of . can be seen as the vacuum expectation value of the trace in the representation of the quantum surface operator denoted by O x, z. In other words we set O x, z exp HolA, y,x ByHolA, z,y ,y,. where, in order to avoid a cumbersome notation, we did not write the ex plicit dependence on the paths , and we did not use dierent symbols for the holonomy and its quantum counterpart quantum holonomy. More over, in . a timeordering symbol has to be understood. Note that we will also allow the operator . to be dened for any embedded surface closed or with boundary. In the latter case the points x and z are always supposed to belong to the boundary. As far as the role of the paths considered above is concerned, we recall that, in a dimensional theory with knots, a framing is a smooth assignment of a tangent vector to each point of the knot. In dimensions, We assume to have chosen once and for all a reference section for the trivial bundle P . Hence the holonomy along a path is dened by the comparison of the horizontally lifted path and the path lifted through the reference section. BF Theories and knots instead, we assign a curve to each point of the knot. We will refer to this assignment as a higherdimensional framing. We will also speak of a framed knot. Gauss constraints In order to study the quantum theory corresponding to ., we rst con sider the canonical quantization approach. We take the group G to be SUn and consider its fundamental representation hence we write the eld B as B a B a R a . Here B is a multiple of and R a is an or thonormal basis of k G. In the BF action we can disregard the B component of the eld B. We choose a time direction t and write in local coordinates t, x t, x ,x ,x dd t d x ,AA dt A x A dt A i dx i i,,, F A i d t A i dx i d x A dt i A i ,A dx i dt iltj F ij dx i dx j B iltj B ij dx i dx j B i dt dx i . In local coordinates the action is given by L M TrB F A . M I i,j,k TrB ij d t A k B i F jk dt A DB ijk dx i dx j dx k , where D denotes the covariant dimensional derivative with respect to the connection A x . We rst consider the pure BF theory, namely, a BF theory where no embedded surface is considered. We perform a Legendre transformation for the Lagrangian L the conjugate momenta to the elds B i and A , namely L t B i and L t A , are zero, so we have the primary constraints L B i j,k ijk F Ax jk , L A i,j,k ijk DB ijk .. We do not have secondary constraints since the Hamiltonian is zero hence the time evolution is trivial. At the formal quantum level the constraints . will be written as F Ax op physical , DB op physical ,. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini where op stands for operator and the vectors physical span the physical Hilbert space of the theory. We now consider the expectation value of Tr O x, x see denition .. We still want to work in the canonical formalism the result will be that instead of the constraints . and ., we will have a source represented by the assigned surface . In order to represent the surface operator . as a source action term to be added to the BF action, we assume that we have a current singular form J sing , concentrated on the surface , of the form J sing a J a sing R a . Thus J sing can take values in G, but has no component in C G. We are now in a position to write the operator . as O z, z exp M TrHolA, y,z ByHolA, z,y J sing ,. where for any A, B G, A a A a R a ,B a B a R a , we have set TrAB a A a B a . From . it follows that the component of J sing in LieG does not give any signicant contribution. We now assume J sing G. In this way we neglect possible higherorder terms in k G G, but this is consistent with our semiclassical treatment. With the above notation and taking into account the BF action as well, the observable to be functionally integrated is Tr exp M Tr HolA, y,z ByHolA, z,y J sing HolA, z,y FyHolA, y,z .. At this point the introduction of the singular current allows us to rep resent formally a theory with sources concentrated on surfaces as a pure BF theory with a new curvature given by the dierence of the previ ous curvature and the currents associated to such sources. From eqn . we conclude, moreover, that J sing as a form should be such that J sing yd y , , y , where d y is the surface form of . Now we choose a time direction and proceed to an analysis of the Gauss constraints as in the pure BF theory. We assume that locally the manifold M is given by M I I being a time interval and the inter In particular Tr coincides with Tr when A, B LieG. BF Theories and knots section of the dimensional manifold M t with the surface is an ordinary link L t . In a neighborhood of y the current J sing will look like J a sing xy x yR a dx dx ,y,. where is a plane orthogonal to at y with coordinates x and x and n denotes the ndimensional delta function. The Gauss constraints imply that in the above neighborhood of y we have F a x HolA, z,y J a sing x yHolA, y,z ,y,x,. where is a loop in based at z and passing through y. The righthand side of . is also equal to HolA, z,y,z A a x y,x. Notice that the previous analysis implies that the components of the curvature F a and consequently the components of the connection A a must take values in a noncommutative algebra, at least when sources are present. More precisely the components F a as well as A a should be proportional to R a LieG. Given the fact that B a and A a are conjugate elds, we can conclude that the commutation relations of the quantum theory will require B a to be proportional to R a as well. As in the lowerdimensional case ordinary knots or links as sources in a dimensional theory, the restriction of the connection A to the plane looks in the approximation for which HolA, z,x,z like A a x R a d logx y . for a given y here d is the exterior derivative. In order to have some geometrical insight into the above connection, we consider a linear approximation, where the surface can be approximated by a collection of dimensional planes in R , i.e. by a collection of hyper planes in C . These hyperplanes, and the hyperplane considered above, are assumed to be in general position. This means that the intersection of the hyperplane with any other hyperplane is given by a point. The quantum connection . on gives a representation of the rst homotopy group of the manifold of the arrangements of hyperplanes points in , i.e. more simply, of the pure braid group , . It is then natu ral to ask whether the same is true in dimensions, namely whether the dimensional connection, corresponding to the critical curvature . in the linear approximation dened above, is related to the higher braid group . We will discuss this point further elsewhere let us mention only that the dimensional critical connection is related to the existence Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini of a higherdimensional version of the KnizhnikZamolodchikov equation associated with the representation of the higher braid groups, as suggested by Kohno . Path integrals and the Alexander invariant of a knot In the previous section we worked specically in the canonical approach. When instead we consider a covariant approach, and compute the expec tation values, with respect to the BF functional measure only, we can write Tr O x, x TATB Tr exp Tr M BxFxHolA, x,z J sing xHolA, z,x . . Again, in the approximation in which HolA, x,z , we can set Tr O x, x TATB Tr exp Tr M Bx Fx J sing x . . A rough and formal estimate of the previous expectation value . can be given as follows. By integration over the B eld we obtain something like Tr O x, x dim TAF J sing ,. using a functional Dirac delta. By applying the standard formula for Dirac deltas evaluated on composite functions, we heuristically obtain Tr O x, x dim detD A M ,. where detD A M denotes the regularized determinant of the covariant derivative operator with respect to a background at connection A on the space M. It is then natural to interpret the expectation value . with the FaddeevPopov ghosts included as the analytic RaySinger torsion for the complement of the knot see , . This torsion is related to the Alexander invariant of the knot . We omit the ghosts and gaugexing terms , since they are not relevant for a rough calculation of .. BF Theories and knots Firstorder perturbative calculations and higherdimensional linking numbers Let us now consider the expectation value of the quantum surface observ able Tr O x, x, with respect to the total BF Chern action. The two elds involved in the quantum surface operator are A a the connection and B a , the Beld with a , . . . , dimG and , , . . . , . The connection A is present in the quantum surface operator via the holonomy of the paths y,x and x,y y as in denitions . and .. At the rstorder approximation in perturbation theory with a back ground eld and covariant gauge, we can write the holonomy as HolA, y,x y,x A zdz . At the same order, the only relevant part of the BF action is the kinetic part B dA, so we get the following Feynman propagator A a xB b y i ab x y xy .. In order to avoid singularities, we perform the usual pointsplitting regu larization. This is tantamount to lifting the loops x,y,x in a neighborhood of y. The lifting is done in a direction which is normal to the surface . The complication here is that the loop itself based at x and passing through y depends on the point y. While the general case seems dicult to handle, we can make simplifying choices which appear to be legitimate from the point of view of the general framework of quantum eld theory. For instance, we can easily assume that when we assign to a point y the loop x,y,x based at x and passing through y, then the same loop will be assigned to any other point y t belonging to . Moreover, we can consider an arbitrarily ne triangulation T of and take into consideration only one loop T which has nonempty intersection with each triangle of T. This approximation will break gauge invariance, which will be, in principle, recovered only in the limit when the size of the triangles goes to zero. For a related approach see . The advantage of this particular approximation is that we have only to deal with one loop T , which by pointsplitting regularization is then completely lifted from the surface. We call this lifted path r T , where r stands for regularized. Finally we get to rstorder approximation in perturbation theory and Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini up to the normalization factor Tr O x, x dim C i ,,, dx dx r T dy x y xy , . where C is the trace of the quadratic Casimir operator in the represen tation . When is a sphere, then . is given by dim C i L r T , where L r T , is the higherdimensional linking number of with r T . Wilson channels Let again represent our knot surface embedded in the manifold M. Carter and Saito , , inspired by a previous work by Roseman , describe a knot in fact an embedded sphere in space by the dimensional analogue of a knot diagram they project down to a dimensional space, keeping track of the over and undercrossings. One of the coordinates of this space is interpreted as time. The intersection of this dimensional diagram of a knot with a plane at a xed time gives an ordinary link diagram, while the collection of all these link diagrams at dierent times stills gives a movie representing the knot. In the Feynman formulation of eld theory, we start by considering the surface embedded in the manifold M directly, not its projection. At the local level M will be given by M I I being a time interval, so that the intersection of the dimensional manifold M t with gives an ordinary link L t for all times t in M . In order to connect quantum eld theory with the standard theory of knots, we assume more simply that M is the space R and that is a sphere. One coordinate axis in R is interpreted as time, and the intersection of with space at xed times is given by ordinary links, with the possible exception of some critical values of the time parameter. In other words, we have a space projection t R R for each time t, so that L t t R is, for noncritical times, an ordinary link. For any time interval t ,t we While the normalization factor for a pure dimensional BF theory appears to be trivial , in a theory with a combined BF Chern action we have a contribution coming from the Chern action. This contribution has been related to the rst Donaldson invariant of M . BF Theories and knots will also use the notation t,t tt,t t R . We consider a set T of noncritical times t i i,,n . We denote the components of the corresponding links L ti by the symbols K ji i ,j , . . . , si. Here and below we will write ji simply to denote the fact that the index j ranges over a set depending on i. We choose one base point x ji i in each knot K ji i and we denote by ji,ji i the surface contained in whose boundary includes K ji i and K ji i . We then as sign a framing to ji,ji i as follows for each point p in the interior of ji,ji i we associate a path with endpoints x ji i and x ji i passing through p. To the surface ji,ji i with boundary components K ji i and K ji i , we associate the operator HolA, K ji i x ji i O ji,ji i x ji i ,x ji i HolA, K ji i x ji i , . where the subscript to the term HolA, . . . denotes the basepoint. We refer to the knot equipped with the set T of times as the temporally sliced knot. For the sliced knot, we dene the Wilson channels to be the operators of the form O ,t HolA, K x HolA, K ji i x ji i O ji,ji i x ji i ,x ji i HolA, K ji i x ji i O tn, x jn n ,.. We assume the following requirements for the Wilson channels . The operators which appear in a Wilson channel are chosen in such a way that a surface operator is sandwiched between knot operators only if the relevant knots belong to the boundary of the surface. . The paths that are included in the surface operators O ji,ji i are not allowed to touch the boundaries of the surface, except at the initial and nal point. Finally, to the sliced knot we associate the product of the traces of all possible Wilson channels. This product can be seen as a possible higher dimensional generalization of the Wilson operator for ordinary links in space that was considered by Witten. We would like now to compare the Wilson channel operators associated to a sliced knot with the operator O,. considered in Section no temporal slicing involved. The main dierence concerns the prescriptions that are given involving the paths that enter Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini the denition of . or, equivalently, the framing of the knot. The Wilson channels are obtained from . by . choosing a nite set of times T t i , and . requiring the paths to follow one of the components of the link L t , for each t T . Finally, recall that in the Wilson channel operators, each of the paths is forbidden to follow two separate components of the same link L t , for any time t T . This last condition can be understood by noticing that in order to follow both the jth and the j t th components of the link L ti , for some i, ji, j t i, one path should follow the jth component, then enter the surface ji,ji i which is assumed to be equal to j i,j i i , and nally go back to the j t th component, thus contradicting a local causality condition. Integration by parts The results of the previous section imply that, given a temporally sliced knot , we can construct quantum operators by considering all the Wilson channels relevant to surfaces ji,ji i , i l i l, and links L ti for i lt l i gt l. Let us denote these quantum operators by the terms W in ,t l ,W out ,t l .. They can be seen as a sort of convolution, depending on , of all the quantum holonomies associated to the links L ti for i lt l i gt l. Ordinary links are the closure of braids, and one may describe the sur face which generates the dierent links at times t i as a sequence movie of braids . But a link is also obtained by closing a tangle, and the time evolution of a link represented by a surface can also be described in terms of tangles, i.e. movies of ordinary tangles. It has been shown that tangles form a rigid, braided category . The tangle ap proach with its categorical content may reveal itself as a useful one for quantum eld theory. The initial tangle is called the source and the nal tangle is called the target. In our case, say, the source represents L t l while the target represents L t l , for l t gt l. The quantum counterpart of the source and target is represented by the quantum holonomies associated to the corresponding links, while the quantum counterpart of the tangle is represented by the quantum surface operator relevant to the surface t l ,t l . One can think of the quantum surface operators as acting on quantum holonomies by convolution, but it is dicult to do nite calculations and write this action explicitly. What we can do instead is to make some innitesimal calculations using integrationbyparts techniques in Feynman path integrals. BF Theories and knots Fig. . Three strings Generally speaking, in a nite time evolution t l t l , the quantum surface operator dened by the surface with boundaries L t l and L t l will map the operator W in ,t l into the operator W in ,t l . Let us now con sider what can be seen as the derivative of this map. Namely, let us see what happens when we consider the quantum operator corresponding to a surface bordering two links L t l and L t t l that dier by an elementary change. What the functional integrationbyparts rules will show, is that one can in terchange a variation of the surface operator with a variation of the link and consequently of its quantum holonomy. So in order to compute the derivative of the surface operator, we may consider variations of the link L t l . In order to describe elementary changes of links, recall that braids or tangles representing links at a xed time can be seen as collections of oriented strings, while tangles describe the interaction of those strings . We consider now two links that dier from each other only in a small region involving three strings. Let us number these strings with numbers , , . The string crosses under the string , then the string crosses under the string , and the string crosses under the string . We denote by the symbols a and b the part of each string that precedes and, respectively, follows the rst crossing, as shown in Fig. . The integrationbyparts rules for the BF theory are as follows. We consider a knot K jl l , which we denote here by C in order to simplify the notation, and a point x C. By the symbol x we mean the variation of C obtained by inserting an innitesimally small loop c x in C at the point x. We obtain x HolA, C x exp M TrB F ,,a d c x HolA, C x F a R a exp M TrB F Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini ,,,,a d c x exp M TrB F HolA, C x R a B a x , . where d c x denotes the surface form of the surface bounded by the in nitesimal loop c x ,R a denotes as usual an orthonormal basis of LieSUn, and the trace is meant to be taken in the fundamental representation. The second equality has been obtained by functional integration by parts in this way we produced the functional derivative with respect to the Beld. The integrationbyparts rules of the BF theory in dimensions completely parallel the integrationbyparts rules of the ChernSimons theory in dimensions . When we apply the functional derivative B a x to a surface operator O t x t ,x t t for a surface t whose boundary includes C we obtain B a x O t x t ,x t t R a xx t d t , O t x t ,x t t ,. where d t is the surface form of t . From eqn . we conclude that only the variations c x for which d t d c x , matter in the functional integral. But these variations are exactly the ones for which the small loop c x is such that the surface element d c x is transverse to the knot C as in . Now we come back to the link L t l with the three crossings as in Fig. . In order to consider the more general situation we assume that the three strings in Fig. belong to dierent components K l ,K l ,K l of L t l that will evolve into three dierent components K l ,K l ,K l of L t l . By performing three such small variations at each one of the crossings of the three strings considered in Fig. , we can switch each undercrossing into an overcrossing. Now as in we compare the expectation value of the original conguration with the conguration with the three crossings switched. Such comparison, with the aid of eqns . and . and the Fierz identity , leads to the conclusion that when we consider the action of the surface operators O j,j l x j l ,x j l , j , , , on the quantum holonomies of the knots K j l , its innitesimal variation O can be expressed as follows OW l W l .. Here W l is a short notation for the operator We are considering here only the small variations of , so we can disregard the holonomies of the paths in the surface operators the only relevant contribution to be considered is the one given by the eld B B a R a . Details will be discussed elsewhere. BF Theories and knots W l HolA, K l x l O , l x l ,x l HolA, K l x l HolA, K l x l O , l x l ,x l HolA, K l x l HolA, K l x l O , l x l ,x l HolA, K l x l the dots in . involve the operators W in ,t l and W out ,t l see ., the vector space associated to the string j is given by a tensor product V j a V j b , and nally is a suitable representation of the following operator / a R a R a a,a / a R a R a b,a / a R a R a b,b . Now we recall that / a R a R a is the innitesimal approxima tion of a quantum YangBaxter matrix R. Hence the calculations of this section suggest that, at the nite level, the solution of the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation which may be more relevant to topological quantum eld theories is the one considered in , , namely S R a,a R b,a R b,b , where R is a solution of the quantum YangBaxter equation. Acknowledgements S. Carter and M. Saito have kindly explained to us many aspects of their work on knots, both in person and via email. We thank them very much. We also thank A. Ashtekar, J. Baez, R. Capovilla, L. Kauman, and J. Stashe very much for discussions and comments. Both of us would also like to thank J. Baez for having organized a very interesting conference and for having invited us to participate. P. C.R. would like to thank S. Carter and R. Capovilla for invitations to the University of South Alabama and Cinvestav Mexico, respectively. Bibliography . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Com mun. Math. Phys. . . E. Witten, Topological quantum eld theory, Commun. Math. Phys. . . D. Birmingham, M. Blau, M. Rakowski, and G. Thompson, Topo logical eld theory, Phys. Rep. . . M. F. Atiyah and I. M. Singer, Dirac operators coupled to vector Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini potentials, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. . . L. Bonora, P. CottaRamusino, M. Rinaldi, and J. Stashe, The evaluation map in eld theory, sigmamodels and strings, Commun. Math. Phys. and . . L. Baulieu and I. M. Singer, Topological YangMills symmetry, Nucl. Phys. Proc. Suppl. B . . S. K. Donaldson and P. K. Kronheimer, The Geometry of Four Manifolds, Oxford University Press . . R. Capovilla, T. Jacobson, and J. Dell, Gravitational instantons as SU gauge elds, Classical amp Quantum Gravity LL. . A. Ashtekar, C. Rovelli, and L. Smolin, Weaving a classical metric with quantum threads, Phys. Rev. Lett. . . D. Rolfsen, Knots and Links, Publish or Perish, Inc., Wilmington, Delaware . . A. M. Polyakov and P. B. Wiegmann, Goldstone elds in two dimen sions with multivalued actions, Phys. Lett. B . . E. Guadagnini, M. Martellini, and M. Mintchev, Braids and quan tum group symmetry in ChernSimons theory, Nucl. Phys. B . . T. Kohno, Monodromy representation of braid groups and Yang Baxter equations, Ann. Inst. Fourier . . Yu. Manin and V. V. Schechtman, Arrangements of hyperplanes, higher braid groups and higher Bruhat orders, Adv. Studies Pure Math. . . T. Kohno, Integrable connections related to Manin and Schecht mans higher braid groups, preprint. . A. S. Schwarz, The partition function of degenerate quadratic func tionals and RaySinger invariants, Lett. Math. Phys. . . M. Blau and G. Thompson, A new class of topological eld theories and the RaySinger torsion, Phys. Lett. B . . V. G. Turaev, Reidemeister torsion in knot theory, Russ. Math. Surv. . . I. Ya. Arefeva, Non Abelian Stokes formula, Teor. Mat. Fiz. . . G. T. Horowitz and M. Srednicki, A quantum eld theoretic descrip tion of linking numbers and their generalization, Commun. Math. Phys. . . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, Syzygies among elementary string inter actions of surfaces in dimension , Lett. Math. Phys. . BF Theories and knots . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, Reidemeister moves for surface isotopies and their interpretation as moves to movies, J. Knot Theory Rami cations, . . D. Roseman, Reidemeistertype moves for surfaces in four dimensional space, preprint . . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, Knotted surfaces, braid movies, and be yond, this volume. . J. E. Fischer, Jr, Geometry of categories, PhD Thesis, Yale Uni versity . . A. B. Zamolodchikov, Tetrahedra equations and integrable systems in dimensional space, Sov. Phys. JETP . . P. CottaRamusino, E. Guadagnini, M. Martellini, and M. Mintchev, Quantum eld theory and link invariants, Nucl. Phys. B. . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, On formulations and solutions of simplex equations, preprint . . R. J. Lawrence, Algebras and triangle relations, preprint . Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond J. Scott Carter Department of Mathematics, University of South Alabama, Mobile, Alabama , USA email cartermathstat.usouthal.edu Masahico Saito Department of Mathematics, University of Texas at Austin, Austin, Texas , USA email saitomath.utexas.edu Abstract Knotted surfaces embedded in space can be visualized by means of a variety of diagrammatic methods. We review recent develop ments in this direction. In particular, generalizations of braids are explained. We discuss generalizations of the YangBaxter equation that correspond to diagrams appearing in the study of knotted sur faces. Our diagrammatic methods of producing new solutions to these generalizations are reviewed. We observe categorical aspects of these diagrammatic methods. Finally, we present new observa tions on algebraic/algebraictopological aspects of these approaches. In particular, they are related to identities among relations that ap pear in combinatorial group theory, and cycles in Cayley complexes. We propose generalizations of these concepts from braid groups to groups that have certain types of Wirtinger presentations. Introduction It has been hoped that ideas from physics can be used to generalize quan tum invariants to higherdimensional knots and manifolds. Such possibili ties were discussed in this conference. In dimension Jonestype invariants were dened algebraically via braid group representations or diagrammatically via Kauman brackets. The rst step, then, in the dimensionally higher case is to get algebraic or diagrammatic ways to describe knotted surfaces embedded in space. In this paper, we rst review recent developments in this direction. Reidemeistertype moves were generalized by Roseman and their movie versions were classied by the authors , . On the other hand, various braid forms for surfaces were considered by several other authors. In partic ular, Kamada proved generalized Alexanders and Markovs theorems for surface braids dened by Viro. We combined the movie and the surface braid approaches to obtain moves for the braid movie form of knotted sur J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito faces. The braid movie description is rich in algebraic and diagrammatic avor. The exposition in Section provides the basic topological tools for nd ing new invariants along these lines if they exist. On the other hand, knot theoretical, diagrammatic techniques have been used to solve algebraic problems related to statistical physics. In par ticular, we gave solutions to various types of generalizations of the quan tum YangBaxter equation QYBE. Such generalizations originated in the work of Zamolodchikov . In Section we review our diagrammatic methods in solving these equations. Such generalizations appeared in the context of categories and higher algebraic structures . In Section we follow Fischer to show that braid movies form a braided monoidal category in a natural way. New observations in this paper are in Section , where we discuss close relations between braid movie moves and various concepts in algebra and algebraic topology. Some of the moves correspond to cycles in Cayley complexes. Others are related to Peier equivalences that are studied in combinatorial group theory and homotopy theory. The charts dened in Section can be regarded as pictures that are dened for any group presentations of null homotopy disks in classifying spaces. We propose generalized chart moves for groups that have Wirtinger presentations. Movies, surface braids, charts, and isotopies . Movie moves The motion picture method for studying knotted surfaces is one of the most well known. It originated with Fox and has been developed and used extensively for example , , , , . In , we gave a set of Reidemeister moves for movies of knotted surfaces such that two movies described isotopic knottings if and only if one could be obtained from the other by means of certain local changes in the movies. In order to depict the movie moves, we rst projected a knot onto a dimensional subspace of space. Here a map from a surface to space is called generic if every point has a neighborhood in which the surface is either embedded, two planes intersecting along a doublepoint curve, three planes intersecting at an isolated triple point, or the cone on the gure eight also called Whitneys umbrella. Such a map is called generic because the collection of maps of this form is an open dense subset of the space of all the smooth maps see . Local pictures of these are depicted in Fig. . Then we x a height function on the space. By cutting space by level planes, we get immersed circles with nitely many exceptions where critical points occur. We also can include crossing information by break ing circles at underpasses. By a movie we mean a sequence of such curves Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . Generic intersection points J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito on the planes. Each element in a sequence is called a still. Again without loss of generality we can assume that successive stills dier by at most a classical Reidemeister move or a critical point of the surface. The Reide meister moves are interpreted as critical points of the double points of the projected surface, and so the movies contain critical information for the surface and for the projection of the surface. Finally, the moves to these movies were classied following Roseman by means of an analysis of foldtype singularities and intersection sets. The movie moves are depicted in Figs and . In these gures each still represents a local picture in a larger knot diagram. The dierent stills dier by either a Reidemeister move or critical point birth/death or saddle on the surface. These are called the elementary string interactions ESIs. Figure depicts ESIs. The moves indicate when two dierent sequences of ESIs depict the same knotting. Any two movie descriptions of the same knot are related by a sequence of these moves. One rather large class of moves is not explicitly given in this list namely, distant ESIs commute that is, when two string interactions occur on widely separated segments, the order of the interactions can be switched. . Surface braids In April , Oleg Viro described to us the braided form of a knotted surface. Similar notions had been considered by Lee Rudolph and X. S. Lin . Kamada has studied Viros version of surface braids we follow Kamadas descriptions. .. Denitions Let B and D denote disks. A surface braid is a compact oriented surface F properly embedded in B D such that the projection p B D D to the second factor restricted to F, p F FD , is a branched covering The boundary of F is the standard unlink F n points D B D B D where n points are xed in the interior of B . Here the positive integer n is called the surface braid index. A surface braid is called simple if every branch point has branch index . A surface braid is simple if the covering in condition above is simple. Throughout the paper we consider simple surface braids only. Two surface braids are equivalent if they are isotopic under level preserving isotopy relative to the boundary, where we regard the projection pB D D as a disk bundle over a disk. .. Closed surface braids Let F B D be a surface braid with braid index n. Embed B D in space standardly. Then F is the unlink in the sphere B D Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . The elementary string interactions J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . The Roseman moves Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . The remaining movie moves J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito so that we can cap o these circles with the standard embedded disks in space to obtain a closed, orientable embedded surface in space. The closed surface, F called the closure of F, is dened up to ambient isotopy. A surface obtained this way is called a closed surface braid. Viro and Kamada have proven an Alexander theorem for surfaces. Thus, any orientable surface embedded in R is isotopic to a closed surface braid. Furthermore, Kamada has recently proven a Markov theorem for closed surface braids in the PL category. However, in his proof he does not assume that the branch points are simple. An open problem, then, is to nd a proof of the Markov theorem for closed surface braids in which each branch point is simple. Such a theorem would show a clear analogy between classical and higherdimensional knot theory. .. Braid movies Write B and D as products of closed unit intervals B B B , D D D . Factor the projection p B D D into two projections p B B D B D and p B D D . Let F be a surface braid. We may assume without loss of generality that p restricted to F is generic. We further regard the D factor in B D B D D as the time direction. In other words, we consider families P t B D ttD . Except for a nite number of values of t D the intersection p FP t is a collection of properly immersed curves on the disk P t . Exceptions occur when P t passes through branch points, or local max ima/minima of the doublepoint set, or triple points. We may assume that for any t D there exists a positive such that at most only one of such points is contained in st,t P s . If one of such points is contained, the dierence between p FP s , s t , is one of the following smoothing/unsmoothing of a crossing corresponding to a branch point, type II Reidemeister move corresponding to the maximum/minimum of the doublepoint set, or type III Reidemeister move corresponding to a triple point. Except for such t, p FP t is the projection of a classical braid. Fur thermore, we can include crossing information by breaking the underarc as in the classical case. Here the underarc lies below the overarc with respect to the projection p . To make this convention more precise we identify the image of p with an appropriate subset in B D . This idea was used by Kamada when he constructed a surface with a given chart. See and also the next section. By this convention we can describe surface braids by a sequence of classical braid words. Including another braid group relation i j j i , i j gt we dene a braid movie as follows. A braid movie is a sequence b ,...,b k of words in i , i , . . . , n, such that for any m, b m is obtained from b m by one of the following Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond changes insertion/deletion of i , insertion/deletion of a pair i i , replacement of i j by j i where i j gt , replacement of i j i by j i j where i j . These changes are called elementary braid changes or EBCs, for short. This situation is illustrated in Fig. . Two braid movies are equivalent if they represent equivalent surface braids. . Chart descriptions A chart is an oriented labelled graph embedded in a disk, the edges are labelled with generators of the braid group, and the vertices are of one of three types A black vertex has valence . A valent vertex can also be thought of as a crossing point of the edges of the graph. The labels on the edges at such a crossing must be braid generators i and j where i j gt . A white vertex on the chart has valence . The edges around the vertex in cyclic order have labels i , j , i , j , i , j where i j . Here, the orientations are such that the rst three edges in this labelling are incoming and the last three edges are outgoing. Consider the double point set of F under the projection p F B D FB D which is a subset of B D . Then a chart depicts the image of this double point set under the projection p B D D in the following sense The birth/death of a braid generator occurs at a saddle point of the surface at which a doublepoint arc ends at a branch point. This projects to a black vertex on a chart. The projection of the braid exchange i j j i for i j gt is a valent vertex or a crossing in the graph. The valent vertex corresponds to a Reidemeister type III move, and this in turn is a triple point of the projected surface. Maximal and minimal points on the graph correspond to the birth or death of i i , and this is an optimum on the doublepoint set. The relationships among surface projections, braid movies, and charts is depicted in Fig. . .. Reconstructing the surface braid from a chart A chart gives a complete description of a surface braid in the following way. Recall that the D factor of D is interpreted as a time direction. Thus J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . Braid movies, charts, and diagrams Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . Chart moves J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito the vertical axis of the disk points in the direction of increasing time. Each generic intersection of a horizontal line with the graph generic intersections will miss the vertices and the critical points on the graph gives a sequence of braid words. The letters in the word are the labels associated to the edges the exponent on such a generator is positive if the edge is oriented coherently with the time direction, otherwise the exponent is negative. By taking a single slice on either side of a vertex or a critical point on the graph, we can reconstruct a braid movie from the sequence of braid words that results. Therefore, given a chart and a braid index, we can construct a surface braid and, indeed, a knotted surface by closing the surface braid. Theorem . Kamada Every surface braid gives rise to an oriented labelled chart, and every oriented labelled chart completely describes a sur face braid. Furthermore, Kamada provided a set of moves on charts. His list consists of three moves called CI, II, and III. From the braid movie point of view, we need to rene his list incorporating movie moves. Such generalized chart moves, yielding braid movie moves that will be discussed in the next section, are listed in Fig. . . Braid movie moves The following types of changes among braid movies are called braid movie moves CIR i , i j j , j i j i , j j i , j i j , where i j gt . CIR t i , i i i , i i . CIR i j , j i , i j i j , where i j gt . CIR i k j , k i j , k j i , j k i i k j , i j k , j i k , j k i , where i j gt , j k gt , k i gt . CIR k i j i , i k j i , i j k i , i j i k , j i j k k i j i , k j i j , j k i j , j i k j , j i j k , where i j and i k gt , j k gt . Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond CIM empty word empty word, i i , empty word. CIM i i , empty word, i i i i . CIM i j i , j i j , i j i i j i , where i j . CIM i j k i j i , i j i k j i , j i j k j i , j i k j k i , j k i j k i , j k i j i k , j k j i j k , k j k i j k i j k i j i , i j k j i j , i k j k i j , k i j k i j , k i j i k j , k j i j k j , k j i k j k , k j k i j k , where k j i or k j i . CIM j i , i i j i , i j i j j i , j i j j , i j i j , where i j . CII j , j i , i j j , i j , where i j gt . CIII i j , i j i , j i j i j , j i j , where i j . CIII j j , j i j , i j i j j , empty word, i i , i j i , where i j . CIV empty word, i i , i empty word, i . Furthermore, we include the variants obtained from the above by the fol lowing rules replace i with i for all or some of i appearing in the sequences if possible, if b ,...,b k b t ,...,b t k is one of the above, add b k ,...,b b t k ,...,b t , J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito if b ,...,b k b t ,...,b t k is one of the above, add c ,...,c k c t ,...,c t k where c j resp. c t j is the word obtained by reversing the order of the word b j resp. b t j . combinations of the above. The braid movie moves are depicted in Figs and . There is an overlap between the braid movie moves and the ordinary movie moves that overlap is to be expected. . Denition locality equivalence Let b ,...,b n and b t ,...,b t n be two braid movies that satisfy the fol lowing condition. There exists i, i n, such that b j b t j for all j , i , i, i , b j resp. b t j , j i , i, i , are written as b j u j v j resp. b t j u t j v t j where u and v satisfy au i resp. v t i is obtained from u i resp. v t i by one of the elementary braid changes, say , and v i v i resp. u t i u t i , bv i resp. u t i is obtained from v i resp. u t i by one of the elementary braid changes, say , and u i u i resp. v t i v t i . Then we say that b t ,...,b t n is obtained from b ,...,b n by a locality change or vice versa. If two braid movies are related by a sequence of lo cality changes then they are called equivalent under locality. Loosely speak ing, equivalence under locality changes means that distant EBCs commute. Theorem . Two braid movies are equivalent if and only if they are related by a sequence of braid movie moves and locality changes. It is interesting to note that in the braid movie point of view, the move that corresponds to a quadruple point gives a movie move corresponding to the permutohedral equation rather than to the tetrahedral equation. We will discuss these equations at some length in Section . The permutohedral and tetrahedral equations In , Zamolodchikov presented a system of equations and a solution to this system that corresponded to the interaction of straight strings in statistical mechanics. This system of equations is related to the Yang Baxter equations, and this relationship suggests topological applications. Baxter showed that the Zamolodchikov solution worked. And in higherdimensional analogues were dened. In , these systems are interpreted as consistency conditions for the obstructions to the lower di mensional equations having solutions. Frenkel and Moore produced a formulation and a solution of a variant of the Zamolodchikov tetrahe dral equation. And Kapranov and Voevodsky consider the solution of Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . The braid movie moves J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . The braid movie moves Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond the Zamolodchikov equation to be a key feature in the construction of a braided monoidal category. In a parallel development, Ruth Lawrence described the permutohedral equation and two others as natural equa tions for which solutions in a algebra could be found. There are other solutions of these higherorder equations known to us. In particular, we mention , , , and . In , solutions are studied in relation to quasicrystals. We expect there are even more solu tions in the literature and would appreciate being told of these. Here we review these equations and our methods for solving them. . The tetrahedral equation The FrenkelMoore version of the tetrahedral equation is formulated as S S S S S S S S . where S EndV , V a module over a xed ring k. Each side of the equation acts on V V V V V , and S , for example, acts on V as the identity. Notice here that eqn . has the nice property that each index appears three times on either side of the equation. Compare this equation with the movie move that involves ve frames on either side. On the lefthand movie, the elementary string interactions that occur are Reidemeister type III moves. Label the strings to from left to right in the rst frame of the movie. This index is one more than the number of strings that cross over the given string. Then the Reidemeister type III moves occur in order among the strings , , , . Thus we think of the tensor S as corresponding to a type III Reidemeister move. The equation corresponds to the given movie move as these type III moves occur in opposite order on the righthand side of the move. This correspondence was also pointed out by Towber. .. A variant There is a natural variant of this equation S S S S S S S S . where each side of the equation now acts on V . In this equation each index appears twice in each side. This tetrahedral equation was also for mulated in , , . We review how to obtain eqn . from eqn . cf. . Dene a set of pairs of integers among to C, , , , , , with the lexicographical ordering as indicated. There are six elements and the ordering denes a map C, , . . . , . The rst factor of the lefthand side of the equation . is S . Consider the pairs of integers among this subscript , , in the lexicographical ordering. Under J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . Solving the Zamolodchikov equation Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond these are mapped to , , which is the subscript of the rst factor in eqn .. The other factors are obtained similarly. For example, the second factor of . has the subscript which yields pairs , , which are mapped under to , , giving the second factor of .. This is how we obtain . from .. Next we observe that eqn . is solvable appropriate products of QYB solutions give solutions to .. Let V W W where W is a module over which there is a QYB solution R R R R R R R . For given V give a and b as subscripts of W V i W ia W ib for i , . . . , . For SS acting on V V V W a W b W a W b W a W b set S R aa R ba R bb . One can compute S S S S R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R aa R aa R ba R ba R aa R bb R ba R ba R bb R bb R bb R aa R aa R aa R aa R ba R ba R ba R ba R bb R bb R bb R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb R aa R ba R bb S S S S . Thus . is solvable. This computation is a bit tedious algebraically. We obtained this result by considering the preimage of four planes of dimension generically inter secting in space. The movie version of such planes is depicted in Fig. . The numbering in the gure matches those described above. Specically, the intersection points among planes and receive the number since is the rst in the lexicographical ordering. Each plane is one of the strings as it evolves on one side of the movie of the corresponding movie move. The crossing points of the remaining planes give one side of the Reidemeister type III move on the preimage, and on the other side of the movie move the other side of the Reidemeister type III move appears. Thus the solution is a piece of bookkeeping based on this picture. .. Remarks In we showed that solutions to the FrenkelMoore equations could also produce solutions to higherdimensional equations. All of the higher dimensional solutions are obtained because the equations correspond to the intersection of hyperplanes in hyperspaces, and the selfintersection sets of these contain intersections of lowerdimensional strata. J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . The permutohedral equation . The permutohedral equation This equation was studied in and S S R R S S R R S S R R S S . The subscripts indicate factors of vector spaces on which the tensor acts nontrivially, and it acts as the identity on the other factors. The tensors S and R live in EndV and EndV , respectively, and both sides of the equation live in EndV . A pictorial representation is given in Fig. . This gure shows two sides of a permutohedron truncated octohedron. The gure is the dual to the CIM move on charts. Each hexagon is dual to a valence vertex, and each parallelogram is dual to a crossing point on the graph. Thus this equation is a natural one to consider from the point of view of knotted surfaces, as it expresses one of the braid movie moves. The equation expresses the equality among tensors that are associated to the faces on the sides of the permutohedron. Each hexagon represents the tensor S and each parallelogram represents R. Parallel edges receive the same number, and the numbers assigned to the boundary edges of hexagons and parallelograms determine the subscripts of the tensor. Finally, observe that by setting R equal to the identity, the equation reduces to the variant of the tetrahedral equation given above. Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . Assigning tensors to the hexagons .. Solutions Suppose A, B, M, and R EndV V satisfy the following conditions AAA AAA, BBB BBB . MMA AMM, BMM MMB . MMA AMM, BMM MMB . AMB BMA . AMR RMA, RMB BMR . ARM MRA, MRB BRM . MAR RAM . ARB BRA, BRA ARB . BAR RAB, RAB BAR . MRM MRM . where the LHS resp. RHS of every relation has subscripts , , and resp. , , and and lives in EndV . The subscripts indicate the factor in the tensor product on which these operators are acting. For exam ple, AMM MMA stands for A M M M M A EndV . We do not require the equalities with the subscripts of the RHS and LHS switched. In case those equalities are used, they are listed explicitly as in eqns . and .. J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . The computational technique Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Proposition . If the conditions stated in eqns .. hold, then S A M B is a solution to the permutohedral equation. The proof is presented in detail in . Here we include the illustrations that led to the proof. In this way we reinforce the diagrammatic nature of the subject. In Fig. , we assign the product ABM to each of the S tensors. Then in Fig. , we indicate that if A, B, M, and R satisfy YangBaxterlike relations, then we can get from one side of the permutohedron to the other. To read this gure start at the upper left, travel left to right, then go directly down to the second row and read right to left. The zigzag pattern continues. Now in the solution given in . set A M R. Then the list of the conditions reduces to RRR RRR, BBB BBB . BRR RRB, RRB BRR . with the same subscript convention as in eqns ... To get Rmatrices that satisfy these conditions, we embedded quantum groups into bigger quantum groups. This idea was inspired by Kapranov and Voevodskys idea of using projections of quantum groups to obtain solutions to Zamolodchikovs equation . There exists a canonical embedding i U qi sl U q sln corresponding to the ith vertex of the Dynkin diagram, where q i q i , i /, , is the canonical inner product, i r i is a basis of simple roots of the root system, and r is the rank p. , . Let R t resp. B be the universal Rmatrix in U qi sl U qi sl resp. U q sln U q sln. Let R i R t where i is xed. If we take a representation f U q sln EndV for a vector space V over the complex numbers, both fR and fB satisfy the quantum Yang Baxter equation RRR RRR, BBB BBB since fR f i R t is a representation of U qi sl and R t is a universal Rmatrix. Furthermore, in we showed that the remaining relations held between R and B. In this way, we were able to construct solutions. . Planar versions Simplex equations can be represented by planar diagrams when the sub scripts consist of adjacent sequences of numbers. We can use planar dia grams to solve such equations. J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito .. Planar tetrahedral equations One such equation is S S S S S S S S . We regarded the corresponding planar diagram as the diagrams in the TemperleyLieb algebra. Elements in the TemperleyLieb algebra are rep resented by diagrams involving and . Playing with such diagrams, we found a continuous family of solutions to the above equation expressed as a linear combination with variables in generators of the Temperley Lieb algebra. Such generalizations of the Kauman bracket seem useful in general. .. The planar permutohedral equation It was observed by Lawrence that the permutohedral equation becomes the following equation r s s r r s s s s r r s s r . after multiplying by permutation maps s P S, r PR. We found some new and interesting solutions to this version by using the Burau representation of the braid group, and these were presented in . Some of the solutions were noninvertible, and another class of solutions reected the noninjectivity of the Burau representation. categories and the movie moves At the Isle of Thorns Conference in , Turaev described the category of tangles and laid the foundations for his paper . The objects in the category are in onetoone correspondence with the nonnegative integers. And the morphisms are isotopy classes of tangles joining n dots along a horizontal to m dots along a parallel horizontal. Such a tangle, then, is a morphism from n to m. A week later in France similar ideas were being discussed by Joyal . All of the known generalizations of the Jones polynomial can be understood as representations on this category. Consequently, there is hope that the yet to be found higherdimensional generalizations can be found as representations of the category of tangles that we will describe here. . Overview of categories In a category, there are objects. For any two objects in a category there is a set of morphisms. A category has objects, morphisms, and mor phisms between morphisms called morphisms. The morphisms can be composed in essentially two dierent ways either they can be glued along common morphisms, or they can be glued along common objects. Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Obviously, they can be glued only if they have either a morphism or an object in common. Just as the fundamental problem in an ordinary category is to determine if two morphisms are the same, the fundamental problem in a category is to determine if two morphisms are the same. The geometric depiction of a category consists of dots for objects, arrows between dots for morphisms, and polygons where poly means two or more for morphisms. Thus, by composing morphisms we obtain faces of polyhedra, and an equality among morphisms is a solid bounded by these faces. . The category of braid movies This section is an interpretation of Fischers work in the braid movie scheme. Here we give a description of the category associated to nstring braids. There is one object, the integer n, and this is identied with n points arranged along a line. The set of morphisms is the set of nstring braid diagrams without an equivalence relation of isotopy imposed. Two diagrams related by a levelpreserving isotopy of a disk which keeps the crossings are identied, but for example two straight lines and a braid dia gram represented by i i are distinguished. Equivalently, a morphism is a word in the letters ,..., n . A generating set of morphisms is the collection of EBCs. More generally, consider the category in which the collection of objects consists of the natural numbers , , , . . . each number n is identied with n dots arranged along a horizontal line. The set of morphisms from n to m when m , n is empty, and the set of morphisms from n to n is the set of nstring braid diagrams or equivalently words on the alphabet ,..., n . A tensor product is dened by addition of integers, and acts as an identity for this product. A morphism is a surface braid that runs between two nstring braid diagrams. Equivalently, a morphism can be represented by a movie in which stills dier by at most an EBC. We dene a braiding which is a morphism from n m to m n, by braiding n strings in front of m strings that is, the braid diagram represented by the braid word n n nm n n nm m . Assertion With the tensor product, identity, and braiding dened above, we can dene all the data various morphisms in terms of braid movies such that the category of braid movies denes a braided monoidal category. Sketch of Proof In Figs and a set of movie moves to ribbon diagrams are depicted. These are illustrations of the KapranovVoevodsky axioms as interpreted in our setting. In the middle of gures polytopes are depicted. These are two exam J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . A ribbon movie move Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Fig. . Another ribbon movie move J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito ples of axioms in that are to be satised by morphisms. Letters represent objects where tensor product notation is abbreviated. Edges in these polytopes are morphisms. They are in turn represented by braid words. The ribbon diagrams surrounding the polytopes represent braid movies. Ribbons represent parallel arcs as in the classical case. Then each morphism, a braid word, is represented by ribbon diagrams to simplify movie diagrams. Therefore each ribbon diagram represents a composition of edges in the polytopes. A morphism is a face in the polytopes, and changes between two ribbon diagrams. The polytopes are relations satis ed by compositions of morphisms. In ribbon diagrams, this means that two ways of deforming ribbon diagrams have to be equal. There are two ways to deform by braid movie moves one the top ribbon diagram to the other the bottom by going along the left hand side of the polytope, or the right hand side. The conditions say that these two ways are equal. Each frame in a movie can be written as a product of braid generators while each morphism can be decomposed as a sequence of EBCs. These EBCs can be written in terms of charts. Then two ribbon movies are equivalent if and only if the resulting charts are chart equivalent. Thus we can check the equality by means of chart moves. Alternatively, we can decompose the polytopes into simpler pieces that correspond to the polytopes of the braid movie moves. .. Remark The existence of a braided monoidal category is not enough to conclude that one has an invariant of knots. In addition, to the braiding R AB BA, we need a braiding R BA AB that also gives a morphism from R R to the identity morphism on A B. If R is thought of as crossing the strings of A over those of B, then R crosses Bs strings over As. Since moves CIM and CIM hold, these morphisms are isomorphisms. .. Fischers result Fischers dissertation gives an axiomatization of the category that is as sociated to regular isotopy classes of knotted surface diagrams. That is, he denes this category, and he shows that it is the free, rigid, braided, semistrict monoidal category FRBSMcat generated by a set. Fischers theorem means that if one has an RBSMcat then one automatically has constructed an invariant of regular isotopy classes of knotted surface dia grams. Algebraic interpretations of braid movie moves Our motivation in dening braid movies and their moves was to get a more algebraic description of knotted surfaces. In particular, it is hoped that this description can be dened and studied in a more general setting Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond for example, for any group. Also, it is desirable if there is an algebraic topological description of braid movies generalizing the fact that a classical braid represents an element of the fundamental group of the conguration space. In this section, we work towards this goal we observe close relations between braid movie moves and various concepts in algebra and algebraic topology. . Identities among relations and Peier elements In this section we recall denitions of various concepts for group presenta tions following , where details appear. .. Identities among relations Let G be a group. A presentation of G is a triple X R, w such that R is a set, w R F is a map, where F is the free group on X, and G is isomorphic to F/NwR, where N is the normal closure. Let H be the free group on Y R F let H F denote the homomorphism r, u u wru. Then H NwR. An identity among relations is any element in the kernel of . .. Peier transformations A Y sequence is a sequence of elements y a ,...,a n where a i r i ,u i is a generator or its inverse of H for i , , . . . , n. The follow ing operations are called Peier transformations A Peier exchange replaces the successive terms r i ,u i ,r i ,u i with either r i ,u i ,r i ,u i u i wr i u i or r i ,u i u i wr i u i ,r i ,u i . A Peier deletion deletes an adjacent pair a, a in a Y sequence. A Peier insertion inserts an adjacent pair a, a into a Y sequence. A Peier equivalence is a nite sequence of exchanges, deletions, and insertions to a Y sequence performed in some order. .. Pictures for presentations Let X, R, w denote a group presentation. A picture over the presentation consists of A disk D with boundary D. A collection ,..., k of disjoint disks in the interior of D that are labelled by elements of R. A collection of disjoint oriented arcs labelled by elements of X that either form simple closed loops or join points on the boundaries of two or possibly one of the . J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . Pictures for group presentations A base point for each of the and one for the big disk D. The base point on a is distinct from the endpoints of the connecting arcs. Finally, starting from the base point and reading around the boundary of any in a counterclockwise fashion, the labels on the edges that are encountered should spell out either the relation R or its inverse that is associated to the small disk. An incoming edge is interpreted as having a positive exponent, and an outgoing edge has a negative exponent. In a spherical picture is dened as a picture in which none of the edges touch the outer boundary. Figure illustrates a spherical picture. The dotted arcs indicate how to obtain a Y sequence from a picture. The Y sequence obtained from a spherical picture is an identity sequence in the sense that the product a a n in the free group. A picture determines a map of a disk into BG, the classifying space of the group with given presentation, that is dened up to homotopy, and by transversality if such a map is given then there is a picture the little disks are the inverse images of regular neighborhoods of points at the center of the disks that correspond to relators. The arcs are the inverse images of interior points on the edges of the complex. From a picture a Y sequence can be obtained. Namely, for each disk a dotted arc is chosen that connects the base point of the small disk to that of the larger disk. These arcs do not intersect in their interiors. Furthermore, the dotted arcs are chosen to be transverse to the arcs that Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond interconnect the disks. To each dotted arc we associate a pair r , u, where r R and u F. The element u is the word in the free group corresponding to the intersection sequence of the dotted arc with connecting arcs. The exponent on a letter is determined by an orientation convention. The element r is the intersection sequence on the boundary of read in a counterclockwise fashion. The collection of dotted arcs is ordered in a counterclockwise fashion at the base point, and this gives the ordering of the Y sequence. In , it is noted that an elementary Peier exchange corresponds to rechoosing a pair of successive arcs from the base points of a pair of to the base point of D. Thus pictures can be used to study Y sequences and their Peier equivalences. They provide a diagrammatic tool for the study of groups from an algebraictopological viewpoint. Furthermore, they dene deformations of pictures. There are three types of moves to pictures. The rst type is to insert or delete small circles labelled by the generating set. This is a direct analogue of the CIM move on charts. Secondly, surgery between arcs with compatible labels and orientations is analogous to the CIM move. Third is an insertion or deletion of a pair of small disks labelled with the same relator, but oppositely oriented, joined together by arcs corresponding to generators that appear in the relator. This is an isolated conguration disjoint from other components of the graph in the picture, but corresponds to CIM and CIR combined with CIM, CIM. . Moves on surface braids and identities among relations In this subsection we observe which moves on surface braids correspond to Peier transformations dened above, and what the others correspond to. .. Moves corresponding to Peier transformations Braid movie moves CIM and CIR are used to perform Peier inser tions and deletions as noted in the previous section. Peier exchanges correspond to locality equivalences because ordering the vertices is tanta mount to choosing a height function. .. Moves corresponding to cycles The chart moves CIR, CIR, and CIM are identities among relations that correspond to nondegenerate cycles in the Cayley complex for the standard presentation of the braid group. The correspondence is given by taking duals. The cube, the hexagonal prism, and the permutohedron, respectively, are the dual cycles in the Cayley complex. .. Other CI moves These correspond to rechoosing the dotted arcs in the homotopy classes relative to the endpoints. For example, CIR t looks like straightening up a cubic curve. Thus if J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito the xaxis in the gure is a part of a dotted arc, then this move corresponds to rechoosing a dotted arc so that it intersects the edge with two less intersection points. Other moves can be interpreted similarly. This rechoosing in turn corresponds to changing the words u i in the terms r i ,u i of the Y sequences, since dotted arcs correspond to these words. In summary, we interpret charts without black vertices as null homo topies of the second homotopy group of the classifying space. Let G be a braid group B n on n strings and BG its classifying space constructed from the standard presentation. Specically, BG is constructed as follows start with one vertex, add n oriented edges corresponding to generators, attach cells corresponding to relators along the skeleton, add cells to kill the second homotopy group of the skeleton thus constructed, and continue killing higher homotopies to build BG. Note that pictures are dened for maps of disks to BG as in the case of maps to the Cayley complexes by transversality. Proposition . Let C be a chart of a surface braid S without black vertices. Note here that S is trivial i.e. S is an unlinked collection of n spheres. Then there is a map f from a disk to BG, f D ,D BG, vertex, such that the picture corresponding to f is the same isotopic as a planar graph as C. Since BG , this picture is deformed to the empty picture by a sequence of picture moves. This is the same as a sequence of CI moves realizing an isotopy of surface braids from S to the trivial surface braid whose chart is the empty diagram. In other words, CI moves of isotopy of surface braids correspond to picture moves of BG . Furthermore, this deformation is interpreted as identities among rela tions. In particular, braid movie moves correspond to Peier transforma tions, or cells of BG, or rechoosing the dotted arcs in pictures. . Symmetric equivalence and moves on surface braids In this section we consider moves on group elements that are conjugates of generators. This generalizes Kamadas denition of symmetric equivalence for charts. These moves correspond to CII and CIII moves on charts which are the moves involving black vertices. .. Symmetric equivalence and charts Fix a base point on the boundary of the disk on which the chart of a surface braid lives. Suppose there are black vertices. Consider a small disk B centered at a black vertex v. Pick a point d on the boundary of B which misses the edge coming out of v. Connect d to the base point by a simple arc which intersects the chart transversely. More precisely, the arc misses the vertices and crossings of the chart and intersects the edges transversely. Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Starting from the base point, travel along the arc and read the labels as it intersects the edges. Then go around v along B counterclockwise, and go back to the base point. This yields a word w in braid generators of the form of a conjugate of a generator w Y i Y , where i is the label of the edge coming from v, depends on the orientation of this edge, and Y is the word we read along the arc. Then before/after the CII move, the word thus dened changes as follows Y i YY j i j Y, where also denotes and i j gt . Similarly a CIII move causes the word change Y i YY j i j i i Y, where i j , , and . Kamada dened symmetric equivalence between words that are conju gates of generators in the braid group. The equivalence relation reects the changes above. He proved that two such words are symmetrically equiv alent i they represent the same element in the braid group, and then he used this theorem to prove that C moves suce. Kamadas denition of symmetric equivalence is dierent from the above. We indicated the word changes that correspond to CII and CIII moves. .. Chart moves that involve black vertices Charts that have black vertices can be interpreted as pictures in the sense of as follows. Consider a chart with black vertices. Cut the disk open along the arcs dened above to obtain a picture in which the boundary of the disk is mapped to the product of conjugates of generators. This gives a picture associated to a chart that has black vertices. The chart moves CII and CIII have the following interpretation as moves on pictures. The words on the boundary of the disk change as indicated above. The picture represents a map from the disk into BGwhere Gis the braid group. Either of these moves corresponds to sliding the disk by homotopy across the polygon representing the given relation. .. Generalizations of Wirtinger presentations Generalizing Kamadas theorem, we consider Wirtinger presentations of groups. Let G X R be a nite Wirtinger presentation. Thus each of the relators is of the form r y V xV , where x, y X are generators and V is a word in generators. Let A be the set of all the words in X i.e., elements in the free group on X of the form w Y xY , where x X and Y is a word in X. Dene symmetric equivalence on A as follows Two words Y xY and Z xZ are symmetrically equivalent if Y and Z represent the same element in G. J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . Generalized chart move Two words Y yY and Y V xV Y are symmetrically equivalent if ry V xV R where x, y X. Two words in A are symmetrically equivalent i they are related by a nite sequence of the above changes. In terms of pictures, if we allow univalent vertices in pictures, and if we dene arc systems connecting univalent vertices to a base point on the boundary of the disk, then we can diagrammatically represent the above two changes in terms of pictures. They are depicted in Fig. . Such a generalization of pictures will be discussed next. We generalize pictures for group presentations to include univalent ver tices. To make homotopytheoretic sense out of such pictures, consider small disks centered at each univalent vertex and simple, mutually disjoint arcs connecting them to a base point. More precisely, our data consist of a picture on a disk where univalent vertices are allowed, a small disk centered at each univalent vertex with a specied point on the boundary of each disk which misses the edge coming from the univalent vertex, a system of mutually disjoint simple arcs such that for each univalent vertex a simple arc from this system connects the specied point on the boundary of the small disk to a xed base point on the boundary of the big disk where the picture lives. These arcs miss vertices of the picture and intersect the edges transversely. Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Let a ,...,a n be the system of arcs dened above. Starting from the base point, read the labels of the edges intersecting a when we trace it towards the univalent vertex. Go around the vertex along the boundary of the small disk and come back to the base point to get a word w . Then we trace a up to a n to get a sequence w ,...,w n of words. Each word is in a conjugate form w i Y i x i Y i i , . . . , n, where x i is the label of the edge coming from the ith univalent vertex. Now we require that the product w w n is in G, the group with which we started. Call this a generalized picture. This has the following meaning as explained in the case of braid groups above. Given a generalized picture, remove the interior of small disks around each univalent vertex. Then dene a smooth map from the bound ary big disk cut open along dotted arcs connecting small disks to the base point, to the skeleton of BG. This edge path represents the product w w n in G BG which was assumed to be the identity. Therefore the map on the boundary of the cutopen disk extends to a map of the big disk. The transverse preimages of points in cells resp. cells gives edges resp. vertices of the rest of the picture. Here we remark that Kamadas theorem on symmetric equivalence seems to be generalized to other groups. Kamada used Garsides results , and Garside gave other groups to which his arguments can be applied. . Concluding remarks We have indicated relations among braid movie moves, charts and classi fying spaces of braid groups, and null homotopy disks in such spaces. We further discussed potential generalizations to Wirtinger presented groups. We conclude this section with remarks on these aspects. In the preceding section we discussed null homotopy disks in classifying spaces in the presence of generalized black vertices. However, we do not want to allow cancelling black vertices since if we did charts represent just null homotopies in the case of braid groups and we instead want something highly nontrivial. Thus we need restrictions on homotopy classes of maps from cutopen disks to classifying spaces to be able to dene nontrivial ho motopy classes to represent surface braids. Keeping base point information is such an example. More natural interpretations are expected in terms of other standard topological invariants. By xing a height function on the disk where pictures are dened, we can dene sequences of words for Wirtinger presented groups generalizing braid movies. Furthermore we can generalize braid movie moves to such sequences for Wirtinger presented groups by examining moves on pictures in the presence of height functions. The moves in this case would consist of the moves that correspond to Peier equivalences and the moves on pictures described in , the moves that are dependent on the choice of height functions, the moves that correspond to cycles in the Cayley J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito complex associated to the presentation, the moves that push black vertices through Wirtinger relations. The algebraic signicance of such sequences of words and relations among them deserves further study, since this is a natural context in which the braid movie moves appear. Acknowledgements We thank the following people for valuable conversations and correspon dence John Baez, Dan Silver, Dan Flath, John Fischer, Seiichi Kamada, Ruth Lawrence, Dennis McLaughlin, and Kunio Murasugi. Some of the material here was presented at a special session hosted by YongWu Rong and at a conference hosted by David Yetter and Louis Crane. Financial support came from Yetter and Crane and from John Luecke. Cameron Gordons support nancial and moral is especially appreciated. Bibliography . Baxter, R. J. On Zamolodchikovs Solution of the Tetra hedron Equations, Commun. Math. Phys. , Reprinted in Jimbo, M., YangBaxter Equation in Integrable Systems, World Scientic Publishing, Singapore. . Bazhanov, V. V. and Stroganov, Yu. G. Chiral Potts Mod els as a Descendant of the SixVertex Model, in Jimbo, M., YangBaxter Equation in Integrable Systems, World Scientic Pub lishing, Singapore. . Brown, R. and Huebschmann, J. Identities among Relations, in Brown, R. and Thickstun, T. L. Lowdimensional Topol ogy, London Math. Soc. Lecture Note Series , pp. . . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico, Syzygies among Ele mentary String Interactions in Dimension , Lett. Math. Phys. ,. . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Canceling Branch Points on Projections of Surfaces in Space, Proc. AMS , . . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Planar Generalizations of the YangBaxter equation and Their Skeins, J. Knot Theory Ramications , . . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Reidemeister Moves for Surface Isotopies and Their Interpretation as Moves to Movies, J. Knot Theory Ramications , . . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico On Formulations and Solutions of Simplex Equations, Preprint. . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Diagrammatic Invari ants of Knotted Curves and Surfaces, Preprint. Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico A Diagrammatic The ory of Knotted Surfaces, to appear in Baddhio, R. and Kauman, L. The Conference Proceedings for AMS Meeting , on Knots and Quantum Field Theory, World Scientic Publishing, Sin gapore. . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Some New Solutions to the Permutohedron Equation, Preprint. . Carter, J. Scott and Saito, Masahico Braids and Movies, Preprint. . Ewen, H. and Ogievetsky, O. Jordanian Solutions of Simplex Equations, Preprint. . Fischer, John Braided Tensor categories and Invariants of knots, Preprint. . Fox, R. H. A Quick Trip Through Knot Theory, in Cantrell, J. and Edwards, C. H. Topology of Manifolds, Prentice Hall. . Frenkel, Igor and Moore, Gregory Simplex Equations and Their Solutions, Commun. Math. Phys. , . . Garside, F. A. The Braid Group and Other Groups, Q. J. Math. Oxford , . . Golubitsky, Martin and Guillemin, Victor Stable Mappings and Their Singularities, GTM , Springer Verlag. . Hietarinta, J. Some Constant Solutions to Zamolodchikovs Tetrahedron Equations, Preprint. . Jones, V. F. R. A Polynomial Invariant for Knots and Links via von Neumann Algebras, Bull. AMS , . Reprinted in Kohno, T. New Developments in the Theory of Knots, World Scientic Publishing, Singapore. . Joyal, A. and Street, R. Braided Monoidal Categories, Math ematics Reports , Macquarie University. . Kamada, Seiichi Surfaces in R of Braid Index Three are Ribbon, J. Knot Theory Ramications , . . Kamada, Seiichi A Characterization of Groups of Closed Ori entable Surfaces in space, to appear in Topology. . Kamada, Seiichi Dimensional Braids and Chart Descrip tions, Preprint. . Kamada, Seiichi jigen braid no chart hyoji no douchi henkei ni tsuite On Equivalence Moves of Chart Descriptions of Dimensional Braids, Preprint in Japanese. . Kamada, Seiichi Generalized Alexanders and Markovs The orems in Dimension Four, Preprint. . Kapranov, M. and Voevodsky, V. Braided Monoidal J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Categories, Vector Spaces and Zamolodchikovs Tetrahedra Equa tions rst draft. Preprint. . Kapranov, M. and Voevodsky, V. Categories and Zamolod chikov Tetrahedra Equations, Preprint. . Kawauchi, A., Shibuya, T., and Suzuki, S. Descriptions of Surfaces in Fourspace, Math. Semin. Notes Kobe Univ. , . . Kawauchi, A., Shibuya, T., and Suzuki, S. Descriptions of Surfaces in Fourspace, Math. Semin. Notes Kobe Univ. , . . Kazhdan, D. and Soibelman, Y. Representations of Quan tized Function Algebras, Categories and Zamolodchikov Tetrahe dra Equation, Preprint. . Korepin, V. E. Completely Integrable Models in Quasicrys tals, Commun. Math. Phys. , . . Lawrence, Ruth On Algebras and Triangle Relations, in Mickelsson, J. and Pekonen, O. Topological and Geometric Methods in Field Theory, World Scientic Publishing, Singapore, pp. . . Libgober, A. Invariants of Plane Algebraic Curves via Rep resentations of the Braid Groups, Invent. Math., . . Lin, X.S. AlexanderArtinMarkov Theory for links in R , Preprint. . Lomonaco, Sam The Homotopy Groups of Knots I. How to Compute the Algebraic Type, Pacic J. Math. . . Maillet, J. M. and Nijho, F. W. Multidimensional Integrable Lattices, Quantum Groups, and the DSimplex Equations, Inst. for NonLinear Studies preprint . . Roseman, Dennis ReidemeisterType Moves for Surfaces in Four Dimensional Space, Preprint. . Rudolph, Lee Braided Surfaces and Seifert Ribbons for Closed Braids, Commun. Math. Helv. , . . Rudolph, Lee Algebraic Functions and Closed Braids, Topol ogy , . . Soibelman, Y. The Algebra of Functions on a Compact Quan tum Group, and its Representations, Leningrad Math. J., . . Turaev, V. The YangBaxter Equation and Invariants of Links, Invent. Math. , . Reprinted in Kohno New Developments in the Theory of Knots, World Scientic Publishing, Singapore. . Zamolodchikov, A. B. Tetrahedron Equations and the Rela tivistic SMatrix of StraightStrings in Dimensions, Commun. Math. Phys. , , Reprinted in Jimbo, M. Yang Knotted Surfaces, Braid Movies, and Beyond Baxter Equation in Integrable Systems, World Scientic Publishing, Singapore. Preface A fundamental problem with quantum theories of gravity, as opposed to the other forces of nature, is that in Einsteins theory of gravity, general relativity, there is no background geometry to work with the geometry of spacetime itself becomes a dynamical variable. This is loosely summarized by saying that the theory is generally covariant. The standard model of the strong, weak, and electromagnetic forces is dominated by the presence of a nitedimensional group, the Poincar group, acting as the e symmetries of a spacetime with a xed geometrical structure. In general relativity, on the other hand, there is an innitedimensional group, the group of dieomorphisms of spacetime, which permutes dierent mathematical descriptions of any given spacetime geometry satisfying Einsteins equations. This causes two dicult problems. On the one hand, one can no longer apply the usual criterion for xing the inner product in the Hilbert space of states, namely that it be invariant under the geometrical symmetry group. This is the socalled inner product problem. On the other hand, dynamics is no longer encoded in the action of the geometrical symmetry group on the space of states. This is the socalled problem of time. The prospects for developing a mathematical framework for quantizing gravity have been considerably changed by a number of developments in the s that at rst seemed unrelated. On the one hand, Jones discovered a new polynomial invariant of knots and links, prompting an intensive search for generalizations and a unifying framework. It soon became clear that the new knot polynomials were intimately related to the physics of dimensional systems in many ways. Atiyah, however, raised the challenge of nding a manifestly dimensional denition of these polynomials. This challenge was met by Witten, who showed that they occur naturally in ChernSimons theory. ChernSimons theory is a quantum eld theory in dimensions that has the distinction of being generally covariant and also a gauge theory, that is a theory involving connections on a bundle over spacetime. Any knot thus determines a quantity called a Wilson loop, the trace of the holonomy of the connection around the knot. The knot polynomials are simply the expectation values of Wilson loops in the vacuum state of ChernSimons theory, and their dieomorphism invariance is a consequence of the general covariance of the theory. In the explosion of work that followed, it became clear that a useful framework for understanding this situation is Atiyahs axiomatic description of a topological quantum eld theory, or TQFT. On the other hand, at about the same time as Jones initial discovery, Ashtekar discovered a reformulation of general relativity in terms of v vi Preface what are now called the new variables. This made the theory much more closely resemble a gauge theory. The work of Ashtekar proceeds from the canonical approach to quantization, meaning that solutions to Einsteins equations are identied with their initial data on a given spacelike hypersurface. In this approach the action of the dieomorphism group gives rise to two constraints on initial data the dieomorphism constraint, which generates dieomorphisms preserving the spacelike surface, and the Hamiltonian constraint, which generates dieomorphisms that move the surface in a timelike direction. Following the procedure invented by Dirac, one expects the physical states to be annihilated by certain operators corresponding to the constraints. In an eort to nd such states, Rovelli and Smolin turned to a description of quantum general relativity in terms of Wilson loops. In this loop representation, they saw that at least formally a large space of states annihilated by the constraints can be described in terms of invariants of knots and links. The fact that link invariants should be annihilated by the dieomorphism constraint is very natural, since a link invariant is nothing other than a function from links to the complex numbers that is invariant under dieomorphisms of space. In this sense, the relation between knot theory and quantum gravity is a natural one. But the fact that link invariants should also be annihilated by the Hamiltonian constraint is deeper and more intriguing, since it hints at a relationship between knot theory and dimensional mathematics. More evidence for such a relationship was found by Ashtekar and Kodama, who discovered a strong connection between ChernSimons theory in dimensions and quantum gravity in dimensions. Namely, in terms of the loop representation, the same link invariant that arises from Chern Simons theorya certain normalization of the Jones polynomial called the Kauman bracketalso represents a state of quantum gravity with cosmological constant, essentially a quantization of antideSitter space. The full ramications of this fact have yet to be explored. The present volume is the proceedings of a workshop on knots and quantum gravity held on May thth, at the University of California at Riverside, under the auspices of the Departments of Mathematics and Physics. The goal of the workshop was to bring together researchers in quantum gravity and knot theory and pursue a dialog between the two subjects. On Friday the th, Dana Fine began with a talk on ChernSimons theory and the WessZuminoWitten model. Wittens original work deriving the Jones invariant of links or, more precisely, the Kauman bracket from ChernSimons theory used conformal eld theory in dimensions as a key tool. By now the relationship between conformal eld theory and topological quantum eld theories in dimensions has been explored from a number of viewpoints. The path integral approach, however, has not yet and methods for constructing TQFTs in terms of these data. Louis Kauman spoke on Vassiliev invariants and the loop states in quantum gravity. This concept also plays a major role in the study of Vassiliev invariants of knots. has been notoriously dicult to make precise. Introduction . In this talk Fine described work in progress on reducing the ChernSimons path integral on S to the path integral for the WessZuminoWitten model. She also discussed her work on applications of the loop representation to lattice gauge theory. going back to the ReggePonzano model of Euclidean quantum gravity.. The notion of measures on the space A/G of connections modulo gauge transformations has long been a key concept in gauge theory. In a sense this is an old idea. His paper with Gambini in this volume is a more detailed proof of this fact. However. however. Gambini. Kauman explained their relationship from the path integral viewpoint. largely concerned the paper with Jerzy Lewandowski appearing in this volume. Abhay Ashtekars talk. cell complexes. this idea was given new life by Turaev and Viro.Preface vii been worked out in full mathematical rigor. Curiously. Ashtekar also discussed the implications of this work for the study of quantum gravity. etc. Recently there has been increasing interest in formulating TQFTs in a manner that relies upon triangulating spacetime. that the coefcient of the nd term of the AlexanderConway polynomial represents a state of quantum gravity with zero cosmological constant. an algebra of observables generated by Wilson loops. Loop transforms. Oleg Viro spoke on Simplicial topological quantum eld theories. however. and Pullin that is especially of interest to knot u theorists is that it involves extending the bracket invariant to generalized links admitting certain kinds of selfintersections. describing his work with Bernd Br gmann and Rodolfo Gambini u on this subject. Ashtekar and Lewandowski have been able to construct such a state with remarkable symmetry properties. Pullin spoke on The quantum Einstein equations and the Jones polynomial. the extensions occurring in the two cases are dierent. introduced the loop representation and various mathematical issues associated with it. Sunday morning began with a talk by Gerald Johnson. who rigorously constructed the ReggePonzano model of d quantum gravity as a TQFT based on the j symbols for the quantum group SUq . Formalizing the notion of a measure on A/G as a state on this algebra. Saturday began with a talk by Renate Loll on The loop formulation of gauge theory and gravity. He also sketched the proof of a new result. which. One aspect of the work of Br egmann. The goal here is to make the loop representation into rigorous mathematics. On Saturday afternoon. A key notion developed by Ashtekar and Isham for this purpose is that of the holonomy Calgebra. in some sense analogous to Haar measure on a compact Lie group. Viro discussed a variety of approaches of presenting manifolds as simplicial complexes. Michel Lapidus deserves warm thanks for his help in planning the workshop. Albert Stralka and Benjamin Shen. Viktor Ginzburg then spoke on Vassiliev invariants of knots. Paolo CottaRamusino spoke on d quantum gravity and knot theory. includes quantum gravity in the Ashtekar formulation. and beyond. but the stringtheoretic approach is also related to the study of knots. The workshop was funded by the Departments of Mathematics and Physics of U. loops. Lastly. He attempted to clarify the similarity between the loop representation of quantum gravity and string theory. and Chris Truett. Carlips paper. At a xed time both involve loops or knots in space. and particularly Susan Spranger. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito. Knotted surfaces. treats the thorny issue of relating the loop representation of quantum gravity to the traditional formulation of gravity in terms of a metric. This class. which is an exactly soluble test case. spin geometry. This talk dealt with his work in progress with Maurizio Martellini. Riverside. knots and gauge elds. They also discuss the role in dimensional topology of new algebraic structures such as braided tensor categories. and in the afternoon. Invaluable help in organizing the workshop and setting things up was provided by the sta of the Department of Mathematics. and his work with Igor Frenkel on certain braided tensor categories. As some of the speakers did not submit papers for the proceedings. In the nal talk of the workshop.viii Preface to the Feynman integral and Feynmans operational calculus. Just as Chern Simons theory gives a great deal of information on knots in dimensions. the speakers and other participants are to be congratulated for making it such a lively and interesting event. The paper by Carter and Saito. C. his construction with David Yetter of a dimensional TQFT based on the j symbols for SUq . Geometric structures and loop variables. CottaRamusino and Martellini have described a way to construct observables associated to knots. contains a review of their work on knots as well as a number of new results on braids. Arthur Greenspoon kindly volunteered to help edit the proceedings. and are endeavoring to prove at a perturbative level that they give knot invariants. This was a review of his work on the relation between ChernSimons theory and dimensional quantum gravity. He treats quantum gravity in dimensions. The editor would like to thank many people for making the workshop a success. braid movies. and the chairs of these departments. as well as Donaldson theory. that is. thanks go to all the participants in the . Linda Terry. and categorical physics. embedded surfaces in dimensions. First and foremost. there appears to be a relationship between a certain class of dimensional theories and socalled knots. Louis Crane spoke on Quantum gravity. called BF theories. papers were also solicited from Steve Carlip and also from J. John Baez spoke on Strings. on his work with Michel Lapidus on rigorous path integral methods. were crucial in bringing this about. C. Riverside. and especially Jim Gilliam. Javier Muniain.Preface ix Knots and Quantum Gravity Seminar at U. who helped set things up. . and Mou Roy. x Preface . Contents The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Renate Loll Introduction YangMills theory and general relativity as dynamics on connection space Introducing loops Equivalence between the connection and loop formulations Some lattice results on loops Quantization in the loop approach Acknowledgements Bibliography Representation Theory of Analytic Holonomy Calgebras Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski Introduction Preliminaries The spectrum . U N and SU N connections Acknowledgements Bibliography The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Introduction The WheelerDeWitt equation in terms of loops The Gauss selflinking number as a solution Discussion Acknowledgements xi . Examples of A Integration on A/G . Loop decomposition . Cylindrical functions . Characterization of A/G . A natural measure Discussion Appendix A C loops and U connections Appendix B C loops. Categorical physics Ideas from TQFT Hilbert space is deadlong live Hilbert space or the observer gas approximation The problem of time . Fine Introduction The main result A/G n as a bundle over G An explicit reduction from ChernSimons to WZW Acknowledgements Bibliography Topological Field Theory as the Key to Quantum Gravity Louis Crane Introduction Quantum mechanics of the universe.xii Bibliography Contents Vassiliev Invariants and the Loop States in Quantum Gravity Louis H. Kauman Introduction Quantum mechanics and topology Links and the Wilson loop Graph invariants and Vassiliev invariants Vassiliev invariants from the functional integral Quantum gravityloop states Acknowledgements Bibliography Geometric Structures and Loop Variables in dimensional Gravity Steven Carlip Introduction From geometry to holonomies Geometric structures from holonomies to geometry Quantization and geometrical observables Acknowledgements Bibliography From ChernSimons to WZW via Path Integrals Dana S. Denition locality equivalence The permutohedral and tetrahedral equations . Baez Introduction String eld/gauge eld duality YangMills theory in dimensions Quantum gravity in dimensions Quantum gravity in dimensions Acknowledgements Bibliography BF Theories and knots Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini Introduction BF theories and their geometrical signicance knots and their quantum observables Gauss constraints Path integrals and the Alexander invariant of a knot Firstorder perturbative calculations and higherdimensional linking numbers Wilson channels Integration by parts Acknowledgements Bibliography Knotted Surfaces. The category of braid movies xiii . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Introduction Movies. Braid Movies.Contents Matter and symmetry Acknowledgements Bibliography Strings. charts. Knots. and Gauge Fields John C. Surface braids . The tetrahedral equation . Movie moves . surface braids. and isotopies . Chart descriptions . Planar versions categories and the movie moves . Braid movie moves . and Beyond J. Loops. The permutohedral equation . Overview of categories . Concluding remarks Acknowledgements Bibliography . Symmetric equivalence and moves on surface braids .xiv Contents Algebraic interpretations of braid movie moves . Identities among relations and Peier elements . Moves on surface braids and identities among relations . Pennsylvania . Introduction This chapter summarizes the main ideas and basic mathematical structures that are necessary to understand the loop formulation of both gravity and gauge theory.edu Abstract This chapter contains an overview of the loop formulation of Yang Mills theory and dimensional gravity in the Ashtekar form. It is also meant as a guide to the literature. YangMills theory and general relativity as dynamics on connection space In this section I will briey recall the Lagrangian and Hamiltonian formulation of both pure YangMills gauge theory and gravity. University Park. Since the conguration spaces of these theories are spaces of gauge potentials. Pennsylvania State University.The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Renate Loll Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry. and in Section some of the main ingredients of quantum loop representations are discussed. USA email lollphys. The gravitational theory will be described in the Ashtekar form. I discuss some mathematical problems that arise in the loop formulation and illustrate parallels and dierences between the gauge theoretic and gravitational applications. formulated as theories of connections. in which it most . Section contains a summary of progress in a corresponding lattice loop approach. their classical and quantum descriptions may be given in terms of gaugeinvariant Wilson loops. In Section .psu. Section summarizes the classical and quantum features of gauge theory and gravity. the Wilson loops and their properties are introduced. I have tried to treat YangMills theory and gravity in parallel. Some remarks are made on the discretized lattice approach. dened on a dimensional manifold M R of Lorentzian signature. Many of the mathematical problems arising in the loop approach are described in a related review article . but also to highlight important dierences. where all the relevant details may be found. and Section discusses the classical equivalence between the loop and the connection formulation. a and b are dimensional spatial indices and i . for gravity. and .. . e M M d x Tr F F M TrF F . pseudotensorial form gauge potential and E a LieGvalued vector density generalized electric eld on . and e a vierbein. Note that the action . with the totally antisymmetric tensor. for YangMills theory and general relativity respectively. The classical actions dening these theories are up to overall constants SY M A and SGR A. A mathematical characterization of the action . F denotes in both cases the curvature associated with the dimensional connection A. In . Assuming the underlying principal bre bundles P . so. Details may be found in . Ej y i j a x y a . In . for gauge theory.. d x e e e F IJ I J IJKL M eI eJ F KL . we can identify the relevant phase spaces with cotangent bundles over ane spaces A of LieGvalued connections on the dimensional manifold assumed compact and orientable. E. is contained in Baez chapter . C valued connection form. We have G SU N . dening an isomorphism of vector spaces between the tangent space of M and the xed internal space with the Minkowski metric IJ . has the unusual feature of being complex. In . and i b b Ai x. I will not explain here why this still leads to a welldened theory equivalent to the standard formulation of general relativity. the basic variable A is a LieGvalued connection form on M . The standard symplectic structure on T A is expressed by the fundamental Poisson bracket relations i b b Ai x. Renate Loll closely resembles a gauge theory. where A is a LieG valued... Ej y j a x y a . and . The cotangent bundle T A is coordinatized by canonically conjugate pairs A. As usual. i The connection A is selfdual in the internal space. G to be trivial. A is a selfdual. and G SOC for gravity. where G denotes the compact and semisimple Liestructure group of the YangMills theory typically G SU N . which is a rstorder form of the gravitational action. say. AMN MN IJ AIJ . for gauge theory. where the factor of i arises because the connection A is complex valued. Our main interest will be the Hamiltonian formulations associated with . and . we have HY M A. is A. The wellknown YangMills transformation law corresponding to a group element g G. C . However. generates phase space transformations that are interpreted as corresponding to the time evolution of the spatial slice in M in a spacetime picture. this manifests itself in the existence of socalled rstclass constraints. is a density. . for physical congurations and at the same time generate transformations between physically indistinguishable congurations. the rstclass constraints for the two theories are CY M Da E ai and b CGR Da E ai . as the Hamiltonian for YangMills theory where for convenience we have a introduced the generalized magnetic eld Bi abc Fbc i . the socalled scalar or Hamiltonian constraint C. we see that in the Hamiltonian formulation. The physical interpretation of these constraints is as follows the so called Gauss law constraints Da E ai . Comparing . because both theories possess gauge symmetries. These are sets C of functions C on phase space. pure gravity may be interpreted as a YangMills theory with gauge group G SOC . subject to four additional constraints in each point of . of constraints in . a b Fab i Ej Ek .The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity and j internal gauge algebra indices. On the other hand. At the Hamiltonian level. which are related to invariances of the original Lagrangians under certain transformations on the fundamental variables. E g Ag g dg. the set of Gvalued functions on . generates dimensional dieomorphisms of and the last expression. Note the explicit appearance of a Riemannian background metric g on . E b b d x gab E ai Ei gB ai Bi g . which are required to vanish. Ca Fab i Ei .. In our case. points in T A do not yet correspond to physical congurations. However. to contract indices and ensure the integrand in . g Eg. and at the same time generate local gauge transformations in the internal space. C ijk . Ca . which are common to both theories. The second set. the dynamics of the two theories is dierent. The Hamiltonian HGR for gravity is a sum of a . . restrict the allowed congurations to those whose covariant divergence vanishes. no such additional background structure is necessary to make the gravitational Hamiltonian well dened. and therefore vanishes on physical congurations. whose gauge group contains the dieomorphism group of the underlying manifold. This a means that one rst quantizes on the unphysical phase space T A. N and N a in . and the presence of gauge symmetries for these theories. HGR A. After excluding the reducible connections from A. E. this approach has not yielded enough information about other sectors of the theory. are Lagrange multipliers. the socalled lapse and shift functions. lead to numerous diculties in their classical and quantum description. . Similarly. That is. The corresponding physical phase space is then its cotangent bundle T A/G. one uses a formal operator repre sentation of the canonical variable pairs A. A further dierence from the gaugetheoretic application is the need for a set of reality conditions for the gravitational theory. It is nonlinear and has nontrivial topology. The nonlinearities of both the equations of motion and the physical conguration/phase spaces. as if there were no constraints. In any case. because the principal bundle A A/G is nontrivial. with Sfree being just quadratic in A. This latter feature is peculiar to generally covariant theories. subset of the constraints . a gaugexing term has to be introduced in the sum over all congurations Z A dA eiSY M . because the connection A is a priori a complex coordinate on phase space. since the expression .. h . since no good explicit description of T A/G is available. to ensure that the integration is only taken over one member A of each gauge equivalence class. can be made meaningful only in a weakeld approximation where one splits SY M Sfree SI . E i Renate Loll b i d x N a Fab i Ei N ijk a b Fab k Ei Ej . in the canonical quantization. in the path integral quantization of YangMills theory. a j j a . this quotient can be given the structure of an innitedimensional manifold for compact and semisimple G . The space of physical congurations of YangMills theory is the quotient space A/G of gauge potentials modulo local gauge transformations. Elements of T A/G are called classical observables of the YangMills theory. where the elds cannot be assumed weak. satisfying the canonical commutation relations Ai x. one quantizes the theory la Dirac. . However. For example. E b y i i b x y. we know that a unique and attainable gauge choice does not exist this is the assertion of the socalled Gribov ambiguity. If we had such a measure again. DE. Whereas this is not required on the unphysical YM space F .. one does need such a structure on Fphy in order to make physical statements. i. Gauss constraint.e. Again. Unfortunately.. The notations F and Fphy indicate that these are just spaces of complexvalued functions on A and do not yet carry any Hilbert space structure. Given such a measure. well dened. see . . reads phy . one now needs an inner product on the space of such states. . Unfortunately. the Hilbert space HGR of states for quantum gravity would conGR sist of all those elements of Fphy which are squareintegrable with respect to that measure. an appropriate gaugeinvariant measure dAG in phy . Fphy consists of all functions that lie in the kernel of the quantized A/G More precisely.e. the analogue of . YM i. the situation for gravity is not much better. according to YM Fphy A F DEA .The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity the quantum analogues of the Poisson brackets . we lack an appropriate scalar product. phy . phy M dA Aphy A. In theup to nowabsence of explicit measures to make . phy dAG Aphy A. we expect the integral to range over an extension of the space A/G which includes also distributional elements .. . F A. CA . where the measure dA is now both gauge and dieomorphism invariant and projects in an appropriate way to M. for instance about the spectrum of the quantum Hamiltonian H. our condence in the procedure outlined here stems from the fact that it can be made meaningful for lowerdimensional model systems such as YangMills theory in and gravity in di . we do not. the space of physical wave functions would be the Hilbert space YM HY M Fphy of functions squareintegrable with respect to the inner product . Ca A . For a critical appraisal of the use of such Dirac YM conditions. phy . Then a subset of YM physical wave functions Fphy phy A is projected out from the space of all wave functions. Here the space of physical wave functions is the subspace of F projected out according to GR Fphy A F DEA . Assuming that the states phy of quantum gravity can be described as the set of complexvalued functions on some still innitedimensional space M. we can dene . whereas in gravity the quantum Hamiltonian C is one of the constraints and therefore a physical state of quantum gravity must lie in its kernel. one searches for solutions in HY M of the eigenvector equation HY M phy A Ephy A. Note that there is a very important dierence in the role played by the quantum Hamiltonians in gauge theory and gravity. which also in this framework are not well understood. where the analogues of the space M are nite dimensional cf. also . Cphy A . For the case of YangMills theory. However. Many qualitative and quantitative statements about quantum gauge theory can be derived in a regularized version of the theory. the most important being the connement property of YangMills theory. One important ingredient we will be focusing on are the nonlocal loop variables on the space A of connections. Still there are nonperturbative features. Introducing loops . Similar attempts to discretize the Hamiltonian theory have so far been not very fruitful in the treatment of gravity. and a space A of connections. s. because. . Renate Loll mensions. . where the at background spacetime is approximated by a hypercubic lattice. one then tries to extract for either weak or strong coupling properties of the continuum theory. in the limit as the lattice spacing tends to zero. there is no xed background metric with respect to which one could build a hypercubic lattice. A loop in is a continuous map from the unit interval into . . which will be the subject of the next section. The set of all such maps will be denoted by . After all that has been said about the diculties of nding a canonical quantization for gauge theory and general relativity. An example of this is given by the latticelike structures used in the construction of dieomorphisminvariant measures on the space A/G . without violating the dieomorphism invariance of the theory. the loop space of . t. there are more subtle ways in which discrete structures arise in canonical quantum gravity. Using rened computational methods. Given such a loop element . the answer is of course in the armative. for exam ple an approximate spectrum of the Hamiltonian HY M . s a s. In YangMills theory. unlike in YangMills theory. the reader may wonder whether one can make any statements at all about their quantum theories. and N is the dimensionality of this linear representation. It is invariant under orientationpreserving reparametrizations of the loop . is also known as the holonomy of A along . T T . there is now one more reason to consider variables that depend on closed curves in . the socalled Wilson loop. and therefore an observable for YangMills theory. .. It is independent of the basepoint chosen on . by considering Wilson loops that are constant along the orbits of the Diaction. . TA FA/G /Di S . etc. The trace is taken in the representation R of G. The Wilson loop has a number of interesting properties. In contrast. . The pathordered exponential of the connection A along the loop . since observables in gravity also have to be invariant under diffeomorphisms of . . Wilson as an indicator of conning behaviour in the lattice gauge theory . . which is not usually considered in knot theory. The analogue of . The use of nonlocal holonomy variables in gauge eld theory was pioneered by Mandelstam in his paper on Quantum electrodynamics . as can easily be seen by expanding TA for an innitesimal loop . The holonomy measures the change undergone by an internal vector when parallel transported along . Such a loop variable will just depend on what is called the generalized knot class K of generalized since may possess selfintersections and selfoverlaps. It follows from and that the Wilson loop is a function on a crossproduct of the quotient spaces. However. would then tell us that had to be constant on any connected component of . since they are not invariant under the full set of gauge transformations of the theory. Di. x. In gravity. TA TrR P exp N A. This means going one step further in the construction of such observables. Note that a similar construction for taking care of the dieomorphism invariance is not very contentful if we start from a local scalar function. say. It is invariant under the local gauge transformations . the Wilson loops are not observables. U P exp A. The set of such variables is not big enough to account for all the degrees of freedom of gravity. It measures the curvature or eld strength in a gaugeinvariant way the components of the tensor Fab itself are not measurable. number of points of nondierentiability. The quantity TA was rst introduced by K. loops can carry dieomorphisminvariant information such as their number of selfintersections.The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity a complex function on A . as will be explained in the next section. there is no action principle in terms of loop variables. Another upsurge in interest in pathdependent formulations of YangMills theory took place at the end of the s. which are to be thought of as the analogues of the usual local YangMills equations of motion. this in general will ensure the existence of neither inverse and implicit function theorems nor theorems on the existence and uniqueness of solutions of dierential equations. For the YangMills theory itself. . one rst has to introduce a suitable topology. or for their vacuum expectation values. following the observation of the close formal resemblance of a particular form of the YangMills equations in terms of holonomy variables with the equations of motion of the dimensional nonlinear sigma model . and then set up a dierential calculus on . one expects that not all loop variables will be independent. the holonomy or the Wilson loop seem like ideal candidates. and has therefore obscured many attempts of establishing an equivalence between the connection and the loop formulation of gauge theory. The aim has therefore been to derive suitable dierential equations in loop space for the holonomy U . the review . Since the space of all loops in is so much larger than the set of all points in . and are able to dene dierentiation. The hope underlying such approaches has always been that one may be able to nd a set of basic variables for YangMills theory which are better suited to its quantization than the local gauge potentials Ax. Renate Loll without potentials . Still. For example. for example. Even if we give locally the structure of a topological vector space. Owing to their simple behaviour under local gauge transformations. This expectation is indeed correct. T . its trace. To make sense of dierential equations on loop space. perturbation theory in the loop approach always had to fall back on the perturbative expansion in terms of the connection variable A. Another set of equations for the Wilson loop was derived by Makeenko and Migdal see. there is a strong physical motivation to choose . Such issues have only received scant attention in the past. The fact that none of these attempts have been very successful can be attributed to a number of reasons. and later generalized to the nonAbelian theory by BialynickiBirula and again Mandelstam . the ensuing redundancy is hard to control in the continuum theory. which leaves considerable freedom for deriving loop equations of motion. As another consequence. Equivalence between the connection and loop formulations In this section I will discuss the motivation for adopting a pure loop formulation for any theory whose conguration space comes from a space A/G of connection forms modulo local gauge transformations. They are typically algebraic. in our case the Wilson loops. For example. /Di S . . Mandelstam constraints . exhaust the Mandelstam constraints for this particular gauge group and representation. It turns out that. nonlinear constraints among the T . To obtain a complete set of such conditions without making reference to the connection space A is a nontrivial problem that for general G to my knowledge has not been solved. This is the case for holonomies that take their values in the socalled subgroup of null rotations . at least for compact G. However. for any structure group G GLN. Therefore all that remains to be shown is that one can reconstruct the holonomies U from the set of Wilson loops T . this leads only to an incompleteness of measure zero of the Wilson . In e. although I am not aware of a formal proof. for G SL. Still. C in the fundamental representation by matrices.e. By Mandelstam constraints I mean a set of necessary and sucient conditions on generic complex functions f on /Di S that ensure they are the traces of holonomies of a group G in a given representation R. The loop in eqn d is the loop with an appendix attached. T T . owing to the noncompactness of G. it can be shown that not every element of A/G can be reconstructed from the Wilson loops. . one requires only physical observables O i.The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity the variables T as a set of basic variables on physical grounds. is a path starting at a point of and ending at see Fig. with the classical Poisson relations O. It is a wellknown result that one can reconstruct the gauge potential A up to gauge transformations from the knowledge of all holonomies U . there is indeed an equivalence between the two quotient spaces A G T . h There is also a mathematical justication for reexpressing the classical theory in terms of loop variables. and all conditions that can be derived from . . the Mandelstam constraints are a b c d e T T T point loop T T T T T T . It is believed that the set . C. O going over to the quantum commutators i O. The circle denotes the usual path composition. O . and not the local elds A to be represented by selfadjoint operators O in the quantum theory. where is any path not necessarily closed starting at a point of see Fig. whereas for SU . which now take the form of inequalities . C one derives T T T T T T . T T T T . and no restrictions for other values of T and T . The loop congurations related by the Mandelstam constraint T T T T loops on A/G. . one nds the two conditions T . C. . Adding an appendix to the loop does not change the Wilson loop Fig. . there are further conditions on the loop variables. . SL. C. Renate Loll Fig. . Unfortunately. If one wants to restrict the group G to a subgroup of SL. For SU SL. but real progress in this direction has only been made in the discretized lattice gauge theory see Section below. . as applied to gauge theory. because in it the gauge elds are taken to be concentrated on the dimensional links li of the lattice. The existence of such relations makes it dicult to apply directly mathematical results on the loop space or the space /Di S of oriented. Finally.e. Note that one may interpret some of the constraints . . One may indeed hope that at some level. implicitly the nontrivial topological structure of A/G. with the loop representation being better suited for the description of the nonperturbative structure of the theory. The Wilson loops are easily formed by multiplying together the holonomies Ul . although some of the techniques and conclusions may be relevant for gravitational theories too. the Wilson loops are eectively not functions on /Di S . to the present case. but on some appropriate quotient with respect to equivalence relations such as . and . There are more inequalities corresponding to more complicated congurations of more than two intersecting loops. let me emphasize that the equivalence of the connection and the loop description at the classical level does not necessarily mean that quantization with the Wilson loops as a set of basic variables will be equivalent to a quantization in which the connections A are turned into fundamental quantum operators. Some lattice results on loops This section describes the idea of taking the Wilson loops as the set of basic variables. Let me nish this section with some further remarks on the Mandelstam constraints In cases where the Wilson loops form a complete set of variables. respectively. Another possibility will be mentioned in Section . which are critically dependent on the geometry of the loop conguration. This is the overcompleteness I referred to in the previous section. One may try to eliminate as many of them as possible already in the classical theory. The lattice discretization is particularly suited to the loop formulation. those two possibilities lead to dierent results. do not exhaust all inequalities there are for SU and SU . oriented links that form . due to the existence of the Mandelstam constraints i. they are actually overcomplete. One has to decide how the Mandelstam constraints are to be carried over to the quantum theory.e. as constraints on the underlying loop space. . unparametrized loops such as . i.The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity . Uln of a set of contiguous. . Again. with a compact. Although the lattice is nite. and hence an innite number of Wilson loops. and the gauge group G to be SU . using the Mandelstam constraints see. in terms of which all the others can be expressed. Uln . the number of Mandelstam constraints . Renate Loll Fig. it is possible to solve this coupled set of equations and obtain an explicit local description of the nitedimensional physical conguration space Cphy A G lattice T . . is innite. consisting of no more than six lattice links. in terms of an independent set of Wilson loops. We take the lattice to be the hypercubic lattice N d . as I showed in . dimensional Riemann surface g of genus g. One also has a discrete set of loops. . . there are an innite number of closed contours one can form on it. N . d . . T TrR Ul Ul . a lattice loop Mandelstam constraints . with periodic boundary conditions N is the number of links in each direction. . At the same time. . Nevertheless. The nal solution for the independent degrees of freedom is surprisingly simple it suces to use the Wilson loops of small lattice loops. one is interested in nding a maximally reduced set of such Wilson loops. At this point it may be noted that a similar problem arises in gravity in the connection formulation on a manifold g R. again in the fundamental representation. The only constraints that cause problems are those of type e. . for example. and can introduce the corresponding Wilson loops. . because of their nonlinear and highly coupled character. namely. a closed chain on the lattice see Fig. is a loop on the hypercubic lattice N d . the elements of the homotopy group of g . and it is clear that all of the aboveposed problems are rather nontrivial. Quantization in the loop approach I will now return to the discussion of the continuum theory of both gravity and gauge theory. . even in the discretized lattice theory where the number of degrees of freedom is eectively nite. and maybe derive a prescription of how to translate local quantities into their loop space analogues. . What are the consequences of this result for the continuum theory. where there is no obstruction to shrinking loops down to points Some progress on points and has been made for small lattices . one also has to show that the dynamics can be expressed in a manageable form in terms of these variables. Since the space Cphy A/G is topologically nontrivial. where discrete structures appear too the generalized knot classes after factoring out by the spatial dieomorphisms. . and review a few concepts that have been used in their quantization in a loop formulation. What is the explicit form of the Jacobian of the transformation from the holonomy link variables to the Wilson loops From this one could derive an eective action/Hamiltonian for gauge theory. once one understands which Wilson loop congurations contribute most in the path integral. One may be able to apply some of the techniques used here to dimensional gravity. gaugeinvariant phase space variables T and not on some gaugecovariant local eld variables. and may lead to new and more ecient ways of performing calculations in lattice gauge theory. This . It would therefore be desirable to nd a minimal embedding into a space of loop variables that is topologically trivial together with a nite number of nonlinear constraints that dene the space Cphy . Lastly. in nding a solution to the Mandelstam constraints it was crucial to have the concept of a smallest loop size on the lattice the loops of link length going around a single plaquette. The contributions by Ashtekar and Lewandowski and Pullin in this volume contain more details about some of the points raised here. Some important problems are the following. .The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Of course it does not suce to establish a set of independent loop variables on the lattice. say This would be an interesting alternative to the usual perturbation theory in A or the N expansion. the set of independent lattice Wilson loops cannot provide a good global chart for Cphy . Is it possible to dene a perturbation theory in loop space. The main idea is to base the canonical quantization of a theory with conguration space A on the nonlocal. For gauge group SU N . but needs an additional geometric ingredient. T a . In any case. T b . In the derivation of this semidirect product algebra. T a . ut T b . C or any of its subgroups in the fundamental representation. . You may have noted that so far we have only talked about conguration space variables. t . the momentum Wilson loop depends not just on a loop. t. but a vector density. the righthand sides of the Poisson brackets can no longer be written as linear expressions in T .e. The structure constants are distributional and depend just on the geometry of loops and intersection points. Also it is strictly speaking not a function on phase space. ut .e have been used to bring the righthand sides into a form linear in T . The crucial ingredient in the canonical quantization is the fact that the loop variables T . b b s . T a . a nondegenerate parameter congruence of curves t s Rs. . This fact was rst established by Gambini and Trias for the gauge group SU N and later rediscovered by Rovelli and Smolin in the context of gravity . and it is still gauge invariant under the transformations . T a . The Poisson bracket of two loop variables is nonvanishing only when an insertion of an electric eld E in a T a variable coincides in with the holonomy of another loop. x dt t. . but takes directly into account the nonlinearities of the theory. i.. t T a t . One choice of a generalized Wilson loop that also depends is on E a TA. . x a t. For a canonical quantization we obviously need some momentum variables that depend on the generalized electric eld E. This variable depends now on both a loop and a marked point. This latter fact may be remedied by integrating T a over a dimensional ribbon or strip. t a . s form a closing algebra with respect to the canonical symplectic structure on T A. the Wilson loops.E . the Poisson algebra of the loop variable s is T . the Mandelstam constraints . vs . s T s T s . a . s. s. s Tr U sE a s. T . Renate Loll is a somewhat unusual procedure in the quantization of a eld theory. For the special case of G SL. vs T a t . I will use here the unsmeared version since it does not aect what I am going to say. s T s . solutions to these quantum constraints have to be found. but there exist a large number of solutions to the quantum constraint equations . i. Ca T . . These solutions and their relation to knot invariants are the subject of Pullins chapter . the space of these solutions or an appropriate subspace has to be given a Hilbert space structure to make a physical interpretation possible. . The completion of this quantization program is dierent for gauge theory and gravity. to obtain the spectrum of the theory. Finally. Because of the lack of an appropriate scalar product in the continuum theory. since they correspond to genuine observables in the classical theory. has to be reexpressed as a function of Wilson loops. s. For YangMills theory. T a . Then the YangMills Hamiltonian . as the commutator algebra of a set of selfadjoint operators T . . For the momentum Wilson loops there are analogous Mandelstam constraints. s to be represented selfadjointly. one has to solve the eigenvector equation HY M T . There is one more interesting mathematical structure in the loop ap .The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity By a quantization of the theory in the loop representation we will mean a representation of the loop algebra . For the case of general relativity one does not require the loop variables T . loop functionals that lie in their kernel. T a . the only progress that has been made along these lines is in the latticeregularized version of the gauge theory see. which again means that they have to be reexpressed in terms of loop variables. and nally. Then. cf.e. T a E. .. for example. the Mandelstam constraints must be incorporated in the quantum theory. hold also for the corresponding quan tum operators T . s or an appropriately smeared version of the momentum operator T a . . T a . for example by demanding that relations like . Secondly. one has to nd a Hilbert space of wave functionals that depend on either the Wilson loops T or directly on the elements of some appropriate quotient of a loop space. in line with the remarks made in Section above. No suitable scalar product is known at the moment. and has been extensively used in quantum gravity. T a CT . The completion of the loop quantization program for gravity requires an appropriate inclusion of the dimensional dieomorphism constraints Ca and the Hamiltonian constraint C.. because they do not constitute observables on the classical phase space. The quantized Wilson loops must be selfadjoint with respect to the inner product on this Hilbert space. At least one such representation where the generalized Wilson loops are represented as dierential operators on a space of loop functionals is known. . etc. that Rovelli and Smolin arrived at the quantum representation of the loop algebra . and which tries to establish a relation between the quantum connection and the quantum loop representations. Indeed. a variety of simpler examples such as dimensional gravity. although in this case the loop transform can be given a rigorous mathematical meaning. is to be thought of as a nonlinear analogue of the Fourier transform p dx eixp x . which is supposed to intertwine the two types of representations according to A/G dAG TA phy A . however. .. Renate Loll proach to which I would like to draw attention. but for this case we know even less about the welldenedness of expressions like . both classically and quantummechanically. For the application to gravity. and . This is the socalled loop transform. and . dx. as explained in Section above. There is. summarizes the relations between connection and loop dynamics. mentioned above. and similarly for the action of the T a . rst introduced by Rovelli and Smolin . but does in general not possess an inverse. the domain space of the integration will be a smaller space M. electrodynamics. for Yang Mills theory we do not know how to construct a concrete measure dAG that would allow us to proceed with a loop quantization program. and T A/G dAG TA T phy A . Again. The following diagram Fig. where the loop transform is a very useful and mathematically welldened tool. on L R. it was by the heuristic use of . as outlined in Sections and . The relation . The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity Fig. . . Fulp.. Ashtekar. A. I. A. SU QCD in the path representation. D . J. I. Arms. Rev. Representations of the holonomy algebras of gravity and nonAbelian gauge theories. Bibliography . this volume . Polon. M. Connections on the path bundle of a principal bre bundle. A. this volume . and Lewandowski. Br gmann. preprint Montevideo. and gauge elds. J. . Math. loops. R. . O. Gambini. Brylinski. Marsden. Ashtekar. Bull. L. Les Houches lecture notes.. M. April . Gaugeinvariant variables in the YangMills theory. O. The gauge eld as chiral eld on the path and its integrability. New loop representations for gravity. Ashtekar. in preparation . in Proceedings of the Summer Institute on Dierential Geometry. State pure mathematics report No. The nonintegrable phase factor and gauge theory. Singapore. and Setaro. A. Lectures on nonperturbative gravity. Mathematical problems of nonperturbative quantum general relativity. The Kaehler geometry of the space of knots in a smooth threefold. and Trias. Baez. Symmetry and bifurcations of momentum mappings. World Scientic. to appear in the Proceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology. Strings. . R. V. eds L. J. Ashtekar. J. Gambini. Penn. . J. Yetter. preprint Syracuse SUGP/ . The method of loops applied to lattice gauge theory. . A. Dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations. Sci. J. Arefeva. Lett. B. hepth . J. Baez. Penn. BialynickiBirula. Phys. State University preprint. Representation theory of analytic Calgebras. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . C. Math. and Loll. Fulp. Ashtekar. preprint North Carolina State University . Renate Loll Acknowledgements Warm thanks to John Baez for organizing an inspiring workshop. Ya. Commun. and Moncrief. Math. Gauge dynamics in the Crepresentation. knots. R. Crane and D. A. Acad. u Phys. Phys. Symposia in Pure Mathematics Series . PM . E. and Isham. R. R. Phys. R. Phys. S. B Schper. S. Phys. V. Loop space representation of quantum general relativity. Geometry of loop spaces. Quantum electrodynamics without potentials. . . . R.. Loll. Rev. Moncrief. Wilson. A KaluzaKlein type point a of view. R. R. B Loll. A. Nelson. . Phys. Commun. State University preprint CGPG/. and Regge. . eds M. Connement of quarks. Feynman rules for electromagnetic and YangMills elds from the gaugeindependent eldtheoretic formalism. D . L. Rev. and Stornaiolo. I. in Mathematical aspects of classical eld theory. pp. and Smolin. Gotay. March . K. YangMills theory without Mandelstam constraints. Math. J. D Goldberg. The Gauss linking number in quantum gravity. J. . Nucl. . Phys.. R. String representations and hidden symmetries for gauge elds. A. Ann. Penn. preprint Freiburg THEP /. C. Phys. J. . B Pullin. Migdal. M. Canonical and BRSTquantization of constrained systems. T. Phys. NY Mandelstam. Degeneracy in loop variables. Phys. A. . Classical amp Quantum Gravity Mandelstam. Rep. Contemporary Mathematics Series. U. J. September Loll. Phys. Math. . Nucl. . Lett. R. vol. Loop equations and /N expansion. J. gravity for genus gt . Loll. this volume Rovelli. Rev. C. Phys. Nucl. Reconstruction of gauge potentials from Wilson loops. B Giles. Lewandowski. Chromodynamics and gravity as theories on loop space. . E. hepth . Phys. . N. . Phys. Polyakov. B Loll. Commun. . .The Loop Formulation of Gauge Theory and Gravity . Nucl. Independent SUloop variables and the reduced conguration space of SUlattice gauge theory. Marsden. Loop variable inequalities in gravity and gauge theory. Renate Loll . In a typical setup. Gainesville. by the traces of holonomies of connections around closed loops.psu.pl Abstract Integral calculus on the space A/G of gaugeequivalent connections is developed. This measure can be used to dene the Hilbert space of quantum states in theories of connections. Warszawa.edu Jerzy Lewandowski Department of Physics. regular measures on a suitable completion of A/G are in correspondence with certain functions of loops and dieomorphism invariant measures correspond to generalized knot and link invariants. The general setting is provided by the Abelian Calgebra of functions on A/G generated by Wilson loops i. USA email ashtekarphys. including certain topological theories and general relativity . Loops. University of Florida. Pennsylvania . The framework is well suited for quantization of dieomorphisminvariant theories of connections. a faithful. In the quantum theory.edu. links. dieomorphisminvariant measure is introduced.Representation Theory of Analytic Holonomy Calgebras Abhay Ashtekar Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry. Pennsylvania State University. the Hilbert space of states On leave from Instytut Fizyki Teoretycznej. Poland . The Wilson loop functionals then serve as the conguration operators in the quantum theory. Florida . Introduction The space A/G of connections modulo gauge transformations plays an important role in gauge theories. USA email lewandfuw. Hoza . University Park.e. and graphs feature prominently in this description. A/G is the classical conguration space. The representation theory of this algebra leads to an interesting and powerful duality between gauge equivalence classes of connections and certain equivalence classes of closed loops. By carrying out a nonlinear extension of the theory of cylindrical measures on topological vector spaces. then. knots. Warsaw University ul. In particular. n will be taken to be and G will be taken to be SU both for concreteness and simplicity. at the outset. For this. the Wilson loop functions provide a natural set of manifestly gaugeinvariant conguration observables. Consequently. will be a Cauchy surface in an n dimensional spacetime in the Lorentzian regime or an ndimensional spacetime in the Euclidean regime. the Gelfand spectral theory provides a natural setting since any given Abelian Calgebra with identity is naturally isomorphic with the Calgebra of continuous functions on a compact. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski would consist of all squareintegrable functions on A/G with respect to some measure. Even if this problem could be overcome. Since these are conguration observables. The next step is to construct representations of this algebra. These choices correspond to the simplest nontrivial applications of the framework to physics. they commute even in the quantum theory. Thus. the theory of integration over A/G would lie at the heart of the quantization procedure. In a Hamiltonian approach. As the notation suggests. Fix an nmanifold on which the connections are to be dened and a compact Lie group G which will be the gauge group of the theory under consideration. In the main body of this paper. Ashtekar and Isham hereafter referred to as AI developed an algebraic approach to tackle these problems. The Calgebra is therefore Abelian. there is a correspondence between regular measures on spC In typical applications. the wellknown techniques to dene integrals do not go through and. A natural strategy is to use the Wilson loop functionsthe traces of holonomies of connections around closed loops on to generate this Calgebra. . since A/G is an innitedimensional nonlinear space. AI pointed out that. spC can be constructed directly from the given Calgebra its elements are homomorphisms from the given Calgebra to the algebra of complex numbers. the Gelfand spectrum spC of that algebra. d for some regular measure d and the Wilson loop operators act on squareintegrable functions on spC simply by multiplication. manifestly gaugeinvariant momentum observables is dicult already in the classical theory these observables would correspond to vector elds on A/G and dierential calculus on this space is not well developed. Unfortunately. one would still face the issue of constructing selfadjoint operators corresponding to physically interesting observables. since the elements of the Calgebra are labelled by loops. The rst step is the construction of a Calgebra of conguration observablesa suciently large set of gaugeinvariant functions of connections on . every continuous cyclic representation of the AI Calgebra is of the following type the carrier Hilbert space is L spC . the problem appears to be rather dicult. The problem of constructing the analogous. Hausdor space. The AI approach is in the setting of canonical quantization and is based on the ideas introduced by Gambini and Trias in the context of YangMills theories and by Rovelli and Smolin in the context of quantum general relativity . Recently. Holonomy Calgebras and certain functions on the space of loops. Dieomorphisminvariant measures correspond to knot and link invariants. Thus, there is a natural interplay between connections and loops, a point which will play an important role in the present paper. Note that, while the classical conguration space is A/G, the domain space of quantum states is spC . AI showed that A/G is naturally embedded in spC and Rendall showed that the embedding is in fact dense. Elements of spC can be therefore thought of as generalized gaugeequivalent connections. To emphasize this point and to simplify the notation, let us denote the spectrum of the AI Calgebra by A/G. The fact that the domain space of quantum states is a completion ofand hence larger thanthe classical conguration space may seem surprising at rst since in ordinary i.e. nonrelativistic quantum mechanics both spaces are the same. The enlargement is, however, characteristic of quantum eld theory, i.e. of systems with an innite number of degrees of freedom. AI further explored the structure of A/G but did not arrive at a complete characterization of its elements. They also indicated how one could make certain heuristic considerations of Rovelli and Smolin precise and associate momentum operators with closed strips i.e. ndimensional ribbons on . However, without further information on the measure d on A/G, one cannot decide if these operators can be made selfadjoint, or indeed if they are even densely dened. AI did introduce certain measures with which the strip operators interact properly. However, as they pointed out, these measures have support only on nitedimensional subspaces of A/G and are therefore too simple to be interesting in cases where the theory has an innite number of degrees of freedom. In broad terms, the purpose of this paper is to complete the AI program in several directions. More specically, we will present the following results . We will obtain a complete characterization of elements of the Gelfand spectrum. This will provide a degree of control on the domain space of quantum states which is highly desirable since A/G is a nontrivial, innitedimensional space which is not even locally compact, while A/G is a compact Hausdor space, the completion procedure is quite nontrivial. Indeed, it is the lack of control on the precise content of the Gelfand spectrum of physically interesting Calgebras that has prevented the Gelfand theory from playing a prominent role in quantum eld theory so far. . We will present a faithful, dieomorphisminvariant measure on A/G. The theory underlying this construction suggests how one might introduce other dieomorphisminvariant measures. Recently, Baez has exploited this general strategy to introduce new measures. These developments are interesting from a strictly mathematical standpoint because the issue of existence of such measures was a subject of Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski controversy until recently . They are also of interest from a physical viewpoint since one can, for example, use these measures to regulate physically interesting operators such as the constraints of general relativity and investigate their properties in a systematic fashion. . Together, these results enable us to dene a RovelliSmolin loop transform rigorously. This is a map from the Hilbert space L A/G, d to the space of suitably regular functions of loops on . Thus, quantum states can be represented by suitable functions of loops. This loop representation is particularly well suited to dieomorphisminvariant theories of connections, including general relativity. We have also developed dierential calculus on A/G and shown that the strip i.e. momentum operators are in fact densely dened, symmetric operators on L A/G, d i.e. that they interact with our measure correctly. However, since the treatment of the strip operators requires a number of new ideas from physics as well as certain techniques from graph theory, these results will be presented in a separate work. The methods we use can be summarized as follows. First, we make the nonlinear duality between connections and loops explicit. On the connection side, the appropriate space to consider is the Gelfand spectrum A/G of the AI Calgebra. On the loop side, the appropriate object is the space of hoopsi.e. holonomically equivalent loops. More precisely, let us consider based, piecewise analytic loops and regard two as being equivalent if they give rise to the same holonomy evaluated at the basepoint for any Gconnection. Call each holonomic equivalence class a Ghoop. It is straightforward to verify that the set of hoops has the structure of a group. It also carries a natural topology , which, however, will not play a role in this paper. We will denote it by HG and call it the hoop group. It turns out that HG and the spectrum A/G can be regarded as being dual to each other in the following sense . Every element of HG denes a continuous, complexvalued function on A/G and these functions generate the algebra of all continuous functions on A/G. . Every element of A/G denes a homomorphism from HG to the gauge group G which is unique modulo an automorphism of G and every homomorphism denes an element of A/G. In the case of topological vector spaces, the duality mapping respects the topology and the linear structure. In the present case, however, HG has the structure only of a group and A/G of a topological space. The duality mappings can therefore respect only these structures. Property above should add, however, that in most of these debates, it was A/Grather than its completion A/Gthat was the center of attention. We Holonomy Calgebras provides us with a complete algebraic characterization of the elements of Gelfand spectrum A/G while property species the topology of the spectrum. The second set of techniques involves a family of projections from the topological space A/G to certain nitedimensional manifolds. For each subgroup of the hoop group HG, generated by n independent hoops, we dene a projection from A/G to the quotient, Gn /Ad, of the nth power of the gauge group by the adjoint action. An element of Gn /Ad is thus an equivalence class of ntuples, g , . . . , gn , with gi G, where g , . . . , gn g g g , . . . , g gn g for any g G. The lifts of funcn tions on G /Ad are then the nonlinear analogs of the cylindrical functions on topological vector spaces. Finally, since each Gn /Ad is a compact topological space, we can equip it with measures to integrate functions in the standard fashion. This in turn enables us to dene cylinder measures on A/G and integrate cylindrical functions thereon. Using the Haar measure on G, we then construct a natural, dieomorphisminvariant, faithful measure on A/G. Finally, for completeness, we will summarize the strategy we have adopted to introduce and analyze the momentum operators, although, as mentioned above, these results will be presented elsewhere. The rst observation is that we can dene vector elds on A/G as derivations on the ring of cylinder functions. Then, to dene the specic vector elds corresponding to the momentum or strip operators we introduce certain notions from graph theory. These specic vector elds are divergencefree with respect to our cylindrical measure on A/G, i.e. they leave the cylindrical measure invariant. Consequently, the momentum operators are densely dened and symmetric on the Hilbert space of squareintegrable functions on A/G. The paper is organized as follows. Section is devoted to preliminaries. In Section , we obtain the characterization of elements of A/G and also present some examples of those elements which do not belong to A/G, i.e. which represent genuine, generalized gauge equivalence classes of connections. Using the machinery introduced in this characterization, in Section we introduce the notion of cylindrical measures on A/G and then dene a natural, faithful, dieomorphisminvariant, cylindrical measure. Section contains concluding remarks. In all these considerations, the piecewise analyticity of loops on plays an important role. That is, the specic constructions and proofs presented here would not go through if the loops were allowed to be just piecewise smooth. However, it is far from being obvious that the nal results would not go through in the smooth category. To illustrate this point, in Appendix A we restrict ourselves to U connections and, by exploiting the Abelian character of this group, show how one can obtain the main results of this paper using piecewise C loops. Whether similar constructions are possible in the nonAbelian case is, however, an open question. Finally, in Appendix Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski B we consider another extension. In the main body of the paper, is a manifold and the gauge group G is taken to be SU . In Appendix B, we indicate the modications required to incorporate SU N and U N connections on an nmanifold keeping, however, piecewise analytic loops. Preliminaries In this section, we will introduce the basic notions, x the notation, and recall those results from the AI framework which we will need in the subsequent discussion. Fix a dimensional, real, analytic, connected, orientable manifold . Denote by P , SU a principal bre bundle P over the base space and the structure group SU . Since any SU bundle over a manifold is trivial we take P to be the product bundle. Therefore, SU connections on P can be identied with suvalued form elds on . Denote by A the space of smooth say C SU connections, equipped with one of the standard Sobolev topologies see, e.g., . Every SU valued function g on denes a gauge transformation in A, A g g Ag g dg. . Let us denote the quotient of A under the action of this group G of local gauge transformations by A/G. Note that the ane space structure of A is lost in this projection A/G is a genuinely nonlinear space with a rather complicated topological structure. The next notion we need is that of closed loops in . Let us begin by considering continuous, piecewise analytic C parametrized paths, i.e. maps p , s . . . sn , . which are continuous on the whole domain and C on the closed intervals sk , sk . Given two paths p , and p , such that p p , we denote by p p the natural composition p p s p s, for s , p s , for s , . . The inverse of a path p , is a path p s p s. . A path which starts and ends at the same point is called a loop. We will be interested in based loops. Let us therefore x, once and for all, a point x . Denote by Lx the set of piecewise C loops which are based at x , i.e. which start and end at x . Given a connection A on P , SU , a loop Lx , and a xed point x in the ber over the point x , we denote the corresponding element of the A. . where A A/G. We will call it the hoop group . Denote it by HA and call it the holonomy algebra. A H. the group structure of HG has been systematically exploited and extended by Di Bartolo. e. Owing to SU trace identities. bounded between and T A Tr H. where. and where the trace is taken in the fundamental representation of SU . where e is the identity in SU . on the right. whence the hoop should in fact be called an SU hoop. so that p p is a loop in Lx . for example.g. we drop this sux. More precisely. A. they belong to the same hoop.Holonomy Calgebras holonomy group by H. two loops which have the same orientation and which dier only in their parametrization dene the same hoop. has a natural group structure . . Thus. since the group is xed to be SU in the main body of this paper. we can now introduce the AI Calgebra. Lx will be said to be holonomically equivalent. The collection of all hoops will be denoted by HG. Note that in general the equivalence relation depends on the choice of the gauge group. Each holonomic equivalence class will be called a hoop. With this machinery at hand. . if paths p and p are such that p p and p p x . A. any loop in the hoop . Since P is a product bundle. Since each T is a bounded continuous func The hoop equivalence relation seems to have been introduced independently by a number of authors in dierent contexts e. The hoop to which a loop belongs will be denoted by . by Gambini and collaborators in their investigation of YangMills theory and by Ashtekar in the context of gravity. it has the structure of a algebra. Recently. if two loops dier just by a retraced segment. T is called the Wilson loop function in the physics literature. because of the properties of the holonomy map. for every SU connection A in A. i H. and Griego to develop a new and potentially powerful framework for gauge theories. products of these functions can be expressed as sums T T T T . and if is a path starting at the point p p . However. Using the space of connections A. We begin by assigning to every HG a realvalued function T on A/G. Gambini. the space of hoops. then p p and p p dene the same hoop. Note that. Therefore. HG. thus HG Lx / . A is any connection in the gauge equivalence class A. . Similarly. we now introduce a key equivalence relation on Lx Two loops . we will make the obvious choice x x . the complex vector space spanned by the T functions is closed under the product. we have used the composition of hoops in HG. Therefore. the spectrum spHA. d for some regular measure d on A/G and elements of HA. each of these representations is uniquely determined via the GelfandNaimark Segal construction by a positive linear functional on the Calgebra HA ai Ti ai Ti ai Ti . By construction. it is equipped with the identity element To oK . one can show that the space A/G of connections modulo gauge transformations is densely embedded in spHA. The operation. Furthermore. the product. Furthermore. one can make the structure of HA explicit by constructing it. we can denote the spectrum as A/G. and the norm on HA can be specied directly on F Lx /K as follows ai i K i i ai i K . zero loop. The completion HA of HA under the sup norm has therefore the structure of a Calgebra. bounded. Second. from the space of loops Lx . Thus. HA is an Abelian Calgebra. act simply by pointwise multiplication. Finally. we can directly apply the Gelfand representation theory. Therefore. where ai is the complex conjugate of ai . elements of HA can be represented either as ai Ti or as ai i K . cyclic representation of HA by bounded operators on a Hilbert space has the following form the representation space is the Hilbert space L A/G. HA is a subalgebra of the Calgebra of all complexvalued. regarded as functions on A/G. i ai i K bj j K j ij ai i K i AA/G sup ai Ti A. The functionals naturally dene functions on the space Lx of loopswhich in turn serve as the generating functionals for the representa . continuous functions on a compact Hausdor space. As in . . The Calgebra HA is obtained by completing HA in the norm topology. Let us summarize the main results that follow .e. It is then easy to verify that HA F Lx /K. step by step. i . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski tion on A/G. This is the AI Calgebra. we know that HA is naturally isomorphic to the Calgebra of complexvalued. Note that the Kequivalence relation subsumes the hoop equivalence. Denote by F Lx the free vector space over complexes generated by Lx . every continuous. A A/G. ai bj i j K i j K . where o is the trivial i. First. continuous functions thereon. Let K be the subspace of F Lx dened as follows i ai i K i i ai Ti A . however. and the space of hoops. The measure d is invariant under this induced action on A/G i is invariant under the induced action on HG. triple and higher products can. more precisely.j ai aj i j i .. is well dened while the second condition by . it follows that the positive linear functional extends to the full Calgebra HA. i i.e. conguration operators are labelled by elements of HG. The elements of the representation space i. obtained by extending by linearity.Holonomy Calgebras tionvia T . Note. or. one can answer this question armatively A function on Lx serves as a generating functional for the GNS construction if and only if it satises the following two conditions ai Ti ai i . a dieomorphism invariant function of hoops is a function of generalized knotsgeneralized. one cannot get rid of double products. together. Hence. Conversely. ensures that it satises the positivity property. there is a correspondence If the gauge group were more general. The question naturally arises can we write down necessary and sucient conditions for a function on the loop space Lx to qualify as a generating functional Using the structure of the algebra HA outlined above. they provide a positive linear functional on the algebra HA. Thus. quantum states are L functions on A/G. its spectrum A/G. Thus. be reduced to linear combinations . j The rst condition ensures that the functional on HA. nally.e. i and . that the rst equation in .. intersections. determined by functions on HG satisfying . HG. a loop function satisfying . We thus have an interesting interplay between connections and loops. for example. The group of dieomorphisms on has a natural action on the algebra HA. generalized gaugeequivalent connections elements of A/G and hoops elements of HG. in turn. Now. we could not have expressed products of the generators T as sums eqn .. and segments that may be traced more than once. Finally. ensures that the generating function factors through the hoop equivalence relation . For SU . every regular measure on A/G provides through vacuum expectation values a loop functional T satisfying . The generators T of the holonomy algebra i. determines a cyclic representation of HA and therefore a regular measure on A/G. there is a canonical correspondence between regular measures on A/G and generating functionals . Regular measures d on A/G are. B HA. since HA is dense in HA and contains the identity. because our loops are allowed to have kinks. B B . Thus. . . the spectrum is the StoneCch compactication e of that space. one does not have as much control as one would like on the points that lie in its closure see. However. the generating functional is dened on single and double loops. . . in practice. We shall see in this section that this is indeed the case. The main point here is that a given set of double products of T and the T themselves. However.e. i. in the second. and therefore outside the range of applicability of standard theorems. In the rst. whence the situation is again rather unruly. the holonomy Calgebra is also rather special it is constructed from natural geometrical objectsconnections and loopson the manifold . generally we will not explicitly distinguish between paths and loops and their images in . one might hope that its spectrum can be characterized through appropriate geometric constructions. the situation seems to be even more complicated since the algebra HA is generated only by certain functions on A/G. In particular. of elements of A/G A/G.g. at least at rst sight. . . a good control on the precise content and structure of the Gelfand spectrum A/G of HA is needed to make further progress. and in the third we give examples of generalized gaugeequivalent connections. . bounded functions on a completely regular topological space. In the case of a Calgebra of all continuous. The spectrum The constructions discussed in Section have several appealing features. . HA appears to be a proper subalgebra of the Calgebra of all continuous functions on A/G. . . we introduce the key tools that are needed also in subsequent sections. . and regular dieomorphisminvariant measures on generalized gaugeequivalent connections. This section is divided into three parts. . into a nite number of independent hoops. while Rn is densely embedded in the spectrum. e. Even for simple algebras which arise in nonrelativistic quantum mechanicssuch as the algebra of almost periodic functions on Rn the spectrum is rather complicated. whence. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski between generalized knot invariants which in addition satisfy . In this case. n . To keep the discussion simple. . link invariants can also feature in the denition of the generating function. in addition to knot invariants. Therefore. k . In the case of the AI algebra HA. we present the main result. Loop decomposition A key technique that we will use in various constructions is the decomposition of a nite number of hoops.. The specic techniques we use rest heavily on the fact that the loops involved are all piecewise analytic. they open up an algebraic approach to the integration theory on the space of gaugeequivalent connections and bring to the forefront the duality between loops and connections. . m . Denote by n the number of edges that result. Our aim then is to show that.e. The edges and vertices form a piecewise analytically embedded graph. k . as before. The rst condition makes the sense in which each hoop i can be decom posed in terms of j precise while the second condition species the sense in which the new hoops . . and has a nonzero parameter measure along any loop to which it belongs. . . there exists a nite set of loops. k . . . each edge in the original decomposition of k loops . if the initial set . . . n . . . . such that none of the i has a piece which is immediately retraced i. Let us call these marked points vertices. whence. . . . . . . . Next. . then we have HG . . . . . which satises the following properties . Let us call these oriented paths edges. . with i identity in HG for any i. each of these paths is piecewise analytic. Let us begin by choosing a loop i Lx in each hoop i . k . k of loops is extended to include p additional loops. . . none of the loops contains a path of the type . can be expressed as a composition of a nite number of its n edges. n are independent. where. this decomposition is minimal in the sense that. . . . If we denote by HG . ignoring parametrization. Each of the new loops i contains an open segment i. m the subgroup of the hoop group HG generated by the hoops . . . the holonomies around these loops could be interrelated. Finally. we will be able to show that any nite set of loops can be decomposed into a nite number of independent segments and this in turn leads us to the desired independent hoops. an embedding of an interval which is traced exactly once and which intersects any of the remaining loops j with i j at most at a nite number of points. . . Now. . . . divide each loop i into paths which join consecutive vertices. i denotes the hoop to which i belongs. n Lx . Thus. Ignore the isolated intersection points and mark the end points of all the overlapping intervals including the end points of selfoverlaps of a loop. k. . .Holonomy Calgebras of loops need not be holonomically independent every open segment in a given loop may be shared by other loops in the given set. . . By construction. .e. since the loops are piecewise analytic. . . However. for any connection A in A. . for all i . kp . k HG . given a nite number of hoops. . The availability of this decomposition will be used in the next subsection to obtain a characterization of elements of A/G and in Section to dene cylindrical functions on A/G. Two distinct paths intersect at a nite set of points. each loop in the list is contained in the graph and. . any two which overlap do so either on a nite number of nite intervals and/or intersect in a nite number of points. using the fact that the loops are piecewise analytic. . is part of at least one of the loops . . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski is expressible as a product of the edges which feature in the decomposition of the k p loops. . . . k . . . i. . For the moment we only note that we have achieved our goal the property above ensures that the set . k in our initial set can be expressed as a nite composition of hoops dened by elements of S and their inverses where a loop i and its inverse i may occur more than once. . . . where vi are the end points of the edge ei . if the initial set . and.. . then each hoop i is a nite product of the hoops j . . and that above implies that the hoop group generated by . n has an interesting consequence which will be used repeatedly Lemma . k is contained in the hoop group generated by . there exists a connection A A such that Hi . kp . However. . . Loops i are not unique because of the freedom in choosing the curves qv. . . that our decomposition satises . such that the paths q v agree with the paths qv whenever v v . . . S is a nite set and every i S is a nontrivial loop in the sense that the hoop i it denes is not the identity element of HG. . . . . starting and ending at the basepoint x . . The next step is to convert this edge decomposition of loops into a decomposition in terms of elementary loops. .e. n corresponding to . . n. . . We will conclude this subsection by showing that the independence of hoops . k of loops is extended to include p additional loops. A gi i . . i qvi ei qvi . . . . and denote by S the set of these n loops. This is easy to achieve. n of loops is independent in the sense we specied in the point just below eqn . . . . . . . . piecewise analytic curve qv such that these curves overlap with any edge ei at most at a nite number of isolated points. . . . . Let us rst note that the decomposition satises certain conditions which follow immediately from the properties of the segments noted above . gn SU n . These properties will play an important role throughout the paper. For every g . . k . . and if S is the set of n loops . . Consider the closed curves i . . kp . . n . . . . every hoop . we will show that they provide us with the required set of independent loops associated with the given set . Connect each vertex v to the basepoint x by an oriented. . . every loop i contains an open interval which is traversed exactly once and no nite segment of which is shared by any other loop in S. . . . From now on. w su. consider a connection Ai t g Ai g.. i. Finally. we have the following. Then. Ai is not the identity element of SU . Similarly. . pick an Abelian connection Ai ai w where ai is a realvalued form on and w a xed element of the Lie algebra of SU . in particular gi . it captures the idea that the loops . Hence. .e. w with w a multiple of w . Now. .Holonomy Calgebras Proof Fix a sequence of elements g . by choosing g and t appropriately. . t R Then. for each loop i . are independent in the sense of . Then. Let furthermore the support of ai intersect the ith segment si in a nite interval.. we will say that loops satisfying . . that notion does not refer to connections at all and is therefore not tied to any specic gauge group. . since the square root is well dened in SU but not in the sense of . Ai exp tg wg. we can set . . n . n we constructed above are holonomically independent as far as SU connections are concerned. The converse is not true. Ai coincide with any element of SU . . g SU . we just proved can be taken as a statement of the independence of the SU hoops . We conclude this subsection with two remarks. . The result . Let and be two loops in Lx which do not share any point other than x and which have no selfintersections or selfoverlaps. and. i . we can choose connections Ai independently for every i . . if j i. This notion of independence is. a point in SU n . the connection A A An satises . Then. however. they are necessarily independent in the sense of . . it is of the form Hi . we can make Hi . Indeed. let us suppose that the connection is generic in the sense that the holonomy that the holonomy Hi . . . Because of the independence of the loops i noted above. Ai exp w. More precisely. is independent in the sense of . We just showed that if loops are independent in the sense of . . we have Hi . although they are obviously not independent in the sense of . Set and . gn of SU . Next. intersect the jth segment sj only on a set of measure zero as measured along any loop m containing that segment. given . Then. it is easy to check that i . weaker than the one contained in the statement above. . . to ensure that the measure introduced in Section is well dened. This characterization continues to hold if the gauge group is replaced by SU N or indeed any group which has the property that. AI were able to show that Lemma . This second characterization is useful because it involves only the loops. However. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski are independent and those satisfying . A Tr HA . no mention is made of connections and holonomies. . However. in particular. Algebraically. preserving homomorphisms from HA to the algebra of complex numbers. using certain constructions due to Giles. Our aim now is to establish the converse of this result. we have paraphrased the AI result somewhat because they did not use the notion of hoops. The availability of the loop decomposition sheds considerable light on the hoop equivalence one can show that two loops in Lx dene the same SU hoop if and only if they dier by a combination of reparametrization and immediate retracings. Weak independence will suce for all considerations in this section. HG. for every nonnegative integer n. . n . . n to any group G can be extended to every nitely generated subgroup of HG which contains HG . Although we will not need them explicitly. it is instructive to spell out some algebraic consequences of these two notions. Thus. . then every homomorphism from other hand.a They also exhibited the homomorphism explicitly. the group contains a subgroup which is freely generated by n elements. if HG . Given a homomorphism H from HG to SU we can simply via A Tr H . Recall rst that elements of the Gelfand spectrum A/G are in correspondence with multiplicative. Characterization of A/G We will now use the availability of this hoop decomposition to obtain a complete characterization of all elements of the spectrum A/G. On the i are independent. Let us make a small digression to illustrate why the converse cannot be entirely straight forward. . The question is whether this A can qualify dene A . weak independence of hoops i ensures that i freely generate a subgroup of HG. are weakly independent. Now. The characterization is based on results due to Giles . Here. the step involved is completely straightforward. . we will need hoops which are independent. . . every A A/G acts on T HA and hence on any hoop to produce a complex number A . Every element A of A/G denes a homomorphism HA from the hoop group HG to SU such that. This denition extends naturally to hoops. . Then. the homomorphism A must be continuous. a priori. It turns out. k .b.a. .b Two homomorphisms H and H dene the same element of the spectrum . . we have H H . and every nite set of hoops . one might expect that the converse of the AI result would not be true. . For every homomorphism H from HG to SU . . we have Lemma . From the denition. as before. We begin our detailed analysis with an immediate application of Lemma . that if the holonomy algebra is constructed from piecewise analytic loops. .a is in fact equivalent to . . ..Holonomy Calgebras as an element of the spectrum. . . n under H. n . should satisfy Af f . . We now use this lemma to prove the main result. n . as in Section . . . . . A is the holonomy of the connection A around any loop in the hoop class . which arise from elements of A/G. . n generated by . .. Given a homomorphism H from the hoop group HG to SU there exists an element AH of the spectrum A/G such that AH Tr H . A . the apparently weaker condition . there exists an SU connection A such that for every i in the set.b appears to be a stronger requirement than . a set of independent loops corresponding to the given set of hoops. . Use the construction of Section . . . Since. . n be. . to obtain a connection A such that gi Hi . Proof Let . Denote by g . On the other hand. . however. Whether it would continue to hold if one used piecewise smooth loopsas was the case in the AI analysisis not clear see Appendix A.a for all hoops . . and the converse does hold. That is. . Hi .b for every f ai i K HA. . . . A . . . Since each of the given i belongs to HG . gn the image of . where. A for all i. . to qualify as an element of the spectrum A/G. we have. it is clear that A T sup T A AA/G . H i Hi . Recall that each A A/G is a homomorphism from HA to complex numbers and as before denote by A the number assigned to T HA by A. . one would expect that there are more homomorphisms H from the hoop group HG to SU than the HA . It then follows from the denition of the hoop group that for any hoop in the subgroup HG .e. . Lemma . in particular. i. we obtain the following characterization of the points of the Gelfand spectrum of the holonomy Calgebra Theorem . . We will rst show that h passes through the Kequivalence relation of AI noted in Section and is therefore a welldened complexvalued function on the holonomy algebra HA F HG/K. Next. . for some independent g in SU . .b provides a homomorphism from HA to the algebra of complex numbers. given a nite set of hoops. That h is linear is obvious from its denition. . Tr H for all hoops. Now. Tr H general result given two homomorphisms H and H from a group G to g Tr H g. g G. Let us begin with the free complex vector space F HG over the hoop group HG and dene on it a complexvalued function h as follows h ai i ai Tr H i . we have k i k ai Ti A A A/G h i ai i . Using the hoop group HG for G.e. it follows that the function h on F HG has a welldened projection to the holonomy algebra HA. the continuity of this funtion on HA is obvious from . B HA. HG. there exists a connection A such that k k k h i ai i i ai Ti A sup AA/G i ai Ti A . by combining the results of the three lemmas. Every point A of A/G gives rise to a homomorphism H from the hoop group HG to SU and every homomorphism H denes a point of A/G.e. To summarize. there exists g SU SU such that Tr H such that H g g H g g .b. k . immediately implies that. Note rst that Lemma . That it respects the operation and is a multiplicative homomorphism follows from the denitions . suppose H and H give rise to the same element of the spectrum. . denes a unique element AH via AH B hB. such that A Tr H . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski if and only if H g H g. we obtain the desired uniqueness result. .. Finally. Therefore. of these operations on HA and the denition of the hoop group HG. i. to show H that the right side of . Hence h extends uniquely to a homomorphism from the Calgebra HA to the algebra of complex numbers. then. there is a In particular. Proof The idea is to dene the required A using . where g is independent of g. i. This is a correspondence modulo the trivial ambiguity that homomorphisms H and g H g dene Since the left side of this implication denes the Kequivalence. . However. however..g. Results obtained in this subsection have a similar avor. It is striking that Theorem .Holonomy Calgebras the same point of A/G. Therefore. . does not require the homomorphism H to be continuous. but in a generalized bundle . tells us.. there is a key dierence our main result shows the existence of a generalized connection modulo gauge. This is one illustration of the nontriviality of Note. gives rise to the homomorphism HA g x HA gx . In this case. no reference is made to the topology of the hoop group anywhere. one can construct a smooth connection which is indistinguish able from AH as far as these hoops are concerned. Lemma . AH nection.e. A/G is naturally embedded in A/G. there would exist nontrivial Gprincipal bundles over . This is stronger than the statement that A/G is dense in A/G. A denes a ho momorphism HA HG SU . that while this proof is tailored to the holonomy Calgebra HA. in general. Then. This purely algebraic characterization of the elements of A/G makes it convenient to use it in practice. connections on all possible bundles belong to the Gelfand spectrum see Appendix B. by Theorem . . A generalized connection can also be given a geometrical meaning in terms of parallel transport. it can be approximated by smooth connections in the sense that. as Lemma . . an element of A/G rather than a regular connection in A/G. indeed. now implies that the embedding is in fact dense. Furthermore. one can reconstruct a connection modulo gauge such that the given function is the trace of the holonomy of that connection. i. Nonetheless. A and A dene the same element of the Gelfand spectrum. Necessary and su cient conditions for H to arise from a smooth connection were given by Barrett see also . Examples of A Fix a connection A A. There are several folk theorems in the literature to the eect that given a function on the loop space Lx satisfying certain conditions. see. even if we begin with a specic bundle in our construction of the holonomy Calgebra. This provides an alternative proof of the AI and Rendall results quoted in Section . Rendalls proof is applicable in more general contexts. . the holonomy H. A g Ag g dg. e. . Had the gauge group been dierent and/or had a dimension greater than . A gaugeequivalent connection. Note that the homomorphism H determines an element of A/G and is not. We conclude this subsection with some remarks . given any nite number of hoops. a smooth gaugeequivalent connot of A/G. For a summary and references. the homomorphism H from HG to SU it denes sends every hoop to the identity element e of SU and the multiplicative homomorphism it denes from the Calgebra HA to complex numbers sends each T to /Tr e. While HA has . we can similarly construct elements which depend . i.. or. if HG x . For each choice of . it does so only a nite number of times. Note rst that. We will say that A A/G has support on a subset S of if for every hoop which has at least one representative loop which fails to pass through S. otherwise. we have j e. so that. The generalized connections we want to dene now will depend only on these tangent directions at x. is independent of the choice of the loop in the hoop class used in its construction. Let us denote the incoming and outgoing tan gent directions to the curve at its jth passage through x by vj . Hence. In this subsection. Furthermore. equivalently. and hence a generalized connection with support at x. arrives at x and then simply returns by retracing its path in a neighborhood of x. . It denes a homomorphism from HG to SU which is nontrivial only on HG x . where HG x is the space of hoops every loop in which passes through x. In particular. is the most general element of A/G which has support at x and depends only on the tangent vectors at that point. we will illustrate another facet of this nontriviality we will give examples of elements of A/G which do not arise from A/G. noted in Theorem . In ii. conditions i and ii are insensitive to it. we used tangent directions rather than vectors to ensure this. if at the jth passage. Recall rst that the holonomy of the zero connection around any hoop is identity. we have i HA e . Let be a not necessarily continuous mapping from the sphere S of directions in the tangent space at x to SU . if Lx passes through x. . . one can verify that . ii A K is regarded as a homomorphism of algebras. vj . We are now ready to give the simplest example of a generalized connec tion A which has support at a single point x .e. the mapping H is well dened. . the identity element of SU . These are the generalized gaugeequivalent connections A which have a distributional character in the sense that their support is restricted to sets of measure zero in . Set j vj vj . / N . Using analyticity of the loops. Now. dene H HG SU via H e. We now use this information to introduce the notion of the support of a generalized connection. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski the completion procedure leading from A/G to A/G. A an ambiguity. the identity element of SU . owing to piecewise analyticity. say N . We conclude with an example. The key idea in our approach is to replace the standard linear duality on vector spaces by the duality between connections and loops. which is nontrivial only on HG M and therefore denes a generalized connection with support on M . g N g N In this section we shall develop a general strategy to perform integrals on A/G and introduce a natural. The basic strategy is to carry out an appropriate generalization of the theory of cylindrical measures . is a welldened homomorphism from HG to SU .M HG SU via if HG M . The existence of this measure provides considerable condence in the ideas involving the loop transform and the loop representation introduced in . dieomorphisminvariant measure on this space. one can check that . In the rst part of This idea was developed also by Baez using.. Let equal if the orientation j of vj . on topological vector spaces . where g e. Baez and the authors independently realized that the theory of cylindrical measures provides the appropriate conceptual setting for this discussion.e. Fix a dimensional.Holonomy Calgebras on the higherorder behavior of loops at x. Denote by HG M the subset of HG consisting of hoops. Again. Dene Hg. g e. There is no generalized connection with support at x which depends only on the zerothorder behavior of the curve. Subsequently. owing to analyticity. each loop of which intersects M nontangentially. . an approach which is somewhat dierent from the one presented here. . i. i. the identity element of SU .M e. only on whether the curve passes through x or not. Denote as before the incoming and the outgoing tangent directions at the jth intersection by vj and vj respectively. such that at least one of the incoming or the outgoing tangent direction to the curve is transverse to M . One can proceed in an analogous manner to produce generalized connections which have support on . M coincides with the orientation of . Hg. oriented.. Integration on A/G . One can construct more sophisticated examples in which the homomorphism is sensitive to the higherorder behavior of the loop at the points of intersection and/or the xed SU element g is replaced by gx M SU . the authors of this paper rst found the faithful measure introduced in this section and reported this result in the rst draft of this paper. otherwise.e. faithful.or dimensional submanifolds of . As before. g g . any Lx can intersect M only a nite number of times. analytic submanifold M of and an element g of SU . however. and if vj is tangential to M . if the two orientations are opposite. Chronologically. / . n . Recall that S is generated by a nite number of linearly independent basis vectors. The idea is to use the results of Section to nd suitable substitutes for these spaces. Perhaps the most familiar example is the normalized Gaussian measure. let us introduce the following equivalence relation on A/G A A i HA g HA g for all S and some hoopindependent g SU . we proceed as follows. More precisely. S is a nitedimensional vector space and we have a natural projection map S V S. we can dene an equivalence relation on V v v if and only if v . Using this S . . . generated by a nite number of independent hoops. if a function f on V is expressible as a pullback via Sj of functions fj on Sj . For this denition to be meaningful. for some choice of S .. . using A/G in place of V . the set of measures d that we chose on vector spaces S must satisfy certain compatibility conditions. . Now suppose we are given n independent loops. Denote the quotient V / by S. . . we will dene cylindrical functions. we will present a natural cylindrical measure. Equip each nitedimensional vector space S with a measure d and set d f V S d f . Clearly. We want to extend these ideas. however. A function f on V is said to be cylindrical if it is a pullback via S to V of a function f on S. Denote by S the . s for all v . for j . which is unique up to the freedom HA g HA g for some g SU . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski this section. where v. An immediate problem is that A/G is a genuinely nonlinear space whence there is no obvious analog of V and S which are central to the above construction of cylindrical measures. we must have d f S S d f . the role of S . say. s is the action of s S on v V . we know that each A in A/G is completely characterized by the homomorphism HA from the hoop group HG to SU . Such compatible measures do exist. . These are the functions we will be able to integrate. . The appropriate choices turn out to be the following we will let the hoop group HG play the role of V and its subgroups. From Theorem . Thus. Given a nitedimensional subspace S of V . Denote by S the subgroup of the hoop group HG they generate. and in the second part. Let V denote a topological vector space and V its dual. v V and s S . . s v . Cylindrical functions Let us begin by recalling the situation in the linear case. cylindrical measures are generally introduced as follows. Proof By denition of the equivalence relation .Holonomy Calgebras projection from A/G onto the quotient space A/G/ . as usual. s of V . However. there is a bijection A/G/ SU n /Ad c Given S as in a. . . SU on the chosen generators. every A in A/G/ is in correspondence with the restriction to S of an equivalence class HA of homomorphisms from the full hoop group HG to SU . there is a correspondence between equivalence classes A and equivalence classes of homomorphisms from S to SU where. This is similar to the situation in the linear case where one may begin with a set of linearly independent elements s . . Therefore. . The idea is to consider functions f on A/G which are pullbacks under S of functions f on A/G/ and dene the integral of f on A/G to be equal to the integral of f on A/G/ . . Let S be a subgroup of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops. this is the case Lemma . Although we began with independent loops . SU /Ad b For each choice of independent generators . A/G/ should have a simple structure that one can control.. at the end one must make sure that . Then. In particular. two are equivalent if they dier by the adjoint action of SU . n . . uses it to dene an isomorphism between S V / and Rn . However. . . a specic basis is often used in subsequent constructions. in turn. . . a There is a natural bijection A/G/ HomS . One xes a basis in S . However. Some remarks about this result are in order . the equivalence relation we introduced makes direct reference only to the subgroup S of the hoop group they generate. introduces a measure on Rn for each n and uses the isomorphism to dene measures d on spaces S. . let them generate a subspace n S and then introduce the equivalence relation on S using S directly. Now. The proof of c is a simple exercise. Fortunately. n of S . that every homomorphism from S to SU extends to a homomorphism from the full hoop group to SU . These. . since S admits other bases. dene a cylindrical measure d on V through . . The statement b follows automatically from a the map in b is given by the values taken by an element of HomS . the topology induced on A/G/ from SU n /Ad according to b is independent of the choice of free generators of S . it follows from Lemma . for this strategy to work. These are the functions we want to integrate. It follows from Lemma . then they are equivalent where i is any loop in the hoop class i . Let us note an elementary property of cylindrical functions which will be used repeatedly. In the remainder of this subsection.. By a cylindrical function f on A/G. we shall regard S as a projection map from A/G onto BS and parametrize BS by SU n /Ad. Let S be a subgroup of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent loops. i. The initial choice of the independent hoops is. Thus. there is now a natural projection from BS onto BS given by the projection HomS . we can identify A/G/ with SU n /Ad. for some subgroup S of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent loops. Finally. SU /Ad Using Lemma . Let S and S be two nitely generated subgroups of the hoop group and such that S S . it is easy to check that if a function f on A/G is cylindrical with respect to S . are indistinguishable. . . the projection S maps the domain space A/G of the continuum quantum theory to the domain space of a lattice gauge theory where the lattice is formed by the n loops . As we just showed in Lemma . SU HomS . We can now dene cylindrical functions on A/G. arbitrary and it is this arbitrariness that is responsible for the richness of the continuum theory. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski the nal measure d on V is welldened. we will follow a similar strategy. In the case now under consideration. Furthermore. is insensitive to the specic choice of basis made in its denition. . we can dene a cylindrical measure on A/G by rst choosing suitable measures on SU n /Ad for each n. Let us set BS HomS . it is also cylindrical with respect to S . in eect. generated by a nite number of independent loops. . Then. . . . using the isomorphism to dene measures on A/G/ and showing nally that the nal integrals are insensitive to the initial choices of generators of S .e. we will analyse the structure of the space C of cylindrical functions. if A and A are two regular connections whose pullbacks to all i are the same for i . For the topology on BS we will use the one dened by its identication with SU n /Ad. says that two generalized connections are equivalent if their actions on the group S . Therefore. First we have . The equivalence relation of Lemma . SU and f is the pullback of f via this projection. n. we shall mean the pullback to A/G under S of a continuous function f on BS . . . given a set of independent loops which generate S . n . however. that each equivalence class A contains a regular connection A.. . Therefore. and since A/G is embedded densely in A/G. it is clear that the map from F to f is isometric. .Holonomy Calgebras Lemma . C has the structure of a normed algebra with respect to the operations of taking linear combinations. Proof It is clear by denition of C that if f C. Hence we have f C. While the rst n and the last n hoops are independent. . given two elements. . then any complex multiple f as well as the complex conjugate f also belongs to C. Consider the set of hoops . . . since Si S . Since the norms of F in HA and f in C are given by F sup F A AA Theorem . its Gelfand transform is a function f on the spectrum A/G. The Calgebra C is isomorphic to the Calgebra HA. Finally. k that feature in the sum.. Let Si be nitely generated subgroups of the hoop group HG such that fi are the pullbacks to A/G of continuous functions fi on BSi . . fi with i . More precisely. and f sup AA/G f A. Thus C has the structure of a algebra. it follows that the cylindrical functions are bounded. given by f A ai A i . and since elements of C are pullbacks to A/G of continuous functions on BS . since BS being homeomorphic to SU n /Ad is compact for any S . A natural class of functions one would like to integrate on A/G is given by the Gelfand transforms of the traces of holonomies. decompose them into independent hoops . We will use the sup norm to complete C and obtain a Calgebra C. . . Given an element F with F A ai Ti A of HA. since the restriction of f to A/G coincides with F . nd the set of independent hoops. Then.. . Not only is the answer armative. Then. . . there may be relations between hoops belonging to the rst set and those belonging to the second. Finally. complex conjugation and sup norm of cylindrical functions. . of C. it is clear that the function f is the pullback via S of a continuous function f on BS . we will show that their sum and their product also belong to C. . multiplication. but in fact the traces of holonomies generate all of C. Using the technique of Section . . . say. Next. n which generate the given n n hoops and denote by S the subgroup of the hoop group generated by . f f and f f are also cylindrical with respect to S . . Consider the sets of n and n independent hoops generating respectively S and S . The question then is if these functions are contained in C. and denote by S the subgroup of the hoop group they generate. . since HA is obtained by a C completion of the space of functions . n as in Section . n . we have Proof Let us begin by showing that HA is embedded in C. it follows that fi are cylindrical also with respect to S . We can therefore use the sup norm to endow C with the structure of a normed algebra. . we could have proceeded as follows. . each A A/G/ contains a regular connection. . Its projection under the appropriate S is. it is good to keep in mind that this alternate strategy is available as it may make other issues more transparent. A g H . by the preceeding result. n. we could have introduced an equivalence relation on A/G not A/G which we do not yet have as follows A A i H . . suggests that from the very beginning we could have introduced the Calgebra C in place of HA. . . suppose we are given a cylindrical function f on A/G. From a mathematical viewpoint. this is unsatisfactory since Wilson loops are the basic observables of gauge theories. C is contained in HA. Begin with the space A/G. it follows from the Weierstrass theorem that the Calgebra generated by these projected functions is the entire Calgebra of continuous functions on BS . More precisely. gn of SU . . We can therefore dene cylindrical functions. from the knowledge of traces in the fundamental representation of all elements which belong to the group generated by these gi . i . . We can use it as the starting point in place of the AI holonomy algebra. Then. Thus. . Now. that the quotient A/G/ is isomorphic to BS . Next. both stemming from the fact that the Wilson loops are now assigned a secondary role. Fix n elements g . we can reconstruct g . we have the desired result the Calgebras HA and C are isomorphic. While this strategy seems natural at rst from an analysis viewpoint. It therefore follows that the space of functions f on BS considered as n a copy of SU /Ad which come from the functions F on HA using all the hoops i S suce to separate points of BS . Nonetheless. but now on A/G rather than A/G as the pullbacks of continuous functions on BS . It is then again true due to Lemma . as remarked immediately after Lemma . For physical applications. . we have the result that HA is embedded in the Calgebra C. A g for all S and some hoop independent g SU . contained in the projection of some element of HA. . Combining the two results. These functions have a natural Calgebra structure. gn modulo an adjoint map. . we will show that there is also an inclusion in the opposite direction. the relation between knot/link invariants and measures on the spectrum of the algebra would now be obscure. This is indeed the case. Since this space is compact. Then given a subgroup S of HG generated by a nite number of independent hoops. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski of the form F . it has two drawbacks. Remark Theorem . This is true inspite of the fact that we are using A/G rather than A/G because. and introduce the notion of hoops and hoop decomposition in terms of independent hoops. . We rst note a fact about SU .. In particular. . Denote by d the normalized Haar measure on SU .. i . We will show that the measure dS is insensitive to the specic choice of the generators of S used in its construction and that the resulting family of measures on the various BS satises the appropriate compatibility conditions. d f A/G BS where f is any cylindrical function compatible with S . faithful. dieomorphism invariant measure on A/G. the idea is similar to the one used in the case of topological vector spaces. we have BS dS f BS dS f . . Next. holds. Our main objective is to introduce a natural. n and use the corresponding map SU n /Ad BS to transport the measure dn to a measure dS on BS . each of which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops. consider an arbitrary group S which is generated by n independent loops. Then. A natural measure In this subsection. Theorem . if fi denote the projections of f to BSi . as in . . We will then explore the properties of the resulting cylindrical measure on A/G. Our construction is natural since SU comes equipped with the Haar measure. we will discuss the issue of integration of cylindrical functions on A/G.Holonomy Calgebras . Choose a set of independent generators . As mentioned in the remarks following Lemma . Fix a set of generators in each subgroup and denote by dSi the corresponding measures on BSi . . set dS f . a Let f be a cylindrical function on A/G with respect to two subgroups Si . Thus. we have not introduced any additional structure on the underlying manifold on which the initial connections A are dened. if S S .. we will equip the space BS with a measure dS and. the integral is independent of the choice of generators used in its denition. It is clear that for the integral to be welldened. . for each subgroup S of the hoop group which is generated by a nite number of independent hoops. . hence the resulting cylindrical measure will be automatically invariant under the action of Di. In particular. . of the hoop group. the set of measures we choose on different BS should be compatible so that the analog of . It naturally induces a measure on SU n which is invariant under the adjoint action of SU and therefore projects down unambiguously to a measure dn on SU n /Ad. We will now exhibit a natural choice for which the compatibility is automatically satised. Furthermore. to carry out the decompo sition of these n n hoops in terms of independent hoops.e. Then gi is expressed in terms of gi as gi . . . . . . . . by showing that each of the two integrals in that equation equals the analogous integral of f over BS . . is a genuine. we can ignore the distinction between BSi and SU ni /Ad and between BS and SU n / Ad. Ki Kj .. it follows that every hoop in the second set can be expressed as a composition of the hoops in the rst set and their inverses. . Thus. in particular. the construction implies that for each i . Then. is the pullback of a function f on BS . n . the hoop Kj does not appear at all. . where d is dened by . Note rst that. . let us denote by g . regular and strictly positive measure on A/G. with S S . Clearly. and where the cylindrical function f on A/G is the Gelfand transform of the element F of HA. the hoop Ki or its inverse appears exactly once and if i j . . . the given f is cylindrical also with respect to S . say . . strictly positive and Diinvariant functional on HA vF A/G d f . ii in the decomposition of i in terms of unprimed hoops. Si S . n while those . Hence. . as in the proof of Theorem . and a function f which is cylindrical with respect to both of them. . .gKi .. We will now establish . with n lt n. It will also be convenient to regard functions on SU n /Ad as functions on SU n which are invariant under the adjoint SU action. since the generators have been xed. n . the original n n hoops are contained in the group S generated by the i . To deal with quantities with suxes and simultaneously. we have nitely generated subgroups S and S of the hoop group. gn a point of the quotient SU n which is projected to g .. gn in SU n . and. where . . Thus. . c The cylindrical measure d dened by . The generators of S are . we can integrate the lifts of these functions to SU ni and SU n respectively. . . d is Di invariant. there exists Ki . . . . Proof Fix ni independent hoops that generate Si and. For simplicity. Next. instead of carrying out integrals over BSi and BS of functions on these spaces. . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski b The functional v HA C dened below extends to a linear. for notational simplicity we will let a prime stand for either the sux or . since the hoops in each set are independent. . n with the following properties i if i j . and. Furthermore.. use the construction of Section . From the construction of S Sec of S are n tion . i. . let us assume that the orientation of the primed hoops is such that it is Ki rather than its inverse that features in the decomposition of i . . denotes a product of elements of the .. in the second step we used the invariance property of the Haar measure and simplied notation for dummy variables being integrated. in turn is the Calgebra of all continuous functions on the compact Hausdor space A/G. . . v is strictly positive. That it is positive.gK . . i. Hence. . . .. with n and n . ... . This establishes the required result .Holonomy Calgebras type gm where m Kj for any j. . which.gK ... Then dg dg f g . satises vF F . .. g dg dg f g g dg f g .. since the measure is normalized. then vF F gt since the value vF F of v on F F is obtained by integrating a nonnegative function f f on SU n /Ad with respect to a regular measure.gKn .. The vacuum expectation value function v is therefore a continuous linear functional on the algebra of all continuous functions on A/G equipped with the L i. mn dm d dn f g . gn f . Since the given function f on A/G is a pullback of a function f on SU n as well as of a function f on SU n . The continuity and linearity of v follow directly from its denition. . . . . . we simply rearranged the order of integration. . To see that we have a regular measure on A/G. . Hence. . gn .gKn . . .Kn n dK d dKn f .. and. consider the vacuum expectation value functional v on HA dened by .e. in the third step. Thus. a stronger result holds if F . . in the rst step. . . we used the fact that. Next. by the RieszMarkov theorem. where. . . we would for example have f g . . In fact. Since HA is dense in HA it follows that the functional extends to HA by continuity. . . recall rst that the Calgebra of cylindrical functions is naturally isomorphic with the Gelfand transform of the Calgebra HA. ..e... is equally obvious.. where in the second step we have used the invariance and normalization properties of the Haar measure. sup norm. the integral of a constant produces just that constant . it follows that f g . gn dm mK.. . .. it follows that In the simplest case. gn dn f g . g f g g f g . d dn f g . gn f g . selfadjoint operator on L A/G. unlike the standard invariants. Fix a loop Lx and let i iN N . Under this action. We will see below that. . This functional on the loop space Lx is dieomorphism invariant since the measure d is. Finally. giN . We have used the double sux ik because any one independent loop . the representation of HA can be constructed as follows. This is the cylindrical function we wish to integrate. .. . the Hilbert space L A/G. Finally. n as in Section . We will refer to d as the induced Haar measure on A/G. Thus. d and the elements F of HA act by multiplication so that we have F f for all L A/G. i. This representation is cyclic and the function dened by A on A/G is the vacuum state. gn Tr gi . . The Hilbert space is L A/G. . N n. Now. since our construction did not require the introduction of any extra structure on such as a metric or a volume element. To our knowledge. the vacuum state is left invariant. only on generalized loops. the projection map of Lemma . Since the measure d on A/G is invariant under this action. . We now explore some properties of this measure and of the resulting representation of the holonomy Calgebra HA. This is just our cylindrical measure. d. it follows from the strictness of the positivity of the measure that the resulting representation of the Calgebra HA is faithful. this is the rst faithful representation of the holonomy Calgebra that has been constructed explicitly. Second. . First. restricting the values of v to the generators T K of HA. where k . . Its action is nontrivial only when the loop is retraced. Third. . assigns to t the function t on SU n /Ad given by N t g . . Every generator T of the holonomy Calgebra is represented by a bounded. . be the minimal decomposition of into independent loops . .e. it follows that the functional v and the measure d are Di invariant. d carries a unitary representation of Di. where f C is the Gelfand transform of F . n. . d. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski vf df is in fact the integral of the continuous function f on A/G with respect to a regular measure. . vanishes on all smoothly embedded loops. . keeps track of the orientation and ik . Let us conclude this section by indicating how one computes the integral in practice. The loop denes an element T of the holonomy Calgebra HA whose Gelfand transform t is a function on A/G. . . the dieomorphism group Di of has an induced action on the Calgebra HA and hence also on its spectrum A/G. It thus dened a generalized knot invariant. . n can arise more than once in the decomposition. we obtain the generating functional of this representation dA . . g. In particular. Now. is naturally isomorphic with the Calgebra of all continuous functions on the compact Hausdor space A/G and hence. AI had shown that every element of A/G denes a homomorphism from the hoop group HG to SU . and self . Since C is the Calgebra of all continuous functions on A/G. Finally. We then carried out a nonlinear extension of the theory of cylindrical measures to integrate these cylindrical functions on A/G. we completed the AI program in several directions. This family of projections enables us to dene cylindrical functions on A/G these are the pullbacks to A/G of the continuous functions on SU n /Ad. the cylindrical measures in fact turn out to be regular measures on A/G. its generating function which sends loops based at x to real numbers denes a generalized knot invariant generalized because we have allowed loops to have kinks. selfintersections. to integrate t on A/G. say n. The second main result also intertwines the structure of the hoop group with that of the Gelfand spectrum.Holonomy Calgebras Thus. Discussion In this paper. Hence. Given a subgroup S of HG generated by a nite number. we need to integrate this t on SU n /Ad. Since this characterization is rather simple and purely algebraic. of independent hoops.. we were able to introduce explicitly such a measure on A/G which is natural in the sense that it arises from the Haar measure on SU . it is useful in practice. if and only if H g H g for some g SU . e. We analysed the space C of these functions and found that its completion C has the structure of a Calgebra which. A/G unless every loop i is repeated an even number of times in the decomposition . These can be now used to evaluate the required integrals on SU n /Ad. via the inverse Gelfand transform. First. we were able to obtain a complete characterization of the Gelfand spectrum A/G of the holonomy Calgebra HA. of .e. also to the holonomy Calgebra HA with which we began. We found that every homomorphism from HG to SU denes an element of the spectrum and two homomorphisms H and H dene the same element of A/G only if they dier by an SU automorphism. i. by exploiting the fact that the loops are piecewise analytic. the representation is faithful and dieomorphism invariant. we were able to dene a projection S from A/G to the compact space SU n /Ad. . there exist in the literature useful formulae for integrating polynomials of the matrix element functions over SU see. In particular. one can readily show the following result d t . The resulting representation of the holonomy Calgebra has several interesting properties. moreover. e. in the transform the traces of holonomies play the role of the integral kernel. however. that these operators also have simple action on the hoop states. denotes the inner product on L A/G. This condition is awkward to impose in the connection representation. In the connection representation. we can now make the ideas on the loop transform T of . Having the induced Haar measure d on A/G at ones disposal. rigorous. The transform T sends it to a function on the space HG of hoops. In such theories. it is convenient to lift canonically to the space Lx and regard it as a function on the loop space. a state in the connection representation is a squareintegrable function on A/G. this action translates to T . one can transform this action to the hoop states . one can forgo the connection representation and work directly in terms of hoop states. Elements of the holonomy algebra have a natural action on the connection states . We will show elsewhere that the transform also interacts well with the momentum operators which are associated with closed strips. the task is rather simple physical states depend only on generalized knot and link classes of loops. raises several issues which are . Di invariant theories. In terms of machinery introduced in this paper. we have T A T A A. where is the composition of hoops and in the hoop group. On the hoop states. The use of this representation. These constructions show that the AI program can be realized in detail. It turns out that the action is surprisingly simple and can be represented directly in terms of elementary operations on the hoop space. by contrast. and it is dicult to control the structure of the space of resulting states. thus L A/G. This is the origin of the term loop representation. d. A/G where t with t A A is the Gelfand transform of the trace of the holonomy function. Using T . the loop representation has proved to be a powerful tool in quantum general relativity in and dimensions. and . Consider a generator T of HA. In the loop representation. We have T with . T . Sometimes. . d t AA t . The transform T sends states in the connection representation to states in the socalled loop representation. d. associated with the hoop . Because of this simplication and because the action of the basic operators can be represented by simple operations on hoops. The hoop states are especially well suited to deal with dieomorphism i. physical states are required to be invariant under Di. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski overlaps. i. Thus. Thus.e. on A/G. HG will denote the U hoop group and HA. Now. i. by loops we shall mean continuous. A.Holonomy Calgebras still open. the U holonomy algebra. d. we would have a nonlinear generalization of the Plancherel theorem which establishes that the Fourier transform is an isomorphism between two spaces of L functions. and exploiting. rather than on A/G. piecewise C loops. unlike SU . We will use the same notation as in the main text but now those symbols will refer to the U theory. Thus. Nonetheless. Throughout this appendix. our main results do continue to hold for piecewise C loops. the new arguments make a crucial use of the Abelian character of U and do not by themselves go over to nonAbelian theories. Perhaps the most basic of these is that. of elements of L A/G. The third introduces a dieomorphisminvariant measure on the spectrum and discusses some of its properties. The appendix is divided into three parts. Neither do we have an expression of the inner product between hoop states. for example. This restriction was essential in Section . without any reference to the connection representation. but now on HG. we consider U connections rather than SU and show that. In this appendix. it is important to nd out if our arguments can be replaced by more sophisticated ones so that the main results would continue to hold even if the holonomy Calgebra were constructed from piecewise smooth loops. This may indeed be possible using again the idea of cylindrical functions.e. we restricted ourselves to piecewise analytic loops. It would be extremely interesting to develop integration theory also over the hoop group HG and express the inner product between hoop states directly in terms of such integrals. this Abelian example is an indication that analyticity may not be indispensible even in the nonAbelian case. Topological considerations Fix a smooth manifold . we do not yet have a useful characterization of the hoop states which are images of connection states. The loop transform would then become an extremely powerful tool. If this is achieved and if the integrals over A/G and HG can be related. However. The second proves the analog of the spectrum theorem of Section . for our decomposition of a given set of a nite number of loops into independent loops which in turn is used in every major result contained in this paper. Appendix A C loops and U connections In the main body of the paper. The restriction is not as severe as it might rst seem since every smooth manifold admits a unique analytic structure. Denote by A the space of all smooth U connections which belong to an appropriate Sobolev space. as before. the duality between these spaces. Nonetheless. in this theory. The rst is devoted to certain topological considerations which arise because manifolds admit nontrivial U bundles. without referring back to the connection representation. n . . one could ask that the holonomies . for all i. . . Thus. i . i. A A. . . This lemma has several useful implications. Let be a globally dened. . there are two equivalence relations on the space Lx of based loops that one can introduce. A expi A expi. Proof Suppose the connection A is dened on the bundle P . Denote by A the subspace of A consisting of connections on the trivial U bundle over . Hi . U dened on a subset V S B which contains all the loops i . Since the loops i cannot form a dense set in S . since S B is contractible. The map carries each i into a loop i in S . Given a nite number of loops. . A . As is common in the physics literature. Now. the connection A denes on the given loops i the same holonomy elements as A. there exists a smooth section of the Hopf bundle U SU S . or. A Hi . U see Trautman . We mention two that will be used immediately in what follows. and depends on both the connection A and the loop . Denition of hoops A priori. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski bundles. One may say that two loops are equivalent if the holonomies of all connections in A around them are the same. . Hence. for every A A there exists A A such that Hi . we can now look for the connection A . We will show rst that there exists a local section s of P which contains the given loops i .e. S B SU . Having obtained this section s. . we will identify elements A of A with realvalued forms. The question therefore arises as to whether we should allow arbitrary U connections or restrict ourselves only to the trivial bundle in the construction of the holonomy Calgebra. We begin with the following result Lemma A. A Hi . the holonomies dened by any A A will be denoted by H. . Hence. real form on such that V s A. n. Fortunately. U bundles over manifolds need not be trivial. This is the main result of this subsection. To construct the section we use a map S which generates the bundle P . where takes values in . we may remove from the sphere an open ball B which does not intersect any of i . it turns out that both choices lead to the same Calgebra. there exists a section s of P . However. n A . it follows that e. where is any loop in the hoop . Since the holonomies themselves are complex numbers. Clearly. the Abelian hoop group HG has no torsion. A aj exp i j A . H. then e. there is only one HA. Then if n e.. for n Z. As we will see below. we will denote by the hoop to which a loop Lx belongs. A H . is easy to establish every element A of the spectrum denes . Sup norm Consider functions f on A dened by nite linear combinations of holonomies on A around hoops in HG. AA A A As a consequence of these implications. implies that sup f A sup f A . Lemma A. where aj are complex numbers. Hence. Proof Since n e. in that case. in spite of topological nontrivialities. Let HA denote the complex vector space of functions f on A of the form n n f A j aj H. Although the proof is more complicated. A. A H . the trace operation is now redundant. there is only one hoop group HG. the hoop group is nonAbelian. A. The analog of Lemma . A Hn . A . The result is the required Calgebra HA. A H. the identity in HG. More precisely. by Lemma A. We conclude by noting another consequence of Lemma A. A. . Lemma A. Let HG. Equip it with the sup norm and take the completion. we can use either A or A to construct the holonomy Calgebra. The Gelfand spectrum of HA We now want to obtain a complete characterization of the spectrum of the U holonomy Calgebra HA along the lines of Section . As in the main text. it is the Abelian character of the U hoop group that makes the result of this lemma useful. We can restrict these functions to A . we have. the analogous result holds also in the SU case treated in the main text. implies that the two notions are in fact equivalent.Holonomy Calgebras be the same only for connections in A . To construct this algebra we proceed as follows. A and the relation given by H. HA has the structure of a algebra with the product law H. we have the following result Lemma A. for every A A . On the other hand. . A. . Furthermore. . . . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski a homomorphism HA from the hoop group HG to U now given simply by HA A . . HG . Indeed. H k U k . .e. i. . mk Zk . which would contradict the assumption that the given set of hoops is independent. For every homomorphism H from the hoop group HG to U . given such hoops i . if A. k . we can assume that the hoops i are weakly U independent. . Hence we necessarily have Vm lt V . i . V Rk . Therefore. This is not surprising. A lt . . . . then ki i.. Now if Vm were to equal V then we would have m k mk . . The rst map in A. k. Now. without loss of generality. we must now modify that argument suitably.e i k A U k . . . . . Let m m . it is clear from the discussion in Section that this lemma continues to hold for piecewise smooth loops even in the full SU theory.. . which can be expressed as a composition A A A . k A e i A . A. say . the situation is quite dierent for Lemma . that they satisfy the following condition if k n kn e. . An appropriate replacement is contained in the following lemma. is satised by i for a suciently small then it will also be satised by the given j for the given . . the homomorphism H HG U denes a point H . However. Hence. k . Since HG is Abelian and since it has no torsion.. and every gt . . is a vector space. . . it follows that Vm lt V. n . . Lemma A. . . . Denote by Vm the subspace of V orthogonal to m. . . Proof Consider the subgroup HG . mZk This strict inequality implies that there exists a connection B A such . k is nitely and freely generated by some elements. Consequently.. . . there also exists a map from A to U k . is linear and its image. . since a countable union of subsets of measure zero has measure zero. n HG that is generated by . . . there exists a connection A A such that H i Hi . every nite set of hoops . because there we made a crucial use of the fact that the loops were continuous and piecewise analytic. . . regular measure on the spectrum of HA. in the SU holonomy algebra we have T T T . this function is strictly positive. Furthermore. otherwise. for the sake of diversity. we will exhibit a natural measure. into a line which is dense in U k . . . Rather than going through the same constructions as in the main text. and. extends to a continuous positive linear function on the holonomy Calgebra HA. to specify a positive linear functional on HA. It is clear that this functional on Lx is dieomorphism invariant. This is a correspondence. We will present a strictly positive linear functional on the holonomy Calgebra HA whose properties suce to ensure the existence of a dieomorphisminvariant. Combining these results. We will now show that it does have all the properties to be a generating function . Theorem A. it is the simplest of such functionals on Lx . B is such that every ratio vi /vj of two dierent components of v is irrational. the line in A dened by B via A t tB is carried by the map A. this strategy fails because of the SU identities. where o is the identity hoop in HG. This ensures that there exists an A on this line which has the required property A. we will adopt here a complementary approach. However. . n B V Vm . . we have the U spectrum theorem Theorem A. Indeed. For example. We can dene a . We know from the general theory outlined in Section that. A. mZk In other words. Armed with this substitute of Lemma .. it is straightforward to show the analog of Lemma . one might imagine using it to dene a positive linear functional also for the SU holonomy algebra of the main text. A natural measure Results presented in the previous subsection imply that one can again introduce the notion of cylindrical functions and measures. Let us simply set . Since this functional is so simple and natural.. it suces to provide an appropriate generating functional on Lx . Evaluation of the generating functional A. A. conversely. on this identity would lead to the contradiction .. Every A in the spectrum of HA denes a homomorphism from the hoop group HG to U . In this subsection. if o . every homomorphism H H denes an element A of the spectrum such that H A .Holonomy Calgebras that v B. Thus. faithful. we have n n n n j aj j j aj j lt sup A A j aj H j . Hence we have A. strictly positive measure on the Gelfand spectrum of this algebra. .. . given the n complex numbers ai . The inequality A. this positive linear functional is not strictly positive the measure on A/G it denes is concentrated just on A . if i j if i j. if T A A A otherwise. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski Proof By its denition. A. the projection is positive denite. However. . the left side equals aj . f f for all f HA. Furthermore. given the n hoops j . since the norm on this algebra is the sup norm on A . To see this. However. Finally. faithful representation of HA and hence a regular. the resulting representation of the SU holonomy Calgebra fails to be faithful. by denition of . A j aj H j . we will let the manifold have positive linear function on the SU holonomy Calgebra via .. Finally. implies that the generating functional provides a continuous. one can nd an A such that the angles j can be made as close as one wishes to a prespecied ntuple j . note rst that. UN and SUN connections In this appendix. j . Now. implies that the functional continues to be strictly positive on HA. . where we have regarded A as a subspace of the space of SU connections. Extend to F HG by linearity. equality holding only if f . We will now work with analytic manifolds and piecewise analytic loops as in the main text. such that. Theorem A. one can always nd j such that aj lt aj exp ij aj exp ij . . by Lemma A. We will rst establish that this extension satises the following property given a nite set of hoops j . implies that the functional has a welldened projection on the holonomy algebra HA which is obtained by taking the quotient of F HG by the subspace K consisting of bi i such that bi H i . it follows from A. n. that the functional is continuous on HA. Consequently. A for all A A . . A . the loop functional admits a welldened projection on the hoop space HG which we will denote again by . Let F HG be the free vector space generated by the hoop group. we will consider another extension of the results presented in the main text. Hence it admits a unique continuous extension to the Calgebra HA. Appendix B C loops. The right side equals aj exp ij aj exp ij where j depend on A and the hoop j . on the SU holonomy algebra. Next. It is not dicult to verify by direct calculations that this is precisely the U analog of the induced Haar measure discussed in Section . A. . the products of traces of holonomies can no longer be expressed as sums while the second arise because the connections in question may be dened on nontrivial principal bundles. we will refrain from making digressions to the general case. the situation is more involved. with the relation given by f f . G. G. A. AA and take the completion of HA to obtain a Calgebra. and HA will be the holonomy Calgebra generated by nite sums of nite products of traces of holonomies of connections in A around hoops in HG. see eqn . where the trace is taken in the fun damental representation of U N or SU N . at the end. This was possible because. are the same as in Section . details will be omitted. for example. The rst arise because. Being traces of U N and SU N matrices. where the bar stands for complex conjugation. In . For the groups under consideration. now refer to connections on P . The holonomy algebra HA is. products of any two T could be expressed as a linear combination of T eqn . the algebra HA was obtained simply by imposing an equivalence relation K. The key dierence between the structure of this HA and the one we constructed in Section is the following. T are bounded functions on A/G. Let us summarize the situation in the slightly more general context of the group GLN . since most of the arguments are rather similar to those given in the main text. that they are independent of the initial choice of P . we will see that the main results of the paper continue to hold in these cases as well. In Section . there are two types of complications algebraic and topological. and holonomy maps H. and then show. and regard T as a function on A/G. Denitions of the space Lx of based loops. This is the holonomy Calgebra. G. the space of gaugeequivalent connections. Ghoop group. Several of the results also hold when the gauge group is allowed to be any compact Lie group. Nonetheless. generated by all nite linear combinations with complex coecients of nite products of the T . We can therefore introduce on HA the sup norm f sup f A. on the free vector space generated by the loop space Lx . HG will denote the P . Consequently. Thus. However. obtain the main results. owing to SU Mandelstam identities. B. we will continue to use the same symbols as in the main text to denote various spaces which. To keep the notation simple. A.Holonomy Calgebras any dimension and let the gauge group G be either U N or SU N . Let us begin by xing a principal bre bundle P . however. Also. for brevity of presentation. We will denote it by HA. by denition. G. A will denote the space of suitably regular connections on P . Holonomy Calgebra We will set T A N TrH. the Mandelstam identities follow from the contraction of N matricesH . . the AI result that there is a natural embedding of A/G into the spectrum A/G of HA goes through as before and so does the general argument due to Rendall that the image of A/G is dense in A/G. where a. . B. . if the gauge group is GLN . we have. . The proof requires some minor modications which consist of using local sections and a suciently large number of generators of the gauge group. c N . These result from the fact that the determinant of N N matrix M can be expressed in terms of traces of powers of that matrix. . . for any hoop . using the analog of Lemma . TN . .. . . Also. TrM . . Consequently. an element of the holonomy algebra HA is expressible as an equivalence class a. . . . . They enable one to express products of N T functions as a linear combination of traces of products of . A Gn is onto if the loops i are independent. A in our casewith the identity j N i . Hn . . it is straightforward to establish the analog of the . . A. F T . . b . TN F T . . This is true for any group and representation for which the traces of holonomies separate the points of A/G. for decomposition of a nite number of loops into independent loops makes no direct reference to the gauge group and therefore carries over as is. . Finally. namely det M F TrM. . continues to hold. . . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski this case. Finally. we have to begin by considering the free algebra generated by the hoop group and then impose on it all the suitable identities by extending the denition of the kernel . . As for the Gelfand spectrum. . . . . . Hence. Loop decomposition and the spectrum theorem B. . let us note identities that will be useful in what follows. iN j j where i is the Kronecker delta and the bracket stands for the antisymmetrization. For subgroups of GLN such as SU N further reductions arise. A. . . In the SU N case a stronger identity holds F T . . A direct consequence is that the analog of Lemma .a The construction of Section . c are complex numbers. if the gauge group G is U N . . it is still true that the map A A H . . HN . TrM N for a certain polynomial F . . Hence.. TN . N T functions. . products involving N and higher loops are redundant. b. .b B. . we note from eqn B. . by the identity B.on the other hand requires further analysis based on Giles results along the lines used by AI in the SU case. . given an ele ment of the spectrum Ai. . . . If G is SU N then. N for every integer k. Therefore. holds.b. we have the spectrum theorem every element A of the spectrum A/G denes a homomorphism H from the hoop group HG to the gauge group G. This suces to conclude that With this result in hand. an A i A A for all S . The conversethe analog of Lemma . . . we can dene cylindrical functions on A/G as the pullbacks to A/G of continuous functions on Gn /Ad. as before. For the gauge group under consideration. . we can now use Giles analysis to conclude that given A we can nd HA which takes values in U N . the traces of all elements of a nitely generated subgroup in the fundamental representation suce to characterize the subgroup modulo an overall adjoint map. for groups under consideration. TrHA N . Two homomorphisms H and H dene the same element of the spectrum if and only if TrH TrH . First. Thus far. for every i. and.e. . . so that the analog of Lemma . . n generated by n independent hoops . N of HA . They again . a continuous homomorphism from HA to the algebra of complex numbersGiles theorem provides us with a homomorphism HA from the hoop group HG to GLN . n . every homomorphism H from of the spectrum A/G such the hoop group HG to G denes an element A that A N TrH for all HG.a that in particular i . the characteristic polynomial of the matrix HA is expressible directly by the values of A taken on n the hoops . we have det HA . Cylindrical functions and the induced Haar measure Using the spectrum theorem. . From continuity it follows that for every hoop . B. we have used only the algebraic properties of A. What we need to show is that HA can be so chosen that it takes values in the given gauge group G. . We can establish this by considering the eigenvalues . . . we can again associate with any subgroup S HG . . After all. Combining these results.Holonomy Calgebras main conclusion of Lemma . conversely. equivalence relation on A/G A This relation provides us with a family of projections from A/G onto the compact manifolds Gn /Ad since. . . Substituting for its powers we conclude that k k N i . n . and consider a connection A dened on P . A denes also a point in the spectrum of HA . . be the corresponding projection maps from A/G to Gn /Ad. i. we have n n ai Ti i i ai Ti . Thus. . Hence. Let us decompose the given hoops . Fix a gauge group G from U N . . Hence. Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski form a Calgebra. the construction of Section . P say. . to GN /Ad are in fact equal. SU N and let P . we know that their I ai Ti i i ai Ti B. we obtain the same holonomy Calgebra HA. whence it follows that I is an isomorphism of Calgebras. G and P . as noted at the end of Section . Therefore. we xed a principal bundle P . G be two principal bundles. Note that the holonomy map of A denes a homomorphism from the bundleindependent hoop group to G. . it does not matter which bundle we begin with. .. B. the hoop groups obtained from any two bundles are the same. is an isomorphism from HA to HA . let i S . First. i . We spectra are naturally isomorphic A/G wish to show that the algebras are themselves naturally isomorphic. as in Section . Therefore. Using the fact that traces of products of group elements suce to separate points of Gn /Ad when G U N or G SU N .e. k into independent hoops .. G A/G . given a manifold M and a gauge group G the spectrum A/G automatically contains all the connections . . Using the spectrum theorem. Let the corresponding holonomy Calgebras HomHG. The resulting representation of the Calgebra HA is again faithful and dieomorphism invariant. Now. . From the denition of the maps it follows that the projections of the two functions in B. To conclude. . Finally. Let S be the subgroup of the hoop group they generate and. using the hoop decomposition one can show that two loops in Lx dene the same hoop if and only if they dier by a combination of reparametrization and an immediate retracing of segments for gauge groups under consideration. we will show that the Calgebra HA and hence its spectrum are independent of this choice. G. Bundle dependence In all the constructions above. x a bundle. it again follows that the Calgebra of cylindrical functions is isomorphic with HA. that the map I dened by n n be HA and HA . which led us to the denition of the induced Haar measure goes through step by step. . Classical amp Quantum Gravity . .N. gr qc/ . Trias. Nonperturbative canonical quantum gravity Notes prepared in collaboration with R. DeWittMorette and M. A. Nucl. C. Adv. Commun. Acknowledgements The authors are grateful to John Baez for several illuminating comments and to Roger Penrose for suggesting that the piecewise analytic loops may be better suited for their purpose than the piecewise smooth ones. M. . C. eds L. Analysis. B. Mitter and C. Singapore . . . Di Bartolo. B. . . DillardBleick. J. Theor. J. New York . Phys. Quarks. J. . Ashtekar. Isham. Cambridge University Press. Phys. J. Int. R. Giles. Amsterdam . . Gambini. A. World Scientic. . pp. ChoquetBruhat. Phys. Crane and D. Math. Ashtekar and C. A. In Proceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology. Procesi. B. J. Y. and J. Rev. Cambridge Chapter . A.K. Creutz. by the Polish Committee for Scientic Research KBN through grant no. C. Bibliography . Phys. hepth/ . D. Rendall. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Lewandowski. preprint IFFI/. . Trautman. Kolmogorov. A. Czech. NorthHolland.Holonomy Calgebras on all the principal Gbundles over M . . . Gambini and A. This work was supported in part by the National Science Foundation grants PHY and PHY. . Barrett. Phys. Smolin. Manifolds and Physics. Nucl. Baez. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Foundations of the Theory of Probability. Rovelli and L. P. Gluons and Lattices. Math. Viallet. JL also thanks Cliord Taubes for stimulating discussions. R.W. Yetter to appear. and by the Eberly research fund of Pennsylvania State University. Chelsea. Tate. C. Phys. R.S. Griego. . Abhay Ashtekar and Jerzy Lewandowski . Tristan Narvaja . Uruguay email rgambinising. Montevideo. Using this fact. This does not appear as reasonable since dierent values of the cosmological constant lead to widely dierent behaviors in general relativity. Therefore the problem of solving the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop . Pennsylvania State University.psu. it was later realized that such solutions are associated with degenerate metrics metrics with zero determinant and this posed inconsistencies if one wanted to couple the theory . Facultad de Ciencias. University Park. starting from the connection representation and give details of the proof.The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity Rodolfo Gambini Intituto de Fsica. it is straightforward to prove that the second coecient of the Jones polynomial is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space with no cosmological constant. For instance.edu Abstract We show that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number of a knot is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space with a cosmological constant. USA email pullinphys.uy Jorge Pullin Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry. In the loop representation the Hamiltonian constraint has nonvanishing action only on functions of intersecting loops. It was rst argued that by considering wave functions with support on smooth loops one could solve the constraint straightforwardly . We perform calculations from scratch.edu. Pennsylvania . Implications for the possibility of generation of other solutions are also discussed. Introduction The introduction of the loop representation for quantum gravity has made it possible for the rst time to nd solutions to the WheelerDeWitt equation the quantum Hamiltonian constraint and therefore to have possible candidates to become physical wave functions of the gravitational eld. . However. if one considered general relativity with a cosmological constant it turns out that nonintersecting loop states also solve the WheelerDeWitt equation for arbitrary values of the cosmological constant. space is far from solved and has to be tackled by considering the action of the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop representation on states based on at least triply intersecting loops. as depicted in Fig. produces a term in Fab that exactly cancels the contribution from the vacuum Hamiltonian constraint. . . And even in this case the metric is nondegenerate only at the point of intersection. At least a triple intersection is needed to have a state associated with a nondegenerate dimensional metric in the loop representation. . Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. Although performing this kind of direct calculations is now possible. is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in the connection representation with a cosmological term H ijk Fk Ai Aj ab a b ijk abc Ai a Aj b Ak c . the rst term is just the usual Hamiltonian constraint with and the second term is just det g where det g is the determinant of the spatial part of the metric written in terms of triads. since welldened expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint exist in terms of the loop derivative see also and actually some solutions have been found with this approach . . To prove this fact one simply needs to notice that for the ChernSimons state introduced above. another line of reasoning has also proved to be useful. and therefore the rightmost functional derivative in the cosmological coni stant term of the Hamiltonian . This other approach is based on the fact that the exponential of the ChernSimons term based on Ashtekars connection CS A exp d xAi b Ai Ai Aj Ak a c a b c ijk abc . CS A Ai a abc i Fbc CS A. should be a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation in loop space. The Jones polynomial. since one expects states of quantum gravity to be truly dieomorphisminvariant objects and framing is always dependent on an external device which should conict with the dieomorphism invariance of the theory. This last fact can actually be checked in a direct fashion using the expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint in loop space of . which relates the Kauman bracket. and we know due to the insight of Witten that this coincides with the Kauman bracket of the loop. however. Unfortunately it is not clear at present how to settle this issue since it is tied to the regularization procedures used to dene the constraints. This raises the issue of up to what extent statements about the Kauman bracket being a state of gravity are valid.. a are the second and third coecient of the innite expansion of the Jones polynomial in terms of . where a . the Gauss selflinking number. In order to do this we make use of the identity Kauman bracket eGauss Jones polynomial .The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity This result for the ChernSimons state in the connection representation has an immediate counterpart in the loop representation. CS dA e SCS W A W . We now expand both the Jones polynomial and the exponential of the Gauss linking number in terms of and get the expression Kauman bracket Gauss Gauss a Gauss Gauss a a . and so is the Kauman bracket. . is framing independent.. with coupling constant . We will return to these issues in the nal discussion. . can be interpreted as the expectation value of the Wilson loop in a Chern Simons theory. a is known to coincide with the second coecient of the Conway polynomial . since the transform of the ChernSimons state into the loop representation CS dA CS A W A . The Gauss selflinking number is framing dependent. Therefore the state CS Kauman bracket . and the Jones polynomial. Therefore we see that by noticing that the Gauss linking number is a state with cosmological constant. Summarizing. . . D Kauman bracket G . where H is the Hamiltonian constraint without cosmological constant more recently it has also been shown that H a but we will not discuss it here. Now. Even if one is reluctant to accept the Kauman bracket as a state because of its framing dependence. and one would nd that certain conditions have to be satised if the Kauman bracket is to be a solution. is also a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological constant. perspective. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin One could now apply the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop representation with a cosmological constant to the expansion . This means that a should be a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation. . Among them it was noticed that H a . Given this fact. . it can be viewed as an intermediate step of a framingdependent proof that the Jones polynomial which is a framingindependent invariant solves the WheelerDeWitt equation it should be stressed that we only have evidence that the rst two nontrivial coecients are solutions. . it is easy to prove that the second coecient of the innite expansion of the Jones polynomial which coincides with the second coecient of the Conway polynomial is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with . . This dierence is of the form D a a Gauss a . in particular for . It can be viewed as an Abelian limit of the Kauman bracket more on this in the conclusions. and to our understanding simpler. one can therefore consider their dierence divided by . which is also a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with a cosmological constant. the fact that the Kauman bracket is a solution of the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological constant seems to have as a direct consequence that the coecients of the Jones polynomial are solutions of the vacuum WheelerDeWitt equation This partially answers the problem of framing we pointed out above. . this dierence is a state for all values of . The purpose of this paper is to present a rederivation of these facts from a dierent. We will show that the framingdependent knot invariant G eGauss . This conrms the proof given in . in the case of the Hamiltonian constraint without . In Section we derive the expression of the Hamiltonian constraint with a cosmological constant in the loop representation for a triply intersecting loop in terms of the loop derivative.The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity The rest of this paper will be devoted to a detailed proof that the exponential of the Gauss linking number solves the WheelerDeWitt equation with cosmological constant. where means the adjoint operator with respect to the measure of integration dA. Concretely. Apart from presenting this new state. On the other hand. To this aim we will derive expressions for the Hamiltonian constraint with cosmological constant in the loop representation. Applying the transform OL dAOL W AA . it is clear that OL W A OC W A. this denition should agree with OL dAW AOC A . Therefore. the operator O in the right member acts on the loop dependence of the Wilson loop. where OC is the connection representation version of the operator in question. we just present the explicit proof for a triple intersection since in three spatial dimensions it represents the most important type of intersection. the more interesting case for gravity purposes it should be noticed that all the arguments presented above were independent of the number and order of intersections of the loops. the only eect of taking the adjoint is to reverse the factor ordering of the operators. Suppose one wants to dene the action of an operator OL on a wave function in the loop representation . In Section we write an explicit analytic expression for the Gauss linking number and prove that it is a state of the theory. . If one assumes that the measure is trivial. The WheelerDeWitt equation in terms of loops Here we derive the explicit form in the loop representation of the Hamiltonian constraint with a cosmological constant. we think the calculations exhibited in this paper should help the reader get into the details of how these calculations are performed and make an intuitive contact between the expressions in the connection and the loop representation. We will perform the calculation explicitly for the case of a triply selfintersecting loop. The derivation proceeds along the following lines. We end in Section with a discussion of the results. However. It is evident that with this action of the functional derivative the Hamiltonian operator is not well dened. Here we will only study the operator in the limit in which the regulator is removed. since it yields a term i i dy a dy b Fab which vanishes due to the antisymmetry of Fab and the symmea b try of dy dy at points where the loop is smooth. . continue along to the intersection. . We need to regularize it as HL W A lim f x z ijk k Fab x W A Ai x Aj z a b . For that we need the expression of the functional derivative of the Wilson loop with respect to the connection W A Ai x a dy a y xTr Pexp y o dz b Ab i Pexp y o dz b Ab . One of them is to dene the Hamiltonian inserting pieces of holonomies connecting the points x and z between the functional derivatives to produce a gaugeinvariant quantity . Ai Aj a b . Here we compute the contribution at a point of triple selfintersection. There are a number of ways of xing this situation in the language of loops. By W j k A we really mean take the holonomy from the basepoint along up to just before the intersection point. A proper calculation would require their careful study. at intersections there can be nontrivial contributions. therefore we will not be concerned with these issues. insert a Pauli matrix. ijk k Fab x Ai x a Aj z b W A ijk k Fab x . since such point splitting breaks the gauge invariance of the Hamiltonian. ab ab where we have denoted where i are the petals of the loop as indicated in Fig. It is immediate from the above denitions that the Hamiltonian constraint vanishes in any regular point of the loop. where o is the basepoint of the loop. ab W j k A W j k A W j k A. continue along . The Wilson loop is therefore broken at the point of action of the functional derivative and a Pauli matrix i is inserted. We now need to compute this quantity explicitly. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin cosmological constant HC and therefore HL W A ijk k Fab ijk Fk Ai Aj ab a b W A. where f x z x z when . Caution should be exercised. and complete the loop along . so strictly speaking really is a distribution that is nonvanishing only at a the point of intersection. The result of the application of these identities to the expression of the Hamiltonian is HW A . . . We will not discuss all its properties here. Its denition is x o x o x ab ab o . which is a natural generalization to the case of loops with insertions of the SU Mandelstam identities. and just before the intersection insert another Pauli matrix. This expression can be further rearranged making use of the loop derivax tive. This is just shorthand for expressions like dy a x y when the point x is close to the intersection. which reects the intuitive notion that a holonomy of an innitesimal loop is related to the eld tensor. . . x o where ab is the element area of the innitesimal loop and by o x we mean the loop obtained by traversing the path from the basepoint to x. and then the loop . continue to the intersection. where means the loop opposite to . Therefore we can write expressions like i Fab W i A . One could pick after the intersection instead of before to include the Pauli matrices and it would make no dierence since we are concentrating on the limit in which the regulator is removed. in which the insertions are done at the intersection. is the dierentiation operator that appears in loop space when one considers two loops to be close if they x dier by an innitesimal loop appended through a path o going from the basepoint to a point of the manifold x as shown in Fig. the innitesimal loop . a b a b a b i Fab W i A W i A W i A . The only one we need is that the loop derivative of a Wilson loop taken with a path along the loop is given by x ab o W A Tr Fab xPexp dy c Ac . W AW A W A W A. the path from x to the basepoint. .The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity . By we mean the tangent to the petal number just before the intera section where the Pauli matrix was inserted. The loop derivative ab o . ijk W j k A W i AW A W AW i A. One now uses the following identity for traces of SU matrices. we thought that a direct derivation for this particular case would be useful for pedagogical purposes. The loop dening the loop derivative as ab W A. . . W A Ai Aj Ak a c b abc ijk a b c W i j k A . .. This latter expression can be rearranged with the following identity between holonomies with insertions of Pauli matrices ijk W i j k A W A W A W A. We proceed in a similar fashion. . Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. rst computing the action of the operator in the connection representation det q on a Wilson loop ijk abc ijk abc Ai Aj Ak a c b . It is therefore immediate to nd the expression of the determinant of the metric in the loop representation detq a b c abc . . and the nal expression for the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop representation can therefore be read o as follows H ab a b ab ab ab . . However. We now have to nd the loop representation form of the operator corresponding to the determinant of the metric in order to represent the second term in . a b This expression could be obtained by particularizing that of to the case of a triply selfintersecting loop and rearranging terms slightly using the Mandelstam identities. . This is furnished by the wellknown integral expression Gauss dxa dy b abc x yc x y . and the quantity gab x. y . This formula is most well known when the two loop integrals are computed along dierent loops. This is in general not well dened without the introduction of a framing . where x y is the distance between x and y with a ducial metric. gab x. x y . X b y. y is the propagator of a ChernSimons theory . b and integrate over the manifold for repeated continuous indices. In the present case we are considering the expression of the linking of a curve with itself. that is. The Gauss selflinking number as a solution In order to be able to apply the expressions we derived in the previous section for the constraints to the Gauss selflinking number we need an expression for it in terms of which it is possible to compute the loop derivative. We will rewrite the above expression in a more convenient fashion Gauss d x d yX a x. This notation is also faithful to the fact that the index a behaves as a vector density index at the point x. where the vector densities X are dened as X a x. where we have promoted the point dependence in x.The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity With these elements we are in a position to perform the main calculation of this paper. to show that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number of a loop is a solution of the Hamiltonian constraint with a cosmological constant. y abc x yc . The only dependence on the loop of the Gauss selflinking number is through the X. dz a z x . For calculational convenience it is useful to introduce the notation Gauss X ax X by gax by . y to a continuous index and assumed a generalized Einstein convention which means sum over repeated indices a. it is natural to pair a and x together. gab x. so we just need to compute the action of the loop derivative on one of them to be in a position to perform the calculation straightfor . In that case the formula gives an integer measuring the extent to which the loops are linked. . that is we consider the change in the X when one appends an innitesimal loop to the loop as illustrated in Fig. . the product of the Kronecker and Dirac deltas. v v b uc c x z v c c x z u a uc v c c x z a o z dy a y z. c c where the notation b x z stands for b x z. . Rearranging one gets z c ab o X cx a b x z . which we characterize as four segments along the integral curves of two vector elds ua and v b of associated lengths and . In order to do this we apply the denition of loop derivative. z ab ab o X ax z o dy a x y ua x z . This is really all we need to compute the action of the Hamiltonian. and then we continue from there back to the basepoint along the loop. Now we must integrate by parts. We partition the integral in a portion going from the basepoint to the point z where we append the innitesimal loop. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin Fig. We therefore now consider the action of the vacuum part of the Hamiltonian on the exponential of the Gauss linking number. Using the fact that a X ax and . The last and rst term combine to give back X ax and therefore one can read o the action of the loop derivative from the other terms. The action of the loop derivative is x ab o exp X cy X dz gcy dz c a b x yX dz gcy dz exp X ew X f w gew f w . Therefore. The loop derivative that appears in the denition of the Hamiltonian is evaluated along a path that follows the loop wardly. If one is to pointsplit. As a consequence of this. In that case. Discussion We showed that the exponential of the Gauss selflinking number is a solution of the Hamiltonian constraint of quantum gravity with a cosmological constant. its form is exactly the same as that of the exponential of the Gauss linking number if one replaces the propagator of the ChernSimons theory present in the .The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity the denition of gcy dz . We assume such factors coming from all terms to be similar and therefore ignore them. This concludes the main proof of this paper.. A regularized form of the Hamiltonian constraint in the loop representation is more complicated than the expression we presented. the determinant of the metric requires splitting three points whereas the Hamiltonian only needs two. If one does not take the limit the various terms do not cancel. innitesimal segments of loop should be used to connect the split points to preserve gauge invariance and a more careful calculation would be in order. In fact. It is straightforward now to check that applying the determinant of the metric one the Gauss linking number one gets a contribution exactly equal and opposite by inspection from expression .. This naturally can be viewed as the Abelian limit of the solution given by the Kauman bracket. that is. as here. What about the issue of regularization The proof we presented is only valid in the limit where . there are two terms in the Hamiltonian that need to be regularized in a dierent way in the case of gravity. What does all this tell us about the physical relevance of the solutions The situation is remarkably similar to the one present in the loop representation of the free Maxwell eld . In the case of the Maxwell eld the vacuum in the loop representation needs to be regularized. However. the expression for the Hamiltonian constraint we introduced is also only valid when the regulator is removed. it is not surprising that the wave functions that solve the constraint have some regularization dependence. The expression is only formal since in order to do this a divergent factor should be kept in front. when the regulator is removed. cy dz abc X X X exp X X gcy dz . where we again have replaced the distributional tangents at the point of intersection by an expression only involving the tangents. cx cx cx Therefore the action of the Hamiltonian constraint on the Gauss linking number is HeGauss abc eGauss abc . we get x ab o exp X cy X dz gcy dz . Lett. B. Phys. Phys. Nucl. Pullin. How could these regularization ambiguities be cured In the Maxwell case they are solved by considering an extended loop representation in which one allows the quantities X ax to become smooth vector densities on the manifold without reference to any particular loop . R G wishes to thank Karel Kucha and r Richard Price for hospitality at the University of Utah where part of this work was accomplished. although it is more complicated. Phys. Br gmann. Smolin. . J. Rovelli. Br gmann. . NSFPHY. . In the gravitational case such construction is being actively pursued . B. u . Smolin. If one allows the X to become smooth functions the framing problem disappears and one is left with a solution that is a function of vector elds and only reduces to the Gauss linking number in a very special singular limit. J P wishes to thank John Baez for inviting him to participate in the conference and hospitality in Riverside. It would certainly provide new insights into how to construct nonperturbative quantum states of the gravitational eld. L. R. Phys. . Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin latter by the propagator of the Maxwell eld. L. Support from PEDECIBA Uruguay is also acknowledged. and by research funds of the University of Utah and Pennsylvania State University. . Nucl. B. . It would be interesting to study if such a limit could be pursued in a systematic way order by order. In the extended representation. J. This similarity is remarkable. This work was supported by grants NSFPHY. It has been proved that the extensions of the Kauman bracket and Jones polynomials to the case of smooth density elds are solutions of the extended constraints. the wave functions inherit regularization dependence since the regulator does not appear as an overall factor of the wave equation. B. It is in this context that the present solutions really make sense. . u . T. B. The Abelian limit of the Kauman bracket the Gauss linking number appears as the restriction of the extended Kauman bracket to the case in which higherorder multivector densities vanish. . Rev. Gambini. Lett. Rev. . . C. The problem is therefore the same. Bibliography . Phys. Pullin. Acknowledgements This paper is based on a talk given by J P at the Riverside conference. Jacobson. A similar proof goes through for the extended Gauss linking number. R. Phys. B. Nucl. there are additional multivector densities needed in the representation. . Gambini. Lett. Nucl. Lett. Trias. Guadagnini. Pullin. A. . . Leal. . The extended loop representation a rst approach. Cim. . . . . Classical loop actions of gauge theories. M. ArmandUgon. Witten. . in preparation. Gambini. Phys. Gambini. preprint hepth . R. Br gmann. J. . Math. L. . Gambini. Nori. . Phys. R. preprint . E. F. C. R. Griego. L. General Relativity Gravitation u . Griego. Trias. . Rev. E. Commun. J. Gambini. Gambini. Pullin. D. B. Mintchev. D. J.The Gauss Linking Number in Quantum Gravity . Griego. J. . Setaro. R. Martellini. J. B. M. . Di Bartolo. C. A. . Phys. Nuovo. R. Di Bartolo. Rodolfo Gambini and Jorge Pullin . Vassiliev Invariants and the Loop States in Quantum Gravity Louis H. This gives a neat point of view on the results of BarNatan. Statistics. These methods are strong enough to give the top row evaluations of Vassiliev invariants for the classical Lie algebras. The formula is then used to evaluate the top row of the corresponding Vassiliev invariants and it is shown to match the results of BarNatan obtained via perturbation expansion of the integral. They give an insight into the structure of these invariants without using the full perturbation expansion of the integral. Chicago. The same level of handling the functional integral is commonly used in the loop transform for quantum gravity. One reason for examining the invariants in this light is the possible applications to the loop variables approach to quantum gravity.edu Abstract This paper derives at the physical level of rigor a general switching formula for the link invariants dened via the Witten functional integral.uic. The paper is organized as follows. and Computer Science. Section is a brief discussion of the nature of the functional integral. We see that this vertex is not just a transversal intersection of Wilson loops. Section details the formalism of the functional integral that we shall use. Section denes the Vassiliev invariants and shows how to formulate them in terms of the functional integral. Kauman Department of Mathematics. These are applied to the case of an SU N gauge group. In particular we derive the specic expressions for the top rows of Vassiliev invariants corresponding to the fundamental representation of SU N . Introduction The purpose of this paper is to expose properties of Vassiliev invariants by using the simplest of the approaches to the functional integral denition of link invariants. but rather has the structure . and also gives a picture of the structure of the graphical vertex associated with the Vassiliev invariant. and works out a dierence formula for changing crossings in the link invariant and a formula for the change of framing. Illinois . University of Illinois at Chicago. USA email Uuicvm. It is explained how this formalism for Vassiliev invariants can be used in the context of the loop transform for quantum gravity. The invariants associated with this integral have been given rigorous combinatorial descriptions see . The gauge eld is a form on M with values in a representation of a Lie algebra. support the existence of a large class of topological invariants of manifolds and associated invariants of knots and links in these manifolds. The group corresponding to this Lie algebra is said to be the gauge group for this particular eld. the integral ZM integrates over all gauge elds modulo gauge equivalence see for a discussion of the denition and meaning of gauge equivalence. The formalism of the integral. We need the Wilson loop. . This marks the beginning of a study that will be carried out in detail elsewhere. In this integral the action SM. A . but questions and conjectures arising from the integral formulation are still outstanding see . Here M denotes a manifold without boundary and A is a gauge eld also called a gauge potential or gauge connection dened on M . Louis H. The analogue of all paths from point a to point b is all elds from eld A to eld B. Section is a quick remark about the loop formalism for quantum gravity and its relationships with the invariants studied in the previous sections. The question posed in this domain is to nd the value of an amplitude for starting with one eld conguration and ending with another. in its form. Links and the Wilson loop We now look at the formalism of the Witten integral and see how it implicates invariants of knots and links corresponding to each classical Lie algebra. a typical integral in quantum eld theory. This generalization from paths to elds is characteristic of quantum eld theory. . Wittens integral ZM is. The Wilson loop is an exponentiated . In quantum electrodynamics the classical entity is the electromagnetic eld. . This claries an issue raised by John Baez in . In its content ZM is highly unusual. Instead of integrating over paths. Quantum mechanics and topology In Edward Witten proposed a formulation of a class of manifold invariants as generalized Feynman integrals taking the form ZM where ZM dA exp ik/SM. Quantum eld theory was designed in order to accomplish the quantization of electromagnetism. The product is the wedge product of dierential forms. Kauman of Casimir insertion up to rst order of approximation coming from the dierence formula in the functional integral. . A is taken to be the integral over M of the trace of the ChernSimons threeform CS AdA/AAA. and its internal logic. With the help of the Wilson loop functional on knots and links. We can write Ax Aa xTa dxk where the index a ranges from to m with the Lie k algebra basis T . This analysis depends upon key facts relating the curvature of the gauge eld to both the Wilson loop and the ChernSimons Lagrangian. K dA exp ik/SM. The reader may compare with the exposition in . It is the . For each choice of a and k. There is summation over repeated indices. as in the previous discussion. where x is a point in space. Witten writes down a functional integral for link invariants in a manifold M ZM. It is usually indicated by the symbolism Tr P exp KA . . The curvature tensor is written Frs xTa dxr dy s . . the manifold M will be the dimensional sphere S . Tm .Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity version of integrating the gauge eld along a loop K in space that we take to be an embedding knot or a curve with transversal selfintersections. y xy yx. Tb ifabc Tc where x. A as S. . The Lie algebra generators Ta are actually matrices corresponding to a given representation of an abstract Lie algebra. let us recall the local coordinate structure of the gauge eld Ax. T . and fabc the matrix of structure constants is totally antisymmetric. To this end. The rst fact is the relation of Wilson loops and curvature for small loops Fact The result of evaluating a Wilson loop about a very small planar circle around a point x is proportional to the area enclosed by this circle times the corresponding value of the curvature tensor of the gauge eld a evaluated at x. Ak x is a smooth function dened on space. The index k goes from to . We assume some properties of these matrices as follows . An analysis of the formalism of this functional integral reveals quite a bit about its role in knot theory. the Wilson loop will be denoted by the notation KA to denote the dependence on the loop K and the eld A. TrTa Tb ab / where ab is the Kronecker delta ab if a b and zero otherwise. We abbreviate SM. T . Unless otherwise mentioned. We also assume some facts about curvature. Thus KA Tr P exp KA . Ta . But note the dierence in conventions on the use of i in the Wilson loops and curvature denitions. A is the ChernSimons action. For the purpose of this discussion. . A Tr P exp dA exp ik/S KA . KA Here SM. . Here the P denotes pathordered integration. The symbol Tr denotes the trace of the resulting matrix. In Ax a we sum over the values of repeated indices. but inserting the matrix Ta into the loop at the point x. The ordering is forced by the dimensional nature of the loop. Thus one can write symbolically. . See the gure below. over partitions of the loop K. If T is a given matrix then it is understood that T KA denotes the insertion of T into some point of the loop. Insertion of a given matrix into this product at a point on the loop is then a welldened concept. KA xK Ax xK Aa xTa dxk . Let KA denote the change in the value of the loop. This is the rstorder approximation to the change in the Wilson loop. KA Ta KA Remark on insertion The Wilson loop is the limit. Approximate the change according to Fact . and that we are summing over repeated indices. Kauman local coordinate expression of dA AA. of products of the matrices Ax where x runs over the partition. it is understood from the context of the formula a dsr dxs Frs xTa KA that the insertion is to be performed at the point x indicated in the argument of the curvature. Application of Fact Consider a given Wilson loop KA . KA is given by the formula a KA dxr dxs Frs xTa KA . In the case above. Ask how its value will change if it is deformed innitesimally in the neighborhood of a point x on the loop. In this formula it is understood that the Lie algebra matrices Ta are to be inserted into the Wilson loop at the point x. and regard the point x as the place of curvature evaluation. This means that each Ta KA is a new Wilson loop obtained from the original loop KA by leaving the form of the loop unchanged. Louis H. k It is understood that a product of matrices around a closed loop connotes the trace of the product. Let ZK ZK. . k Aa yTa dy k k Fact The variation of the ChernSimons action S with respect to the gauge potential at a given point in space is related to the values of the curvature tensor at that point by the following formula where abc is the epsilon symbol for three indices a Frs x rst S . The volume element rst dxr dy s dz t is taken with regard to the innitesimal directions of the loop deformation from this point on the original loop. Aa x t With these facts at hand we are prepared to determine how the Witten integral behaves under a small deformation of the loop K. S and let ZK denote the change of ZK under an innitesimal change in the loop K. to the case where x is a double point of transversal selfintersection of a loop .Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity Remark The previous remark implies the following formula for the variation of the Wilson loop with respect to the gauge eld KA dxk Ta KA . and the insertion is taken of the matrix products Ta Ta at the chosen point x on the loop K that is regarded as the center of the deformation. The sum is taken over repeated indices. . Proposition Compare . All statements of equality in this proposition are up to order /k . with a dierent interpretation. Then ZK i/k dA exp ik/S r s t rst dx dy dz Ta Ta KA . The same formula applies. Aa x k Varying the Wilson loop with respect to the gauge eld results in the insertion of an innitesimal Lie algebra element into the loop. Proof KA Aa x k yltx Aa x k yK Aa yTa dy k k Ta dxk ygtx Aa yTa dy k k dx Ta KA . This completes the proof of the proposition. with two directions coming from the plane of movement of one arc. Louis H. Applying Proposition As the formula of Proposition shows. one Ta is inserted into each of the transversal crossing segments so that Ta Ta KA denotes a Wilson loop with a selfintersection at x and insertions of Ta at x and x . Kauman K. where and denote small displacements along the two arcs of K that intersect at x. the change of interpretation occurs at the point in the argument when the Wilson loop is dierentiated. the other term is the one that is described in part . This completes the formalism of the proof. One of these derivatives gives rise to a term with volume form equal to zero. In this case. and the deformation consists in shifting one of the crossing segments perpendicularly to the plane of intersection so that the selfintersection point disappears. In this case. the in . In the case of part . the volume form is nonzero. Proof ZK dA exp ik/S KA a dA exp ik/S dxr dy s Frs xTa KA Fact Fact dA exp ik/S dxr dy s dA exp ik/S dA rst S Ta KA Aa x t r s rst dx dy Ta S Aa x t KA KA i/k i/k exp ik/S Aa x t r s rst dx dy Ta dA exp ik/S r s rst dx dy Ta KA Aa x t KA integration by parts i/k dA exp ik/S r s t rst dx dy dz Ta Ta dierentiating the Wilson loop. Dierentiating a selfintersecting Wilson loop at a point of selfintersection is equivalent to dierentiating the corresponding product of matrices at a variable that occurs at two points in the product corresponding to the two places where the loop passes through the point. and the perpendicular direction is the direction of the other arc. Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity tegral ZK is unchanged if the movement of the loop does not involve three independent space directions since rst dxr dy s dz t computes a volume. This means that ZK ZS , K is invariant under moves that slide the knot along a plane. In particular, this means that if the knot K is given in the nearly planar representation of a knot diagram, then ZK is invariant under regular isotopy of this diagram. That is, it is invariant under the Reidemeister moves II and III. We expect more complicated behavior under move I since this deformation does involve three spatial directions. This will be discussed momentarily. We rst determine the dierence between ZK and ZK where K and K denote the knots that dier only by switching a single crossing. We take the given crossing in K to be the positive type, and the crossing in K to be of negative type. The strategy for computing this dierence is to use K as an intermediate, where K is the link with a transversal selfcrossing replacing the given crossing in K or K . Thus we must consider ZK ZK and ZK ZK . The second part of Proposition applies to each of these dierences and gives i/k dA exp ik/S r s t rst dx dy dz Ta Ta KA where, by the description in Proposition , this evaluation is taken along the loop K with the singularity and the Ta Ta insertion occurs along the two transversal arcs at the singular point. The sign of the volume element will be opposite for and consequently we have that . The volume element rst dxr dy s dz t must be given a conventional value in our calculations. There is no reason to assign it dierent absolute values for the cases of and since they are symmetric except for the sign. Therefore ZK ZK ZK ZK . Hence ZK / ZK ZK . Louis H. Kauman This result is central to our further calculations. It tells us that the evaluation of a singular Wilson loop can be replaced with the average of the results of resolving the singularity in the two possible ways. Now we are interested in the dierence ZK ZK ZK ZK i/k dA exp ik/S r s t rst dx dy dz Ta Ta KA. Volume convention It is useful to make a specic convention about the volume form. We take Thus ZK ZK i/k dA exp ik/S Ta Ta K A . r s t rst dx dy dz for and for . Integral notation Let ZTa Ta K denote the integral ZTa Ta K dA exp ik/S Ta Ta K A . Dierence formula Write the dierence formula in the abbreviated form ZK ZK i/kZTaTa K . This formula is the key to unwrapping many properties of the knot invariants. For diagrammatic work it is convenient to rewrite the dierence equation in the form shown below. The crossings denote small parts of otherwise identical larger diagrams, and the Casimir insertion Ta Ta K is indicated with crossed lines entering a disk labelled C. Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity The Casimir The element a Ta Ta of the universal enveloping algebra is called the Casimir. Its key property is that it is in the center of the algebra. Note that by our conventions Tr a Ta Ta a aa / d/ where d is the dimension of the Lie algebra. This implies that an unknotted loop with one singularity and a Casimir insertion will have Zvalue d/. In fact, for the classical semisimple Lie algebras one can choose a basis so that the Casimir is a diagonal matrix with identical values d/D on its diagonal. D is the dimension of the representation. We then have the loc loc general formula ZTa Ta K d/DZK for any knot K. Here K denotes the singular knot obtained by placing a local selfcrossing loop in K as shown below loc Note that ZK ZK. Let the at loop shrink to nothing. The Wilson loop is still dened on a loop with an isolated cusp and it is equal to the Wilson loop obtained by smoothing that cusp. Louis H. Kauman loc Let K denote the result of adding a positive local curl to the knot loc K, and K the result of adding a negative local curl to K. Then by the above discussion and the dierence formula, we have loc ZK loc loc ZK i/kZTa Ta K Thus, ZK i/kd/DZK. loc ZK i/kd/D ZK. Similarly, loc ZK i/kd/D ZK. These calculations show how the dierence equation, the Casimir, and properties of Wilson loops determine the framing factors for the knot invariants. In some cases we can use special properties of the Casimir to obtain skein relations for the knot invariant. For example, in the fundamental representation of the Lie algebra for SU N the Casimir obeys the following equation see , Ta ij Ta kl a il jk ij kl . N Hence ZTa Ta K ZK ZK N where K denotes the result of smoothing a crossing as shown below commutativeringvalued invariant of knots. This last equation shows that P K is a specialization of the Homy polynomial for arbitrary N . Therefore. so the framing factor is i/k N N e N /N . then it can be naturally extended to an invariant of rigid vertex graphs by dening the invariant of graphs in terms of the . and that for N SU it is a specialization of the Jones polynomial. or. Here d N and D N . we obtain ZK ZK i/k ZK / Hence i/N kZK i/N kZK i/kZK or e ZK e ZK e e ZK N N N ZK ZK . Graph invariants and Vassiliev invariants We now apply this integral formalism to the structure of rigid vertex graph invariants that arise naturally in the context of knot polynomials.Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity Using ZK ZK ZK and the dierence identity. then e/N P K e/N P K e e P K . Hence eN P K eN P K e e P K . if P K wK ZK denotes the normalized invariant of ambient isotopy associated with ZK with wK the sum of the crossing signs of K. more generally. where ex expi/kx taken up to O/k . If V K is a Laurentpolynomialvalued. constitute the important special case of these graph invariants where a . It is not hard to see that if V K is an ambient isotopy invariant of knots. See the gure below. Here K indicates an embedding with a transversal valent vertex . We use the symbol to distinguish this choice of vertex designation from the previous one involving a selfcrossing Wilson loop. this means that we dene V G for an embedded valent graph G by taking the sum over ai S bi S ci S V S for all knots S obtained from G by replacing a node of G either with a crossing of positive or negative type. If V is the nite type k. Thus V G is a Vassiliev invariant if V K V K V K . then this extension is a rigid vertex isotopy invariant of graphs. so that the vertex behaves like a rigid disk with exible strings attached to it at specic points. For purposes of enumeration it is convenient to use chord diagrams to enumerate and indicate the abstract graphs. and c . b . Kauman knot invariant via an unfolding of the vertex as indicated below V K aV K bV K cV K . Formally. . Louis H. then V G is independent of the embedding type of the graph G when G has exactly k nodes. The values of V G on all the graphs of k nodes is called the top row of the invariant V . or with a smoothing denoted . The Vassiliev invariants . . These points are paired with the pairing indicated by arcs or chords connecting the paired points. V G is said to be the nite type k if V G whenever G gt k where G denotes the number of valent nodes in the graph G. In rigid vertex isotopy the cyclic order at the vertex is preserved. This follows at once from the denition of nite type. There is a rich class of graph invariants that can be studied in this manner. A chord diagram consists of an oriented circle with an even number of points marked along it. Therefore Vj K is a Vassiliev invariant of nite type. loc We have shown that ZK ZK with ed/D. The fascinating thing is that the ambient dierence formula. appropriately interpreted. Hence Vj G if G has more than j nodes.Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity This gure illustrates the process of associating a chord diagram to a given embedded valent graph. Hence P K wK ZK is an ambient isotopy invariant. Each transversal selfintersection in the embedding is matched to a pair of points in the chord diagram. This formula tells us that for the Vassiliev invariant associated with P we have P K w i/k ZTa Ta K d/DZK . actually tells us how to compute Vk G when G has k . then we have the ambient isotopy dierence formula P K P K w i/k ZTa Ta K d/DZK . The framed dierence formula provides the necessary information for obtaining the top row. Furthermore. and then consider the structure of the dierence between positive and negative crossings. then the ambient dierence formula implies that /kj divides P G when G has j or more nodes. if Vj K denotes the coecient of i/kj in the expansion of P K in powers of /k. Vassiliev invariants from the functional integral In order to examine the Vassiliev invariants associated with the functional integral. This result was proved by Birman and Lin by dierent methods and by BarNatan by methods equivalent to ours. we must rst normalize these invariants to invariants of ambient isotopy. We leave the proof of this formula as an exercise for the reader. The equation ZK ZK i/kZTa Ta K implies that if wK w . it follows from BarNatan and Kontsevich that the condition of topological invariance is translated into the fact that the Lie bracket is represented as a commutator and that it is closed with respect to the Lie algebra. each of which can be evaluated by taking the indicated trace. we insert nothing else into the loop. Louis H. but it is very interesting to see how it follows from a minimal approach to the Witten integral. This yields the graphical evaluation implied by the recursion V G V Ta Ta G d/DV G . This result is equivalent to BarNatans result. After k steps we have a fully inserted sum of abstract Wilson loops. Kauman nodes. independent of the embedding. In particular. and because the Wilson loop is being evaluated abstractly. Under these circumstances each node undergoes a Casimir insertion. At each stage in the process one node of G disappears or it is replaced by these insertions. Thus we take the pairing structure associated with the graph the socalled chord diagram and use it as a prescription for obtaining a trace of a sum of products of Lie algebra elements with Ta and Ta inserted for each pair or a simple crossover for the pair multiplied by d/D. Diagrammatically we have Since Ta Tb Tb Ta we obtain ifabc Tc c . and so we bring this discussion to a close. all circling this basic problem. . In particular. it must be mentioned that this brings us to the core of the main question about Vassiliev invariants are there nontrivial Vassiliev invariants of knots and links that cannot be constructed through combinations of Lie algebraic invariants There are many other open questions in this arena. Nevertheless. There is not room here to go into more detail about this matter. it implies the basic term relation Proof The presence of this relation on chord diagrams for Vi G with G i is the basis for the existence of a corresponding Vassiliev invariant.Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity This relationship on chord diagrams is the seed of all the topology. This situation suggests that one should amalgamate the formalism of the Vassiliev invariants with the structure of the Poisson algebras of loops and insertions used in the quantum gravity theory . The main point that we wish to make in the relationship of the Vassiliev invariants to these loop states is that the Vassiliev vertex satisfying is not simply a transverse intersection of Wilson loops. Louis H. to corresponding statements about the Wilson loop. Rovelli. It also suggests . via integration by parts. In this way. We have seen that it follows from the dierence formula that the Vassiliev vertex is much more complex than thisthat it involves the Casimir insertion at the transverse intersection up to the rst order of approximation. In this theory the metric is expressed in terms of a spin connection A. . and that this structure can be used to compute the top row of the corresponding Vassiliev invariant. Kauman Quantum gravityloop states We now discuss the relationship of Wilson loops and quantum gravity that is forged in the theory of Ashtekar. and quantization involves considering wave functions A. Smolin and Rovelli analyze the loop transform K dAA KA where KA denotes the Wilson loop for the knot or singular embedding K. knots and weaves and their topological invariants become a language for representing a state of quantum gravity. It turns out that the condition that K be a knot invariant without framing dependence is equivalent to the socalled dieomorphism constraint for these wave functions. Dierential operators on the wave function can be referred. and Smolin . Atiyah. Math. Lin. One can begin to work backwards. Baez. Ashtekar. R. Quantum Mechanics and Path Integrals. M. Hibbs. Knot invariants as nondeu generate quantum geometries. Berkeley. Link invariants of nite type and perturbation theory. The Geometry and Physics of Knots. R. and L. spin geometry and quantum gravity. . Crane. On the Vassiliev knot invariants. C. M. This theory can be investigated by working the transform methods backwardsfrom knots and links to dierential operators and dierential geometry. . . . Crane and D. . A categorical construction of D topological quantum eld theories. . L. Pisa . and J. Math. Preprint . L. Yetter. Bibliography . . . Preprint . Phys. Geometry of YangMills Fields. Br gmann. Lett. Lett. A. Principles of Quantum Mechanics. Preprint . Commun. S. Phys. Math. taking the position that invariants that do not ostensibly satisfy the dieomorphism constraint owing to change of value under framing change nevertheless still dene states of a quantum gravity theory that is a modication of the Ashtekar formulation. R. F. Phys. P. . . Gambini. . A. Weaving a classical geometry with quantum threads. All these remarks are the seeds for another paper. B. F. Phys. Knot polynomials and Vassilievs invariants. . J. Freed and R. Smolin. Invent. Pullin. CA. Rovelli. . Atiyah. McGrawHill . Acknowledgements It gives the author pleasure to acknowledge the support of NSF Grant Number DMS and the Program for Mathematics and Molecular Biology of the University of California at Berkeley. Rev. J. Cambridge University Press . BarNatan. . D. Computer calculations of Wittens manifold invariants. D. Feynman and A. and ask the reader to stay tuned for further developments. M. B . We close here. Dirac. Accademia Nazionale dei Lincei Scuola Superiore Lezioni Fermiare. to appear. Conformal eld theory. Birman and X. Oxford University Press . Gompf. .Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity taking the formalism of these invariants in the functional integral form quite seriously even in the absence of an appropriate measure theory. Lett. F. Oxford . . Lett. . Jones. Kauman. . . . J. Preprint . Am. . L. H. . Gravitation. L. Louis H. L. Thesis. Math. On the manifold invariants of ReshetikhinTuraev for sl. H. . B. V. V. Princeton University Press. Knot theory and quantum gravity a primer. Lett. World Scientic Pub. Hecke algebra representations of braid groups and link polynomials. Preprint . K. H. Kauman and P. Melvin. manifolds and the Temperley Lieb algebra. R. . . Soc. J. Jerey. Kontsevich. Kauman. Kauman. V. Ooguri. Jones. Math. W. . . B . C. H. L. Am. . . . homotopical algebra and low dimensional topology. and J. Perry. L. . Temperley Lieb Recoupling Theory and Invariants of Manifolds to appear as Annals monograph. J. Kauman . H. B. A polynomial invariant for links via von Neumann algebras. R. Math. V. H. Ramications. Preprint . . Jones. Not. Graphs. H. Index for subfactors. R. Lins. . . Discrete and continuum approaches to threedimensional quantum gravity. L. Applications of TQFT to invariants in low dimensional topology. R. Soc. Invent. Invent. Topology . AMS Contemp. Kauman. W. A . Garoufalidis. Kirby and P. Bull. Hasslacher and M. Statistical mechanics and the Jones polynomial. . Kauman and S. Ooguri. . Math. On knot invariants related to some statistical mechanics models. . R. Knots and Physics. Misner. Thorne. R. . . S. R. Math. V. Phys. Pullin. A. . Vogel. Preprint . Princeton University Press . Ann. . Math. On Some Aspects of ChernSimons Gauge Theory. Lickorish. Pacic J. Freeman . Math. F. F. F. Mod. Ann. Topological lattice models in four dimensions. H. Annals of Mathematics Studies Number . Spin networks are simplicial quantum gravity. C. . H. W. Ser. . A new knot polynomial and von Neumann algebras. C. Jones. L. F. On Knots. S. Math. Jones. . Phys. Knot Theor. M. Wheeler. State models and the Jones polynomial. Link polynomials and a graphical calculus. . ed. Quantum invariants of manifolds associated with classical simple Lie algebras. . . Wenzl. . Quantum gravity in the selfdual representation. G. Commun. Large k asymptotics of Wittens invariant of Seifert manifolds. Phys. On Wittens manifold invariants. Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial. Math. . dimensional gravity as an exactly soluble system. . . The TuraevViro state sum model and dimensional quantum gravity. G. Nucl. Turaev and H. Finitetype invariants of knots. Contemp. Viro. . Math. . G. Preprint. G. B . . . . Phys. Reshetikhin and V. . V. Invariants of three manifolds via link polynomials and quantum groups. Preprint . Quantum invariants of manifolds and a glimpse of shadow topology. . links and graphs. N. L. T. V. . Stanford. Turaev and O. Witten. Preprint . . Turaev. Invent. Preprint . I. Turaev. Preprint . Cohomology of knot spaces. . V. V. Arnold. N. Phys. pp. Reshetikhin and V. Turaev. .. Commun. Quantum invariants of links and valent graphs in manifolds. V. Witten. Preprint . Soc. L. State sum invariants of manifolds and quantum j symbols. Walker. Preprint .Vassiliev Invariants and Quantum Gravity . Topology . R. Am. Math. . Williams and F. . G. K. Ribbon graphs and their invariants derived from quantum groups. Turaev. E. In Theory of Singularities and its Applications V. Y. Archer. . Smolin. Rozansky. E. Turaev. . Math. Topology of shadows. Math. Preprint . V. . . Y. Vassiliev. Louis H. Kauman . from the values of the loop variables. an arbitrary splitting of spacetime into spacelike hypersurfaces. particularly for covariant canonical approaches to quantum gravity.ucdavis. this is already a source of trouble in classical general relativity. To a certain extent. Introduction Ashtekars connection representation for general relativity . I emphasize the possibility of reconstructing the classical geometry. I close with a brief discussion of implications for quantization. and refer only to the invariant underlying geometry. however. USA email carlipdirac. and the rst steps have been taken towards establishing a reasonable weakeld perturbation theory . where one must take care to separate physical phenomena from artifacts of coordinate . But real geometry and physics cannot depend on such a choice. University of California. California . Some important progress has been made a number of observables have been found. the true physical observables must somehow forget any details of the time slicing.edu Abstract In this chapter. inherent in almost any canonical formulation of general relativity. by the absence of a clear physical interpretation for the observables built out of Ashtekars new variables.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables in dimensional Gravity Steven Carlip Department of Physics. But there is a deeper problem as well. Davis. Progress has been hampered. and the closely related loop variable approach have generated a good deal of excitement over the past few years. via the theory of geometric structures. While it is too early to make rm predictions. In part. the problem is simply one of unfamiliarityphysicists accustomed to metrics and their associated connections can nd it dicult to make the transition to densitized triads and selfdual connections. large classes of quantum states have been identied. To dene Ashtekars variables. one must choose a time slicing. I review the relationship between the metric formulation of dimensional gravity and the loop observables of Rovelli and Smolin. there seems to be some real hope that these new variables will allow the construction of a consistent nonperturbative quantum theory of gravity. This notation is standard in papers in dimensional gravity. are spacetime coordinate indices. The fundamental variables are a triad e a a section of the bundle of orthonormal framesand a connection on the same bundle. c. are spatial coordinate indices. . which we shall often assume to have a topology R. and a. . however. where ea e a dx and a local SO. From geometry to holonomies Let us begin with a brief review of dimensional general relativity in rstorder formalism. As our spacetime we take a manifold M . so readers should be careful in translation. and one may hope that at least some of the technical results have extensions to our physical spacetime. general relativity in two spatial dimensions plus time. transformations. . . allowing the use of powerful techniques not readily available in the realistic dimensional theory. But the success of dimensional gravity can be viewed as an existence proof for canonical quantum gravity. j. A reduction in the number of dimensions greatly simplies general relativity. But although some progress has been made in dening area and volume operators in terms of these variables . the goal of reconstructing spacetime geometry from such invariant quantities remains out of reach. . . Steven Carlip choices. . where is a closed orientable surface. and the need to reconstruct geometry and physics from such quantities becomes unavoidable. b. . which can be specied by a connection form a b . . we can actually write down a large set of dieomorphisminvariant operators. In canonical quantization. many of the specic results presented here will not readily generalize to higher dimensions. The action is invariant under eb c abc ea a abc a . As a consequence. i. b c . d Indices . built out of the loop variables of Rovelli and Smolin in the loop representation of quantum gravity . k. bc dx . The EinsteinHilbert action can be written as Igrav M ea da abc abc b c . . The purpose of this chapter is to demonstrate that such a reconstruction is possible in the simple model of dimensional gravity. are Lorentz indices. but diers from the usual conventions for Ashtekar variables. labelling vectors in an orthonormal basis. the problem becomes much sharperall observables must be dieomorphism invariants. For the rst time. Lorentz indices are raised and lowered with the Minkowski metric ab . In a sense. . the Ashtekar program is a victim of its own success. . . . . can be interpreted as the statement that e is a cotangent vector to the space of at SO. actually implies that the metric g is at. indeed. for as a function of e. As a second alternative. connections. In fact. but this is not an independent symmetry Witten has shown that when the triad e a is invertible. is simply the requirement that the curvature of vanish. In dimensions. which will form the basis for our analysis . We therefore need only worry about equivalence classes of dieomorphisms that are not isotopic to the identity. abc These equations have four useful interpretations. . . if s is a curve in the space of at connections. these eld equations are much more powerful than they are in dimensions the full Riemann curvature tensor is linearly dependent on the Ricci tensor. the derivative of . that be a at SO.. that is elements of the mapping class group of M . so . dieomorphisms in the connected component of the identity are equivalent to transformations of the form . R g R g R g R g R g g g g R. and rewrite . . are easily derived dea and d a abc b ec b c . Moreover. that is. as an equation for e. . ea da . connection.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables as well as local translations. gives d d a ds abc b dc ds . note that eqn .e. We can solve . The space of solutions of the eld equations can thus be identied with the set of at Lorentzian metrics on M . . for the Lorentzian i. Igrav is also invariant under dieomorphisms of M . . depends only on and not on e. a abc b c . of course. The equations of motion coming from the action . R g . The result is equivalent to the ordinary vacuum Einstein eld equations.. eqn . . pseudoRiemannian metric g e a e b ab . and it is often the case that only one connected component corresponds to physically admissible spacetimes. If we denote equivalence under this action by . if h h .. SO. for physical implications. with a d a ds .. it is easy to check that the rst equations of . Now.. is not always connected. These transfor mations act on N through their action as a group of automorphisms of M . we must still factor out the gauge transformations . transformations. this description can be further rened. The transformations of e can once again be interpreted as statements about the cotangent space if we consider a curve s of SO. the mapping class group. and let N / N . A solution of the eld equations is thus determined by a point in the cotangent bundle T N . follow from dierentiating the second equation of . . the space N or at least the physically relevant is homeomorphic to the Teichm ller connected component of N u Strictly speaking. . we can express the space of solutions of the eld equations . and tell us that only gauge equivalence classes of at SO. as T N . . To determine the physically inequivalent solutions of the eld equations. act on as ordinary SO. In that case. Steven Carlip which can be identied with . See . h SO. and . We can therefore write N Hom M . ds . a at connection on the frame bundle of M is determined by its holonomies. The space of homomorphisms . / . for the mathematical structure and . Let us denote the space of such equivalence classes as N . one more subtlety remains. connections are relevant. .. when M has the topology Rthis action comprises the entire set of outer automorphisms of M . and in many interesting casesfor example.. When M has the topology R. It remains for us to factor out the dieomorphisms that are not in the component of the identity. and ea as in . . with ea d a . that is by a homomorphism M SO. . and gauge transformations act on by conjugation. gauge transformations. The local Lorentz transformations . . This is consistent with our previous results. abc Comparing with . now from to SO. solutions of the dimensional eld equations are certainly not static as geometriesthey do not. For a topology of the form R . For despite eqn . it is useful to split the eld equations into spatial and temporal components. and N is the corresponding moduli space . who observed that the triad e and the connection could . and is therefore invisible to the holonomies. solutions may therefore be labelled by classes of homomorphisms.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables space of . But the central dilemma described in the introduction now stands out sharply. The temporal components of the eld equations. and must be uncovered if we are to nd a sensible physical interpretation of our solutions. on the other hand. A third approach is available if M has the topology R. The set of vacuum spacetimes can thus be identied with the cotangent bundle of the moduli space of . with a a e and a e a .. is entirely described by a gauge transformation. ea ea e a dt. with all quantities replaced by their tilded spatial equivalents.. of course. . Let us write d d dt . This puzzle is an example of the notorious problem of time in gravity . the fundamental group is simply that of . The spatial projections of . shows in detail how this occurs motion in coordinate time is merely a gauge transformation. . dt... This decomposition can be made in a less explicitly coordinatedependent mannersee. Equation .. and exemplies one of the basic issues that must be resolved in order to construct a sensible quantum theory. b ec b c . for example. was suggested by Witten . in general. A nal approach to the eld equations . For such a topology. we see that the time development of . admit timelike Killing vectors. now become ea de a a d a abc a a a . take the same form as the original equations. and an invariant description in terms of holonomies should not be able to detect a particular choice of spacelike slice. The real physical dynamics has somehow been hidden by this analysis. and many powerful results from Riemann surface theory become applicable. abc eb c . As above. and the corresponding cotangent vectors. . but the nal results are unchanged. . may be recognized as the standard semidirect product composition law for Poincar transformations. . if h h . as the same group of automorphisms of M . . ISO. that is by homomorphisms in the space M Hom M . can be identied with standard ISO. inherits this cotangent bundle structure in an obvious way. Imitating the arguments of our second interpretation. . . and the multiplication law . . . d .. has a Lie algebra with e generators J a and P b and commutation relations J a. is simply the Chern Simons action for A. To relate this description to our previous results. an invariant inner product on the Lie algebra. But this group acts in . d . and the gauge transformations . we thus see that M T N .. ICS Tr A dA A A A . . leading to the identication M T N . and . can be written in the form d . observe that ISO. . Steven Carlip be combined to form a single connection on an ISO. connection. is itself a cotangent bundle with base space SO. P b abc Pc . where N is the space of homomorphisms . h ISO. d . The space of homomorphisms from e M to ISO. a cotangent vector at the point SO. gauge transformations. we should therefore expect solutions of the eld equations to be characterized by gauge equivalence classes of at ISO. Indeed. the dimensional Poincar group. J a. P a . writing the quotient as M/ M. P b . . connections. then it is easy to verify that the action . Tr J a J b Tr P a P b . / . d d . It remains for us to factor out the mapping class group. by Tr J a P b ab . J b abc Jc . bundle. If we write a single connection form A ea Pa a Ja and dene a trace. ISO. M The eld equations now reduce to the requirement that A be a at ISO. and considerable work is still needed to construct dieomorphisminvariant observables that depend only on knot classes. The loop variables of Rovelli and Smolin . T and T are not quite the equivalence classes of holonomies of our interpretation number above T is not a holonomy. the loop variables can serve as local coordinates on N . ds . on the other hand. In dimensions. is the one that is closest to the loop variable picture in dimensional gravity. Here. given a curve s in the space of at SO.. holonomy around . and we have already seen that the derivative d a /ds can be identied with the triad ea . and indeed. to obtain d T ds Tr U . while T is essentially a cotangent vector to T indeed. . In dimensions. . The key dierence is that in dimensions the connection is at. at least under dieomorphisms isotopic to the identity. the variables T and T depend on particular loops . may be expressed as follows. this issue has been investigated in a slightly dierent context by Nelson and Regge . only the rst corresponds directly to our usual picture of spacetime physics. and the basepoint x species the point at which the path ordering begins.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables Of these four approaches to the dimensional eld equations. on the other hand. But knowledge of T for a large enough set of homotopically inequivalent curves may be used to reconstruct a point in the space N of eqn . are geodesics in the at manifolds of this description. . Of course. We then dene T Tr U . T is thus the trace of the SO. connections. dx tJa . . x and T dt Tr U . xt d a tJa . Let U . x P exp a Ja . xt e a t . P denotes path ordering. we can dierentiate . so the holonomy U . Some care must be taken in handling the mapping class group. which acts nontrivially on T and T . The second approach. be the holonomy of the connection form a around a closed path t based at x. . Trajectories of physical particles. for instance. the loop variables are already invariant. but only the trace of a holonomy. x depends only on the homotopy class of . dt . specic examples are familiar for example. i Ui Ui gi i Ui Ui . the vanishing of the curvature tensor implies that M. i. A fundamental ingredient in the description of a G. Steven Carlip Geometric structures from holonomies to geometry The central problem described in the introduction can now be made explicit. .R. . . M can still be covered by contractible coordinate patches Ui that are each isometric to V . just as an ordinary ndimensional manifold is modelled on Rn . Moreover. Our goal is therefore to provide a translation between these two descriptions. Such a description is fully dieomorphism invariant.e. which determine how these patches are glued together. We can cover with coordinate charts i Ui X. A G. or at least some subset of V . e Such a construction is an example of what Thurston calls a geometric structure . these transition functions must be isometries of . . If the spacetime topology is nontrivial. Spacetimes in dimensions can be characterized a la Ashtekar et al. as points in the cotangent bundle T N . a G. X manifold containing a closed path . structure. H structure. . that is elements of the Poincar group ISO. with constant transition functions gi G between Ui and Ui .V . If M is topologically trivial. . X structure on M is then a set of coordinate patches Ui covering M with coordinates i Ui X taking their values in the model space and with transition functions ij i j Ui Uj in G. X structure is its holonomy group. While this general formulation may not be widely known. To proceed. let us investigate the space of at spacetimes in a bit more detail. with the standard Minkowski metric on each patch. . our description number of the last section. n . More precisely. which can be viewed as a measure of the failure of a single coordinate patch to extend around a closed curve. since the metrics in Ui and Uj are identical. and provides a natural starting point for quantization. in this case a Lorentzian or ISO. the uniformization theorem for Riemann surfaces implies that any surface of genus g gt admits an P SL. But our intuitive geometric picture of a dimensional spacetime is that of a manifold M with a at metricdescription number and only in this representation do we know how to connect the mathematics with ordinary physics. g is simply ordinary Minkowski space V . . Let M be a G. the model space. . . . let G be a Lie group that acts analytically on some nmanifold X. and let M be another nmanifold. . . X manifold is one that is locally modelled on X. The geometry is then encoded in the transition functions ij on the intersections Ui Uj . . i . In general. that can be extended to the whole of Minkowski space. which again overlaps U .. For spacetimes. . . To do so. . . We can begin with a coordinate transformation in U that replaces by g . . . Otherwise. . where G ISO. the holonomy H. In fact. X structure of M . gn . . dened as H g . gj j . we simply form the product G Ui in each patchgiving the local structure of a G bundleand use the transition functions ij of the geometric structure to glue together the bers on the overlaps. The homomorphism H is not quite uniquely determined by the geometric structure. It is then easy to verify that the at connection on the resulting bundle has a holonomy group isomorphic to the holonomy group of the geometric structure. reproducing approach number . If we start with a at manifold M and simply cut out a ball. The resulting map D M X is called the developing map of the G. we can obtain a new at manifold without aecting . Note that if we pass from M to its universal covering space M . In general. and use one of the holonomy groups of eqn . the holonomy denes a homomorphism H M G. we will eventually reach the nal patch Un . with j g . If the new coordinate function n g . measures the obstruction to such a covering. we are thus led to a space of holonomies of precisely the form . At least in simple examples. it is easy to see what can go wrong.approach number to the eld equationsto dene a Lorentzian structure on M . we will have succeeded in covering with a single patch. Continuing this process along the curve. D embodies the classical geometric picture of development as unrollingfor instance. the unwrapping of a cylinder into an innite strip. thus changing the transition functions gi without altering the G. We can now try to reverse this process. It may be shown that the holonomy of a curve depends only on its homotopy class . gn n happens to agree with on Un U . and will be extendable to all of M . It is easy to see that such a transformation has the eect of conjugating H by h. X structure is not necessarily sucient to determine the full geometry. X structure. X structure on a manifold M . it is straightforward to dene a corresponding at G bundle . and it is not hard to prove that H is in fact unique up to such conjugation . For the case of a Lorentzian structure. thus extending to U U . since we are free to act on the model space X by a xed element h G. This identication is not a coincidence. Given a G. we will no longer have noncontractible closed paths. Let us now try analytic continuation of the coordinate from the patch U to the whole of .Geometric Structures and Loop Variables n Un U gn Un U . this step may fail the holonomy group of a G. . holonomy group H M. for instance in a time slicing by surfaces of constant mean curvature. This is a rather trivial change. if we can solve the dicult technical problem of nding an appropriate fundamental region W V . Hence. For the black hole. For the dimensional black hole. although more exotic topologies may occur in some approaches to quantum gravity. as in our approach number . the geometric structure can be read o from and . a spacetime constructed as a domain of dependence of a spacelike surface . in and . First. He shows that the holonomy group determines a unique maximal spacetime M specically. This means that for spatially closed dimensional universes. This quotient construction can be a powerful tool for obtaining a description of M in reasonably standard coordinates. and the full topology is uniquely xed by that of an initial spacelike slice. however. we can write M as a quotient space W/H. and is explored in some detail in . and that M can be obtained as the quotient space W/H. Finally. Steven Carlip the holonomy of the geometric structure. Next. Mess has investigated this question for the case of spacetimes with topologies of the form R. For topologies more complicated than R. topology change is classically forbidden. a cosmological constant must be added to the eld equations. structure. To summarize. Instead of being at. a theorem of Mess is relevant if M is a compact manifold with a at. then M necessarily has the topology R . and we would like to show that nothing worse can go wrong. of Minkowski space. RT . the resulting spacetime has constant negative curvature. establishing a connection to our second approach to the eld equations. This procedure has been investigated in detail for the case of a torus universe. we identify the group H with the holonomy group of a Lorentzian structure on M . A related result for the torus will appear in . it is not physically unreasonable to restrict our attention to spacetimes R. thus determining a at spacetime of approach number . Mess also demonstrates that the holonomy group H acts properly discontinuously on a region W V . . we now have a procedurevalid at least for spacetimes of the form Rfor obtaining a at geometry from the invariant data given by AshtekarRovelliSmolin loop variables. For a universe containing point particles. where is a closed surface homeomorphic to one of the boundary components of M . In particular. But again. timeorientable Lorentzian metric and a strictly spacelike boundary. nondegenerate. the recent work of t Hooft and Waelbroeck is really a description of at spacetimes in terms of Lorentzian structures. we associate that point with an ISO. H. it is implicit in the early descriptions of Deser et al. I know of very few general results. and the geometric structure becomes an SO. for the action of H. we use the loop variables to determine a point in the cotangent bundle T N . And although it is never stated explicitly. . each of the four interpretations of the eld equations discussed above suggests its own set of fundamental observables. or the elds and their canonical momenta in a free eld theory. In our second interpretationsolutions as classes of at connections and their cotangentsthe natural observables are points in the bundle T N . from to R. for instance.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables Quantization and geometrical observables Our discussion so far has been strictly classical. In dimensions. Classical observables are functions of the positions and momenta. and it seems that the best we can do is to dene a quantum theory in some particular. . I would like to conclude by briey describing some of the issues that arise if we attempt to quantize dimensional gravity. . In practice. and there is no reason to expect the quantum theories coming from dierent slicings to be equivalent. one that must be small enough to permit a consistent representation and yet big enough to generate a large class of classical observables . no such irreducible representation of the full Poisson algebra of classical observables exists . where a number of approaches to quantization can be carried out explicitly. The canonical quantization of a classical system is by no means uniquely dened. there is often an obvious set of preferred observablesthe positions and momenta of point particles. that is maps f. on the other hand. The symplectic form on determines a set of Poisson brackets f. . g. we are to look for an irreducible representation of this Lie algebra as an algebra of operators acting on some Hilbert space. and we will have to look hard for physical and mathematical justications for our selection. As stated. we are instructed to replace the classical observables with operators and the Poisson brackets with commutators. In particular. with local coordinates consisting of N position variables and N conjugate momenta. A classical system is characterized by its phase space. that is. . Ordinarily. In the rst interpretationsolutions as at spacetimesthe natural candidates are the metric and its canonical momentum on some spacelike surface. For gravity. and hence induces a Lie algebra structure on the space of observables. such a natural choice seems dicult to nd. g among observables. the resulting quantum theory will depend on this choice of preferred observables. it is known that dierent choices of variables lead to genuinely dierent quantum theories . but most approaches have some basic features in common. . But these quantities are not dieomorphism invariant. xed time slicing . we must therefore choose a subalgebra of preferred observables to quantize. In simple classical systems. this program cannot be carried out Van Hove showed in that in general. . since the choice of such a slicing is arbitrary. . however. This is a rather undesirable situation. . a N dimensional symplectic manifold . To quantize such a system. Q Q. one obtains a parameter family of dieomorphisminvariant operators T and p T that describe the physical evolution of a spacelike slice. Classically. . We begin by choosing a set of physically interesting classical observables of at spacetimes. a natural set of geometric variables are the modulus of a toroidal slice of constant mean curvature TrK T and its conjugate momentum p . the appropriate symplectic structure for quantization is just the natural symplectic structure of T N as a cotangent bundle. and there seem to be no fundamental diculties in constructing the quantum theory. There. The procedure for quantizing such a cotangent bundle is well established . such observables can be determinedat least in principle as functions of the geometric structure. Steven Carlip These are dieomorphism invariant. It is therefore natural to ask whether we can extend the classical relationships between these approaches to the quantum theories. Q Q. into an operator equation. Some ambiguity will remain. This program has been investigated in some detail for the simplest nontrivial topology. the answer is positive. M RT . . just as in the classical theory. holonomies of the spacetime. We now adopt these holonomies as our preferred observables for quantization. These can be expressed explicitly in terms of a set of loop variables that characterize the ISO. Finally. the requirement of mapping class group invariance seems to place major restrictions on the possible orderings . T . since the operator ordering in . where the parameter T labels the time slice on which the Q are dened for instance. Let us denote these variables generically as QT . in particular. and thus of the ISO. holonomies . Following the program outlined above. But now. but in the examples studied so far. thus obtaining a set of dieomorphisminvariant but timedependent quantum observables to represent the variables Q. we translate . is rarely unique. At least for simple topologies. The basic strategy is as follows. the physical interpretation of the quantum observables is obscure. obtaining a Hilbert space L N and a set of operators . The T dependence of these operators can be described by a set of Heisenberg . . T TrK. For example. it is often possible to foliate uniquely a spacetime by spacelike hypersurfaces of constant mean extrinsic curvature TrK. T . and quantization is relatively straightforward. the intrinsic and extrinsic geometries of such slices are useful observables with clear physical interpretations. But I believe that some of the basic features are likely to extend to realistic dimensional gravity. C. Phys. in General Relativity and Gravitation . Rovelli. R. Rovelli and L. A. the parameter T is not a time coordinate in the ordinary sense. ed. of course. Ashtekar. . Smolin. . Smolin. our simple model has strikingly conrmed the power of the RovelliSmolin loop variables. We do not yet understand the classical solutions of the dimensional eld equations well enough to duplicate such a strategy. Moreschi IOP Publishing. one would like to nd some kind of perturbation theory for geometrical variables like Q. but for the rst time in years. The invariant but T dependent operators T and p T are examples of Rovellis evolving constants of motion . see L. Rev. but little progress has yet been made in this direction. C. but a similar approach may be useful in minisuperspace models. . Lett. the operators T and p T are fully dieomorphism invariant. Acknowledgements This work was supported in part by US Department of Energy grant DEFGER. . Ashtekar.. For more complicated topologies. such an explicit construction seems quite dicult. . Ashtekar. For a recent review. A. Gleiser. . or quantization of the space of classical solutions. there seems to be some real cause for optimism. Ideally. with a Hamiltonian H. . T that can again be calculated explicitly. dT d p i H. Smolin. A full extension to dimensions undoubtedly remains a distant goal. and O. d i H. an expression of dynamics in terms of operators that are individually constants of motion. The quantization of holonomies is a form of covariant canonical quantization . Phys. N. D . Phys. J. The specic constructions I have described here are unique to dimensions. dT . p . . We thus have a kind of time dependence without time dependence. Kozameh. p . Singapore. . although Unruh and Newbury have taken some interesting steps in that direction . B . C. Nucl. Bristol. Bibliography . whose use has also been suggested in dimensional gravity. Rev. Lectures on Nonperturbative Quantum Gravity World Scientic. Finally. A. Let me stress that despite the familiar appearance of . M. and L.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables equations of motion. Singapore. . . B. ed. . Smolin. Carlip. . For examples of geometric structures. Ser. in Geometry of Group Representations. Institut des Hautes Etudes Scientiques preprint IHES/M// . L. Goldman and A. Harvey Academic Press. Solution Space to Gravity on RT in Wittens Connection Formulation. Regge. aa . New York. . . S. Invent. on General Relativity and Relativistic Astrophysics. Sci. Phys. B . Harvey. Hiroshima Math. and P. C. Marolf. Husein. of the th Canadian r Conf. . Regge. E. in Knots. . . Lusanna World Scientic. Princeton lecture notes . B . World Scientic. in Analytical and Geometric Aspects of Hyperbolic Space. Witten. Adv. Ann. Ashtekar. Rev. . Lett. Classical amp Quantum Gravity L. Phys. J. Phys. ed. Phys. Math. W. Math. M. Math. D. Kucha. A. I. J. M. ed. Thurston. . M. Goldman. Math. S. . and G. G. Math. Epstein Cambridge University Press. Enseign. Goldman. . Singapore. E. Phys. J. . Jackiw. The Geometry and Topology of ThreeManifolds. Fenn. Acad. J. Providence. E. Samuel. S. Sorvali. R. M. Syracuse preprint SUGP/ . W. Sullivan and W. Topology. Phys. Witten. Math. see D. D . Nelson and T. Phys. D. R. M. A. . Ann. see K. W. Canary. Luoko and D. . B . . W. Soc. Commun. and Quantum Field Theory. B. . Nucl. . . Magid American Mathematical Society. Commun. and L. J. . T. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . G. Smolin. . . . Thurston. . A. . in Proc. ed. Commun. Seppl and T. . ed. D. Okai. . . Lorentz Spacetimes of Constant Curvature. M. W. . Cambridge. R. . Goldman. . Steven Carlip . Jacobson and L. Math. Nelson and T. J. W. V. in Discrete Groups and Automorphic Functions. . Smolin. For an extensive review. Epstein. Nucl.P. L. Mess. Carlip. . Green. Rovelli. W. . Lecture Notes Series . t Hooft. E. Kunstatter et al. J. . Deser. Phys. See also T. London Math. M. Witten. . Loop Representations for Gravity on a Torus. W. of the Fifth Canadian Conference on General Relativity and Relativistic Astrophysics. Ba ados et al. G. Hosoya and K. . Roy. . Phys. . Van Hove. Lett. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Groups. . D . Rev. J. de lAcad. H. University of British Columbia preprint . Solution to Gravity in the Dreibein Formalism. t Hooft. D . Isham. Magnon. Carlip. Carlip and J. Rev. Cangemi. . and R. Phys. Six Ways to Quantize Dimensional Gravity. MIT preprint MITCTP . DeWitt and R. A. . B. Turin preprint DFTT / and Davis preprint UCD. For a useful summary. D. Rovelli. Phys. in Relativity. London A . . n . D . D. . . . Gauge Formulation of the Spinning Black Hole in Dimensional Antide Sitter Space. Cambridge. Phys. Rev. Equivalent Quantisations of Dimensional Gravity. Israel Cambridge University Press.Geometric Structures and Loop Variables . Hawking and W. C. M. J. S. and Topology II. . Nelson. Davis preprint UCD. Amsterdam. Rev. Phys. G. . . de Belgique Classe de Sci. D . see C. R. B. to appear in Proc. . E. Stora NorthHolland. M. Mann. D . Nakao. . Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Proc. Leblanc. S. W. Syracuse preprint SUGP/ . Rev. . Mem. B . Phys. Marolf. Crnkovic and E. L. ed. C. ed. Waelbroeck. Math. Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Ashtekar and A. Unruh and P. Soc. . Nucl. Phys. A. Rev. in Three Hundred Years of Gravity. Moncrief. . S. Carlip. Newbury. S. . Classical amp Quantum Gravity . V. S.. Phys. Steven Carlip . Fine Department of Mathematics. where is a Riemann surface . That is. second. Introduction In this chapter. Treatments of the path integral for ChernSimons in the axial gauge on R tend to make contact with the WZW model at earlier stages. one must already know how to solve the WZW model or at least know that its solution denes this modular functor to recognize its appearance in the ChernSimons theory. Massachusetts . The details I omit appear in . That the two theories are related has been known at least since Witten rst described the geometric quantization of the ChernSimons theory in the axial gauge on manifolds of the form R . In this approach. rst.edu Abstract Direct analysis of the ChernSimons path integral reduces quantum expectations of unknotted Wilson lines in ChernSimons theory on S with group G to npoint functions in the WZW model of maps from S to G. the formal properties of the path integral provide axioms crucial to extending the theory from R to compact manifolds. USA email dnecis. the WZW model appears in a highly rened form. it does not use a direct evaluation of the path integral.From ChernSimons to WZW via Path Integrals Dana S. as the source of a certain modular functor. that the ChernSimons path integral on S is tractable. as itself a principal ber bundle with anelinear ber. that it provides an unusually direct link between the ChernSimons theory and the WZW model. The points I would like to emphasize are. where G is the symmetry group of the ChernSimons theory. Although this is frequently described as a path integral approach. I will describe how to reduce the path integral for Chern Simons theory on S to the path integral for the WessZuminoWitten WZW model for maps from S to G. Dartmouth. the space of connections modulo those gauge transformations which are the identity at a point n. The reduction hinges on the characterization of A/G n . University of Massachusetts. rather.umassd. and. Moore and Seiberg proceed with the evaluation of the path integral far enough . DA means the standard measure on A. to recognize its appearance in the ChernSimons theory. Take this to be the standard metric on S . The approach I will describe is novel in that it treats the path integral on S directly. The WZW path integral for G based maps from S to G is f WZW Z G f XeiSX DX. and f explicitly determines f . In particular. and X is any extension of X from S to M . if f is is the trace of a product of evaluationatapoint a Wilson line. Note that even the formal denition of DA requires a metric. The main result f Z f AeiSA DA. A/G n The ChernSimons path integral to evaluate is CS where A is a connection on the principal bundle P S G. where X G. S Here A is the space of smooth connections on P . and DA is the pushforward to A/G n . not its solution nor even its current algebra. it does not require a choice of gauge. then f . and SA is the ChernSimons action k Tr A dA A A A . The main result is f CS Z i f Xe k S k TrXXi M Tr X dX DX. and one need only know the action of the WZW model. Dana S. Fine to obtain a path integral over the phase space LG/G. A A/G n is the standard map to the quotient. This links the two theories as theories of the representations of LG/G. Frhlich and King o obtain the KnizhnikZamolodchikov equation of the WZW model from the same gaugexed ChernSimons path integral. Here M is any manifold with M S . The key ingredient is a technique for integrating directly on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations which I developed to evaluate path integrals for YangMills on Riemann surfaces . where the WZW action is SX k S TrX X M TrX dX X dX X dX . Gn is the space of gauge transformations which are the identity at the north pole n of S . A A for Gn . Moreover. the ChernSimons path integral directly reduces to the path integral for a WZW model of based maps from S to G. That is. so A G. Relative to a basepoint in the ber over n. As e varies throughout the equator identied with S . since a gauge transformation aects holonomy about e by conjugation by the value of the gauge transformation at n. The path e maps. the space of such is ker P . and each point e S . That is. In fact. If P S . Integrate along the ber over each point X G. . g S . g denotes projection to the longitudinal part. e follows a longitude from the north pole n to the south pole s through a xed point e of the equator and then returns along the longitude through the variable point e. Recognize the resulting measure on G as a WZW path integral. Since A e . for each A. the ber over A/G n as a bundle over G . dene A e by holonomy about paths e of the form pictured in Fig. . A e denes. The technique is as follows . For each connection A. Turn now to the ber of . Thus the assignment A A denes a mapping A/G n G which will serve as our projection. A e lies in G. A A if vanishes along the longitudes of Fig. Characterize A/G n as a bundle over G with anelinear bers. it is a based map. . Clearly.From ChernSimons to WZW Fig. a map from S to G. . . where is the restriction to a small sphere approaching n. The action along the ber is. . One such choice is determined by A X dX. choose a specic origin A to remove the linear term.. the boundary term vanishes. To see this. In fact X X. k With this choice. use a homotopy from X to the identity to determine lifts to P of the family of paths e in S which dened . The reason to redo this is to describe the topologically trivial ber in an explicit manner. after an integration by parts. Such a homotopy exists. which describe a homotopy equivalence between A/G n for bundles over S and G. This determines P A such that A X. According to eqn . To integrate over the ber. The determinant factor relates DA on the ber to the metriccompatible measure D . and the connection A in the above presentation represents a choice of origin in the ber. because G for any Lie group G. Fine A ker P . the boundary contribution is retained. so to keep A smooth requires A X dX. the integral over the ber looks like Iber X det/ DA P DA f A eiSA D. for reasons which will soon be clear. The integral over the ber becomes Iber X det/ DA P DA eiSA f A ei ker P k Tr DA D. where. and SA SA S Tr DA . SA SA k M Tr DA FA M TrA . Note that X is not well dened at n. The image of is all of G. This is a slight renement of and . where X S G is parallel transport by A along the longitudinal paths e used in dening . Thus the ber is the ane version of the linear space ker P . Thus A is not continuous at n nor is any other such choice. A is the set of orbits Dana S. . with a minor variation to account for the discontinuity. that is. Now. The determinant analogous to the righthand side is that of P DA DA P acting on elements of ker P which vanish at n. where is the etainvariant. Each determinant is constant along the base in A/G n . Repeating these arguments. . f can be expressed as a function f of X. which refer to a nitedimensional analog. where base is the measure on G induced by the metric on A/G n . S A k S Tr X dX . . in terms of which Tr DA S S k Tr DA Tr DA S Tr TrX X. assuming f constant along the bers. Add a small quadratic term. will evaluate Iber . Performing the integration over the bers in the path integral for f . this would be standard. take det P DA DA P ei . The result would be a determinant times the exponential of the etainvariant as in and . The metric on S . as the analogue for det/ T T .v Dv Dv det/ T T . base constant DX. Then det DA P DA Iber X det P DA DA P ei eiSA ei k TrXX . . Now assume f is independent of and consider ei Tr DA D . To interpret this in terms of G requires four observations . But for the discontinuity at n. S Model this by a vector space V V V with a linear mapping T V V . g restricts to ker P to dene a decomposition of its C complexication ker P . and integrate to nd ei T v . thus gives f Z f AeiSA ei k TrXX det DA P DA det P DA DA P ei base .From ChernSimons to WZW where ker P denotes elements of ker P with the prescribed discontinuity at n. . regularize and account for negative eigenvalues using the etainvariant. f CS Z i f Xe k S k TrXXi S Tr X dX DX. For expectations of evaluationatapoint maps. at least formally. Dana S. and let WR denote the Wilson line corresponding to the longitudinal path indicated in Fig. The basic idea is to reinterpret X G as an element of PathG with some constraints on its endpoint values. but this is work in progress. an evaluation of the WZW path integral appearing on the righthand side of the above equation. this work is nearly complete. the WZW path integral is tractable. However. Fine Fig. then. The path whose holonomy is Xe Xe Absorbing everything independent of X into Z . An explicit reduction from ChernSimons to WZW Let R be a representation of G. As a description of the relation between ChernSimons theory on S and the WZW for G. . Then. . Then WR Z TrR Xe Xe e k i CS S k TrXXi Tr X dX DX TrR Xe Xe WZW . namely. the WZW . as claimed. as an evaluation of the ChernSimons path integral it lacks an essential component. At a formal level. . . Topological aspects of YangMills theory.From ChernSimons to WZW path integral becomes a path integral for quantum mechanics on G. Some remarks on the Gribov ambiguity. Phys. YangMills on a Riemann surface. King. B I. Atiyah and J. . Phys. Phys. M. Singer. Witten. Math. D. hor srie. Fine. expectations of evaluationatapoint maps are given by the FeynmanKac formula. Socit Mathmatique de France Astrisque. Phys. D. Frhlich and C. . to come up with an explicit evaluation of even unknot requires going beyond formal properties to a more detailed understanding of the heat kernel on G. M. Commun. D. Taming the conformal zoo. Commun. Acknowledgements This material is based upon work supported in part by the National Science Foundation under Grant DMS. Math. . . Math. . ee e e e E. Fine. M. Singer. However. Jones. Fine. I. S. Bibliography . F. preprint J. Moore and N. ChernSimons on S via path integrals. Families of Dirac operators with applications to physics. Math. Commun. G. Formal calculations lead to some promising preliminary observations such as complicated unknot unknot . YangMills on the twosphere. Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial. Commun. Seiberg. Phys. Phys. Phys. . . Commun. The ChernSimons theory and knot polyo nomials. Math. . D. Lett. Commun. Math. Fine . Dana S. It turns out in regularizing that the links need to be framed. which is GR with a cosmological constant. one should note that a number of very talented workers in the eld have searched in vain for a Hilbert space of states in either representation. the connections between general relativity in the loop formulation and the CSW TQFT are very suggestive. Notice. I do not say that it is a topological eld theory. If one attempts to use the loop variables to quantize subsystems of the universe. gives a state for the Ashtekar variable version of quantized general relativity. at least. Kansas State University. Formally. so it cannot be topological. unless one is prepared to consider states of zero volume. we can think of this measure on the space of connections on a manifold either as dening a theory in dimensions. USA email cranemath. using instead recombination diagrams in a very special tensor category. the CSW action term e ik TrAdA AAA . and one can trace them in .edu Abstract Motivated by the similarity between CSW theory and the Chern Simons state for general relativity in the Ashtekar variables. or as a state in a d theory. That is. Nevertheless. states for the Ashtekar or loop variable form of GR are very scarce. The construction avoids path integrals. Introduction What I wish to propose is that the quantum theory of gravity can be constructed from a topological eld theory. We end up with a construction of propagating states for parts of the universe and a Hilbert space corresponding to a certain approximation. Finally. we explore what a universe would look like if it were in a state corresponding to a d TQFT. Kansas . one ends up looking at functionals on the set of links in a manifold with boundary with ends on the boundary.Topological Field Theory as the Key to Quantum Gravity Louis Crane Mathematics Department. Manhattan.ksu. Furthermore. as mentioned previously in this volume. Physicists will be quick to point out that there are local excitations in gravity. I think it is fair to say that it leads to more beautiful mathematics than any other I know of. Topological quantum eld theory in dimensions . which seems important. Whether that is a good guide for physics. This idea is similar to the suggestion of Witten that the CSW theory is the topological phase of quantum gravity . Another point. During the talk I gave at the conference one questioner pointed out. Thus we do not have to worry about a continuum limit. called modular tensor categories. as a state for GR. As I shall explain below. This suggestion is closely related to the manyworlds interpretation of quantum mechanics the states on surfaces are data in one particular world. but rather due to the collapse of the wave packet in the presence of classical observers. and is leading into an extraordinarily rich mathematical eld. Let me emphasize that it is only a hypothesis. because the coecients attached to simplices are algebraically special. which takes the elegant form of the CSW invariant of links. Motivated by these considerations. we have the possibility of switching from the language of path integrals to a nite. of the Jones polynomial or one of its generalizations. and that the concrete geometry we see is not the result of a uctuation of the state of the universe as a whole. if we want to explore . I have been thinking for several years about an attempt to unite the structures of TQFT with a suitable reinterpretation of quantum mechanics for the entire universe. The coincidence of all this with the picture of d TQFT was the initial motivation for this work. . so they need to be labelled. In the spirit of the drunkard who looks for his keys near a street light. where physics is described by variables on the edges of a triangulation. Physics on a lattice is nothing new. the CSW path integral can be thought of as a symbolic shorthand for a d TQFT which can be rigorously dened by combining combinatorial topology with some very new algebraic structures. only time will tell. quite correctly. since a nite result is exact. My suggestion diers from his in assuming that the universe is still in the topological phase. since other states exist. that it is not necessary to make this conjecture. I propose to consider the hypothesis Conjecture The universe is in the CSW state. or more concretely. Louis Crane any representation of SU . . is that although path integrals in general do not exist. What is new here is that the choice of lattice is unimportant. the machinery of CSW theory provides spaces of states for parts of the universe. The state of the universe is the sum of all possible worlds. discrete picture. Thus. which I interpret as the relative states an observer might see. I believe that the two subjects resemble one another strongly enough that the program I am outlining becomes natural. except in the presence of an external clock. because there is no time. What I am proposing is that the initial conditions become part of the laws. which acts as a clock. A must see B see C see what A sees C see. The quantum theories of dierent parts of the universe are not. Although they do not assume the universe is in the CSW state. Thus. One can phrase this proposal as the suggestion that the wave function of the universe is the CSW functional. while the task of a physical theory is to explain measurements made in this universe in this state. these maps must be consistent. we allow labelled punctures on the boundaries between parts of the universe. so that the gravitational eld is treated as only part of a universe. What replaces a quantum eld theory is a family of quantum theories corresponding to parts of the universe.Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Quantum mechanics of the universe. have suggested that the initial conditions of the universe are determined by the laws. they couple the gravitational eld to a particular matter eld. which we think of as A observing B. we obtain a Hilbert space which is associated to the boundary between them. such as Penrose. It describes all possible universes. i. of course. and include embedded graphs in the parts of the universe we study. When we divide the universe into two parts. in the Ashtekar/loop variables the states of quantum gravity are invariants of embedded graphs. Since. it amounts to abandonment of observation at a distance.e. like quantum mechanics generally. and morphisms are d cobordisms. Naturally. Let us formalize this as follows Denition . Objects are places where observations take place.e. There can be no probability interpretation for the whole universe. Philosophically. An observer is an oriented manifold with boundary . this is similar to the idea of a wave function of the universe. The structure we arrive at has a natural categorical avor. Furthermore. independent. presupposes an external classical observer. the state of the universe cannot change. i. Quantum eld theory. boundaries. what is needed is a theory which describes a universe in a particular state. In fact. This is another departure from quantum eld theory. in manifolds with boundary. There is also a good deal here philosophically in common with the recent paper of Rovelli and Smolin . Since the universe as a whole is in a xed state. physics Categorical I want to propose that a quantum eld theory is the wrong structure to describe the entire universe. this requires that the universe be in a very special state. the quantum theory of the gravitational eld as a whole is not a physical theory. If A watches B watch C watch the rest of the universe. In a situation where one observer watches another there must be maps from the space of states which one observer sees to the other. This is similar to what some researchers. a family of classical observers with consistent mutual . Louis Crane containing an embedded labelled framed graph which intersects the boundary in isolated labelled points. Thus. and the invariant of any link cut by the surface can be expressed as the inner product of two vectors corresponding to the two half links.e. If M is a closed oriented manifold the category of observation in M is the relative i. Denition . but that because the universe is in a very special state. To every inspection of B by A there corresponds a dual inspection of A by B. reverse the orientation on A such that the labellings of the components of the graph which reach the boundary of match the labellings in A B. etc. If we examine the mathematical structure necessary to produce a state for the universe in this sense. John Baez has pointed out that these nitedimensional spaces really do possess natural inner products..e. A state for quantum gravity in M is a functor from the category of observation in M to the category of vector spaces. we can speak of observers. in that it factorizes when we cut the manifold along a surface with punctures. it can contain a classical world. it produces a state also in the sense we have dened above. Denition . The category of observation is the category whose objects are skins of observation and whose morphisms are inspections. of B by A is an observer whose boundary is identied with A B i. This denition requires that the set of labellings possess an involution corresponding to reversal of orientation on a surface. A skin of observation is a closed oriented surface with labelled punctures. If A and B are skins of observation an inspection. Denition . the CSW state produces a state in this new sense as well. given by reversing orientation and dualizing on . In fact.e. Another way to look at this proposal is as follows the CSW state for the Ashtekar variables is a very special state. Denition . Thus. i. We shall discuss this situation below as a key to a physical interpretation of our theory. Nowhere in any of this do we assume that these boundaries are connected. we nd that it is identical to a d TQFT. The labelling sets for the edges and vertices of the graph are nite. embedded version of the above. so that a nitedimensional Hilbert space is attached to each such surface. Denition . in M . and need to be chosen for all of what ensues. Of course. . the most important situation to study may be one in which the universe is crammed full of a gas of classical observers. I interpret this as saying that the state of the universe is unchanging. and no idea how to reintroduce time in the presence of observers. The objects in the richer cobordism category are surfaces with labelled punctures. and linear maps to cobordisms containing links or knotted graphs with labelled edges. There are several ways to construct TQFTs in various dimensions. The TQFTs which have appeared lately are richer than this. there is a great deal of coincidence in the pictures of CSW TQFT and the loop variables. once we learn to interpret vectors in the Hilbert spaces as clocks. and the morphisms are cobordisms containing labelled links with ends on the punctures. . then of tensor categories . so a closed manifold gets a numerical invariant. A more abstract way to phrase this is that a TQFT is a functor from the cobordism category to the category of vector spaces. we need the combination factors to satisfy some equations. The labels correspond to representations. we have a net of nitedimensional Hilbert spaces. The simplest denition of a d TQFT is that it is a machine which assigns a vector space to a surface. and a linear map to a cobordism between two surfaces. links with ends in manifolds with boundary can be interpreted as changing. So far. There are natural things to try for both of these problems in the mathematical context of TQFT. as we go through dierent classes of theories in dierent low dimensions we rst rediscover most of the interesting classes of associative algebras. multiply the factors together. We assign labels to edges in the triangulation. Since it is easy to extend the loop variables to allow traces in arbitrary representations characters. Before going into a program for solving these problems and thereby opening the possibility of computing the results of real experiments let us make a survey of the mathematical toolkit we inherit from TQFT. Let us here discuss the construction of a TQFT from a triangulation.Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity observations. The equations they need to satisfy are very algebraic in nature. The states on pieces of the universe i. We can describe this as a functor from a richer cobordism category to V ect. In order to obtain a topologically invariant theory. Ideas from TQFT As we have indicated. and some sort of factors combining the edge labels to dierent dimensional simplices in the triangulation. The empty surface receives a dimensional vector space. rather than one big one. the notion of a state of quantum gravity we dened above is equivalent to the notion of a d TQFT which is currently prevalent in the literature. Composition of cobordisms corresponds to composition of the linear maps. That constituted much of the initial motivation for this program. They assign vector spaces to surfaces with labelled punctures. and sum over labellings.e. As has been described elsewhere . Much of the rest of classical abstract algebra makes an appearance here too. The most interesting of these is the ElliotBiedenharn identity. . . a d TQFT can be constructed from a modular tensor category. then the TuraevViro formula becomes the PonzanoRegge formula for the evaluation of a spin network. The combinations we attach to tetrahedra simplices are the quantum j symbols. Move for d TQFT A simple example in two dimensions may explain why the equations for a topological theory have a fundamental algebraic avor. This identity is the consistency relation for the associativity isomorphism of the MTC. . For a d TQFT dened from a triangulation. but the weaker TQFT of Turaev and Viro . not the CSW theory. The interesting examples of MTCs can be realized as quotients of the categories of representations of quantum groups. Ponzano and Regge . The full CSW theory can also be reproduced from a modular tensor category by a slightly subtler construction which uses a Heegaard splitting which can be easily produced from a triangulation . If we use the representations of an ordinary Lie group instead of a quantum group. but with irreducible objects from a tensor category. Now. The suggestion that this sort of summation could be related to the quantum theory of gravity is older than one might think. The formula which Regge and Ponzano found for the evaluation of a graph is the analog for a Lie group of the state sum of Turaev and Viro for a quantum group. We refer to this sort of formula as a state summation. we need invariance under the move in Fig. not from a basis for an algebra. The quantum j symbols satisfy some identities. which imply that the summation formula for a manifold is independent under a change of the triangulation. were able to interpret the evaluation as a sort of discrete path integral for d Euclidean quantum gravity. This is another example of the marriage between algebra and topology which underlies TQFT. if we think of the coecients which we use to combine the labels around a triangle as the structure coecients of an algebra. this is exactly the associative law. If we try to use the modular tensor categories to construct a TQFT on a triangulation. which come from the associativity isomorphisms of the category. we obtain. d d d d d d Louis Crane d d d d d d E Fig. Here we label edges. These isomorphisms then satisfy higherorder consistency or coherence relations. out of a modular tensor category. The spirit of the relationship is like the relationship of a tensor category to an algebra. TQFTs in adjacent dimensions seem to be related algebraically. is the ladder of dimensions . The topological invariance of this formula follows from some elementary properties of representation theory. This construction begins with a triangulation of a manifold. The geometric interpretation consisted in thinking of the Casimirs of the representations as lengths of edges. is not yet completed. Representation theory implied that the summation was dominated by at geometries . if the program in succeeds. The ClebschGordan relations imply that only nitely many terms in . labelling the edges of all the internal lines with arbitrary spins. The program of also suggests that the solutions of these two topological problems are closely related. the evaluation of a tetrahedron for a spin network is a j symbol for the group SU dimq j labellings internal edges tetrahedra j. as a discretized path integral for d quantum GR. Ponzano and Regge then proceeded to interpret .Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Thus. The identities of an algebra correspond to isomorphisms in a tensor category. The program of construction in TQFT.. . and which I believe are crucial to the physical problem as well. Topological problem Construct a d TQFT related via the dimensional ladder to CSW theory. Another idea from TQFT. They are Topological problem Find a triangulation version of CSW theory not merely its absolute square as in . but is progressing rapidly. In . and picks a Heegaard splitting for the . which I hope will yield the tools for the quantization of general relativity. Another way to think of the program in this chapter is as an attempt to nd the appropriate algebraic structure for extending the spin network approach to quantum gravity from d to d. Tensor categories look just like algebras with the operation symbols in circles. The solution of these two problems will be in reach. both being constructed from state sums involving the same new algebraic tools. and then cut the interior up into tetrahedra. There are two outstanding problems. which are mathematically natural. we have placed our trivalent labelled graph on the boundary of a manifold with boundary. In this context we should also note that a d TQFT has been constructed in . which seems to have relevance for this physical program. which relate to topology up dimension. are nonzero. which I believe should give us a discretized version of a path integral for quantum gravity. The idea is that if we choose a triangulation for the manifold and a Heegaard splitting for the boundary of each simplex. not yet understood summation. Thus the theory in can be thought of as producing a d theory by lling the space with a network of d subspaces containing observers. of classical observers. and the existence of d cobordisms connecting pieces of the . in which the universe is full of a gas. since we are supposed to be obtaining our relative states from CSW theory on a boundary. Now. if we pass to a ner triangulation. we can then combine the vector spaces which we assign to the surfaces which cut the boundaries of those simplices lying on the boundary into a larger Hilbert space. which will prove to be relevant to quantizing general relativity. There is a natural proposal to make a physical interpretation within it in a dimensional setting. we should obtain a discrete version of F F theory. This combination seems very suggestive. It is this new. If we use the new summation in dimensions. In the scheme I am suggesting. we will obtain a larger space. This connection between TQFTs in dimensions and dimensions is the sort of thing I believe we will need to solve the problem of reintroducing time in a universe in a TQFT state. The linear map comes from the fact that we are using a d TQFT. These surfaces should be thought of as skins of observation for a family of observers who are crowding the spacetime. What I expect is that the program of will provide richer examples of such a connection. the algebraic structure we need to construct seems to be an expanded quantum version of the Lorentz group. In a dimensional boundary component. Also. which comes from the representation theory of the new structure which we call an F algebra in . although one could also try to use the state sum in together with TuraevViro theory. What we conjecture in is that a new algebraic structure will give us a new state summation. we can recover a Hilbert space in a certain sort of classical limit. Hilbert space is deadlong live Hilbert space or the observer gas approximation Let us assume that we have found a suitable state summation formula to solve our two topological problems so that what we suggest will be predicated on the success of the program in . with a linear map to the smaller one. then we obtain a family of surfaces which can be thought of as lling up the manifold. similar to the one we discussed above. which will give us CSW in dimensions. which is a quotient of their tensor product. Louis Crane boundary of each simplex of the triangulation. It is a quotient because the surfaces overlap. Now let us think of a manifold with boundary. while F F theory is a Lagrangian for the topological sector for the quantum theory of GR . The vectors are vectors in any of the spaces. they interpreted the summation we wrote down above as a discretized path integral for d quantum gravity. we can extend the linear map it assigns to a d cobordism to a map on the inverse limit spaces. What I am proposing is that the d state sum which I hope to construct from the representation theory of the F algebra can be interpreted as a discretized version of the path integral for general relativity. The geometric interpretation consisted in thinking of the Casimirs of representations as lengths. The eect of this suggestion is to reverse the relationship between the nitedimensional spaces of states which each observer can actually see and the global Hilbert space. Since the d state sum is assumed to be topologically invariant. This would mean that the theory was a quantum theory whose classical limit was general relativity. although that is not an argument for it. Should this program work One objection. The analogy with the work of Ponzano and Regge is the rst suggestion that this program might work. It was somewhat easier to get Einsteins equations in d . This produces a directed graph of vector spaces and linear maps associated to a manifold. there is a construction called the inverse limit which can combine them into a single vector space.Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity surfaces of the two sets of Heegaard splittings. is that the F F model may only be a sector of quantum . In . I propose that it is these inverse limit spaces which play the role of the physical Hilbert spaces of the theory. in the limit of an innitely dense gas. This relational approach bears some resemblance to the physical ideas of Leibniz. The d state sum can be extended to act on the vectors in these vector spaces by extending a triangulation for the boundary manifold to one for the manifold. The key question is whether the state sum is dominated in the limit of large spins on edges by assignments of spins whose geometric interpretation would give a discrete approximation to an Einstein manifold. Whenever we have a directed set of vector spaces and consistent linear maps. The thought here is that physical Hilbert space is the union of the nitedimensional spaces which a gas of observers can see. which was raised in the discussion. and a linear map when one triangulation is a renement of another. The problem of time The test of this proposal is whether it can reproduce Einsteins equations in some classical limit. We end up with a large vector space for each triangulation of the boundary manifold. with images under the maps identied. since the solutions are just at metrics. We are regarding the states which can be observed at one skin of observation as primary. .e. Louis Crane gravity in some weak sense. It can be replied that since the theory we are writing has the right symmetries. They also say that the sources for such a theory. Matter and symmetry It is natural to ask whether this picture could be expanded to include matter elds. in which Gambini and Pullin point out that the CSW state is also a state for GR coupled to electromagnetism. thought of as places where links have ends. If this does work.e. then we can investigate whether we recover Einsteins equation or not. It would be tting somehow to reconstruct truly fundamental theories of physics from fundamental mathematical expressions of symmetries. in the absence of the questioner. The F algebras arise as a result of pushing this process further. If the state sum suggested in can be dened. x states on surfaces in the dimensional boundaries of a d cobordism. In general. are necessarily fermionic. I do not think that either the objection or the reply is decisive in the abstract. who was thinking of general relativity. i. I am restating this objection somewhat. looking at representations of Dynkin diagrams as quivers. One could interpret these states as initial conditions for an experiment. one could do the state sum on a manifold with corners. The idea that theories in physics should be reconstructed from symmetries actually originated with Einstein. For example. as relatives of Lie groups in a quantum context. the action of the renormalization group should x the Lagrangian. i. and investigate the results by studying the propagation via the d state sum. These constructions can also be done from extremely simple starting points. It may be noted that Peldan has observed that the CSW state also satises the YangMills equation. the constructions which lead up to the F algebras in can be thought of as expressions of quantum symmetry. If we really get a picture of gravity from the state sum associated to SU . These results seem to strengthen further the program set forth here. As I was writing this I became aware of . recategorifying the categories into categories. the modular tensor categories can be described as deformed ClebschGordan coecients. The obvious thing to try is to pass from SU to a larger group. One could conjecture that this would give a spacetime picture for the evolution of relative states within the framework of the CSW state of the universe. it would not be a great leap to try a larger gauge group. P. G. L. . . . Smolin. and J. World Scientic. . Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial. and quantum gravity. K. . Phys. ed. . Moore and N. . Commun. Thesis. in Proceedings of the XXth International Conference on Dierential Geometric Methods in Theoretical Physics. . . G. Crane and I. . personal communication. link invariants and quantum geometry. Commun. in Quantum Theory and Beyond. . Phys. eds S. L. . Bloch. On Wittens manifold invariants. Ponzano and T. . Regge. in Spectroscopic and Group Theoretical Methods in Physics. B . Math. Peldan. Math. . ed. D . R. Phys. F. unpublished. . Nucl. Classical and quantum conformal eld theory. Crane. Smolin. . Crane. Rocha. . Pullin. Penrose. . The author is supported by NSF grant DMS. Catto and A. T. personal communication. Cambridge University Press. . d physics and d topology. Frenkel. spin geometry. RR. B . Quantum symmetry. J. Rev. . L. What is an observable in classical and quantum gravity Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Oxford University . R. Louis Kauman has provided many crucial insights. C. Nucl. Jones polynomials for inu tersecting knots as physical states for quantum gravity. Bibliography . Math. an approach to combinatorial space time. Loop representation for quantum general relativity. . Conformal eld theory. Semiclassical limits of Racah coecients. Seiberg. Singapore. . Lett.Topological Field Theory and Quantum Gravity Acknowledgements The author wishes to thank Lee Smolin and Carlo Rovelli for many years of conversation on this extremely elusive topic. The mathematical ideas here are largely the result of collaborations with David Yetter and Igor Frenkel. B. Phys. Ashtekars variables for arbitrary gauge group. L. Crane. Commun. Quantum Models of Space Time Based on Recoupling Theory. Gambini. Phys. . . . Bastin. L. Moncrief. Phys. Moussouris. . C. Walker. Rovelli. New York. B . V. . . Witten. Angular momentum. Phys. Hopf categories and their representations. Br gmann. E. . Wiley. Rovelli and L. to appear in Proceedings of AMS conference. L. Viro. . A categorical construction of d TQFTs. N. . A representation theoretic approach to dimensional topological quantum eld theory. . to appear in Proceedings of AMS conference. Rovelli and L. Braided monoidal categories. . Kapranov and V. Topology . The physical hamiltonian in nonperturbative quantum gravity. State sum invariants of manifolds and quantum j symbols. V. Mt Holyoke. Voevodsky. preprint. Lett. Smolin. Quantum EinsteinMaxwell elds a unied viewpoint from the loop representation. preprint. . Soo. preprint. L. Rovelli and L. Louis Crane to appear. Pullin. June . C. BRST cohomology and invariants of D gravity in Ashtekar variables. Rev. . Crane and D. Crane and I. . Turaev and O. . Smolin. M. vector spaces and Zamolodchikovs tetrahedra equation. Gambini and J. L. . preprint. . . Ohio. October . Massachusetts. C. Chang and C. . Phys. Frenkel. Yetter. R. Knot theory and quantum gravity. Dayton. We review progress towards making this duality rigorous in three examples d Yang Mills theory which. In fact. in a classical gauge theory. Baez Department of Mathematics. while an excitation of the gauge eld alone can be thought of as a looped ux tube. a Wilson loop is simply the trace of the holonomy of A around a loop in space. California . Two quarks in a meson. A heuristic pathintegral approach indicates a duality between backgroundfree string theories and generally covariant gauge theories. If A denotes the vector potential.edu Abstract The loop representation of quantum gravity has many formal resemblances to a backgroundfree string theory. but here we provide an exact stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory on R S for nite N . typically written in terms . Unfortunately this theory had a number of undesirable features. can be thought of as connected by a stringlike ux tube in which the gauge eld is concentrated. d quantum gravity. with the loop transform relating the two. However. while in dimensions there may be relationships to the theory of tangles. has symmetry under all areapreserving transformations. and Gauge Fields John C. Knots. it predicted massless spin particles. University of California.Strings. which models the strong force by an SU YangMills eld. or connection. Loops. while not generally covariant. USA email jbaezucrmath. and d quantum gravity. its origins lie in attempts to treat the string theory of hadrons as an approximation to QCD. but it can be formalized using the notion of Wilson loops. SU N YangMills theory in dimensions has been given a stringtheoretic interpretation in the largeN limit. The stringtheoretic interpretation of quantum gravity in dimensions gives rise to conjectures about integrals on the moduli space of at connections. String theory rst arose as a model of hadron interactions. in particular. in which the strings represent ux tubes of the gauge eld. Introduction The notion of a deep relationship between string theories and gauge theories is far from new. This is essentially a modern reincarnation of Faradays notion of eld lines. string models continued to be popular as an approximation of the conning phase of QCD.ucr. for example. It was soon supplanted by quantum chromodynamics QCD. Riverside. and. In the late s. applying this operator to the vacuum state one obtains a state in which the YangMills analog of the electric eld ows around the loop . Baez Tr P e A . . More recently. On the other hand. However. recent work by Witten and Periwal suggests that ChernSimons theory in dimensions is also equivalent to a string theory. After Ashtekar formulated quantum gravity as a sort of gauge theory using the new variables. Polyakov. In particular. have been able to reformulate Yang Mills theory in dimensional spacetime as a string theory by writing an asymptotic series for the vacuum expectation values of Wilson loops as a sum over maps from surfaces the string worldsheet to spacetime. and others . thanks to its common origin. Typically one begins with a xed background structure and writes down a string eld theory in terms of this. If instead A denotes the vector potential in a quantized gauge theory. it is a strong candidate for a theory unifying gravity with the other forces. Rovelli and Smolin were able to use the loop representation to study quantum gravity nonperturbatively in a manifestly backgroundfree formalism. it uses the device of Wilson loops to construct a space of states consisting of multiloop invariants. while classical general relativity is an elegant geometrical theory relying on no background structure for its formulation. String theory eventually became popular as a theory of everything because the massless spin particles it predicted could be interpreted as the gravitons one obtains by quantizing the spacetime metric perturbatively about a xed background metric. of a pathordered exponential John C. D. The clarity of a manifestly backgroundfree approach to string theory would be highly desirable. While supercially quite dierent from modern string theory. this approach to quantum gravity has many points of similarity. only afterwards can one investigate its background independence . attempts to formulate YangMills theory in terms of Wilson loops eventually led to a fulledged loop representation of gauge theories. attempted to derive equations of string dynamics as an approximation to the YangMills equation. and others. it has proved dicult to describe string theory along these lines. For example. Nambu. . Gross and others . Makeenko and Migdal. . at least heuristically. . This development raises the hope that other gauge theories might also be isomorphic to string theories. using Wilson loops. Since string theory appears to avoid the renormalization problems in perturbative quantum gravity. which assign an amplitude to any collection of loops in space. thanks to the work of Gambini and Trias . the Wilson loop may be reinterpreted as an operator on the Hilbert space of states. but we nd it to be little extra eort. we begin by describing a general framework relating gauge theories and string theories. We review recent work by Ashtekar. have already given dimensional SU N YangMills theory a stringtheoretic interpretation in the largeN limit. . the group of all areapreserving transformations. we consider quantum gravity in dimensions. In Section we describe how the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory is related to a backgroundfree closed string eld theory. but it has an innitedimensional subgroup of the dieomorphism group as symmetries. In Section we consider quantum gravity in dimensions. thinking of them simply as maps from a surface into spacetime. to ask whether the loop representation of quantum gravity might be a string theory in disguiseor vice versa. These examples have nitedimensional reduced conguration spaces. therefore. . In fact. Taylor. at least in canonical quantization. We also note how a stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory leads naturally to the study of tangles. We take a very naive approach to strings. to give the theory a precise stringtheoretic interpretation for nite N . We base our treatment on the path integral formalism. Loops. which is easier to make rigorous. Rather. and rather enlightening. We also briey discuss ChernSimons theory in dimensions. . and disregarding any conformal structure or elds propagating on the surface. We review the loop representation of this theory and raise some questions about integrals over the moduli space of at connections on a Riemann surface whose resolution would be desirable for developing a stringtheoretic picture of the theory. In Section we consider YangMills theory in dimensions as an example. and Gauge Fields The resemblance of these states to wavefunctions of a string eld theory is striking. Our treatment of examples is also meant to serve as a review of YangMills theory in dimensions and quantum gravity in and dimensions. and the author . and then consider a variety of examples. Rather than the path integral approach we use canonical quantization. Knots. so there are no analytical diculties with measures on innitedimensional spaces. In Section . this theory is not generally covariant. on dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on A/G and their relation to multiloop invariants and knot theory. and others . Our treatment is mostly a review of their work. The present paper does not attempt a denitive answer to this question. however. Here the classical conguration space is innite dimensional and issues of analysis become more important. Isham.Strings. . It is natural. and in order to simplify the presentation we make a number of overoptimistic assumptions concerning measures on innitedimensional spaces such as the space A/G of connections modulo gauge transformations. . Gross. Lewandowski. e. X. to be specied. Here nS denotes the disjoint union of n copies of S . We assume that FunM and the measure D are invariant both under dieomorphisms of space and reparametrizations of the strings. Baez String eld/gauge eld duality In this section we sketch a relationship between string eld theories and gauge theories. by measure in this section we will always mean a positive regular Borel measure. etc. and we write Maps to denote the set of maps satisfying some regularity conditions continuity. We discuss these analytical issues more carefully in Section . and we wish FunM and D to be preserved by these actions. That is. in the sense that some of our assumptions are not likely to hold precisely as stated in the most interesting examples. We assume for convenience that this really is an inner product. which is just the L inner product . We take the classical conguration space of the string theory to be the space M of multiloops in X M with Mn MapsnS . we do not expect Hkin to be the true space of physical states. on spacetime. both the identity component of the dieomorphism group of X and the orientationpreserving dieomorphisms of nS act on M. kin n Mn M D. with X a manifold we call space. but in fact one should work with a more general version of this concept. it is nondegenerate. etc. We emphasize that while our discussion here is rigorous. We do not assume a canonical identication of M with RX. In particular. Taking a . John C. The physical state space thus depends on the dynamics of the theory. it is schematic. Let D denote a measure on M and let FunM denote some space of squareintegrable functions on M. i. or any other background structure metric. In the space of physical states. Consider a theory of strings propagating on a spacetime M that is dieomorphic to R X. From this we derive a Hamiltonian description. Introduce on FunM the kinematical inner product. We begin with a nonperturbative Lagrangian description of backgroundfree closed string eld theories. which turns out to be mathematically isomorphic to the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory. smoothness. Following ideas from canonical quantum gravity. Dene the kinematical state space Hkin to be the Hilbert space completion of FunM in the norm associated to this inner product. any two states diering by a dieomorphism of spacetime are identied. Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields Lagrangian approach, dynamics may be described in terms of path integrals as follows. Fix a time t gt . Let P denote the set of histories, that is maps f , t X, where is a compact oriented manifold with boundary, such that f , t X f . Given , M, we say that f P is a history from to if f , t X and the boundary of is a disjoint union of circles nS mS , with f nS , f mS . We x a measure, or path integral, on P, . Following tradition, we write this as eiSf Df , with Sf denoting the action of f , but eiSf and Df only appear in the combination eiSf Df . Since we are interested in generally covariant theories, this path integral is assumed to have some invariance properties, which we note below as they are needed. Using the standard recipe in topological quantum eld theory, we dene the physical inner product on Hkin by , phys M M P, eiSf Df DD assuming optimistically that this integral is well dened. We do not actually assume this is an inner product in the standard sense, for while we assume , for all Hkin , we do not assume positive deniteness. The general covariance of the theory should imply that this inner product is independent of the choice of time t gt , so we assume this as well. Dene the space of normzero states I Hkin by I , , phys phys for all Hkin and dene the physical state space Hphys to be the Hilbert space completion of Hkin /I in the norm associated to the physical inner product. In general I is nonempty, because if g Di X is a dieomorphism in the connected component of the identity, we can nd a path of dieomorphisms gt Di M with g g and gt equal to the identity, and dening g Di, t X by gt, x t, gt x, we have , phys M M P, eiSf Df DD gg eiSf Df DD M M P, MM John C. Baez g gg eiSf Dgf DgD P, M M P, g eiSf Df DD g, phys for any , . Here we are assuming g eiSf Dgf eiSf Df, which is one of the expected invariance properties of the path integral. It follows that I includes the space J, the closure of the span of all vectors of the form g. We can therefore dene the spatially dieomorphisminvariant state space Hdif f by Hdif f Hkin /J and obtain Hphys as a Hilbert space completion of Hdif f /K, where K is the image of I in Hdif f . To summarize, we obtain the physical state space from the kinematical state space by taking two quotients Hdif f Hdif f /K Hphys . As usual in canonical quantum gravity and topological quantum eld theory, there is no Hamiltonian instead, all the information about dynamics is contained in the physical inner product. The reason, of course, is that the path integral, which in traditional quantum eld theory described time evolution, now describes the physical inner product. The quotient map Hdif f Hphys , or equivalently its kernel K, plays the role of a Hamiltonian constraint. The quotient map Hkin Hdif f , or equivalently its kernel J, plays the role of the dieomorphism constraint, which is independent of the dynamics. Strictly speaking, we should call K the dynamical constraint, as we shall see that it expresses constraints on the initial data other than those usually called the Hamiltonian constraint, such as the Mandelstam constraints arising in gauge theory. It is common in canonical quantum gravity to proceed in a slightly dierent manner than we have done here, using subspaces at certain points where we use quotient spaces , . For example, Hdif f may be dened as the subspace of Hkin consisting of states invariant under the action of Di X, and Hphys then dened as the kernel of certain operators, the Hamiltonian constraints. The method of working solely with quotient spaces has, however, been studied by Ashtekar . The choice between these dierent approaches will in the end be dictated by the desire for convenience and/or rigor. As a heuristic guiding principle, however, it is worth noting that the subspace and quotient space approaches are essentially equivalent if we assume that the subspace I is closed in the norm topology on Hkin . Relative to the kinematical inner Hkin Hkin /J Hdif f Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields d H d d d d a d b c d d EE Fig. . Twostring interaction in dimensional space product, we can identify Hdif f with the orthogonal complement J , and similarly identify Hphys with I . From this point of view we have Hphys Hdif f Hkin . Moreover, Hdif f if and only if is invariant under the action of Di X on Hkin . To see this, rst note that if g for all g Di X, then for all Hkin we have , g g , so J . Conversely, if J , , g so , , g , and since g acts unitarily on Hkin the CauchySchwarz inequality implies g . The approach using subspaces is the one with the clearest connection to knot theory. An element Hkin is a function on the space of multiloops. If is invariant under the action of Di X, we call a multiloop invariant. In particular, denes an ambient isotopy invariant of links in X when we restrict it to links which are nothing but multiloops that happen to be embeddings. We see therefore that in this situation the physical states dene link invariants. As a suggestive example, take X S , and take as the Hamiltonian constraint an operator H on Hdif f that has the property described in Fig. . Here a, b, c C are arbitrary. This Hamiltonian constraint represents the simplest sort of dieomorphisminvariant twostring interaction in dimensional space. Dening the physical space Hphys to be the kernel of H, it follows that any Hphys gives a link invariant that is just a multiple of the HOMFLY invariant . For appropriate values of the parameters a, b, c, we expect this sort of Hamiltonian constraint to occur in a generally covariant gauge theory on dimensional spacetime known as BF theory, with gauge group SU N . A similar construction working with unoriented framed multiloops gives rise to the Kauman polynomial, which is associated with BF theory with gauge group SON . We see here in its barest form the path from stringtheoretic considerations to link invariants and then to gauge theory. In what follows, we start from the other end, and consider a generally covariant gauge theory on M . Thus we x a Lie group G and a principal Gbundle P M . Fixing an identication M R X, the classical conguration space is the space A of connections on P X . The physical John C. Baez Hilbert space of the quantum theory, it should be emphasized, is supposed to be independent of this identication M R X. Given a loop S X and a connection A A, let T , A be the corresponding Wilson loop, that is the trace of the holonomy of A around in a xed nitedimensional representation of G T , A Tr P e A . The group G of gauge transformations acts on A. Fix a Ginvariant measure DA on A and let FunA/G denote a space of gaugeinvariant functions on A containing the algebra of functions generated by Wilson loops. We may alternatively think of FunA/G as a space of functions on A/G and DA as a measure on A/G. Assume that DA is invariant under the action of Di M on A/G, and dene the kinematical state space Hkin to be the Hilbert space completion of FunA/G in the norm associated to the kinematical inner product , kin A/G AA DA. The relation of this kinematical state space and that described above for a string eld theory is given by the loop transform. Given any multiloop , . . . , n Mn , dene the loop transform of FunA/G by , . . . , n A/G AT , A T n , A DA. Take FunM to be the space of functions in the range of the loop transform. Let us assume, purely for simplicity of exposition, that the loop transform is onetoone. Then we may identify Hkin with FunM just as in the string eld theory case. The process of passing from the kinematical state space to the dieomorphisminvariant state space and then the physical state space has already been treated for a number of generally covariant gauge theories, most notably quantum gravity , , . In order to emphasize the resemblance to the string eld case, we will use a path integral approach. Fix a time t gt . Given A, A A, let PA, A denote the space of connections on P ,tX which restrict to A on X and to A on t X. We assume the existence of a measure on PA, A which we write as eiSa Da, using a to denote a connection on P ,tX . Again, this generalized measure has some invariance properties corresponding to the general covariance of the gauge theory. Dene the physical inner product on Hkin by , phys A A PA,A AA eiSa DaDADA Knots. quantum gravity in dimensions. . In the following sections we will consider some examples YangMills theory in dimensions. The Lagrangian for a gauge theory. Letting Hdif f Hkin /J. Loops. A/G M C A. . with . or as a wave function on the classical conguration space M for strings. At this point it is natural to ask what the dierence is. In summary. The loop transform depends on the nonlinear duality between connections and loops. apart from words. . between the loop representation of a generally covariant gauge theory and the sort of purely topological string eld theory we have been considering. Hdif f . with the loop transform relating the gauge theory picture to the string theory picture. with A being the amplitude of a specied connection A. and quantum gravity in dimensions. for all . . . As before. In no case is a string eld action Sf known that corresponds to the gauge theory in question However. and letting K be the image of I in Hdif f . is quite a dierent object than that of a string eld theory. This is. .Strings. n T A. n S X to be present. is that a state in Hkin can be regarded either as a wave function on the classical conguration space A for gauge elds. n being the amplitude of a specied ntuple of strings . a promising alternative to dealing with measures on the . . on the other hand. we can use the general covariance of the theory to show that I contains the closed span J of all vectors of the form g. Note that nothing we have done allows the direct construction of a string eld Lagrangian from a gauge eld Lagrangian or vice versa. the physical state space Hphys of the gauge theory is Hkin /I. in fact. . From the Hamiltonian viewpoint that is. we see that the Hilbert spaces for generally covariant string theories and generally covariant gauge theories have a similar form. The key point. and Gauge Fields again assuming that this integral is well dened and that . we again see that the physical state space is obtained by applying rst the dieomorphism constraint Hkin Hkin /J Hdif f and then the Hamiltonian constraint Hdif f Hdif f /K Hphys . in terms of the spaces Hkin . n which is why we speak of string eld/gauge eld duality rather than an isomorphism between string elds and gauge elds. . again. in d YangMills theory a working substitute for the string eld path integral is known a discrete sum over certain equivalence classes of maps f M . T A. Letting I Hkin denote the space of normzero states. and Hphys the dierence is not so great. . This inner product should be independent of the choice of time t gt . . . . that is ambient isotopy classes of embeddings f . so it can be regarded as a function on the space of connections on M modulo gauge transformations. as well as Driver . then. and the YangMills action is given by SA TrF F M where F is the curvature of A and Tr is the trace in a xed faithful unitary representation of G and hence its Lie algebra g. The Riemannian case of d YangMills theory has been extensively investigated. An equation for the vacuum expectation values of Wilson loops for the theory on Euclidean R was found by Migdal . We x a connected compact Lie group G and a principal Gbundle P M . Baez space P of string histories. the YangMills equation dA F . rather than a Hamiltonian constraint. t X. The group DiM acts on this space. YangMills theory in dimensions We begin with an example in which most of the details have been worked out. Gross. where dA is the exterior covariant derivative. M It follows that the action SA is invariant under the subgroup of dieomorphisms preserving the volume form . and these expectation values were explicitly calculated by Kazakov . but in which dieomorphism invariance is replaced by invariance under this subgroup. this theory has an honest Hamiltonian. Still. Strictly speaking. King and Sengupta . John C. Extremizing this action we obtain the classical equations of motion. So upon quantization one expects toand doesobtain something analogous to a topological quantum eld theory. In particular. These calculations were made rigorous using stochastic dierential equation techniques by L. but the action is not dieomorphism invariant. it illustrates some interesting aspects of gauge eld/string eld duality. if M is dimensional one may write F f where is the volume form on M and f is a section of P Ad g. However. In dimensional quantum gravity. YangMills theory is not a generally covariant theory since it relies for its formulation on a xed Riemannian or Lorentzian metric on the spacetime manifold M . such an approach might involve a sum over tangles. Classically the gauge elds in question are connections A on P . The classical YangMills equations on Riemann surfaces were extensively investigated . and then SA Trf . many of the results of the previous section do not apply. The action SA is gauge invariant. v TrE v. Here. The classical phase space of the theory is the cotangent bundle T A. Witten has shown that the quantization of d YangMills theory gives a mathematical structure very close to that of a topological quantum eld theory. the Gauss law dA E . using the nondegenerate inner product E. Note that a tangent vector v TA A may be identied with a gvalued form on S . where t R. so we x a trivialization and identify a connection on P with a gvalued form on R S . and let E be its covariant time derivative pulled back to S . E satisfying this constraint are the initial data for some solution of the YangMills equation. Similar results were also obtained by Blau and Thompson . owing to the gauge invariance of the equation. and in physics A is called the vector potential and E the electric eld. This approach is an alternative to the path integral approach of the previous section. x S . ZM for each compact oriented manifold M with boundary having total area M . This will simultaneously serve as a brief introduction to the idea of quantizing gauge theories after symplectic reduction. however. E of gvalued forms on S . Given a connection on P solving the YangMills equation we obtain a point A. Loops. as done by Rajeev . the loop group G C S . S We thus regard the phase space T A as the space of pairs A. Moreover. and in some cases is easier to make rigorous. Knots. and Witten . G acts as gauge transformations on A. this solution is not unique. E. We may also think of a gvalued form E on S as a cotangent vector. Fine . In particular. it will be a bit simpler to discuss YangMills theory on R S with the Lorentzian metric dt dx . and the quantum theory on Riemann surfaces has been studied by Rusakov . The pair A. E of the phase space T A as follows let A be the pullback of the connection to S . and a vector ZM. This may be identied with the space of gvalued forms on S . The classical conguration space of the theory is the space A of connections on P S . The YangMills equation implies a constraint on A. Any Gbundle P R S is trivial. which will also be important in d quantum gravity. with a Hilbert space ZS S associated to each compact manifold S S . and this action lifts . and any pair A. and Gauge Fields by Atiyah and Bott .Strings. However. E is called the initial data for the solution. the quotient of the constraint subspace by G is again a symplectic manifold. However. writing E edx. Two points in the phase space T A are to be regarded as physically equivalent if they dier by a gauge transformation. so A/G G/AdG. which acts on the almost reduced conguration space G by conjugation. gives a function on phase space that generates a Hamiltonian ow coinciding with a parameter group of gauge transformations. The quotient of the constraint subspace by G . In this sort of situation it is natural to try to construct a smaller. the Gauss law says that e C S . integrated against any f C S . one can see this quite concretely. by basic results on moduli spaces of at connections. . is identied with T G/AdG. and hence determined by its value at the basepoint of S . Baez naturally to an action on T A. g is a at section. G/AdG. which is just G/AdG. gEg . It follows that any point A. Consequently. Alternatively. all parameter subgroups of G are generated by the constraint in this fashion. We may rst take the quotient of A by only those gauge transformations that equal the identity at a given point of S G g C S . the constraint dA E. E dA E T A is not. the almost reduced phase space. The phase space T A is a symplectic manifold. Next. In the case at hand there is a very concrete description of the reduced phase space. the reduced phase space. Trf dA S E. more physically relevant reduced phase space using the process of symplectic reduction. is thus identied with T G. given by g A. the reduced phase space. John C. g as follows. but the constraint subspace A. E gAg gdg . with an explicit dieomorphism taking each equivalence class A to its holonomy around the circle A P e S A . The remaining gauge transformations form the group G/G G. the reduced conguration space A/G may be naturally identied with Hom S . E in the constraint subspace is determined by A A together with e g. In fact. It follows that the quotient of the constraint subspace by all of G. G g . First. This almost reduced conguration space A/G is dieomorphic to G itself. e. Since the YangMills Hamiltonian on the almost reduced phase space T G is that of a classical free particle on G. In fact. However.Strings. the Hamiltonian of the quantum theory is diagonalized by this basis. we take the quantum Hamiltonian to be that for a quantum free particle on G H / where is the nonnegative Laplacian on G. carry out only part of the process of symplectic reduction. This measure has the advantage of mathematical elegance. What should be the Hilbert space for the quantized theory on R S As described in the previous section. i. p p The advantage of the almost reduced conguration space and phase space is that they are manifolds. note that this measure gives a Hilbert space isomorphism L A/G L Ginv where the right side denotes the subspace of L G consisting of functions constant on each conjugacy class of G. and obtain a Hamiltonian function on the almost reduced phase space. Let denote the character of an equivalence class of irreducible representations of G. and Gauge Fields E. Loops. This is just the Hamiltonian for a free particle on G. we prefer simply to show ex post facto that it gives an interesting quantum theory consistent with other approaches to d YangMills theory. Since the theory is not generally covariant. Observables of the classical theory can be identied either with functions on the reduced phase space. E Hg. however. For example. We will choose the pushforward of normalized Haar measure on G by the quotient map G G/AdG. Now let us consider quantizing dimensional YangMills theory. Knots. E but by the process of symplectic reduction one obtains a corresponding Hamiltonian on the reduced phase space. or functions on the almost reduced phase space T G that are constant on the orbits of the lift of the adjoint action of G. for any p Tg G it is given by HA. Then by the Schur orthogonality relations. To begin with. the set forms an orthonormal basis of L Ginv . it is natural to take L of the reduced conguration space A/G. the kinematical Hilbert space is the physical Hilbert space. When we decompose the . the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints do not enter. While one could also argue for it on physical grounds. One can. to dene L A/G requires choosing a measure on A/G G/AdG. the YangMills Hamiltonian is initially a function on T A with the obvious inner product on Tg G. . For convenience. . In the string eld picture of Section . nk T n T nk . Note that the vacuum the eigenvector of H with lowest eigenvalue is the function . . we obtain a theory in which all physical states have . . we may quantize them by interpreting them as multiplication operators acting on L Ginv T n g Trg n g. because all connections on S are at. To take a step in this direction. so H c . . we dene to be the vacuum state. . In the case at hand these Wilson loop observables depend only on the homotopy class of the loop. let us consider the Wilson loop observables. John C. We may think of T T . We will see this again in d quantum gravity. n when i is homotopic to i for all i. . n . In a sense this diagonalization of the Hamiltonian completes the solution of YangMills theory on R S . we have T n . We can also form elements of L Ginv by applying products of these operators to the vacuum. The states n . respectively. . g Trg n . . and we prefer to think of it as such. . . . However. Since the classical Wilson loop observables are functions on conguration space. and to make the connection to string theory. Letting n S S be an arbitrary loop of winding number n. . nk . but it lifts to a function on the almost reduced conguration space G. . The idea of describing the YangMills Hamiltonian in terms of these string states goes back at least to Jevickis work on lattice gauge the . . A is dened by T . with winding numbers n . as a function on the reduced conguration space A/G. . . where c is the quadratic Casimir of G in the representation . the function lies in the sum of copies of the representation . Recall that given a based loop S S . nk may also be regarded as states of a string theory in which k strings are present. Baez regular representation of G into irreducibles. Let n . extracting the physics from this solution requires computing expectation values of physically interesting observables. . A TrPe A . the classical Wilson loop T . . which is for the trivial representation. . . They are never linearly independent. . . . . However. In what follows we will use many ideas from these authors. More recently. . Taylor. All these authors. because the Wilson loops satisfy relations. . . work primarily with the largeN limit of the theory. . For the rest of this section we set G SU N and take traces in the fundamental representation. . In fact.Strings. Note that this implies that n. . . . although they do in some interesting cases. Knots. so the total number of strings present in a given state is ambiguous. . for example. there is no analog of the Fock space number operator on L Ginv . . which we shall briey review. the T n are analogous to creation operators. and others . Then MN . instead of working in the largeN limit. . One always has T Tr. In other words. Douglas. Polychronakos. let Mk . The resemblance of the string states n . on d YangMills theory as a string theory. nk to states in a bosonic Fock space should be clear. the Mandelstam identity is T n T m T nm T nm . N for all loops i . but give a stringtheoretic formula for the SU N YangMills Hamiltonian that is exact for arbitrary N . for since the work of t Hooft it has been clear that SU N YangMills theory simplies as N . however. . . the string states do not necessarily span L Ginv . and all the linear dependencies between string states are consequences of the following Mandelstam identities . . we do not generally have a representation of the canonical commutation relations. Minahan. The importance of this theory for dimensional physics was stressed by . and Gauge Fields ory. Loops. These formulae are based on the classical theory of Young diagrams. There are also explicit formulae expressing the string states in terms of the basis of characters. k k sgnT gj gjn T gjk gjknk Sk where has the cycle structure j jn jk jknk . and MN . . and for any particular group G the Wilson loops will satisfy identities called Mandelstam identities. m n m n m . In particular. In this case the string states do span L Ginv . for G SU and taking traces in the fundamental representation. . . k in S . for all loops . Given loops . For example. . . string states appear prominently in the work of Gross. . . when is the conjugacy class of permutations with cycle lengths n . Young diagrams describe a duality between the representation theory of SU N and of the symmetric groups Sn which can be viewed as a mathematical reection of string eld/gauge eld duality. nk with all the ni positive but k possibly equal to zero span L SU N inv . . Young diagrams with n boxes are in correspon . . and following the strands around counterclockwise to x . To take advantage of this correspondence. . where n n nk . since the labelling was arbitrary. . In a Young diagram one draws a conjugacy class with cycles of length n nk gt as a diagram with k rows of boxes. we form an irreducible representation of SU N . Suppose we have lengthminimizing strings in S with winding numbers n . . We will write for the character of the representation . which we also call . . in which the string state n . one copy for each box. . The rationale for this description of string states as conjugacy classes of permutations is in fact quite simple. if has gt N rows . . Thus we will restrict our attention for now to states of this kind. and then antisymmetrizing over all copies in each column and symmetrizing over all copies in each row. there is a map from Young diagrams to equivalence classes of irreducible representations of SU N . which we call righthanded. nk corresponds to the conjugacy class of all permutations with cycles of length n . . nk . Note that consists of permutations in Sn . nk . the string state really only denes a conjugacy class of elements of Sn . First. . However. . . . for a total of n n nk labels. note using the Mandelstam identities that the string states n . we obtain a permutation of the labels. and plays a primary role in Gross and Taylors work on d YangMills theory . John C. As we shall see. Baez Nomura . Let Y denote the set of Young diagrams. There is a correspondence between righthanded string states and conjugacy classes of permutations in symmetric groups. If has N rows it is equivalent to a representation coming from a Young diagram having lt N rows. . by taking a tensor product of n copies of the fundamental representation. . We will assume without loss of generality that n nk gt . Labelling each strand of string each time it crosses the point x . nk . See Fig. . Given Y . we simply dene n . . On the other hand. . . nk . . On the one hand. and hence an element of Sn . . and if has gt N rows it is zero dimensional. . having ni boxes in the ith row. This gives a correspondence between Young diagrams with lt N rows and irreducible representations of SU N . . recall that eqn . Y . Knots. . First. Given Y . and Gauge Fields Fig. . Loops. Sn The YangMills Hamiltonian has a fairly simple description in terms of the basis of characters . where n is the number of boxes in . This allows us to write the Frobenius relations expressing the string states in terms of characters and vice versa. . Then the Frobenius relations are and conversely n . We dene the function on Sn to be zero for n n. we write for the corresponding repre sentation of Sn .Strings. . It follows that H N H N H H . Young diagram dence with irreducible representations of Sn . There is an explicit formula for the value of the SU N Casimir in the representation c N n N n nn dim where denotes the conjugacy class of permutations in Sn with one cycle of length and the rest of length . expresses the Hamiltonian in terms of the Casimir. As noted above. To express the operators H and H in stringtheoretic terms. from these denitions and express the basis X in terms of the string states X n . Sn It follows that the string states form a basis for H. for suciently large N . X Y n where is the number of elements in regarded as a conjugacy class in Sn .. Y X . but orthogonal . Baez H n and H nn . Then a calculation using the Schur orthogonality equations twice shows that these string states are not only linearly independent. For each Y . This quotient map sends the string state in H to the corresponding . dim . with the only densely dened quotient map j H L SU N inv being given by X . Let H be a Hilbert space having an orthonormal basis X Y indexed by all Young diagrams. in fact orthogonal. One can also derive the Frobenius relation . simply dening a space in which all the string states are independent. where John C. We will proceed slightly dierently. . there is no natural way to do this in L SU N inv since the string states are not linearly independent. The YangMills Hilbert space L SU N inv is essentially a quotient space of the string eld Hilbert space H. The advantage of taking the N limit is that any nite set of distinct string states becomes linearly independent. it is convenient to dene string annihilation and creation operators satisfying the canonical commutation relations. dene a vector in H by the Frobenius relation . . . Knots. Here in fact we will show that the Hamiltonian on the YangMills Hilbert space L SU N inv lifts to a Hamiltonian on H with a simple interpretation in terms of string interactions. . In the framework of the previous section. dim This clearly has the property that Hj jH. k We could eliminate the factor of j and obtain the usual canonical commutation relations by a simple rescaling. so that dimensional SU N YangMills theory is isomorphic to a quotient of a string theory by the Mandelstam identities. j k aj . On H we can introduce creation operators a j gt by j a n .Strings. It follows that this quotient map is precisely that which identies any two string states that are related by the Mandelstam identities. we dene a Hamiltonian H on the string eld Hilbert space H by H where H X nX . . . . H X N H N H H nn X . so the YangMills dynamics is the quotient of the string eld dynamics.. . n . nk j. We then claim that H a aj j jgt and H j. but it is more convenient not to. and Gauge Fields string state L SU N inv .kgt a aj ak a a ajk . a jjk . . a . . Loops. the Mandelstam identities would appear as part of the dynamical constraint K of the string theory.. j k jk These follow from calculations which we briey sketch here. It was noted some time ago by Gliozzi and Virasoro that Mandelstam identities on string states are strong evidence for a gauge eld interpretation of a string eld theory. ak a . The Frobenius relations and the denition of H give H n . j and dene the annihilation operator aj to be the adjoint of a . . Following eqns . These j satisfy the following commutation relations aj . nk . . An analysis of the eect of composing with all possible shows that either one cycle of will be broken into two cycles. however. Here.. Similarly. By eqn . H can be regarded as a string tension term. we have switched to treating states as functions on the space of multiloops. since if we represent a string state n . . H dim Y Since there are nn / permutations Sn lying in the conjugacy class . Figure can also be regarded as two frames of a movie of a string worldsheet in dimensional spacetime. We may interpret the Hamiltonian in terms of strings as follows. . Similar movies have been used by Carter and Saito to describe string worldsheets in dimensional spacetime . it is an eigenvector of H with eigenvalue equal to n nk . giving the expression above for H in terms of annihilation and creation operators. the Frobenius relations and the denition j of H give nn . Twostring interaction in dimensional space and this implies the formula for H as a sum of harmonic oscillator Hamiltonians a aj . . . we may rewrite this as H Since Y. or two will be joined to form one.. this kind of interaction is a dimensional version of that which gave the HOMFLY invariant of links in dimensional space in the previous section. H corresponds to a twostring interaction as in Fig. Baez H d d E E Fig. Also. John C. dim dim the Frobenius relations give H . the other has been introduced only to keep track of the identities of the strings. nk by lengthminimizing loops. . . In this gure only the x coordinate is to be taken seriously. As the gure indicates. we have a true Hamiltonian rather than a Hamiltonian constraint. proportional to the sum of the lengths of the loops. . By eqn . where the gauge group is SO. Knots. applicable to the dimensional case. so that it converges to H as N . since the gauge group is then noncompact . When considering the /N expansion of the theory. it is convenient to divide the Hamiltonian H by N . Loops. since this seems not to have been done yet. so there are no local degrees of freedom. and Gauge Fields . The theory is therefore only interesting on topologically nontrivial spacetimes. This does not describe any new states in the YangMills theory per se. .Strings. . nk with ni lt . . Rovelli. Since then. Samuel and Smolin . We will follow Ashtekar. Quantum gravity in dimensions Now let us turn to a more sophisticated model. It follows from the work of Minahan and Polychronakos that there is a Hamiltonian H on H H naturally described in terms of string interactions and a densely dened quotient map j H H L SU N inv such that Hj jH. but for simplicity of presentation we will sidestep them by working with the Riemannian case. From the work of Gross and Taylor it is also clear that in addition to the space H spanned by righthanded string states one should also consider a space with a basis of lefthanded string states n . and treat dimensional quantum gravity using the new variables and the loop transform. It is easiest to describe the various action principles for gravity using the abstract index notation popular in general relativity. many approaches to the subject have been developed. and indicate some possible relations to string theory. Interest in the mathematics of this theory increased when Witten reformulated it as a ChernSimons theory. Then the H term is proportional to /N . string worldsheets of genus g give terms proportional to /N g . . The total Hilbert space of the string theory is then the tensor product H H of righthanded and lefthanded state spaces. in the next section . Husain. dimensional quantum gravity. Indeed. It is important to note that there are some technical problems with the loop transform in Lorentzian quantum gravity. but it is more natural from the stringtheoretic point of view. If we draw the string worldsheet corresponding to this movie we obtain a surface with a branch point. They also show that the H term corresponds to string worldsheets with handles. Einsteins equations say simply that the spacetime metric is at. This is in accord with the observation by t Hooft that in an expansion of the free energy logarithm of the partition function as a power series in /N . associated to those histories with branch points. not all equivalent . In this section we describe the Witten action. in the path integral approach of Gross and Taylor this kind of term appears in the partition function as part of a sum over string histories. In dimensions. These are presently being addressed by Ashtekar and Loll in the dimensional case. but we will instead translate them into language that may be more familiar to mathematicians. Note that we can pull back the metric on E by e T M T to obtain a Riemannian metric on M . which we call SO connections on X. and that the metric on M is at. M The classical equations of motion obtained by extremizing this action are F and dA e . The basic elds of the theory are then taken to be a metricpreserving connection A on T . and we only present the nal results. or SO connection. Using the isomorphism T T given by the metric. which applies to dimensions. X . Baez we describe the Palatini action. the curvature F of A may be identied with a T valued form. is only nondegenerate when e is an isomorphism. a number of subtleties. we obtain the Witten action SA. however. Note that a tangent vector v TA A is a T valued form on X. These dene a volume form on T . Fix a real vector bundle T over M that is isomorphic tobut not canonically identied withthe tangent bundle T M . where X is a compact oriented manifold. the equations of motion say simply that this connection is the LeviCivita connection of the metric on M . The relationship between these action principles has been discussed rather thoroughly by Peldan . together with a T valued form e on M . that is a nowherevanishing section of T . It follows that the wedge product e F may be dened as a T valued form. and x a Riemannian metric and an orientation on T . John C. In this case. There are. which. Now suppose that M R X. We can thus regard a T valued form E on X as a cotangent vector by means of the pairing Ev E v. The formalism involving the elds A and e can thus be regarded as a device for extending the usual Einstein equations in dimensions to the case of degenerate metrics on M . The classical conguration and phase spaces and their reduction by gauge transformations are reminiscent of those for d YangMills theory. When e is an isomorphism we can also use it to pull back the connection to a metricpreserving connection on T M . e e F . The classical phase space is then the cotangent bundle T A. The classical conguration space can be taken as the space A of metricpreserving connections on T X. which applies to any dimension. Pairing this with to obtain an ordinary form and then integrating over spacetime. however. and the Ashtekar action. Let the spacetime M be an orientable manifold. . and Gauge Fields Thus given any solution A. vi SO. The two isomorphism classes of SO bundles on M are distinguished by their second StiefelWhitney number w Z . Loops. xg . The bundle T X is trivial so w T X We can calculate w for any point ui . where E plays a role analogous to the electric eld in YangMills theory. which in this context is dA E . e of the classical equations of motion. ug . . so we wish to describe this component. and the vanishing of the curvature B of the connection A on T X. taking the physical state space of the quantized theory to be L of the reduced conguration space. and a point in F is an equivalence class ui .Strings. v . yi x y x y xg yg x yg . g An element of Hom X. A quite concrete description of A /G was given by Goldman . There is a natural identication F Hom X. Knots. The latter constraint subsumes both the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints of the theory. that is a point in the phase space T A. SO may thus be identied with a collection u . which is analogous to the magnetic eld B . choose lifts ui . For all the elements ui . SO/AdSO. vi . given by associating to any at bundle the holonomies around homotopy classes of loops. if we can nd a tractable description of A /G. corresponding to the two isomorphism classes of SO bundles on M . vi . Then the group X has a presentation with g generators x . satisfying Rui . y . . vi F by the following method. The classical equations of motion imply constraints on A. yg satisfying the relation Rxi . we can pull back A and e to the surface X and get an SO connection and a T valued form on X. where A is the space of at SO connections on X. . This is usually written A. . As in d YangMills theory. The moduli space F of at SObundles has two connected components. vg of elements of SO. E. . E T A which dene a reduced phase space. it will be attractive to quantize after imposing constraints. . . vi of such collections. The reduced phase space for the theory turns out to be T A /G. The component corresponding to the bundle T X is precisely the space A /G. Suppose that X has genus g. and G is the group of gauge transformations . These are the Gauss law. but to dene this one must choose a measure on A /G. u It follows that we may think of points of A /G as equivalence classes of gtuples ui . k T T k . . The rst step towards a stringtheoretic interpretation of d quantum gravity would be a formula for an inner product of string states . It would be satisfying if there were a stringtheoretic interpretation of the inner product in L A /G along the lines of Section . vi . and shown to be dimension d g for g . . so given . vi . we can form elements of L A /G by applying products of these operators to the function . the Liouville measure. . . which is just a particular kind of integral over A /G. . In fact A /G is not a manifold. k X. dene . The dfold wedge product denes a measure on A /G. . but a singular variety. Alternatively. In fact. by introducing a coupling . . or d for g the case g is trivial and will be excluded below. Then w Ri . there is a symplectic structure on A /G coming from the following form on A B. k . u where the equivalence relation is given by the adjoint action of SO. Note that we may dene string states in this space as follows. John C. This has been investigated by Narasimhan and Seshadri . As in the case of d Yang Mills theory. . Given any loop in X. C with EndT Xvalued forms. . for any N . On the grounds of elegance and dieomorphism invariance it is customary to use this measure to dene the physical state space L A /G. . one could formulate d quantum gravity as a theory of SU connections and then generalize to SU N . Note that this sort of integral makes sense when A /G is the moduli space of at connections for a trivial SON bundle over X. k . it is natural to take L A /G to be the physical state space. . As noted. . vi of elements of SO admitting lifts ui . . As noted by Goldman . in which we identify the tangent vectors B. vi with Ri . . Baez to the universal cover SO SU . . it appears that this sort of integral can be computed using d YangMills theory on a Riemann surface. . the Wilson loop observable T is a multiplication operator on L A /G that only depends on the homotopy class of . C X TrB C. Strings. in terms of a sum over surfaces having that link as boundary . . Here one xes an arbitrary Lie group G and a Gbundle P M over spacetime. with the Goldman symplectic structure. and Gauge Fields constant in the action SA M TrF F . k as a sum over ambient isotopy classes of surfaces f . and the eld of the theory is a connection A on P . In fact. . . t X having the loops i . k . One thus expects that this sort of integral simplies in the N limit just as it does in d YangMills theory. but . Witten has given such an interpretation using open strings and the BatalinVilkovisky formalism . Nonetheless. as one would expect. . computing the appropriate vacuum expectation value of Wilson loops. and then taking the limit . As noted by Witten . . . rst demonstrated by Witten . This theory does not quite t our formalism because in it the space A /G of at connections modulo gauge transformations plays the role of a phase space. The action is given by SA k Tr A dA A A A . Before concluding this section. This procedure has been discussed by Blau and Thompson and Witten . for example. . It would be very worth while to reformulate ChernSimons theory as a string theory at the level of elegance with which one can do so for d YangMills theory. . it is worth noting another generally covariant gauge theory in dimensions. the Euclidean group in dimension. Taylor and the author are currently trying to work out the details of this program. Moreover. ChernSimons theory. This. together with a method of treating the nite N case by imposing Mandelstam identities. in terms of integrals over moduli spaces of Riemann surfaces. d quantum gravity as we have described it is essentially the same ChernSimons theory with gauge group ISO. Loops. Knots. . i as boundaries. giving a formula for . an expression for the vacuum expectation value of Wilson loops. there are a number of clues that ChernSimons theory admits a reformulation as a generally covariant string eld theory. in the N limit. at least for the case of a link where it is just the Kauman bracket invariant. for the gauge groups SU N Periwal has expressed the partition function for ChernSimons theory on S . In the case N there is also. There is a profound connection between ChernSimons theory and knot theory. rather than a conguration space. with the SO connection and triad eld appearing as two parts of an ISO connection. and then elaborated by many researchers see. would give a stringtheoretic interpretation of d quantum gravity. In dimensions the Palatini action can be rewritten in a somewhat similar form. As in the previous section. Then the classical equations of motion derived from the Palatini action say precisely that this connection is the LeviCivita connection of the metric. John C. the wedge product e e F is a T valued form. we will sidestep certain problems with the loop transform by working with Riemannian rather than Lorentzian gravity. or SOn connection. We shall then discuss some recent work on making the loop representation rigorous in this case. which. and x a Riemannian metric and orientation on T . The metric denes an isomorphism T T and allows us to identify the curvature F of A with a section of the bundle T T M. is expressed in terms of e rather than e . the Palatini action reduces to the Witten action. We may also regard e as a section of T T M and dene e e in the obvious manner as a section of the bundle T T M. however. however. e e e F .e. that e T M T be a bundle isomorphism. Namely. and a T valued form e. Fix a bundle T over M that is isomorphic to T M . The basic elds of the theory are then taken to be a metricpreserving connection A on T . M The Ashtekar action depends upon the fact that in dimensions the . and indicate some mathematical issues that need to be explored to arrive at a stringtheoretic interpretation of the theory. and that the metric satises the vacuum Einstein equations i. In dimensions. Baez Quantum gravity in dimensions We begin by describing the Palatini and Ashtekar actions for general relativity. The natural pairing between these bundles gives rise to a function F e e on M . this has not yet been done. Using the isomorphism e. The Palatini action for Riemannian gravity is then SA. is Ricci at. and pairing it with to obtain an ordinary form we have SA. M We may use the isomorphism e to transfer the metric and connection A to a metric and connection on the tangent bundle. We require. its inverse is called a frame eld. we can push forward to a volume form on M . e F e e . These dene a nowherevanishing section of n T . Let the spacetime M be an orientable nmanifold. that is. a section of so T X T X. e M e e F . Then F is just an sovalued form on M . We can take the classical conguration space to be space A of righthanded connections on T X. Similarly. as is automatically the case when M R X. or equivalently xing a trivialization of T . A tangent vector v TA A is thus an so valued form. and its decomposition into selfdual and antiselfdual parts corresponds to the decomposition so soso. Loops. The gravitational vector potential A is simply the pullback of A to the surface X. This allows us to write F as a sum F F of selfdual and antiselfdual parts F F . E consisting on X. The remarkable fact is that the action SA. This allows us to regard general relativity as the theory of a selfdual connection A and a T valued form ethe socalled new variableswith the Ashtekar action SA . suppose T is trivial. and an sovalued form E denes a cotangent vector by the pairing Ev TrE v. Moreover. Knots. and Gauge Fields metric and orientation on T dene a Hodge star operator T T with not to be confused with the Hodge star operator on dierential forms. A solution A . X A point in the classical phase space T A is thus a pair A. It is easy to see that F is the curvature of A . A is an sovalued form. Obtaining E from e is . E T A as follows. In the of an sovalued form A and an sovalued form E physics literature it is more common to use the natural isomorphism T X T X T X given by the interior product to regard the gravitational electric eld E as an sovalued vector density.Strings. which are forms having values in the two copies of so. where X is a compact oriented manifold. e M e e F gives the same equations of motion as the Palatini action. and may thus be written as a sum A A of selfdual and antiselfdual connections. e of the classical equations of motion determines a point A. sovalued forms on X. Now suppose that M R X. The dieomorphism constraint generates the action of Di X on A/G. we may also regard this as an sovalued form on X. so one forms the reduced phase space T A/G. or curvature of the connection A. the map e T M T gives a map e T X T X. the dieomorphism constraint is given by Tr iE B and the Hamiltonian constraint is given by Tr iE iE B . so in the quantum theory one takes Hdif f to be the subspace of Di Xinvariant elements of FunM. so a more sophisticated strategy. and dene the image of their common kernel in Hdif f to be the physical state space Hphys . E T A. These are the Gauss law dA E . called a cotriad eld on X. or attempt to represent the Hamiltonian constraint directly as operators . By restricting to T X and then projecting down to T X. Baez a somewhat subtler aair. rst devised by Rovelli and Smolin . Quantizing. Letting B denote the gravitational magnetic eld. one obtains the kinematical Hilbert space Hkin L A/G. First. In d quantum gravity this is no longer the case. Let us rst sketch this without mentioning the formidable technical problems. split the bundle T as the direct sum of a dimensional bundle T and a line bundle. One may then either attempt to represent the Hamiltonian constraint as operators on Hkin . One then applies the loop transform and takes Hkin FunM to be a space of functions of multiloops in X. The latter two are most easily expressed if we treat E as an sovalued vector density. similarly. is required. Since there is a natural isomorphism of the bers of T with so. Applying the Hodge star operator we obtain the sovalued form E. and the dieomorphism and Hamiltonian constraints. In d YangMills theory and d quantum gravity one can impose enough constraints before quantizing to obtain a nitedimensional reduced conguration space. The Gauss law constraint generates gauge transformations. The classical equations of motion imply constraints on A. iE iE B is an M R T X T Xvalued function. namely the space A /G of at connections modulo gauge transformations. John C. Here the interior product iE B is dened using matrix multiplication and is an M R T Xvalued form. b in the algebra and C. Then A/I has an honest inner product and we let H denote the Hilbert space completion of A/I in the corresponding norm. In particular. be degenerate a. More recently. There are. Knots. observables are represented by selfadjoint elements of A. the full space Hphys has not yet been determined. it is possible to go a certain distance without becoming involved with these considerations. The latter approach is still under development by Rovelli and Smolin . In fact. one does not really expect to have interesting dieomorphisminvariant measures on the space A/G of connections modulo gauge transformations in this case. It is then easy to check that I is a left .Strings. a a . the loop transform can be rigorously dened without xing a measure or generalized measure on A/G if one uses. Even at this formal level. In the Calgebraic approach to physics. however. b a b. a a . b . for all a. In particular. a state on A denes an inner product that may. signicant problems with turning all of this work into rigorous mathematics. and normalized. Rovelli and Smolin obtained a large set of physical states corresponding to ambient isotopy classes of links in X. It is this work that suggests a profound connection between knot theory and quantum gravity. while states are elements of the dual A that are positive. so at this point we shall return to where we left o in Section and discuss some of the diculties. not the Hilbert space formalism of the previous section. a a a ab b a . Let I A denote the subspace of normzero states. In their original work. but a Calgebraic formalism. ab a a b a b . physical states have been constructed from familiar link invariants such as the Kauman bracket and certain coecients of the Alexander polynomial to all of M. and Gauge Fields on Hdif f and dene the kernel to be Hphys . Some recent developments along these lines have been reviewed by Pullin . The number a then represents the expectation value of the observable a in the state . Namely. This approach makes use of the connection between d quantum gravity with cosmological constant and ChernSimons theory in dimensions. to indicate the basic ideas without becoming immersed in technicalities. Loops. A Calgebra is an algebra A over the complex numbers with a norm and an adjoint or operation satisfying a a. one expects the existence of generalized measures sucient for integrating a limited class of functions. . The relation to the more traditional Hilbert space approach to quantum physics is given by the Gelfand NaimarkSegal GNS construction. At best. In Section we were quite naive concerning many details of analysisdeliberately so. however. the loop transform is onetoone. Some progress in solving these problems has recently been made by Ashtekar. and let P X be a principal Gbundle over X. . the pointwise complex conjugate T equals T . Baez ideal of A. and the author . . It turns out to be more natural to dene the loop transform not on FunA/G but on its dual. observables in A give rise to selfadjoint operators on H.and dimensional quantum gravity. Given FunA/G we dene its loop transform to be the function on the space M of multiloops given by . . While in what follows we will assume that G is compact and is unitary. A Calgebraic approach to the loop transform and generalized measures on A/G was introduced by Ashtekar and Isham in the context of SU gauge theory. The basic concept is that of the holonomy Calgebra. which we denote as FunA/G in order to make clear the relation to the previous section. n T T n . John C. such as G SU N and the fundamental representation. so that A acts by left multiplication on A/I. as this involves no arbitrary choices. and that this action extends uniquely to a representation of A as bounded linear operators on H. In particular. . so FunA/G FunM. the functions T are bounded and continuous in the C topology on A/G. the holonomy Calgebra. . it is important to emphasize that for Lorentzian quantum gravity G is not compact This presents important problems in the loop representation of both . and G the group of smooth gauge transformations. where is the orientationreversed loop. In favorable cases. space. and subsequently developed by Ashtekar. Lewandowski. . on A/G taking traces in this representation. Dene the holonomy algebra to be the algebra of functions on A/G generated by the functions T T . We may thus complete the holonomy algebra in the sup norm topology f sup f A AA/G and obtain a Calgebra of bounded continuous functions on A/G. . Fix a nitedimensional representation of G and dene Wilson loop functions T T . Recall that in the previous section the loop transform of functions on A/G was dened using a measure on A/G. Lewandowski. Moreover. and Loll . Let FunM denote the range of the loop transform. This is the real justication for the term string eld/gauge eld duality. . Let A denote the space of smooth connections on P . If we assume that G is compact and is unitary. . Let X be a manifold. but there is as yet no manifestly welldened expression along these lines. using a slightly dierent formalism. who also constructed many more examples of Di Xinvariant states on FunA/G. g kin f g then generalizes the L inner product used in the previous section. the most progress has been made in the realanalytic case. an inner product for relative states of quantum gravity in the Kauman bracket state has been rigorously constructed by the author . We conclude with some speculative remarks concerning d quantum gravity and tangles. there is a unique inner product on FunM such that this map extends to a map from Hkin to the Hilbert space completion of FunM. Di X to consist of the realanalytic dieomorphisms connected to the identity. If is a state on FunA/G. thinking of the pairing f as the integral of f FunA/G. and Gauge Fields We may take the generalized measures on A/G to be simply elements FunA/G . Knots. in general For technical reasons. Note that the kinematical inner product f . A path integral formula for the inner product has been investigated recently by Rovelli . . we may construct the kinematical Hilbert space Hkin using the GNS construction. The kinematical Hilbert space constructed from a Di Xinvariant state FunA/G thus becomes a unitary representation of Di X. n T T n f in a manner generalizing that of the previous section. . They have also given a general characterization of such dieomorphisminvariant states. Loops. Here Ashtekar and Lewandowski have constructed a Di Xinvariant state on FunA/G that is closely analogous to the Haar measure on a compact group . it is not immediately obvious that any exist. In fact. and FunA/G to be the holonomy Calgebra generated by realanalytic loops. That is. Note that a choice of generalized measure also allows us to dene the loop transform as a linear map from FunA/G to FunM f . .Strings. On the other hand. we take X to be real analytic. It is thus of considerable interest to nd a more concrete description of Di Xinvariant states on the holonomy Calgebra FunA/G. There is thus some real hope that the loop representation of generally covariant gauge theories can be made rigorous in cases other than the toy models of the previous two sections. The example of d YangMills theory would suggest an expression for the . Note also that Di X acts on FunA/G and dually on FunA/G . but there are still many questions about the physics here. . The latter was also given by the author . The correct inner product on the physical Hilbert space of d quantum gravity has long been quite elusive. Moreover. These equations can be understood in terms of category theory. Maurizio Martellini. and Lee Smolin for useful discussions. . Scott Axelrod. I would like to thank the Center for Gravitational Physics and Geometry as a whole for inviting me to speak on this subject. Jacob Hirbawi. Also. Clearly it will be some time before we are able to appraise the signicance of all this work. D . . Holger Nielsen. n as a sum over ambient isotopy classes of surfaces f . New variables for classical and quantum gravity. A. string theory. Bibliography . For example. i as boundaries. just as the Reidemeister moves relate any two pictures of the same tangle in dimensions. since just as tangles form a braided tensor category. Rev. . such surfaces are known as tangles. Jerzy Lewandowski. since braided tensor categories can be constructed from certain conformal eld theories. t X having the loops i . Renate Loll. and the depth of the relationship between string theory and the loop representation of quantum gravity. . Ashtekar. It is thus quite signicant that Crane has initiated an approach to generally covariant eld theory in dimensions using braided tensor categories. . Acknowledgements I would like to thank Abhay Ashtekar. . Baez . tangles form a braided tensor category . rst derived in the context of string theory . Phys. This approach also claries some of the signicance of conformal eld theory for dimensional physics. Phys. the analog of the YangBaxter equation is the Zamolodchikov equation. n . and the loop representation of d quantum gravity are tantalizing but still rather obscure. Matthias Blau. For example. CottaRamusino and Martellini have endeavored to construct tangle invariants from generally covariant gauge theories. inner product of string states John C. In a related development. These moves give a set of equations whose solutions would give tangle invariants. and have been intensively investigated by Carter and Saito using the technique of movies. Paolo CottaRamusino. much as tangle invariants may be constructed using ChernSimons theory. In the case of embeddings. . Louis Crane. Wati Taylor deserves special thanks for explaining his work on YangMills theory to me. there are a set of movie moves relating any two movies of the same tangle in dimensions. The relationships between tangles. . . Lett. Jorge Pullin. Rev. New Hamiltonian formulation of general relativity. Scott Carter. . Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields .. . .. .... . ... . Lectures on Nonperturbative Canonical Quantum Gravity, Singapore, World Scientic, . A. Ashtekar, unpublished notes, June . A. Ashtekar and C. J. Isham, Representations of the holonomy algebra of gravity and nonabelian gauge theories, Classical amp Quantum Gravity , . A. Ashtekar and J. Lewandowski, Completeness of Wilson loop functionals on the moduli space of SL, C and SU , connections, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . Representation theory of analytic holonomy CAlgebras, this volume. A. Ashtekar and R. Loll, New loop representations for gravity, Syracuse U. preprint. A. Ashtekar, V. Husain, C. Rovelli, J. Samuel, and L. Smolin, gravity as a toy model for the theory, Classical amp Quantum Gravity LL. M. Atiyah, The Geometry and Physics of Knots, Cambridge U. Press, Cambridge, . M. Atiyah and R. Bott, The YangMills equations over Riemann surfaces, Phil. Trans. R. Soc. A . J. Baez, Quantum gravity and the algebra of tangles, Classical amp Quantum Gravity . J. Baez, Dieomorphisminvariant generalized measures on the space of connections modulo gauge transformations, to appear in the proceedings of the Conference on Quantum Topology, eds L. Crane and D. Yetter, hepth/. Link invariants, functional integration, and holonomy algebras, U. C. Riverside preprint, hepth/. M. Blau and G. Thompson, Topological gauge theories of antisymmetric tensor elds, Ann. Phys. . Quantum YangMills theory on arbitrary surfaces, Int. J. Mod. Phys. A . S. Carlip, Six ways to quantize dimensional gravity, U. C. Davis preprint, grqc/. J. S. Carter, How Surfaces Intersect in Space an Introduction to Topology, World Scientic, Singapore, . J. S. Carter and M. Saito, Reidemeister moves for surface isotopies and their interpretation as moves to movies, U. of South Alabama preprint. Knotted surfaces, braid movies, and beyond, this volume. P. CottaRamusino and M. Martellini, BF theories and knots, this John C. Baez volume. L. Crane, Topological eld theory as the key to quantum gravity, this volume. M. Douglas, Conformal eld theory techniques for large N group theory, Rutgers U. preprint, hepth/. B. Driver, YM continuum expectations, lattice convergence, and lassos, Commun. Math. Phys. . D. Fine, Quantum YangMills on a Riemann surface, Commun. Math. Phys. . J. Fischer, categories and knots, Yale U. preprint, Feb. . P. Freyd, D. Yetter, J. Hoste, W. Lickorish, K. Millett, and A. Ocneanu, A new polynomial invariant for links, Bull. Am. Math. Soc. . R. Gambini and A. Trias, Gauge dynamics in the Crepresentation, Nucl. Phys. B . J. Gervais and A. Neveu, The quantum dual string wave functional in YangMills theories, Phys. Lett. B , . F. Gliozzi and M. Virasoro, The interaction among dual strings as a manifestation of the gauge group, Nucl. Phys. B . W. Goldman, The symplectic nature of fundamental groups of surfaces, Adv. Math. . Invariant functions on Lie groups and Hamiltonian ows of surface group representations, Invent. Math. . Topological components of spaces of representations, Invent. Math. . D. Gross, Two dimensional QCD as a string theory, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Dec. , hepth/. D. Gross and W. Taylor IV, Two dimensional QCD is a string theory, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Jan. , hepth/. Twists and Wilson loops in the string theory of two dimensional QCD, U. C. Berkeley preprint, Jan. , hepth/. L. Gross, C. King, and A. Sengupta, Twodimensional YangMills theory via stochastic dierential equations, Ann. Phys. . G. Horowitz, Exactly soluble dieomorphisminvariant theories, Commun. Math. Phys. . A. Jevicki, Loopspace representation and the largeN behavior of the oneplaquette KogutSusskind Hamiltonian, Phys. Rev. D . L. Kauman, Knots and Physics, World Scientic, Singapore, . ...... ... . .. . .. . Strings, Loops, Knots, and Gauge Fields . . . . .. . . ... ... . V. Kazakov, Wilson loop average for an arbitrary contour in twodimensional U N gauge theory, Nuc. Phys. B . R. Loll, J. Mouro, and J. Tavares, Complexication of gauge thea ories, Syracuse U. preprint, hepth/. Y. Makeenko and A. Migdal, Quantum chromodynamics as dynamics of loops, Nucl. Phys. B . Loop dynamics asymptotic freedom and quark connement, Sov. J. Nucl. Phys. . D. Marolf, Loop representations for gravity on a torus, Syracuse U. preprint, March , grqc/. An illustration of gravity loop transform troubles, Syracuse U. preprint, May , grqc/. A. Migdal, Recursion equations in gauge eld theories, Sov. Phys. JETP . J. Minahan, Summing over inequivalent maps in the string theory interpretation of two dimensional QCD, U. of Virginia preprint, hepth/ J. Minahan and A. Polychronakos, Equivalence of two dimensional QCD and the c matrix model, U. of Virginia preprint, hepth/. S. Naculich, H. Riggs, and H. Schnitzer, Twodimensional Yang Mills theories are string theories, Brandeis U. preprint, hepth/. Y. Nambu, QCD and the string model, Phys. Lett. B . M. Narasimhan and C. Seshadri, Stable and unitary vector bundles on a compact Riemann surface, Ann. Math. . M. Nomura, A soluble nonlinear Bose eld as a dynamical manifestation of symmetric group characters and Young diagrams, Phys. Lett. A . P. Peldan, Actions for gravity, with generalizations a review, U. of Gteborg preprint, May , grqc/. o V. Periwal, ChernSimons theory as topological closed string, Institute for Advanced Studies preprint. A. Polyakov, Gauge elds as rings of glue, Nucl. Phys. B . Gauge elds and strings, Harwood Academic Publishers, New York, . J. Pullin, Knot theory and quantum gravity in loop space a primer, to appear in Proc. of the Vth Mexican School of Particles and Fields, ed J. L. Lucio, World Scientic, Singapore preprint available as John C. Baez hepth/. S. Rajeev, YangMills theory on a cylinder, Phys. Lett. B . C. Rovelli, The basis of the PonzanoReggeTuraevViroOoguri model is the loop representation basis, Pittsburgh U. preprint, April , hepth/. C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, Loop representation for quantum general relativity, Nucl. Phys. B . C. Rovelli and L. Smolin, The physical hamiltonian in nonperturbative quantum gravity, Pennsylania State U. preprint, August , grqc/. B. Rusakov, Loop averages and partition functions in U N gauge theory on twodimensional manifolds, Mod. Phys. Lett. A . G. t Hooft, A twodimensional model for mesons, Nucl. Phys. B . E. Witten, dimensional gravity as an exactly soluble system, Nucl. Phys. B . E. Witten, Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial, Commun. Math. Phys. , . E. Witten, On quantum gauge theories in two dimensions, Commun. Math. Phys. . Localization in gauge theories, Lectures at MIT, February . E. Witten, ChernSimons gauge theory as a string theory, to appear in the Floer Memorial Volume, Institute for Advanced Studies preprint, . A. Zamolodchikov, Tetrahedron equations and the relativistic SMatrix of straightstrings in dimensions, Commun. Math. Phys. . B. Zwiebach, Closed string eld theory an introduction, MIT preprint, May , hepth/. .. .. . .... . . . Universit di Milano a and INFN. only the general BRST structure has been thoroughly discussed. Introduction In a seminal work. at least in the nonAbelian . Italy email martellinimilano. Sezione di Pavia. unfortunately. Via Celoria . The question. Functional integrationbyparts techniques allow the recovery of an innitesimal version of the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation. One of the questions that is possible to ask is whether there exists an analog of Wittens ideas in higher dimensions.it Maurizio Martellini Dipartimento di Fisica. Sezione di Milano. perturbative calculations. is not easy to answer.infn. Via Celoria . The socalled BF theories allow the construction of quantum operators whose trace can be considered as the higherdimensional generalization of Wilson lines for knots in dimensions.BF Theories and knots Paolo CottaRamusino Dipartimento di Fisica. and it is possible to establish a heuristic relation between BF theories and Alexander invariants. On one hand. in the form considered by Carter and Saito. the theory of higherdimensional knots and links is much less developed. Witten has shown that there is a very deep connection between invariants of knots and links in a manifold and the quantum ChernSimons eld theory. Firstorder perturbative calculations lead to higherdimensional linking numbers. Universit di Trento a and INFN. Milano. .it Abstract We discuss the relations between topological quantum eld theories in dimensions and the theory of knots embedded spheres in a manifold. After all. Italy email cottamilano. for the time being. Milano. the relevant invariants are. and topological quantum eld theories exist in dimensions . knots and links are dened in any dimension as embeddings of kspheres into a k dimensional space. As far as dimensional topological eld theories are concerned. more scarce than in the theory of ordinary knots and links.infn. Chern action exp . . Looking for possible topological actions for a dimensional manifold. is a given represen . These observables can be seen as a generalization of ordinary Wilson lines in dimensions. Finally. . and a principal bundle P M. The group G. No analogous help is available for dimensional topological eld theories. consistent with the proposal made by Carter. In this case. do not appear to have been carried out. Saito. BF action exp M M Tr F F . in dimensions it is also possible to apply functional integrationbyparts techniques. Even the quantum observables have not been clearly dened in the nonAbelian case. these techniques produce a solution of an innitesimal Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation. It is also possible to nd heuristic arguments that may relate the expectation values of our observables in the BF theory with the Alexander invariants of knots. with Lie algebra LieG. and Lawrence. will be. a compact Lie group G. Specically we propose a set of quantum observables associated to surfaces embedded in space. As far as perturbative calculations are concerned. they are much more complicated than in the lowerdimensional case. BF theories and their geometrical signicance We start by considering a dimensional Riemannian manifold M . Moreover. the group SU n or SOn. G over M . the Gibbs measures of the . In this paper we make some preliminary considerations and proposals concerning knots and topological eld theories of the BF type. ChernSimons theory in dimensions beneted greatly from the results of dimensional conformal eld theory. then its curvature will be denoted by FA or simply by F . Nevertheless it is possible to recover a relation between rstorder calculations and higherdimensional linking numbers. Tr B F . in most cases. which parallels a similar relation for ordinary links in a dimensional space. we may consider . The space of all connections will be denoted by the symbol A and the group of gauge transformations by the symbol G. the framework in which these observables are dened ts with the picture of knots as movies of ordinary links or link diagrams considered by Carter and Saito see references below. In the formulae above and are coupling constants. If A denotes a connection on such a bundle. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini case. Moreover. It is an Rn valued form. the space of forms with values in P Ad LieG. for a given section M Og M. It is then convenient to discuss the geometrical aspects of a more general BF theory. We now dene the form B M. In the corresponding BF action. where T denotes transposition. The eld B in eqn .e. given by the identity map on the tangent space of M . adP . UadP . the curvature F is the curvature of a connection in the orthonormal frame bundle Og M . UadP . written in the vielbein formalism. though. with values in M. adP . on M. We denote by the form on A given by the identity map on the tangent space of A. We now mention some examples of Belds that have a nice geometrical meaning . In order to obtain an ordinary form on M from an element of M. . B can be dened as . UadP is obtained by combining the product in UG with the exterior product for ordinary forms. Let LM M be the frame bundle and let be the soldering form.BF Theories and knots tation of the group G and of its Lie algebra. UadP this space naturally contains M. Notice that the wedge product for forms in M. We shall see. More explicitly. For any given metric g we consider the reduced SOnbundle of orthonormal frames Og M . where B is assumed to be a form on M with values in the associated bundle P Ad UG where UG is the universal enveloping algebra of LieG. a tensorial form on P with values in LieG. From this we can obtain the form on A B . that the quantization procedure may force B to take values in the universal enveloping algebra of LieG. equivalently. adP . The manifold A is an ane space with underlying vector space M. one needs to take the trace with respect to a given representation of LieG. This action is known to be classically equivalent to the Einstein action. A vielbein in physics is dened as the Rn valued form on M given by . adOg M as B T Og M . The space of forms with values in P Ad UG will be denoted by the symbol M. is assumed classically to be a form of the same nature as F . In other words B is a section of the bundle T M P Ad UG. The curvature F is a form on M with values in the associated bundle P Ad LieG or. i. . Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini Ba. the wedge product also includes the exterior product of forms on A. F k M Tr B FA . and . M Q F . M M M Q F . F k M Tr B B . F . As Atiyah and Singer pointed out. b TA A. On the principal Gbundle P A M A . F k Tr FA FA . we can consider the tautological connection dened by the following horizontal distribution Horp.A HorA TA A p . Q F . Integrating the ChernWeil forms corresponding to such polynomials over M we obtain for l . where HorA denotes the horizontal space at p P with respect to the p connection A. . F . one can consider together with . where a. where B is dened as in eqns .A FA p A . bX. X. .A aXbY aY bX bXaY bY aX. . Its curvature form is given by Fp.. seen as a . Let us now use Ql to denote an irreducible adinvariant polynomial on LieG with l entries. Y Tp P. Y p.form on P A. F . and kl are normalization factors. We now want to show that the BF action considered in the last example is connected with the ABJ AdlerBellJackiw anomaly in dimensions. In eqn . The connection form of the tautological connection is given simply by A. . We always assume that one of the above choices is made. When we consider such a connection on . via the socalled descent equation. In fact one should really consider only the group of dieomorphisms of M which strongly x one point of M . . then the lefthand side of eqn . i. instead of LM A it is possible to consider OMAmetric . they give closed forms on A. dieomorphism/gauge invariance this refers to the action of AutP . the full group of automorphisms of the principal bundle P including the automorphisms which do not induce the identity map on the base manifold. G dieomorphism invariance this can be considered whenever we have an action of DiM over P and over A.g. gauge invariance this refer to forms which are dened over M A. . the Chern action . and hence on the bundle . is gauge invariant and its connection invariance depends on further specications. . becomes the term which generates.BF Theories and knots . in this case. namely the space of all orthonormal frames paired with the corresponding metric connections see e. is a principal bundle . Hence we can consider dierent kinds of symmetries . or when P is the bundle of linear frames over M .. Also. Hence the BF action . . while the BF action . the following principal Gbundle P A A M . divided by its center. . . Any connection on the bundle A A/G determines a connection on the bundle . the ABJ anomaly in dimensions . connection invariance this refers to forms on M A which are closed when they are integrated over cycles of M . one should consider either the space of irreducible connections and the gauge group. is a sort of gaugexed version of the generating term for the ABJ anomaly. This kind of invariance implies gauge invariance and dieomorphism invariance when the latter is dened. In any BF action one has to integrate forms dened on M A. In particular the BF action of example is connection invariant. In particular we can consider dieomorphism invariance when P is a trivial bundle. A but are pullbacks of forms dened over M . G G . In the latter case P A M A DiM DiM . while the action of Strictly speaking. is both connection and dieomorphism/gauge invariant. For instance. or the space of all connections and the group of gauge transformations which give the identity when restricted to a xed point of M .e. instead of the tautological one. . where Z Z denotes cycles cocycles. has the following properties . .j . B /TrAB. The form . It is an isomorphism of inner product spaces. again with values in the bundle P Ad UG. i. then makes perfect sense in any dimension. When M is a manifold of dimension d. in example . . we have A M Tr F T Og M only when the covariant derivative dA is zero. One can then consider a principal SOdbundle and an associated bundle E with ber Rd . G The map . In this case there is a linear isomorphism Rd LieSOd. then we can take the eld B to be a d form. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini example is not.i n. As a nal remark we would like to mention BF theories in arbitrary dimensions. The left action of SOd on Rn corresponds to the adjoint action on LieSOd. A special situation occurs when the group G is SOd. is the basis for the construction of the Donaldson polynomials . but now this map descends to a map A H M H . then for any cycle in M Tr B Q F F is a closed form on A and so we have a map Z M Z A. When we replace the curvature of the tautological connection with the curvature of a connection in the bundle . dened by j i ei ej Ej Ei . More precisely.. When B is given by .. when the inner product in LieSOd is given by A. then we again obtain a map . the critical connections are the LeviCivita connections. in other words. i where ei is the canonical basis of Rd and Ej is the matrix with entries i m Ej n m. The isomorphism . In this special case we can consider a dierent kind of BF theory.. the integrand of the BF action denes a closed form on Og M A.e. where the eld B is assumed to be a d form with values . . On the other hand. A generalized knot in a dimensional closed manifold M can be dened as a closed surface embedded in M . it is not known whether one can have an analogue of the Jones polynomial for knots. In this case the corresponding BF action is given by exp M BF . . knots and their quantum observables In WittenChernSimons theory we have a topological action on a dimensional manifold M . we can show that there exists a connection between BF theories in dimensions and knots. The theory of knots and links is less developed than the theory of ordinary knots and links. we would like to ask whether there exists a generalization to dimensions of the connection established by Witten between topological eld theories and knot invariants in dimensions. Even though we are not able to show rigorously that a consistent set of nontrivial invariants for knots can be constructed out of dimensional eld theories.BF Theories and knots in the d th exterior power of E. Two knots generalized or not will be called equivalent if they can be mapped into each other by a dieomorphism connected to the identity of the ambient manifold M . or Wilson line. where the wedge product combines the wedge product of forms on M with the wedge product in Rd . one can dene Alexander invariants for knots see e. The problem we would like to address here is whether there exists a connection between dimensional eld theories and invariants of knots.g. gives the classical action for gravity in d dimensions. This connection involves. quantities higherdimensional Wilson lines related to knots. a knot is a sphere embedded in S or in the space R . then the corresponding BF action . in the socalled Palatini rstorder formalism . in dierent places. . More precisely to each knot we associate the trace of the holonomy along the knot in a xed representation of the group G. The action . It is natural to consider as observables. Let us recall here that while an ordinary knot is a sphere embedded in S or R . In Wittens theory one has to perform functional integration upon an observable depending on the given ordinary knot in the given manifold . the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation as well as selflinking and higherdimensional linking numbers. . When the SOdbundle is the orthonormal bundle and the eld B is the d th exterior power of the soldering form. is invariant under gauge transformations. Namely. For instance. and the observables correspond to knots or links in M . In dimensions we have at our disposal the Lagrangians considered at the beginning of the previous section. One expects that the functional integral over the space of all connections will integrate out this dependency. to be dened for any embedded surface closed or with boundary. and we did not use dierent symbols for the holonomy and its quantum counterpart quantum holonomy. Note that we will also allow the operator . x. y. In dimensions. It is gauge invariant if we consider only gauge transformations that are the identity at the points x and z. . we recall that the functional measure over the space of connections is given. z. we recall that. Expression . z. in order to avoid a cumbersome notation. x. See in this regard the analysis of the WessZuminoWitten model made by Polyakov and Wiegmann . z. by the measure over the paths over which the holonomy is computed. a framing is a smooth assignment of a tangent vector to each point of the knot.x we mean the holonomy with respect to the connection A along the path joining two given points y and x belonging to . is gauge invariant without any restriction. we did not write the explicit dependence on the paths . In the special case when z and x coincide. . Moreover. Hence the holonomy along a path is dened by the comparison of the horizontally lifted path and the path lifted through the reference section. namely we want to perform functional integration upon dierent observables depending on a given embedded surface in M with respect to a path integral measure given by the BF action. y. has the following properties . Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini with respect to a topological Lagrangian. it depends on the holonomies along such paths.y . can be seen as the vacuum expectation value of the trace in the representation of the quantum surface operator denoted by O. We assume to have chosen once and for all a reference section for the trivial bundle P . In the latter case the points x and z are always supposed to belong to the boundary. As far as the role of the paths considered above is concerned.x ByHolA. y. then . The functional integral of . where. a timeordering symbol has to be understood. In other words we set O.x ByHolA. . Here we want to do something similar. . in a dimensional theory with knots. up to a Jacobian determinant. Here by HolA. more precisely. y . It depends on the choice of a map assigning to each y a path joining x and z and passing through y. in . z exp HolA. y .y . More precisely. The rst classical observable we want to consider is Tr exp HolA. We will also speak of a framed knot. In local coordinates the action is given by L TrB FA . M M I i.k .BF Theories and knots instead. namely L L and . Here B is a multiple of and Ra is an or thonormal basis of k UG. FA i A A dt Ax A dt Ai dxi i . . where D denotes the covariant dimensional derivative with respect to the connection Ax . In the BF action we can disregard the B component of the eld B.j.k TrBij dt Ak Bi Fjk dt A DBijk dxi dxj dxk . x d dt dx . are zero. A dxi dt iltj Bij dxi dxj Bi dt dxi . We do not have secondary constraints since the Hamiltonian is zero. will be written as FAx op physical . . We take the group G to be SU n and consider its fundamental representation. . L A ijk DBijk i. . we rst consider the canonical quantization approach. We rst consider the pure BF theory. a BF theory where no embedded surface is considered.k . x t. x . namely. We choose a time direction t and write in local coordinates t.. Fij dxi dxj dt Ai dxi dx A dt B iltj i Ai . We perform a Legendre transformation for the Lagrangian L. .j. hence we write the eld B as B a B a Ra . hence the time evolution is trivial. the conjugate momenta to the elds Bi and A . At the formal quantum level the constraints . so we have the primary constraints t Bi t A L Bi ijk FAx jk j. DBop physical . x . We will refer to this assignment as a higherdimensional framing. Gauss constraints In order to study the quantum theory corresponding to . we assign a curve to each point of the knot. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini where op stands for operator and the vectors physical span the physical Hilbert space of the theory. y.. moreover. We assume that locally the manifold M is given by M I I being a time interval and the inter In particular Tr coincides with Tr when A. and . x. Jsing HolA. it follows that the component of Jsing in LieG does not give any signicant contribution. y. y. z. x see denition . a . B UG. the observable to be functionally integrated is Tr exp M Tr HolA. where d y is the surface form of . but has no component in C UG. B Aa B a . . We now consider the expectation value of Tr O.y F yHolA. z. B LieG. a Thus Jsing can take values in UG. . In order to represent the surface operator . we assume that we have a current singular form Jsing . With the above notation and taking into account the BF action as well. we have set TrAB From .z At this point the introduction of the singular current allows us to represent formally a theory with sources concentrated on surfaces as a pure BF theory with a new curvature given by the dierence of the previous curvature and the currents associated to such sources. In this way we neglect possible higherorder terms in U k G UG. we conclude. y .y Jsing . We are now in a position to write the operator . z. z.z ByHolA. as a source action term to be added to the BF action. We still want to work in the canonical formalism. that Jsing as a form should be such that Jsing y d y . of the form a Jsing Jsing Ra . Now we choose a time direction and proceed to an analysis of the Gauss constraints as in the pure BF theory.z ByHolA. but this is consistent with our semiclassical treatment. a a B a Ra . We now assume Jsing U G. concentrated on the surface . z exp M TrHolA. the result will be that instead of the constraints . as O..y . where for any A. we will have a source represented by the assigned surface . A Aa Ra . From eqn . is related to the higher braid group . the restriction of the connection A to the plane looks in the approximation for which HolA.x. z. corresponding to the critical curvature . Aa x Notice that the previous analysis implies that the components of the curvature F a and consequently the components of the connection Aa must take values in a noncommutative algebra. y. let us mention only that the dimensional critical connection is related to the existence . It is then natural to ask whether the same is true in dimensions. In order to have some geometrical insight into the above connection. y .BF Theories and knots section of the dimensional manifold M t with the surface is an ordinary link Lt . in the linear approximation dened above. The righthand side of . x . i. where the surface can be approximated by a collection of dimensional planes in R . The quantum connection . y . y . y x yRa dx dx . for a given y here d is the exterior derivative. and the hyperplane considered above. Given the fact that B a and Aa are conjugate elds. x where is a plane orthogonal to at y with coordinates and and n denotes the ndimensional delta function. where is a loop in based at z and passing through y. by a collection of hyperplanes in C . More precisely the components F a as well as Aa should be proportional to Ra LieG. z. x . We will discuss this point further elsewhere. is also equal to HolA. at least when sources are present. .e. are assumed to be in general position. we consider a linear approximation. yHolA. This means that the intersection of the hyperplane with any other hyperplane is given by a point. z. of the pure braid group . on gives a representation of the rst homotopy group of the manifold of the arrangements of hyperplanes points in . These hyperplanes.z like Aa x Ra d logx y .z . As in the lowerdimensional case ordinary knots or links as sources in a dimensional theory.y Jsing x.y. x . In a neighborhood of y the current Jsing will look like a Jsing x. we can conclude that the commutation relations of the quantum theory will require B a to be proportional to Ra as well.z .e. The Gauss constraints imply that in the above neighborhood of y we have a F a x HolA. namely whether the dimensional connection. i. more simply. . x. where detDA M denotes the regularized determinant of the covariant derivative operator with respect to a background at connection A on the space M . x. . since they are not relevant for a rough calculation of . We omit the ghosts and gaugexing terms . x DADB Tr exp Tr BxF xHolA. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini of a higherdimensional version of the KnizhnikZamolodchikov equation associated with the representation of the higher braid groups. we can set Tr O. x dim detDA M .x . x dim DAF Jsing . Path integrals and the Alexander invariant of a knot In the previous section we worked specically in the canonical approach. x DADB Tr exp Tr Bx F x Jsing x . M . can be given as follows.z . . z. with respect to the BF functional measure only. By applying the standard formula for Dirac deltas evaluated on composite functions. with the FaddeevPopov ghosts included as the analytic RaySinger torsion for the complement of the knot see . x. A rough and formal estimate of the previous expectation value . we can write Tr O. as suggested by Kohno . This torsion is related to the Alexander invariant of the knot .z Jsing xHolA. Again. x. By integration over the B eld we obtain something like Tr O. . . . and compute the expectation values. x. we heuristically obtain Tr O. When instead we consider a covariant approach.. in the approximation in which HolA. x. M using a functional Dirac delta. It is then natural to interpret the expectation value . For instance. with respect to the total BF Chern action. . we can consider an arbitrarily ne triangulation T of and take into consideration only one loop T which has nonempty intersection with each triangle of T . so we get the following Feynman propagator b Aa xB y i ab x y . The connection A is present in the quantum surface operator via the holonomy of the paths y. x. . dimG and . . . We call this lifted path T . While the general case seems dicult to handle. . in principle. The complication here is that the loop itself based at x and passing through y depends on the point y. For a related approach see . the Beld with a . we perform the usual pointsplitting regularization.y.x in a neighborhood of y. In order to avoid singularities. . Moreover. where r stands for regularized. the only relevant part of the BF action is the kinetic part B dA. This is tantamount to lifting the loops x. This approximation will break gauge invariance. The lifting is done in a direction which is normal to the surface . y. which will be.BF Theories and knots Firstorder perturbative calculations and higherdimensional linking numbers Let us now consider the expectation value of the quantum surface observable Tr O. .y y as in denitions . which by pointsplitting regularization is then completely lifted from r the surface.y.x A zdz . we can write the holonomy as HolA. Finally we get to rstorder approximation in perturbation theory and . The advantage of this particular approximation is that we have only to deal with one loop T .x and x. y. we can make simplifying choices which appear to be legitimate from the point of view of the general framework of quantum eld theory. . At the rstorder approximation in perturbation theory with a background eld and covariant gauge. recovered only in the limit when the size of the triangles goes to zero. x y . we can easily assume that when we assign to a point y the loop x. and . x.x based at x and passing through y. The two elds involved in the quantum surface operator are Aa the connection a and B. .x At the same order. then the same loop will be assigned to any other point y belonging to . .. x. we assume more simply that M is the space R and that is a sphere. where C is the trace of the quadratic Casimir operator in the representation . Carter and Saito . x y . One coordinate axis in R is interpreted as time. t we While the normalization factor for a pure dimensional BF theory appears to be trivial . keeping track of the over. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini up to the normalization factor Tr O. is given by dim C i r LT . x y r r where LT . In other words. inspired by a previous work by Roseman . for noncritical times. then . dx dx r T dy . One of the coordinates of this space is interpreted as time. is the higherdimensional linking number of with T . so that Lt t R is. .and undercrossings. we have a space projection t R R for each time t. x dim C i . in a theory with a combined BF Chern action we have a contribution coming from the Chern action. so that the intersection of the dimensional manifold M t with gives an ordinary link Lt for all times t in M . For any time interval t .. At the local level M will be given by M I I being a time interval. . When is a sphere. not its projection. we start by considering the surface embedded in the manifold M directly. The intersection of this dimensional diagram of a knot with a plane at a xed time gives an ordinary link diagram. describe a knot in fact an embedded sphere in space by the dimensional analogue of a knot diagram they project down to a dimensional space.. while the collection of all these link diagrams at dierent times stills gives a movie representing the knot. This contribution has been related to the rst Donaldson invariant of M . In the Feynman formulation of eld theory. with the possible exception of some critical values of the time parameter. Wilson channels Let again represent our knot surface embedded in the manifold M . In order to connect quantum eld theory with the standard theory of knots. an ordinary link. and the intersection of with space at xed times is given by ordinary links. ji point xi in each knot Ki and we denote by i the surface ji ji contained in whose boundary includes Ki and Ki . si.t t R . The operators which appear in a Wilson channel are chosen in such a way that a surface operator is sandwiched between knot operators only if the relevant knots belong to the boundary of the surface. ji.n . . Ki ji xji i jn Otn .BF Theories and knots will also use the notation t .ji ji ji of i we associate a path with endpoints xi and xi passing through p. i . Ki ji ji. denotes the basepoint.t HolA. except at the initial and nal point. . For the sliced knot. . xi ji . We choose one baseji ji ji. . xi ji ji and xji Oi i ji.ji . xi ji HolA. . We refer to the knot equipped with the set T of times as the temporally sliced knot.ji .ji ji. Here and below we will write ji simply to denote the fact that the index j ranges over a set depending on i.. Finally.t tt . we associate the operator HolA. The paths that are included in the surface operators Oi are not allowed to touch the boundaries of the surface. K x HolA. . To the surface i ji Ki . where the subscript to the term HolA. . to the sliced knot we associate the product of the traces of all possible Wilson channels. We denote the ji components of the corresponding links Lti by the symbols Ki . K i ji xji . xn . . Ki ji xji Oi i ji. . . This product can be seen as a possible higherdimensional generalization of the Wilson operator for ordinary links in space that was considered by Witten. The main dierence concerns the prescriptions that are given involving the paths that enter . xi ji HolA. We would like now to compare the Wilson channel operators associated to a sliced knot with the operator O. considered in Section no temporal slicing involved. . We consider a set T of noncritical times ti i. j . we dene the Wilson channels to be the operators of the form O. We then as sign a framing to i as follows for each point p in the interior ji.ji . .ji with boundary components Ki . We assume the following requirements for the Wilson channels . for some i. The tangle approach with its categorical content may reveal itself as a useful one for quantum eld theory. recall that in the Wilson channel operators. One can think of the quantum surface operators as acting on quantum holonomies by convolution. we can construct quantum operators by considering all the Wilson ji. Finally. The initial tangle is called the source and the nal tangle is called the target. for each t T . choosing a nite set of times T ti . movies of ordinary tangles.e. They can be seen as a sort of convolution. say. each of the paths is forbidden to follow two separate components of the same link Lt . tl . then enter ji.tl . i. while the quantum counterpart of the tangle is represented by the quantum surface operator relevant to the surface tl . What we can do instead is to make some innitesimal calculations using integrationbyparts techniques in Feynman path integrals. and one may describe the surface which generates the dierent links at times ti as a sequence movie of braids . or. and the time evolution of a link represented by a surface can also be described in terms of tangles. The quantum counterpart of the source and target is represented by the quantum holonomies associated to the corresponding links. i l i l. Integration by parts The results of the previous section imply that. braided category . for l gt l.j i the surface i which is assumed to be equal to i . and requiring the paths to follow one of the components of the link Lt . but it is dicult to do nite calculations and write this action explicitly. the framing of the knot. of all the quantum holonomies associated to the links Lti for i lt l i gt l.ji j i. and links Lti for i lt l i gt l. Ordinary links are the closure of braids. j i. and nally go back to the j th component. Let us denote these quantum operators by the terms W in . given a temporally sliced knot . Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini the denition of . equivalently. by . one path should follow the jth component. It has been shown that tangles form a rigid. . This last condition can be understood by noticing that in order to follow both the jth and the j th components of the link Lti . for any time t T . the source represents Ltl while the target represents Ltl . depending on . . In our case. tl . But a link is also obtained by closing a tangle. . The Wilson channels are obtained from . ji. W out .ji channels relevant to surfaces i . thus contradicting a local causality condition. We denote by the symbols a and b the part of each string that precedes and. and the string crosses under the string . So in order to compute the derivative of the surface operator. Let us number these strings with numbers . . Three strings Generally speaking. The integrationbyparts rules for the BF theory are as follows. we may consider variations of the link Ltl . respectively. recall that braids or tangles representing links at a xed time can be seen as collections of oriented strings. We consider now two links that dier from each other only in a small region involving three strings. let us see what happens when we consider the quantum operator corresponding to a surface bordering two links Ltl and Ltl that dier by an elementary change. Cx F Ra exp x M . We obtain x HolA. as shown in Fig. is that one can interchange a variation of the surface operator with a variation of the link and consequently of its quantum holonomy. . in a nite time evolution tl tl . then the string crosses under the string . . the quantum surface operator dened by the surface with boundaries Ltl and Ltl will map the operator W in .. By the symbol x we mean the variation of C obtained by inserting an innitesimally small loop cx in C at the point x.BF Theories and knots Fig. tl . tl into the operator W in . What the functional integrationbyparts rules will show. In order to describe elementary changes of links. and a point x C. Let us now consider what can be seen as the derivative of this map.a M TrB F TrB F a d c HolA. Namely. follows the rst crossing. The string crosses under the string . Cx exp . . which we denote here by C in order to simplify the notation. We jl consider a knot Kl . while tangles describe the interaction of those strings . x . Cx Ra a B x . . Kl of Ltl that will evolve into three dierent components Kl . But these variations are exactly the ones for which the small loop cx is such that the surface element d cx is transverse to the knot C as in . . In order to consider the more general situation we assume that the three strings in Fig. . . j . so we can disregard the holonomies of the paths in the surface operators. with the aid of eqns . .. x for a surface whose boundary includes C we obtain O . O . Here Wl is a short notation for the operator We are considering here only the small variations of .a Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini d c exp x TrB F HolA. where d is the surface form of . we can switch each undercrossing into an overcrossing. Such comparison. Details will be discussed elsewhere.j . its innitesimal variation O can be expressed as follows O Wl R Wl . x . By performing three such small variations at each one of the crossings of the three strings considered in Fig. When we apply the functional derivative to a a B x surface operator O . . x . and the Fierz identity . M . we conclude that only the variations cx for which d d cx matter in the functional integral. in this way we produced the functional derivative with respect to the Beld. The integrationbyparts rules of the BF theory in dimensions completely parallel the integrationbyparts rules of the ChernSimons theory in dimensions . xj . Kl . x Ra x x d a B x . Kl of Ltl .. Ra denotes as usual an orthonormal basis of LieSU n. xj . where d cx denotes the surface form of the surface bounded by the innitesimal loop cx . belong to dierent components Kl . Now we come back to the link Ltl with the three crossings as in Fig. leads to the conclusion that when we consider the action of the surface operators Oj. . Now as in we compare the expectation value of the original conguration with the conguration with the three crossings switched.. Kl . . on the quantum l l l holonomies of the knots Klj . The second equality has been obtained by functional integration by parts. and the trace is meant to be taken in the fundamental representation. and . the only relevant contribution to be considered is the one given by the eld B B a Ra . From eqn . x . Now we recall that / a Ra Ra is the innitesimal approximation of a quantum YangBaxter matrix R. Phys. C. Capovilla for invitations to the University of South Alabama and Cinvestav Mexico. F. Ashtekar. involve the operators W in . E. where R is a solution of the quantum YangBaxter equation. R. and nally R is a suitable representation of the following operator / a Ra Ra a. namely S Ra. x . Phys. Kl x O. . Carter and R. M. M. Saito have kindly explained to us many aspects of their work on knots. Kl x O.a Rb.R. Math. . . Kl x l l l l l HolA. Baez for having organized a very interesting conference and for having invited us to participate. Quantum eld theory and the Jones polynomial. Carter and M. Dirac operators coupled to vector . both in person and via email. Atiyah and I. Kl x O. Kauman. Rakowski. Phys. x . Hence the calculations of this section suggest that. D.a / / a a Ra Ra b. respectively. Baez. x HolA.BF Theories and knots Wl HolA. Rep. L.b . Math. Commun.b . the vector space associated to the string j is given by a tensor product j Va Vbj . and G. J. Bibliography . x HolA. Kl x l l l l l the dots in . Birmingham. Singer. Blau. M. Witten. at the nite level. E. M. We also thank A. Commun. Kl x . would like to thank S. P. We thank them very much. l l l l l HolA. Both of us would also like to thank J. Topological quantum eld theory. Topological eld theory. x .a Ra Ra b. Acknowledgements S. . . .. . . Stashe very much for discussions and comments. Thompson. and J. . . Witten.a Rb. x HolA. Capovilla. tl see . the solution of the Zamolodchikov tetrahedron equation which may be more relevant to topological quantum eld theories is the one considered in . tl and W out . Manin and V. Math. Blau and G. . Phys. Turaev. Schwarz. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini potentials. . Ann. B. . Suppl. I. Phys. Schechtman. Phys. Rev. Singer. Publish or Perish. Phys. Teor. Fiz. K. CottaRamusino. M. and L. Wiegmann. sigmamodels and strings. B . Math. Saito. Proc. Reidemeister torsion in knot theory. Polyakov and P. Bonora. M. Commun. M. Phys. T. Phys. S. A. Braids and quantum group symmetry in ChernSimons theory. Guadagnini. Classical amp Quantum Gravity LL. Thompson. Kronheimer. M. Arrangements of hyperplanes. . and J. . Ashtekar. Russ. Syzygies among elementary string interactions of surfaces in dimension . Ya. Fourier . Donaldson and P. . Weaving a classical metric with quantum threads. K. . A quantum eld theoretic description of linking numbers and their generalization. Lett. Lett. . . Kohno. Horowitz and M. B . Lett. D. and J. Srednicki. Surv. V. Arefeva. . Smolin. Wilmington. Studies Pure Math. . V. T. Rinaldi. Stashe. and M. The partition function of degenerate quadratic functionals and RaySinger invariants. Delaware . Rolfsen. Martellini. M. Kohno. Non Abelian Stokes formula. Capovilla.. Knots and Links. T. . The evaluation map in eld theory. . S. higher braid groups and higher Bruhat orders. preprint. P. Jacobson. Phys. Natl. B . E. . Integrable connections related to Manin and Schechtmans higher braid groups. Adv. Topological YangMills symmetry. and . Nucl. . . A. Dell. . Inst. R. G. Goldstone elds in two dimensions with multivalued actions. B . Mat. Inc. L. C. The Geometry of FourManifolds. Mintchev. S. . . Math. L. Nucl. J. Yu. Phys. Rovelli. Acad. Baulieu and I. . . A new class of topological eld theories and the RaySinger torsion. . T. G. Carter and M. . . Oxford University Press . Lett. Math. A. Monodromy representation of braid groups and Yang Baxter equations. . Lett. Math. Proc. Phys. . Commun. Sci. Gravitational instantons as SU gauge elds. Saito. Carter and M. . R. Roseman. . . JETP . Knot Theory Ramications. Saito. J. Zamolodchikov. . D. CottaRamusino. B. S. Saito. Jr. On formulations and solutions of simplex equations. preprint . J. Mintchev. J.BF Theories and knots . . E. B . PhD Thesis. Algebras and triangle relations. Carter and M. Phys. Quantum eld theory and link invariants. and beyond. Sov. S. Guadagnini. Phys. Knotted surfaces. Fischer. Martellini. preprint . this volume. Carter and M. . . S. and M. preprint . J. Tetrahedra equations and integrable systems in dimensional space. M. J. Reidemeistertype moves for surfaces in fourdimensional space. Yale University . braid movies. P. A. J. . Lawrence. Geometry of categories. . Nucl. E. Reidemeister moves for surface isotopies and their interpretation as moves to movies. Paolo CottaRamusino and Maurizio Martellini . in the dimensionally higher case is to get algebraic or diagrammatic ways to describe knotted surfaces embedded in space. In this paper. Kamada proved generalized Alexanders and Markovs theorems for surface braids dened by Viro. we rst review recent developments in this direction.Knotted Surfaces. On the other hand. We propose generalizations of these concepts from braid groups to groups that have certain types of Wirtinger presentations. Our diagrammatic methods of producing new solutions to these generalizations are reviewed. Braid Movies. We observe categorical aspects of these diagrammatic methods. Austin.usouthal. Scott Carter Department of Mathematics. In particular. The rst step. In particular. . USA email cartermathstat. USA email saitomath. University of South Alabama. various braid forms for surfaces were considered by several other authors. then. University of Texas at Austin. Alabama . Texas . Such possibilities were discussed in this conference. We review recent developments in this direction. We combined the movie and the surface braid approaches to obtain moves for the braid movie form of knotted sur . Introduction It has been hoped that ideas from physics can be used to generalize quantum invariants to higherdimensional knots and manifolds. Reidemeistertype moves were generalized by Roseman and their movie versions were classied by the authors . Finally. we present new observations on algebraic/algebraictopological aspects of these approaches.utexas. We discuss generalizations of the YangBaxter equation that correspond to diagrams appearing in the study of knotted surfaces. Mobile. and Beyond J. and cycles in Cayley complexes. generalizations of braids are explained. they are related to identities among relations that appear in combinatorial group theory. In particular. In dimension Jonestype invariants were dened algebraically via braid group representations or diagrammatically via Kauman brackets.edu Abstract Knotted surfaces embedded in space can be visualized by means of a variety of diagrammatic methods.edu Masahico Saito Department of Mathematics. charts. diagrammatic techniques have been used to solve algebraic problems related to statistical physics. . The braid movie description is rich in algebraic and diagrammatic avor. The exposition in Section provides the basic topological tools for nding new invariants along these lines if they exist. In Section we review our diagrammatic methods in solving these equations. . we gave a set of Reidemeister moves for movies of knotted surfaces such that two movies described isotopic knottings if and only if one could be obtained from the other by means of certain local changes in the movies. In order to depict the movie moves. Here a map from a surface to space is called generic if every point has a neighborhood in which the surface is either embedded. Local pictures of these are depicted in Fig. we gave solutions to various types of generalizations of the quantum YangBaxter equation QYBE. three planes intersecting at an isolated triple point. or the cone on the gure eight also called Whitneys umbrella. In Section we follow Fischer to show that braid movies form a braided monoidal category in a natural way. We also can include crossing information by breaking circles at underpasses. The charts dened in Section can be regarded as pictures that are dened for any group presentations of null homotopy disks in classifying spaces. In . Such generalizations originated in the work of Zamolodchikov . J. New observations in this paper are in Section . knot theoretical. Movies. we rst projected a knot onto a dimensional subspace of space. Others are related to Peier equivalences that are studied in combinatorial group theory and homotopy theory. we get immersed circles with nitely many exceptions where critical points occur. . By cutting space by level planes. Then we x a height function on the space. two planes intersecting along a doublepoint curve. Some of the moves correspond to cycles in Cayley complexes. By a movie we mean a sequence of such curves . Such generalizations appeared in the context of categories and higher algebraic structures . Such a map is called generic because the collection of maps of this form is an open dense subset of the space of all the smooth maps. . Movie moves The motion picture method for studying knotted surfaces is one of the most well known. On the other hand. and isotopies . where we discuss close relations between braid movie moves and various concepts in algebra and algebraic topology. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito faces. We propose generalized chart moves for groups that have Wirtinger presentations. see . . surface braids. It originated with Fox and has been developed and used extensively for example . In particular. Generic intersection points . . and Beyond Fig. Braid Movies.Knotted Surfaces. Similar notions had been considered by Lee Rudolph and X. Throughout the paper we consider simple surface braids only. the order of the interactions can be switched. is a branched covering. The dierent stills dier by either a Reidemeister move or critical point birth/death or saddle on the surface. One rather large class of moves is not explicitly given in this list namely. In these gures each still represents a local picture in a larger knot diagram. Lin . Closed surface braids Let F B D be a surface braid with braid index n. Oleg Viro described to us the braided form of a knotted surface. where we regard the projection p B D D as a disk bundle over a disk. These are called the elementary string interactions ESIs. Here the positive integer n is called the surface braid index. Each element in a sequence is called a still. Kamada has studied Viros version of surface braids. Surface braids In April . A surface braid is a compact oriented surface F properly embedded in B D such that the projection p B D D to the second factor restricted to F . A surface braid is called simple if every branch point has branch index . . Figure depicts ESIs. . . that is. The Reidemeister moves are interpreted as critical points of the double points of the projected surface. S. Finally. when two string interactions occur on widely separated segments. The movie moves are depicted in Figs and . Embed B D in space standardly. Then F is the unlink in the sphere B D . distant ESIs commute. Any two movie descriptions of the same knot are related by a sequence of these moves. A surface braid is simple if the covering in condition above is simple.. we follow Kamadas descriptions. and so the movies contain critical information for the surface and for the projection of the surface. pF F D . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito on the planes.. The boundary of F is the standard unlink F n points D B D B D where n points are xed in the interior of B. The moves indicate when two dierent sequences of ESIs depict the same knotting. the moves to these movies were classied following Roseman by means of an analysis of foldtype singularities and intersection sets. Denitions Let B and D denote disks. Two surface braids are equivalent if they are isotopic under levelpreserving isotopy relative to the boundary. J. Again without loss of generality we can assume that successive stills dier by at most a classical Reidemeister move or a critical point of the surface. Braid Movies. The elementary string interactions . and Beyond Fig.Knotted Surfaces. . . J. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. The Roseman moves . and Beyond Fig. Braid Movies. . The remaining movie moves .Knotted Surfaces. . See and also the next section. is to nd a proof of the Markov theorem for closed surface braids in which each branch point is simple. A surface obtained this way is called a closed surface braid. . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito so that we can cap o these circles with the standard embedded disks in space to obtain a closed. Kamada has recently proven a Markov theorem for closed surface braids in the PL category. i j gt we dene a braid movie as follows. Except for such t. Here the underarc lies below the overarc with respect to the projection p . is one of the following smoothing/unsmoothing of a crossing corresponding to a branch point. the dierence between p F Ps . bk of words in i . However. . Braid movies Write B and D as products of closed unit intervals B B B . Factor the projection p B D D into two projections p B B D B D and p B D D . If one of such points is contained. F called the closure of F . We may assume that for any t D there exists a positive such that at most only one of such points is contained in st . or local maxima/minima of the doublepoint set. we can include crossing information by breaking the underarc as in the classical case. To make this convention more precise we identify the image of p with an appropriate subset in B D . . Furthermore. . type II Reidemeister move corresponding to the maximum/minimum of the doublepoint set. Viro and Kamada have proven an Alexander theorem for surfaces. p F Pt is the projection of a classical braid. any orientable surface embedded in R is isotopic to a closed surface braid. in his proof he does not assume that the branch points are simple. In other words. Except for a nite number of values of t D the intersection p F Pt is a collection of properly immersed curves on the disk Pt . Furthermore. Let F be a surface braid. This idea was used by Kamada when he constructed a surface with a given chart. We further regard the D factor in B D B D D as the time direction. . Such a theorem would show a clear analogy between classical and higherdimensional knot theory. A braid movie is a sequence b . s t . n. or triple points. An open problem. J. or type III Reidemeister move corresponding to a triple point. then. By this convention we can describe surface braids by a sequence of classical braid words. is dened up to ambient isotopy. bm is obtained from bm by one of the following . Exceptions occur when Pt passes through branch points. . D D D . orientable embedded surface in space. i . The closed surface. such that for any m. we consider families Pt B D t t D . Thus. Including another braid group relation i j j i . .t Ps .. . We may assume without loss of generality that p restricted to F is generic. Consider the double point set of F under the projection p F B D F B D which is a subset of B D . A white vertex on the chart has valence . and this is an optimum on the doublepoint set.Knotted Surfaces. . . This situation is illustrated in Fig. The projection of the braid exchange i j j i for i j gt is a valent vertex or a crossing in the graph. A valent vertex can also be thought of as a crossing point of the edges of the graph. j where i j . and charts is depicted in Fig. and Beyond changes insertion/deletion of i . insertion/deletion of a pair i i . j . . for short. the orientations are such that the rst three edges in this labelling are incoming and the last three edges are outgoing. and this in turn is a triple point of the projected surface. Thus . . Reconstructing the surface braid from a chart A chart gives a complete description of a surface braid in the following way. j . Braid Movies. Then a chart depicts the image of this double point set under the projection p B D D in the following sense The birth/death of a braid generator occurs at a saddle point of the surface at which a doublepoint arc ends at a branch point. Here. Chart descriptions A chart is an oriented labelled graph embedded in a disk. Maximal and minimal points on the graph correspond to the birth or death of i i . The relationships among surface projections. replacement of i j i by j i j where i j . Recall that the D factor of D is interpreted as a time direction. The labels on the edges at such a crossing must be braid generators i and j where i j gt . i . Two braid movies are equivalent if they represent equivalent surface braids. braid movies. the edges are labelled with generators of the braid group. This projects to a black vertex on a chart. These changes are called elementary braid changes or EBCs. replacement of i j by j i where i j gt . The valent vertex corresponds to a Reidemeister type III move. and the vertices are of one of three types A black vertex has valence . The edges around the vertex in cyclic order have labels i . i .. Braid movies. . charts. J. and diagrams . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. Chart moves . .Knotted Surfaces. Braid Movies. and Beyond Fig. j k i i k j . CIR i k j . j k i j . j k gt . j i j k k i j i . Kamada Every surface braid gives rise to an oriented labelled chart. Kamada provided a set of moves on charts. j k gt . and III. k i gt . . From the braid movie point of view. indeed. k j i j . yielding braid movie moves that will be discussed in the next section. i j i k . i j . Theorem . j i k j . we can construct a surface braid and. Furthermore. otherwise the exponent is negative. CIR k i j i . Such generalized chart moves. where i j gt . By taking a single slice on either side of a vertex or a critical point on the graph. where i j and i k gt . Each generic intersection of a horizontal line with the graph generic intersections will miss the vertices and the critical points on the graph gives a sequence of braid words. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito the vertical axis of the disk points in the direction of increasing time. j j i . and every oriented labelled chart completely describes a surface braid. i j k i . Therefore. . The letters in the word are the labels associated to the edges. CIR CIR i . are listed in Fig. given a chart and a braid index. the exponent on such a generator is positive if the edge is oriented coherently with the time direction. we need to rene his list incorporating movie moves. i i i . i j k . j i . j i j k . i k j i . j i j i . where i j gt . k i j . II. Braid movie moves The following types of changes among braid movies are called braid movie moves CIR i . His list consists of three moves called CI. . i j i j . j k i . j i k . i j j . a knotted surface by closing the surface braid. j i j . i i . J. we can reconstruct a braid movie from the sequence of braid words that results. k j i . where i j gt . Furthermore. k i j i k j . j i j . . k j i k j k . i i . b bk . . where i j . k i j k i j . . i j i . i j i k j i . j i j . where i j . empty word. empty word. we include the variants obtained from the above by the following rules replace i with i for all or some of i appearing in the sequences if possible. i j i j j . i k j k i j . j i k j k i . j k i j i k . b . k j i j k j . i j i j . CII j . . j k j i j k . add bk . . i j i . . i j j . k j k i j k i j k i j i . CIII j j . CIM i j k i j i .Knotted Surfaces. j i j k j i . . Braid Movies. where i j . i . if b . i j i . . i i . . j i j i j . . and Beyond CIM empty word empty word. . . where k j i or k j i . bk b . j i j . i j i j j i . . where i j gt . . CIM j i . i empty word. CIV empty word. i i j i . . where i j . j i j j . CIM CIM i i . empty word. i j k j i j . i j . j i . i i i i . i i . k j k i j k . i j i i j i . bk is one of the above. . j k i j k i . CIII i j . . are written as bj uj vj resp. . . i . bj resp. Then we say that b . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito if b . . and ui ui resp. b vi resp. . . bj uj vj where u and v satisfy a ui resp. . . and vi vi resp. . . . There is an overlap between the braid movie moves and the ordinary movie moves. i. . . bk is one of the above. Zamolodchikov presented a system of equations and a solution to this system that corresponded to the interaction of straight strings in statistical mechanics. There exists i. Denition locality equivalence Let b . . It is interesting to note that in the braid movie point of view. ui by one of the elementary braid changes. i . . . . J. and this relationship suggests topological applications. ck c . ui ui . i n. bn and b . say . bj . . bk b . Theorem . In . add c . . The permutohedral and tetrahedral equations In . vi vi . Frenkel and Moore produced a formulation and a solution of a variant of the Zamolodchikov tetrahedral equation. these systems are interpreted as consistency conditions for the obstructions to the lower dimensional equations having solutions. the move that corresponds to a quadruple point gives a movie move corresponding to the permutohedral equation rather than to the tetrahedral equation. bj . Baxter showed that the Zamolodchikov solution worked. . And Kapranov and Voevodsky consider the solution of . i. that overlap is to be expected. And in higherdimensional analogues were dened. . vi is obtained from ui resp. vi by one of the elementary braid changes. bn is obtained from b . . bn by a locality change or vice versa. . ck where cj resp. . Two braid movies are equivalent if and only if they are related by a sequence of braid movie moves and locality changes. . . combinations of the above. say . The braid movie moves are depicted in Figs and . bn be two braid movies that satisfy the following condition. . This system of equations is related to the Yang Baxter equations. such that bj bj for all j i . . . cj is the word obtained by reversing the order of the word bj resp. If two braid movies are related by a sequence of locality changes then they are called equivalent under locality. . j i . . . We will discuss these equations at some length in Section . . equivalence under locality changes means that distant EBCs commute. Loosely speaking. ui is obtained from vi resp. . Braid Movies.Knotted Surfaces. and Beyond Fig. . The braid movie moves . . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. The braid movie moves . J. is S . acts on V as the identity. the elementary string interactions that occur are Reidemeister type III moves. for example. Braid Movies.. The rst factor of the lefthand side of the equation . . We expect there are even more solutions in the literature and would appreciate being told of these. Dene a set of pairs of integers among to C. where S EndV . The equation corresponds to the given movie move as these type III moves occur in opposite order on the righthand side of the move. . A variant There is a natural variant of this equation S S S S S S S S . We review how to obtain eqn . . This tetrahedral equation was also formulated in .Knotted Surfaces. we mention . Under . Ruth Lawrence described the permutohedral equation and two others as natural equations for which solutions in a algebra could be found. Here we review these equations and our methods for solving them. Compare this equation with the movie move that involves ve frames on either side. . . Then the Reidemeister type III moves occur in order among the strings . On the lefthand movie. In . . . . and . The tetrahedral equation The FrenkelMoore version of the tetrahedral equation is formulated as S S S S S S S S . Label the strings to from left to right in the rst frame of the movie. There are other solutions of these higherorder equations known to us. and Beyond the Zamolodchikov equation to be a key feature in the construction of a braided monoidal category. Each side of the equation acts on V V V V V . . There are six elements and the ordering denes a map C. solutions are studied in relation to quasicrystals. In a parallel development. . . This index is one more than the number of strings that cross over the given string. This correspondence was also pointed out by Towber. with the lexicographical ordering as indicated. . . . from eqn . . Thus we think of the tensor S as corresponding to a type III Reidemeister move. where each side of the equation now acts on V . V a module over a xed ring k. . In particular. . . . . In this equation each index appears twice in each side. Notice here that eqn . cf. . has the nice property that each index appears three times on either side of the equation. . in the lexicographical ordering. and S . Consider the pairs of integers among this subscript . J. Solving the Zamolodchikov equation . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . . . which is the subscript of the rst factor in eqn . has the subscript which yields pairs . This is how we obtain . Braid Movies. . and Beyond these are mapped to . and the selfintersection sets of these contain intersections of lowerdimensional strata. . Specically. . the intersection points among planes and receive the number since is the rst in the lexicographical ordering. For S S acting on V V V Wa Wb Wa Wb Wa Wb set S Raa Rba Rbb . the second factor of . Thus .. is solvable.. The numbering in the gure matches those described above.Knotted Surfaces. . One can compute S S S S Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Raa Raa Rba Rba Raa Rbb Rba Rba Rbb Rbb Rbb Raa Raa Raa Raa Rba Rba Rba Rba Rbb Rbb Rbb Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb Raa Rba Rbb S S S S . . and on the other side of the movie move the other side of the Reidemeister type III move appears. . . which are mapped under to . We obtained this result by considering the preimage of four planes of dimension generically intersecting in space. from . giving the second factor of . For example. The other factors are obtained similarly. The crossing points of the remaining planes give one side of the Reidemeister type III move on the preimage. Each plane is one of the strings as it evolves on one side of the movie of the corresponding movie move. Thus the solution is a piece of bookkeeping based on this picture. For given V give a and b as subscripts of W Vi Wia Wib for i . . This computation is a bit tedious algebraically. Let V W W where W is a module over which there is a QYB solution R R R R R R R . . All of the higherdimensional solutions are obtained because the equations correspond to the intersection of hyperplanes in hyperspaces.. Remarks In we showed that solutions to the FrenkelMoore equations could also produce solutions to higherdimensional equations.. is solvable appropriate products of QYB solutions give solutions to . The movie version of such planes is depicted in Fig. Next we observe that eqn . . and both sides of the equation live in EndV . The tensors S and R live in EndV and EndV . Thus this equation is a natural one to consider from the point of view of knotted surfaces. The permutohedral equation This equation was studied in and S S R R S S R R S S R R S S . and each parallelogram is dual to a crossing point on the graph. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. Each hexagon represents the tensor S and each parallelogram represents R. the equation reduces to the variant of the tetrahedral equation given above. The permutohedral equation . J. Finally. . and it acts as the identity on the other factors. A pictorial representation is given in Fig. . observe that by setting R equal to the identity. The subscripts indicate factors of vector spaces on which the tensor acts nontrivially. Each hexagon is dual to a valence vertex. . respectively. and the numbers assigned to the boundary edges of hexagons and parallelograms determine the subscripts of the tensor. The gure is the dual to the CIM move on charts. This gure shows two sides of a permutohedron truncated octohedron. as it expresses one of the braid movie moves. The equation expresses the equality among tensors that are associated to the faces on the sides of the permutohedron. Parallel edges receive the same number. . AM M M M A stands for A M M M M A EndV .. and R EndV V satisfy the following conditions AAA AAA. RM B BM R ARM M RA. . . they are listed explicitly as in eqns . BM M M M B AM B BM A AM R RM A. M RB BRM M AR RAM ARB BRA. For example. BRA ARB BAR RAB. . In case those equalities are used.. and Beyond Fig. . and resp. Braid Movies. RAB BAR M RM M RM . Assigning tensors to the hexagons . BBB BBB M M A AM M. . . . RHS of every relation has subscripts . .Knotted Surfaces. The subscripts indicate the factor in the tensor product on which these operators are acting. . . We do not require the equalities with the subscripts of the RHS and LHS switched. and and lives in EndV . B. and . M . Solutions Suppose A. . . where the LHS resp. BM M M M B M M A AM M. . J. . The computational technique . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. .. we indicate that if A. and R satisfy YangBaxterlike relations. BBB BBB BRR RRB. . i /. B be the universal Rmatrix in Uqi sl Uqi sl resp. In this way. we embedded quantum groups into bigger quantum groups.Knotted Surfaces. Uq sln Uq sln. then go directly down to the second row and read right to left. then we can get from one side of the permutohedron to the other. Let R i R where i is xed. Now in the solution given in . and Beyond Proposition . i r is a basis of i simple roots of the root system. .. where qi qi . travel left to right. . set A M R. Planar versions Simplex equations can be represented by planar diagrams when the subscripts consist of adjacent sequences of numbers. Furthermore. we were able to construct solutions. then S A M B is a solution to the permutohedral equation. The proof is presented in detail in . is the canonical inner product. The zigzag pattern continues. . To read this gure start at the upper left. Then in Fig. B. . . If we take a representation f Uq sln EndV for a vector space V over the complex numbers. There exists a canonical embedding i Uqi sl Uq sln corresponding to the ith vertex of the Dynkin diagram. and r is the rank p. in we showed that the remaining relations held between R and B. In this way we reinforce the diagrammatic nature of the subject. In Fig. M . Then the list of the conditions reduces to RRR RRR. Here we include the illustrations that led to the proof. Let R resp. hold. RRB BRR . we assign the product ABM to each of the S tensors.. with the same subscript convention as in eqns . To get Rmatrices that satisfy these conditions. We can use planar diagrams to solve such equations. If the conditions stated in eqns . both f R and f B satisfy the quantum Yang Baxter equation RRR RRR. . Braid Movies. This idea was inspired by Kapranov and Voevodskys idea of using projections of quantum groups to obtain solutions to Zamolodchikovs equation . BBB BBB since f R f i R is a representation of Uqi sl and R is a universal Rmatrix. we found a continuous family of solutions to the above equation expressed as a linear combination with variables in generators of the Temperley Lieb algebra. or they can be glued along common objects.. and another class of solutions reected the noninjectivity of the Burau representation. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito . Turaev described the category of tangles and laid the foundations for his paper . is a morphism from n to m. Elements in the TemperleyLieb algebra are represented by diagrams involving and . Such generalizations of the Kauman bracket seem useful in general. Some of the solutions were noninvertible. For any two objects in a category there is a set of morphisms. and morphisms between morphisms called morphisms. there are objects. A category has objects. Playing with such diagrams. r P R.. categories and the movie moves At the Isle of Thorns Conference in . morphisms. Consequently. The morphisms can be composed in essentially two dierent ways either they can be glued along common morphisms. there is hope that the yet to be found higherdimensional generalizations can be found as representations of the category of tangles that we will describe here. then. Such a tangle. All of the known generalizations of the Jones polynomial can be understood as representations on this category. The objects in the category are in onetoone correspondence with the nonnegative integers. . We found some new and interesting solutions to this version by using the Burau representation of the braid group. And the morphisms are isotopy classes of tangles joining n dots along a horizontal to m dots along a parallel horizontal. . J. A week later in France similar ideas were being discussed by Joyal . and these were presented in . Overview of categories In a category. We regarded the corresponding planar diagram as the diagrams in the TemperleyLieb algebra. Planar tetrahedral equations One such equation is S S S S S S S S . after multiplying by permutation maps s P S. . The planar permutohedral equation It was observed by Lawrence that the permutohedral equation becomes the following equation r s s r r s s s s r r s s r . Equivalently. a morphism can be represented by a movie in which stills dier by at most an EBC. consider the category in which the collection of objects consists of the natural numbers . and the set of morphisms from n to n is the set of nstring braid diagrams or equivalently words on the alphabet .Knotted Surfaces. the fundamental problem in a category is to determine if two morphisms are the same. we can dene all the data various morphisms in terms of braid movies such that the category of braid movies denes a braided monoidal category. that is. In the middle of gures polytopes are depicted. by braiding n strings in front of m strings. . Thus. . the integer n. . n . and polygons where poly means two or more for morphisms. The set of morphisms is the set of nstring braid diagrams without an equivalence relation of isotopy imposed. . by composing morphisms we obtain faces of polyhedra. Here we give a description of the category associated to nstring braids. they can be glued only if they have either a morphism or an object in common. . A tensor product is dened by addition of integers. the braid diagram represented by the braid word n n nm n n nm m . arrows between dots for morphisms. Assertion With the tensor product. . each number n is identied with n dots arranged along a horizontal line. . More generally. These are two exam . a morphism is a word in the letters . The geometric depiction of a category consists of dots for objects. . The category of braid movies This section is an interpretation of Fischers work in the braid movie scheme. . and braiding dened above. and this is identied with n points arranged along a line. Equivalently. and an equality among morphisms is a solid bounded by these faces. These are illustrations of the KapranovVoevodsky axioms as interpreted in our setting. identity. Braid Movies. but for example two straight lines and a braid dia gram represented by i i are distinguished. Just as the fundamental problem in an ordinary category is to determine if two morphisms are the same. . Sketch of Proof In Figs and a set of movie moves to ribbon diagrams are depicted. The set of morphisms from n to m when m n is empty. We dene a braiding which is a morphism from n m to m n. . A morphism is a surface braid that runs between two nstring braid diagrams. and Beyond Obviously.. Two diagrams related by a levelpreserving isotopy of a disk which keeps the crossings are identied. . . and acts as an identity for this product. A generating set of morphisms is the collection of EBCs. There is one object. . n . Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. . A ribbon movie move . J. Knotted Surfaces. and Beyond Fig. Braid Movies. Another ribbon movie move . . he denes this category. Edges in these polytopes are morphisms. Alternatively. . and changes between two ribbon diagrams. braided. Letters represent objects where tensor product notation is abbreviated. rigid. Since moves CIM and CIM hold. Fischers result Fischers dissertation gives an axiomatization of the category that is associated to regular isotopy classes of knotted surface diagrams. is represented by ribbon diagrams to simplify movie diagrams. These EBCs can be written in terms of charts. If R is thought of from R as crossing the strings of A over those of B. They are in turn represented by braid words. In addition. In particular.. or the right hand side. In ribbon diagrams. . Algebraic interpretations of braid movie moves Our motivation in dening braid movies and their moves was to get a more algebraic description of knotted surfaces. a braid word. these morphisms are isomorphisms. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito ples of axioms in that are to be satised by morphisms. The polytopes are relations satised by compositions of morphisms. Fischers theorem means that if one has an RBSMcat then one automatically has constructed an invariant of regular isotopy classes of knotted surface diagrams. we need a braiding R B A A B that also gives a morphism R to the identity morphism on A B. Ribbons represent parallel arcs as in the classical case. That is. then R crosses Bs strings over As. Then two ribbon movies are equivalent if and only if the resulting charts are chart equivalent. it is hoped that this description can be dened and studied in a more general setting . Thus we can check the equality by means of chart moves. Therefore each ribbon diagram represents a composition of edges in the polytopes. Then each morphism. J. semistrict monoidal category FRBSMcat generated by a set.. this means that two ways of deforming ribbon diagrams have to be equal. we can decompose the polytopes into simpler pieces that correspond to the polytopes of the braid movie moves. Each frame in a movie can be written as a product of braid generators while each morphism can be decomposed as a sequence of EBCs. to the braiding R AB B A. Remark The existence of a braided monoidal category is not enough to conclude that one has an invariant of knots. The ribbon diagrams surrounding the polytopes represent braid movies. The conditions say that these two ways are equal. A morphism is a face in the polytopes. There are two ways to deform by braid movie moves one the top ribbon diagram to the other the bottom by going along the left hand side of the polytope. and he shows that it is the free. ri . . where F is the free group on X. Braid Movies. where details appear. we work towards this goal. A Peier insertion inserts an adjacent pair a. and Beyond for example. . R. A collection of disjoint oriented arcs labelled by elements of X that either form simple closed loops or join points on the boundaries of two or possibly one of the . for any group. ui . . ri . A presentation of G is a triple X.Knotted Surfaces. ui u wri ui . Also. .. and G is isomorphic to F/N wR. we observe close relations between braid movie moves and various concepts in algebra and algebraic topology. Let H be the free group on Y R F . it is desirable if there is an algebraictopological description of braid movies generalizing the fact that a classical braid represents an element of the fundamental group of the conguration space. w R F is a map. Identities among relations Let G be a group. . .. ui . w such that R is a set. deletions. Identities among relations and Peier elements In this section we recall denitions of various concepts for group presentations following . An identity among relations is any element in the kernel of . . ui . a into a Y sequence. an where ai ri . n. Pictures for presentations Let X. . . where N is the normal closure. Peier transformations A Y sequence is a sequence of elements y a . u u wru. . A picture over the presentation consists of A disk D with boundary D. A Peier equivalence is a nite sequence of exchanges. . . let H F denote the homomorphism r. ui ui wri ui or ri . R. i A Peier deletion deletes an adjacent pair a. a in a Y sequence. ui is a generator or its inverse of H for i . In this section. and insertions to a Y sequence performed in some order. . k of disjoint disks in the interior of D that are labelled by elements of R. Then H N wR. The following operations are called Peier transformations A Peier exchange replaces the successive terms ri . . A collection . . w denote a group presentation. .. ri . ui with either ri . . . From a picture a Y sequence can be obtained. . An incoming edge is interpreted as having a positive exponent. The arcs are the inverse images of interior points on the edges of the complex. starting from the base point and reading around the boundary of any in a counterclockwise fashion. Pictures for group presentations A base point for each of the and one for the big disk D. Furthermore. The dotted arcs indicate how to obtain a Y sequence from a picture. J. the labels on the edges that are encountered should spell out either the relation R or its inverse that is associated to the small disk. that is dened up to homotopy. Finally. A picture determines a map of a disk into BG. the classifying space of the group with given presentation. The base point on a is distinct from the endpoints of the connecting arcs. and an outgoing edge has a negative exponent. These arcs do not intersect in their interiors. for each disk a dotted arc is chosen that connects the base point of the small disk to that of the larger disk. The Y sequence obtained from a spherical picture is an identity sequence in the sense that the product a an in the free group. and by transversality if such a map is given then there is a picture the little disks are the inverse images of regular neighborhoods of points at the center of the disks that correspond to relators. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. In a spherical picture is dened as a picture in which none of the edges touch the outer boundary. Figure illustrates a spherical picture. Namely. the dotted arcs are chosen to be transverse to the arcs that . CIM. The correspondence is given by taking duals. where r R and u F . but corresponds to CIM and CIR combined with CIM. Peier exchanges correspond to locality equivalences because ordering the vertices is tantamount to choosing a height function. . CIR looks like straightening up a cubic curve. This is a direct analogue of the CIM move on charts. they dene deformations of pictures. . and this gives the ordering of the Y sequence. Moves corresponding to Peier transformations Braid movie moves CIM and CIR are used to perform Peier insertions and deletions as noted in the previous section.. are the dual cycles in the Cayley complex. it is noted that an elementary Peier exchange corresponds to rechoosing a pair of successive arcs from the base points of a pair of to the base point of D. Braid Movies. the hexagonal prism. The element r is the intersection sequence on the boundary of read in a counterclockwise fashion. Moves corresponding to cycles The chart moves CIR. respectively. The rst type is to insert or delete small circles labelled by the generating set. and Beyond interconnect the disks. surgery between arcs with compatible labels and orientations is analogous to the CIM move. and what the others correspond to. but oppositely oriented. They provide a diagrammatic tool for the study of groups from an algebraictopological viewpoint. Moves on surface braids and identities among relations In this subsection we observe which moves on surface braids correspond to Peier transformations dened above. Other CI moves These correspond to rechoosing the dotted arcs in the homotopy classes relative to the endpoints. and CIM are identities among relations that correspond to nondegenerate cycles in the Cayley complex for the standard presentation of the braid group.Knotted Surfaces. The cube. To each dotted arc we associate a pair r . u.. Third is an insertion or deletion of a pair of small disks labelled with the same relator. and the permutohedron. The collection of dotted arcs is ordered in a counterclockwise fashion at the base point. For example. The element u is the word in the free group corresponding to the intersection sequence of the dotted arc with connecting arcs. .. Furthermore. There are three types of moves to pictures. . The exponent on a letter is determined by an orientation convention. CIR. Thus if . In . Thus pictures can be used to study Y sequences and their Peier equivalences. Secondly. joined together by arcs corresponding to generators that appear in the relator. This is an isolated conguration disjoint from other components of the graph in the picture. In summary. Since BG . Consider a small disk B centered at a black vertex v. Note here that S is trivial i. add cells to kill the second homotopy group of the skeleton thus constructed. Proposition . S is an unlinked collection of n spheres. This generalizes Kamadas denition of symmetric equivalence for charts. Furthermore. then this move corresponds to rechoosing a dotted arc so that it intersects the edge with two less intersection points. CI moves of isotopy of surface braids correspond to picture moves of BG .. braid movie moves correspond to Peier transformations. J. . In particular. This is the same as a sequence of CI moves realizing an isotopy of surface braids from S to the trivial surface braid whose chart is the empty diagram. . In other words. Let G be a braid group Bn on n strings and BG its classifying space constructed from the standard presentation. Symmetric equivalence and charts Fix a base point on the boundary of the disk on which the chart of a surface braid lives. Pick a point d on the boundary of B which misses the edge coming out of v. More precisely. the arc misses the vertices and crossings of the chart and intersects the edges transversely. Suppose there are black vertices. vertex. and continue killing higher homotopies to build BG. Note that pictures are dened for maps of disks to BG as in the case of maps to the Cayley complexes by transversality. such that the picture corresponding to f is the same isotopic as a planar graph as C. attach cells corresponding to relators along the skeleton. Then there is a map f from a disk to BG. Let C be a chart of a surface braid S without black vertices. this deformation is interpreted as identities among relations. add n oriented edges corresponding to generators. f D .e. BG is constructed as follows start with one vertex. . Connect d to the base point by a simple arc which intersects the chart transversely. or rechoosing the dotted arcs in pictures. this picture is deformed to the empty picture by a sequence of picture moves. This rechoosing in turn corresponds to changing the words ui in the terms ri . or cells of BG. Specically. ui of the Y sequences. we interpret charts without black vertices as null homotopies of the second homotopy group of the classifying space. Other moves can be interpreted similarly. since dotted arcs correspond to these words. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito the xaxis in the gure is a part of a dotted arc. D BG. These moves correspond to CII and CIII moves on charts which are the moves involving black vertices. Symmetric equivalence and moves on surface braids In this section we consider moves on group elements that are conjugates of generators. y X are generators and V is a word in generators. Kamada dened symmetric equivalence between words that are conjugates of generators in the braid group. Then go around v along B counterclockwise. We indicated the word changes that correspond to CII and CIII moves. Let A be the set of all the words in X i. Then before/after the CII move. where also denotes and i j gt . Let G X R be a nite Wirtinger presentation. and Beyond Starting from the base point. Dene symmetric equivalence on A as follows Two words Y xY and Z xZ are symmetrically equivalent if Y and Z represent the same element in G. Either of these moves corresponds to sliding the disk by homotopy across the polygon representing the given relation. elements in the free group on X of the form w Y xY . He proved that two such words are symmetrically equivalent i they represent the same element in the braid group. where i is the label of the edge coming from v. Consider a chart with black vertices. we consider Wirtinger presentations of groups. and then he used this theorem to prove that C moves suce. and go back to the base point. Thus each of the relators is of the form r y V xV . This gives a picture associated to a chart that has black vertices. . where i j . The equivalence relation reects the changes above. where x. The chart moves CII and CIII have the following interpretation as moves on pictures. travel along the arc and read the labels as it intersects the edges. . Chart moves that involve black vertices Charts that have black vertices can be interpreted as pictures in the sense of as follows. and . Braid Movies. and Y is the word we read along the arc.e. Cut the disk open along the arcs dened above to obtain a picture in which the boundary of the disk is mapped to the product of conjugates of generators. The picture represents a map from the disk into BG where G is the braid group. the word thus dened changes as follows Y i Y Y j i j Y. . Similarly a CIII move causes the word change Y i Y Y j i j i i Y. Generalizations of Wirtinger presentations Generalizing Kamadas theorem.. . This yields a word w in braid generators of the form of a conjugate of a generator w Y i Y . The words on the boundary of the disk change as indicated above... where x X and Y is a word in X. Kamadas denition of symmetric equivalence is dierent from the above. depends on the orientation of this edge.Knotted Surfaces. consider small disks centered at each univalent vertex and simple. our data consist of a picture on a disk where univalent vertices are allowed. In terms of pictures. We generalize pictures for group presentations to include univalent vertices. then we can diagrammatically represent the above two changes in terms of pictures. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Fig. More precisely. J. if we allow univalent vertices in pictures. To make homotopytheoretic sense out of such pictures. . a small disk centered at each univalent vertex with a specied point on the boundary of each disk which misses the edge coming from the univalent vertex. mutually disjoint arcs connecting them to a base point. and if we dene arc systems connecting univalent vertices to a base point on the boundary of the disk. . They are depicted in Fig. These arcs miss vertices of the picture and intersect the edges transversely. Generalized chart move Two words Y yY and Y V xV Y are symmetrically equivalent if r y V xV R where x. y X. Such a generalization of pictures will be discussed next. . Two words in A are symmetrically equivalent i they are related by a nite sequence of the above changes. a system of mutually disjoint simple arcs such that for each univalent vertex a simple arc from this system connects the specied point on the boundary of the small disk to a xed base point on the boundary of the big disk where the picture lives. Go around the vertex along the boundary of the small disk and come back to the base point to get a word w . . . This has the following meaning as explained in the case of braid groups above. Given a generalized picture. . Here we remark that Kamadas theorem on symmetric equivalence seems to be generalized to other groups. The moves in this case would consist of the moves that correspond to Peier equivalences and the moves on pictures described in . . This edge path represents the product w wn in G BG which was assumed to be the identity. . Then we trace a up to an to get a sequence w . The transverse preimages of points in cells resp. the group with which we started. Therefore the map on the boundary of the cutopen disk extends to a map of the big disk. and Beyond Let a . Furthermore we can generalize braid movie moves to such sequences for Wirtinger presented groups by examining moves on pictures in the presence of height functions. we can dene sequences of words for Wirtinger presented groups generalizing braid movies. . We further discussed potential generalizations to Wirtinger presented groups. n. We conclude this section with remarks on these aspects. charts and classifying spaces of braid groups. vertices of the rest of the picture. Call this a generalized picture. . Now we require that the product w wn is in G. we do not want to allow cancelling black vertices since if we did charts represent just null homotopies in the case of braid groups and we instead want something highly nontrivial. Kamada used Garsides results . Starting from the base point. where xi is the label of the edge coming from the ith univalent vertex. . cells gives edges resp. . . By xing a height function on the disk where pictures are dened. remove the interior of small disks around each univalent vertex. to the skeleton of BG. Thus we need restrictions on homotopy classes of maps from cutopen disks to classifying spaces to be able to dene nontrivial homotopy classes to represent surface braids. More natural interpretations are expected in terms of other standard topological invariants. . and Garside gave other groups to which his arguments can be applied.Knotted Surfaces. Each word is in a conjugate form wi Yi xi Yi i . the moves that correspond to cycles in the Cayley . Braid Movies. the moves that are dependent on the choice of height functions. and null homotopy disks in such spaces. . an be the system of arcs dened above. read the labels of the edges intersecting a when we trace it towards the univalent vertex. . However. wn of words. Keeping base point information is such an example. Concluding remarks We have indicated relations among braid movie moves. Then dene a smooth map from the boundary big disk cut open along dotted arcs connecting small disks to the base point. In the preceding section we discussed null homotopy disks in classifying spaces in the presence of generalized black vertices. Carter. . Knot Theory Ramications . Proc. Dennis McLaughlin. V. Dan Flath. and Huebschmann. Acknowledgements We thank the following people for valuable conversations and correspondence John Baez. Scott and Saito. Chiral Potts Models as a Descendant of the SixVertex Model. J.. Preprint. Scott and Saito. The algebraic signicance of such sequences of words and relations among them deserves further study. . Scott and Saito. . G. London Math. YangBaxter Equation in Integrable Systems. Masahico. Seiichi Kamada. Phys. Preprint. . AMS . Carter. Brown. . and Thickstun. in Brown. Masahico Reidemeister Moves for Surface Isotopies and Their Interpretation as Moves to Movies. Syzygies among Elementary String Interactions in Dimension . Knot Theory Ramications . Carter. Bazhanov. World Scientic Publishing. Masahico Planar Generalizations of the YangBaxter equation and Their Skeins. Singapore.. Baxter. since this is a natural context in which the braid movie moves appear. Masahico On Formulations and Solutions of Simplex Equations. . Dan Silver. pp. J. Some of the material here was presented at a special session hosted by YongWu Rong and at a conference hosted by David Yetter and Louis Crane. J. and Kunio Murasugi. Math. Singapore. . Financial support came from Yetter and Crane and from John Luecke. M. V. YangBaxter Equation in Integrable Systems. . . Commun. On Zamolodchikovs Solution of the Tetrahedron Equations. J. Identities among Relations. Lett. J. Scott and Saito. . Lecture Note Series . . Carter. Scott and Saito. . Masahico Diagrammatic Invariants of Knotted Curves and Surfaces. . R. and Stroganov. L. Reprinted in Jimbo. . Ruth Lawrence. M. Bibliography . the moves that push black vertices through Wirtinger relations. R. Soc. R. Carter. Carter. . J. . Lowdimensional Topology. in Jimbo. J. J. World Scientic Publishing. Masahico Canceling Branch Points on Projections of Surfaces in Space. Yu. . John Fischer. Cameron Gordons support nancial and moral is especially appreciated. Scott and Saito. J. T. Phys. Math. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito complex associated to the presentation. J. J. . Masahico Braids and Movies. Preprint in Japanese. R. . and Ogievetsky. Scott and Saito. Carter. Preprint. Joyal. J. Topology of Manifolds. J. . . A Quick Trip Through Knot Theory. and Edwards. GTM . and Voevodsky. A. . . Reprinted in Kohno. A. . Kamada. H. R. Braid Movies. Hietarinta. Braided Monoidal Categories. F. Springer Verlag. Martin and Guillemin. Masahico Some New Solutions to the Permutohedron Equation. Some Constant Solutions to Zamolodchikovs Tetrahedron Equations. Ewen. Singapore. Preprint. M. Preprint. Braided Monoidal . . . O. Commun. Oxford . . . Victor Stable Mappings and Their Singularities. Knot Theory Ramications . Scott and Saito. to appear in Baddhio. . Golubitsky. Kapranov. Macquarie University. J. Kamada. Seiichi A Characterization of Groups of Closed Orientable Surfaces in space. to appear in Topology. The Braid Group and Other Groups. Prentice Hall. J. L. Garside. . R. . C. Seiichi Surfaces in R of Braid Index Three are Ribbon. Scott and Saito. AMS . Jones. Q. V. and Kauman. Seiichi jigen braid no chart hyoji no douchihenkei ni tsuite On Equivalence Moves of Chart Descriptions of Dimensional Braids. J. H. J. Gregory Simplex Equations and Their Solutions. Preprint. Carter.Knotted Surfaces. Preprint. World Scientic Publishing. Kamada. T. . Igor and Moore. World Scientic Publishing. J. Jordanian Solutions of Simplex Equations. New Developments in the Theory of Knots. . R. Seiichi Dimensional Braids and Chart Descriptions. . on Knots and Quantum Field Theory. Fox. Masahico A Diagrammatic Theory of Knotted Surfaces. Kamada. Seiichi Generalized Alexanders and Markovs Theorems in Dimension Four. Preprint. Preprint. . Phys. V. . The Conference Proceedings for AMS Meeting . F. . Kamada. Carter. John Braided Tensor categories and Invariants of knots. and Beyond . Mathematics Reports . A Polynomial Invariant for Knots and Links via von Neumann Algebras. . and Street. Singapore. Math. in Cantrell. Math. . H. Frenkel. Bull. Fischer. . . World Scientic Publishing.. . . X. . and Pekonen. . . Pacic J. A. Kawauchi. and Nijho. and its Representations. Dennis ReidemeisterType Moves for Surfaces in Four Dimensional Space.S. and Voevodsky. V. pp. Tetrahedron Equations and the Relativistic SMatrix of StraightStrings in Dimensions. Helv. . .. . B. J. Libgober. AlexanderArtinMarkov Theory for links in R . Lawrence. Completely Integrable Models in Quasicrystals. . Rudolph. Invariants of Plane Algebraic Curves via Representations of the Braid Groups. Quantum Groups. Lee Algebraic Functions and Closed Braids. World Scientic Publishing. Lomonaco. . The YangBaxter Equation and Invariants of Links. .. A. . Categories and Zamolodchikov Tetrahedra Equations. J. Notes Kobe Univ. Commun. A. Preprint. Semin. . Inst. . and Suzuki. F. . Math. Lee Braided Surfaces and Seifert Ribbons for Closed Braids. Leningrad Math. Preprint. Commun. Topological and Geometric Methods in Field Theory.. Rudolph. Preprint. . Singapore. Representations of Quantized Function Algebras. M. Preprint. Categories and Zamolodchikov Tetrahedra Equation. . Phys. How to Compute the Algebraic Type. . Kapranov. . S. Descriptions of Surfaces in Fourspace. J. V. Reprinted in Kohno New Developments in the Theory of Knots. for NonLinear Studies preprint . Maillet. Scott Carter and Masahico Saito Categories. . in Mickelsson. Topology . . S. . Vector Spaces and Zamolodchikovs Tetrahedra Equations rst draft. W. V. Math. Preprint. T. Invent. . Math. . . Roseman. . E. Notes Kobe Univ. Turaev. . The Algebra of Functions on a Compact Quantum Group. Y.. Phys. Soibelman. . Sam The Homotopy Groups of Knots I. Korepin. Reprinted in Jimbo. Zamolodchikov. M. and Soibelman. Kawauchi. Yang . and Suzuki. . Shibuya. Semin. Kazhdan. Math. J. T. Y. D. Singapore. A. Ruth On Algebras and Triangle Relations. . Math. . Shibuya. M. Math. Lin. Multidimensional Integrable Lattices. O. Descriptions of Surfaces in Fourspace. Math. and the DSimplex Equations. . Math. Commun. Invent. Knotted Surfaces. Singapore. and Beyond Baxter Equation in Integrable Systems. . Braid Movies. World Scientic Publishing.